gnu-maintenance: Use (htmlprag) for 'latest-html-release'.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nikita Gillmann@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2020, 2021 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2021 Christopher Lemmer Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2021 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019, 2020 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
78 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Naga Malleswari@*
79 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Brice Waegeneire@*
80 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 R Veera Kumar@*
81 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Pierre Langlois@*
82 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 pinoaffe@*
83 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 André Batista@*
84 Copyright @copyright{} 2020, 2021 Alexandru-Sergiu Marton@*
85 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 raingloom@*
86 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Daniel Brooks@*
87 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 John Soo@*
88 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jonathan Brielmaier@*
89 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Edgar Vincent@*
90
91 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
92 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
93 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
94 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
95 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
96 Documentation License''.
97 @end copying
98
99 @dircategory System administration
100 @direntry
101 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
102 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
103 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
104 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
105 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
106 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
107 @end direntry
108
109 @dircategory Software development
110 @direntry
111 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
112 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
113 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
114 @end direntry
115
116 @titlepage
117 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
118 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
119 @author The GNU Guix Developers
120
121 @page
122 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
123 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
124 @value{UPDATED} @*
125
126 @insertcopying
127 @end titlepage
128
129 @contents
130
131 @c *********************************************************************
132 @node Top
133 @top GNU Guix
134
135 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
136 package management tool written for the GNU system.
137
138 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
139 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
140 @c translation.
141 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
142 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
143 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
144 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
145 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
146 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining
147 @uref{https://translate.fedoraproject.org/projects/guix/documentation-manual,
148 Weblate}.
149
150 @menu
151 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
152 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
153 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
154 * Getting Started:: Your first steps.
155 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
156 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
157 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
158 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
159 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
160 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
161 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
162 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
163 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
164 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
165 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
166 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
167
168 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
169 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
170 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
171 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
172
173 @detailmenu
174 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
175
176 Introduction
177
178 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
179 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
180
181 Installation
182
183 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
184 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
185 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
186 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
187 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
188 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
189 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
190
191 Setting Up the Daemon
192
193 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
194 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
195 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
196
197 System Installation
198
199 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
200 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
201 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
202 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
203 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
204 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
205 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
206 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
207 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
208
209 Manual Installation
210
211 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
212 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
213
214 Package Management
215
216 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
217 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
218 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
219 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
220 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
221 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
222 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
223 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
224 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
225 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
226
227 Substitutes
228
229 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
230 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
231 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
232 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
233 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
234 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
235 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
236
237 Channels
238
239 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
240 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
241 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
242 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
243 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
244 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
245 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
246 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
247 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
248 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
249 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
250
251 Development
252
253 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
254 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
255 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
256 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
257
258 Programming Interface
259
260 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
261 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
262 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
263 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
264 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
265 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
266 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
267 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
268 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
269 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
270 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile.
271
272 Defining Packages
273
274 * package Reference:: The package data type.
275 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
276
277 Utilities
278
279 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
280 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
281 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
282 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
283 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
284 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
285 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
286 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
287 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
288 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
289 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
290 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
291 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
292 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
293 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
294
295 Invoking @command{guix build}
296
297 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
298 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
299 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
300 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
301
302 System Configuration
303
304 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
305 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
306 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
307 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
308 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
309 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
310 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
311 * Services:: Specifying system services.
312 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
313 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
314 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
315 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
316 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
317 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
318 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
319 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
320 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
321
322 Services
323
324 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
325 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
326 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
327 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
328 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
329 * X Window:: Graphical display.
330 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
331 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
332 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
333 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
334 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
335 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
336 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
337 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
338 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
339 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
340 * Web Services:: Web servers.
341 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
342 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
343 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
344 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
345 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
346 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
347 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
348 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
349 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
350 * Game Services:: Game servers.
351 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
352 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
353 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
354 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
355 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
356
357 Defining Services
358
359 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
360 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
361 * Service Reference:: API reference.
362 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
363
364 Installing Debugging Files
365
366 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
367 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
368
369 Bootstrapping
370
371 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
372 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
373
374 @end detailmenu
375 @end menu
376
377 @c *********************************************************************
378 @node Introduction
379 @chapter Introduction
380
381 @cindex purpose
382 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
383 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
384 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
385 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
386 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
387 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
388 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
389
390 @cindex Guix System
391 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
392 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
393 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
394 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
395 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
396 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
397 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
398 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
399 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
400 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
401
402 @menu
403 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
404 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
405 @end menu
406
407 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
408 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
409
410 @cindex user interfaces
411 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
412 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
413 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage
414 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
415 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
416 @cindex build daemon
417 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
418 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
419 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
420
421 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
422 @cindex customization, of packages
423 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
424 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
425 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
426 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
427 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
428 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
429 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
430 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
431
432 @cindex functional package management
433 @cindex isolation
434 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
435 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
436 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
437 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
438 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
439 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
440 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
441 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
442 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
443 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
444 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
445 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
446 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
447 explicit inputs are visible.
448
449 @cindex store
450 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
451 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
452 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
453 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
454 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
455 input yields a different directory name.
456
457 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
458 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
459 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
460
461
462 @node GNU Distribution
463 @section GNU Distribution
464
465 @cindex Guix System
466 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
467 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
468 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
469 users of that software}.}. The
470 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
471 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
472 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
473 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
474 Guix@tie{}System.
475
476 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
477 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
478 list of available packages can be browsed
479 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
480 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
481
482 @example
483 guix package --list-available
484 @end example
485
486 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
487 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
488 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
489 tools that help users exert that freedom.
490
491 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
492
493 @table @code
494
495 @item x86_64-linux
496 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel.
497
498 @item i686-linux
499 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel.
500
501 @item armhf-linux
502 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
503 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
504 and Linux-Libre kernel.
505
506 @item aarch64-linux
507 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
508
509 @item i586-gnu
510 @uref{https://hurd.gnu.org, GNU/Hurd} on the Intel 32-bit architecture
511 (IA32).
512
513 This configuration is experimental and under development. The easiest
514 way for you to give it a try is by setting up an instance of
515 @code{hurd-vm-service-type} on your GNU/Linux machine
516 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, @code{hurd-vm-service-type}}).
517 @xref{Contributing}, on how to help!
518
519 @item mips64el-linux (deprecated)
520 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
521 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
522 supported; in particular, there is no ongoing work to ensure that this
523 architecture still works. Should someone decide they wish to revive this
524 architecture then the code is still available.
525
526 @end table
527
528 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
529 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
530 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
531 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
532 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
533 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
534 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
535
536 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
537 @code{mips64el-linux}.
538
539 @noindent
540 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
541 @pxref{Porting}.
542
543 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
544 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
545
546
547 @c *********************************************************************
548 @node Installation
549 @chapter Installation
550
551 @cindex installing Guix
552
553 @quotation Note
554 We recommend the use of this
555 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
556 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
557 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
558 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
559 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
560 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
561 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
562 as the root user.
563 @end quotation
564
565 @cindex foreign distro
566 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
567 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
568 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
569 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
570 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
571
572 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
573 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
574
575 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
576 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
577 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
578 ready to use it.
579
580 @menu
581 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
582 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
583 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
584 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
585 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
586 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
587 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
588 @end menu
589
590 @node Binary Installation
591 @section Binary Installation
592
593 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
594 @cindex installer script
595 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
596 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
597 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
598 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
599 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
600
601 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
602 @quotation Note
603 We recommend the use of this
604 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
605 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
606 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
607 user. As root, you can thus run this:
608
609 @example
610 cd /tmp
611 wget https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh
612 chmod +x guix-install.sh
613 ./guix-install.sh
614 @end example
615
616 When you're done, @pxref{Application Setup} for extra configuration you
617 might need, and @ref{Getting Started} for your first steps!
618 @end quotation
619
620 Installing goes along these lines:
621
622 @enumerate
623 @item
624 @cindex downloading Guix binary
625 Download the binary tarball from
626 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz},
627 where @code{x86_64-linux} can be replaced with @code{i686-linux} for an
628 @code{i686} (32-bits) machine already running the kernel Linux, and so on
629 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
630
631 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
632 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
633 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
634
635 @example
636 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
637 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
638 @end example
639
640 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
641 then run this command to import it:
642
643 @example
644 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
645 -qO - | gpg --import -
646 @end example
647
648 @noindent
649 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
650
651 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
652 signature!'' is normal.
653
654 @c end authentication part
655
656 @item
657 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
658 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
659
660 @example
661 # cd /tmp
662 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
663 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz
664 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
665 @end example
666
667 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
668 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
669 step).
670
671 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
672 would overwrite its own essential files.
673
674 The @option{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
675 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
676 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
677 versions are fine).
678 They stem from the fact that all the
679 files in the archive have their modification time set to 1 (which
680 means January 1st, 1970). This is done on purpose to make sure the
681 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
682 reproducible.
683
684 @item
685 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
686 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
687
688 @example
689 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
690 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
691 ~root/.config/guix/current
692 @end example
693
694 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @env{PATH} and other relevant
695 environment variables:
696
697 @example
698 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
699 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
700 @end example
701
702 @item
703 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
704 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
705
706 @item
707 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
708
709 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
710 with these commands:
711
712 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
713 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
714 @c files into place.
715 @c
716 @c See this thread for more information:
717 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
718
719 @example
720 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/gnu-store.mount \
721 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
722 /etc/systemd/system/
723 # systemctl enable --now gnu-store.mount guix-daemon
724 @end example
725
726 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
727
728 @example
729 # initctl reload-configuration
730 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
731 /etc/init/
732 # start guix-daemon
733 @end example
734
735 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
736
737 @example
738 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
739 --build-users-group=guixbuild
740 @end example
741
742 @item
743 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
744 for instance with:
745
746 @example
747 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
748 # cd /usr/local/bin
749 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
750 @end example
751
752 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
753 there:
754
755 @example
756 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
757 # cd /usr/local/share/info
758 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
759 do ln -s $i ; done
760 @end example
761
762 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
763 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
764 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
765 Info search path).
766
767 @item
768 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
769 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
770 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
771
772 @example
773 # guix archive --authorize < \
774 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
775 @end example
776
777 @item
778 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
779 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
780 @end enumerate
781
782 Voilà, the installation is complete!
783
784 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
785 the root profile:
786
787 @example
788 # guix install hello
789 @end example
790
791 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
792 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
793
794 @example
795 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
796 @end example
797
798 @noindent
799 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
800
801 @example
802 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
803 --profile-name=current-guix guix
804 @end example
805
806 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
807
808 @node Requirements
809 @section Requirements
810
811 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
812 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
813 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
814 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
815
816 @cindex official website
817 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
818 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
819
820 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
821
822 @itemize
823 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
824 2.2.x;
825 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
826 0.1.0 or later;
827 @item
828 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
829 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
830 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
831 @item
832 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
833 or later;
834 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zlib/guile-zlib, Guile-zlib},
835 version 0.1.0 or later;
836 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-lzlib/guile-lzlib, Guile-lzlib};
837 @item @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-avahi/, Guile-Avahi};
838 @item
839 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
840 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, version 0.3.0
841 or later;
842 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON}
843 4.3.0 or later;
844 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
845 @end itemize
846
847 The following dependencies are optional:
848
849 @itemize
850 @item
851 @c Note: We need at least 0.13.0 for #:nodelay.
852 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
853 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
854 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
855 version 0.13.0 or later.
856
857 @item
858 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zstd/guile-zstd, Guile-zstd}, for zstd
859 compression and decompression in @command{guix publish} and for
860 substitutes (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
861
862 @item
863 @uref{https://ngyro.com/software/guile-semver.html, Guile-Semver} for
864 the @code{crate} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
865
866 @item
867 @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-lib/doc/ref/htmlprag/, Guile-Lib} for
868 the @code{go} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}) and for some of
869 the ``updaters'' (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
870
871 @item
872 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
873 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
874 @end itemize
875
876 Unless @option{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
877 following packages are also needed:
878
879 @itemize
880 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
881 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
882 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
883 C++11 standard.
884 @end itemize
885
886 @cindex state directory
887 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
888 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
889 using the @option{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
890 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
891 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
892 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
893 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
894 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
895
896 @node Running the Test Suite
897 @section Running the Test Suite
898
899 @cindex test suite
900 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
901 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
902 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
903 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
904 suite, type:
905
906 @example
907 make check
908 @end example
909
910 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
911 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
912 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
913 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
914 cache.
915
916 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
917 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
918
919 @example
920 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
921 @end example
922
923 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
924 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
925 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
926
927 @example
928 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
929 @end example
930
931 The underlying SRFI 64 custom Automake test driver used for the 'check'
932 test suite (located at @file{build-aux/test-driver.scm}) also allows
933 selecting which test cases to run at a finer level, via its
934 @option{--select} and @option{--exclude} options. Here's an example, to
935 run all the test cases from the @file{tests/packages.scm} test file
936 whose names start with ``transaction-upgrade-entry'':
937
938 @example
939 export SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--select=^transaction-upgrade-entry"
940 make check TESTS="tests/packages.scm"
941 @end example
942
943 Those wishing to inspect the results of failed tests directly from the
944 command line can add the @option{--errors-only=yes} option to the
945 @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable and set the @code{VERBOSE}
946 Automake makefile variable, as in:
947
948 @example
949 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --errors-only=yes" VERBOSE=1
950 @end example
951
952 The @option{--show-duration=yes} option can be used to print the
953 duration of the individual test cases, when used in combination with
954 @option{--brief=no}:
955
956 @example
957 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --show-duration=yes"
958 @end example
959
960 @xref{Parallel Test Harness,,,automake,GNU Automake} for more
961 information about the Automake Parallel Test Harness.
962
963 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
964 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
965 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
966 your message.
967
968 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
969 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
970 Guix is already installed, using:
971
972 @example
973 make check-system
974 @end example
975
976 @noindent
977 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
978
979 @example
980 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
981 @end example
982
983 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
984 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
985 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
986 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
987 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
988 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
989
990 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
991 all the details.
992
993 @node Setting Up the Daemon
994 @section Setting Up the Daemon
995
996 @cindex daemon
997 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
998 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
999 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
1000 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
1001 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
1002 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
1003 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
1004
1005 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
1006 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
1007 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
1008
1009 @menu
1010 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
1011 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
1012 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
1013 @end menu
1014
1015 @node Build Environment Setup
1016 @subsection Build Environment Setup
1017
1018 @cindex build environment
1019 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
1020 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
1021 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
1022 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
1023 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
1024 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
1025 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
1026
1027 @cindex build users
1028 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
1029 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
1030 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
1031 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
1032 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
1033 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
1034 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
1035 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
1036 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
1037 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
1038
1039 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
1040 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
1041
1042 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
1043 @c for why `-G' is needed.
1044 @example
1045 # groupadd --system guixbuild
1046 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
1047 do
1048 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
1049 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
1050 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
1051 guixbuilder$i;
1052 done
1053 @end example
1054
1055 @noindent
1056 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
1057 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
1058 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
1059 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
1060 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
1061 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
1062 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
1063
1064 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
1065 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
1066 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
1067 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
1068 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
1069 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
1070 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
1071 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
1072
1073 @example
1074 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1075 @end example
1076
1077 @cindex chroot
1078 @noindent
1079 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
1080 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
1081 environment contains nothing but:
1082
1083 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
1084 @itemize
1085 @item
1086 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
1087 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
1088 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
1089 can only be created if the host has them.};
1090
1091 @item
1092 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
1093 since a separate PID name space is used;
1094
1095 @item
1096 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
1097 user @file{nobody};
1098
1099 @item
1100 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
1101
1102 @item
1103 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
1104 @code{127.0.0.1};
1105
1106 @item
1107 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
1108 @end itemize
1109
1110 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
1111 @i{via} the @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
1112 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
1113 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
1114 This way, the value of @env{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1115 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1116 capture the name of their build tree.
1117
1118 @vindex http_proxy
1119 @vindex https_proxy
1120 The daemon also honors the @env{http_proxy} and @env{https_proxy}
1121 environment variables for HTTP and HTTPS downloads it performs, be it
1122 for fixed-output derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes
1123 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1124
1125 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1126 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @option{--disable-chroot}.
1127 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1128 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1129 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1130 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1131 @emph{pure} functions.
1132
1133
1134 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1135 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1136
1137 @cindex offloading
1138 @cindex build hook
1139 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1140 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1141 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1142 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1143 present.}. When that feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build
1144 machines is read from @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build
1145 is requested, for instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to
1146 offload it to one of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the
1147 derivation, in particular its system types---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
1148 A single machine can have multiple system types, either because its
1149 architecture natively supports it, via emulation
1150 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, Transparent Emulation with QEMU}),
1151 or both. Missing prerequisites for the build are
1152 copied over SSH to the target machine, which then proceeds with the
1153 build; upon success the output(s) of the build are copied back to the
1154 initial machine. The offload facility comes with a basic scheduler that
1155 attempts to select the best machine. The best machine is chosen among
1156 the available machines based on criteria such as:
1157
1158 @enumerate
1159 @item
1160 The availability of a build slot. A build machine can have as many
1161 build slots (connections) as the value of the @code{parallel-builds}
1162 field of its @code{build-machine} object.
1163
1164 @item
1165 Its relative speed, as defined via the @code{speed} field of its
1166 @code{build-machine} object.
1167
1168 @item
1169 Its load. The normalized machine load must be lower than a threshold
1170 value, configurable via the @code{overload-threshold} field of its
1171 @code{build-machine} object.
1172
1173 @item
1174 Disk space availability. More than a 100 MiB must be available.
1175 @end enumerate
1176
1177 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1178
1179 @lisp
1180 (list (build-machine
1181 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1182 (systems (list "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux"))
1183 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1184 (user "bob")
1185 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1186
1187 (build-machine
1188 (name "armeight.example.org")
1189 (systems (list "aarch64-linux"))
1190 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1191 (user "alice")
1192 (private-key
1193 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1194 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1195 @end lisp
1196
1197 @noindent
1198 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1199 the @code{x86_64} and @code{i686} architectures and one for the
1200 @code{aarch64} architecture.
1201
1202 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1203 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1204 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1205 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1206 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1207 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1208 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1209 detailed below.
1210
1211 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1212 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1213 builds. The important fields are:
1214
1215 @table @code
1216
1217 @item name
1218 The host name of the remote machine.
1219
1220 @item systems
1221 The system types the remote machine supports---e.g., @code{(list
1222 "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux")}.
1223
1224 @item user
1225 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1226 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1227 allow non-interactive logins.
1228
1229 @item host-key
1230 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1231 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1232 long string that looks like this:
1233
1234 @example
1235 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1236 @end example
1237
1238 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1239 key can be found in a file such as
1240 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1241
1242 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1243 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1244 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1245 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1246
1247 @example
1248 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1249 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1250 @end example
1251
1252 @end table
1253
1254 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1255
1256 @table @asis
1257
1258 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1259 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1260
1261 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1262 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1263 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1264
1265 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1266 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1267
1268 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1269 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1270 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1271
1272 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1273 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1274
1275 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1276 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1277 to on that machine.
1278
1279 @item @code{overload-threshold} (default: @code{0.6})
1280 The load threshold above which a potential offload machine is
1281 disregarded by the offload scheduler. The value roughly translates to
1282 the total processor usage of the build machine, ranging from 0.0 (0%) to
1283 1.0 (100%). It can also be disabled by setting
1284 @code{overload-threshold} to @code{#f}.
1285
1286 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1287 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1288
1289 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1290 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1291 machines with a higher speed factor.
1292
1293 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1294 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1295 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1296 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1297 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1298
1299 @end table
1300 @end deftp
1301
1302 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1303 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1304
1305 @example
1306 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1307 @end example
1308
1309 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1310 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1311 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1312 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1313 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1314
1315 @example
1316 # guix archive --generate-key
1317 @end example
1318
1319 @noindent
1320 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1321 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1322
1323 @example
1324 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1325 @end example
1326
1327 @noindent
1328 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1329
1330 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1331 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1332 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1333 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1334 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1335
1336 @cindex offload test
1337 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1338 master node:
1339
1340 @example
1341 # guix offload test
1342 @end example
1343
1344 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1345 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guix is
1346 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1347 from it, and report any error in the process.
1348
1349 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1350 command line:
1351
1352 @example
1353 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1354 @end example
1355
1356 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1357 regular expression like this:
1358
1359 @example
1360 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1361 @end example
1362
1363 @cindex offload status
1364 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1365 main node:
1366
1367 @example
1368 # guix offload status
1369 @end example
1370
1371
1372 @node SELinux Support
1373 @subsection SELinux Support
1374
1375 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1376 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1377 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1378 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1379 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1380 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1381 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1382 be used on Guix System.
1383
1384 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1385 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1386 To install the policy run this command as root:
1387
1388 @example
1389 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1390 @end example
1391
1392 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1393 mechanism provided by your system.
1394
1395 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1396 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1397 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1398 command:
1399
1400 @example
1401 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1402 @end example
1403
1404 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1405 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1406 operations.
1407
1408 @subsubsection Limitations
1409 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1410
1411 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1412 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1413 the Guix daemon.
1414
1415 @enumerate
1416 @item
1417 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1418 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1419 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1420 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1421
1422 @item
1423 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1424 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1425 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1426 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1427 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1428 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1429 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1430 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1431 reading and following these links.
1432
1433 @item
1434 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1435 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1436 differently from files.
1437
1438 @item
1439 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1440 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1441 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1442 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1443 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1444 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1445 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1446 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1447 allowed for processes in that domain.
1448
1449 You will need to relabel the store directory after all upgrades to
1450 @file{guix-daemon}, such as after running @code{guix pull}. Assuming the
1451 store is in @file{/gnu}, you can do this with @code{restorecon -vR /gnu},
1452 or by other means provided by your operating system.
1453
1454 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1455 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1456 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1457 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1458 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1459 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1460 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1461 @end enumerate
1462
1463 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1464 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1465
1466 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1467 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1468 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1469 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1470
1471 @example
1472 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1473 @end example
1474
1475 @noindent
1476 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1477
1478 @cindex chroot
1479 @cindex container, build environment
1480 @cindex build environment
1481 @cindex reproducible builds
1482 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1483 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1484 @option{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1485 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1486 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1487 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1488 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1489 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1490 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1491 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1492 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1493
1494 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1495 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1496 its @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1497 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1498 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1499
1500 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1501 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1502 (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1503
1504 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1505 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands). The
1506 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1507 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1508 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1509
1510 The following command-line options are supported:
1511
1512 @table @code
1513 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1514 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1515 the Daemon, build users}).
1516
1517 @item --no-substitutes
1518 @cindex substitutes
1519 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1520 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1521 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1522
1523 When the daemon runs with @option{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1524 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1525 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1526
1527 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1528 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1529 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1530 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1531 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1532
1533 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1534 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1535
1536 @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}, for more information on
1537 how to configure the daemon to get substitutes from other servers.
1538
1539 @cindex offloading
1540 @item --no-offload
1541 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1542 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1543 builds to remote machines.
1544
1545 @item --cache-failures
1546 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1547
1548 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1549 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1550 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1551 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1552
1553 @item --cores=@var{n}
1554 @itemx -c @var{n}
1555 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1556 as available.
1557
1558 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1559 as the @option{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1560 guix build}).
1561
1562 The effect is to define the @env{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1563 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1564 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1565
1566 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1567 @itemx -M @var{n}
1568 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1569 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1570 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1571 Setup}), or simply fail.
1572
1573 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1574 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1575 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1576
1577 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1578
1579 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1580 Build Options, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
1581
1582 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1583 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1584 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1585
1586 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1587
1588 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1589 Build Options, @option{--timeout}}).
1590
1591 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1592 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1593 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1594 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1595 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1596
1597 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1598 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1599 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1600
1601 @item --debug
1602 Produce debugging output.
1603
1604 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1605 overridden by clients, for example the @option{--verbosity} option of
1606 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1607
1608 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1609 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1610
1611 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1612 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1613 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1614 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1615 needs.
1616
1617 @item --disable-chroot
1618 Disable chroot builds.
1619
1620 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1621 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1622 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1623 account.
1624
1625 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1626 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1627 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1628
1629 Unless @option{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1630 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1631 them with Bzip2 by default.
1632
1633 @item --discover[=yes|no]
1634 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
1635 and DNS-SD.
1636
1637 This feature is still experimental. However, here are a few
1638 considerations.
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item
1642 It might be faster/less expensive than fetching from remote servers;
1643 @item
1644 There are no security risks, only genuine substitutes will be used
1645 (@pxref{Substitute Authentication});
1646 @item
1647 An attacker advertising @command{guix publish} on your LAN cannot serve
1648 you malicious binaries, but they can learn what software you’re
1649 installing;
1650 @item
1651 Servers may serve substitute over HTTP, unencrypted, so anyone on the
1652 LAN can see what software you’re installing.
1653 @end enumerate
1654
1655 It is also possible to enable or disable substitute server discovery at
1656 run-time by running:
1657
1658 @example
1659 herd discover guix-daemon on
1660 herd discover guix-daemon off
1661 @end example
1662
1663 @item --disable-deduplication
1664 @cindex deduplication
1665 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1666
1667 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1668 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1669 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1670 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1671 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1672 this optimization.
1673
1674 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1675 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1676 derivations.
1677
1678 @cindex GC roots
1679 @cindex garbage collector roots
1680 When set to @code{yes}, the GC will keep the outputs of any live
1681 derivation available in the store---the @file{.drv} files. The default
1682 is @code{no}, meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are
1683 reachable from a GC root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC
1684 roots.
1685
1686 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1687 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1688 corresponding to live outputs.
1689
1690 When set to @code{yes}, as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1691 derivations---i.e., @file{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1692 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1693 items in their store. Setting it to @code{no} saves a bit of disk
1694 space.
1695
1696 In this way, setting @option{--gc-keep-derivations} to @code{yes} causes
1697 liveness to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting
1698 @option{--gc-keep-outputs} to @code{yes} causes liveness to flow from
1699 derivations to outputs. When both are set to @code{yes}, the effect is
1700 to keep all the build prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries,
1701 and other build-time tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of
1702 whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC root. This is
1703 convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1704
1705 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1706 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1707 kernel's @command{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1708
1709 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1710 on the kernel version number.
1711
1712 @item --lose-logs
1713 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1714 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1715
1716 @item --system=@var{system}
1717 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1718 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1719 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1720
1721 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1722 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1723 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1724 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1725 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1726
1727 @table @code
1728 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1729 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1730 creating it if needed.
1731
1732 @item --listen=localhost
1733 @cindex daemon, remote access
1734 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1735 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1736 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1737 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1738 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1739
1740 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1741 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1742 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1743 @end table
1744
1745 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1746 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1747 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1748 by setting the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1749 (@pxref{The Store, @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1750
1751 @quotation Note
1752 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1753 @option{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1754 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1755 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1756 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1757 @end quotation
1758
1759 When @option{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1760 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1761 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1762 @end table
1763
1764
1765 @node Application Setup
1766 @section Application Setup
1767
1768 @cindex foreign distro
1769 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1770 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1771 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1772
1773 @subsection Locales
1774
1775 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1776 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1777 @vindex LOCPATH
1778 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1779 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1780 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1781 available with Guix and then define the @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1782 variable:
1783
1784 @example
1785 $ guix install glibc-locales
1786 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1787 @end example
1788
1789 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1790 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1791 917@tie{}MiB@. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1792 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1793
1794 The @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @env{LOCPATH}
1795 (@pxref{Locale Names, @env{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1796 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1797
1798 @enumerate
1799 @item
1800 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1801 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1802 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1803 incompatible locale data.
1804
1805 @item
1806 libc suffixes each entry of @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1807 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1808 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1809 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1810 data in the right format.
1811 @end enumerate
1812
1813 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1814 versions may be incompatible.
1815
1816 @subsection Name Service Switch
1817
1818 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1819 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1820 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1821 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1822 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1823 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1824 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1825 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1826 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1827 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1828
1829 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1830 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1831 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1832 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1833 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1834
1835 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1836 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1837 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1838 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1839 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1840 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1841 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1842 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1843 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1844 Reference Manual}).
1845
1846 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1847 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1848 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1849 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1850 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1851 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1852 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1853 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1854 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1855
1856 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1857 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1858 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1859 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1860
1861 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1862 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1863 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1864 themselves.
1865
1866 @subsection X11 Fonts
1867
1868 @cindex fonts
1869 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1870 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1871 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1872 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1873 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1874 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1875 @code{font-gnu-freefont}.
1876
1877 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1878 @cindex font cache
1879 Once you have installed or removed fonts, or when you notice an
1880 application that does not find fonts, you may need to install Fontconfig
1881 and to force an update of its font cache by running:
1882
1883 @example
1884 guix install fontconfig
1885 fc-cache -rv
1886 @end example
1887
1888 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1889 graphical applications, consider installing
1890 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1891 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1892 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1893 for Chinese languages:
1894
1895 @example
1896 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1897 @end example
1898
1899 @cindex @code{xterm}
1900 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1901 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1902 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1903
1904 @example
1905 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1906 @end example
1907
1908 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1909 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1910
1911 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1912 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1913 @example
1914 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1915 @end example
1916
1917 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1918 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1919 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1920
1921
1922 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1923
1924 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1925 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1926 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1927
1928 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1929 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1930 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1931 information.
1932
1933 @subsection Emacs Packages
1934
1935 @cindex @code{emacs}
1936 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the Elisp files are placed
1937 under the @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/} directory of the profile in
1938 which they are installed. The Elisp libraries are made available to
1939 Emacs through the @env{EMACSLOADPATH} environment variable, which is
1940 set when installing Emacs itself.
1941
1942 Additionally, autoload definitions are automatically evaluated at the
1943 initialization of Emacs, by the Guix-specific
1944 @code{guix-emacs-autoload-packages} procedure. If, for some reason, you
1945 want to avoid auto-loading the Emacs packages installed with Guix, you
1946 can do so by running Emacs with the @option{--no-site-file} option
1947 (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1948
1949
1950 @node Upgrading Guix
1951 @section Upgrading Guix
1952
1953 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1954
1955 To upgrade Guix, run:
1956
1957 @example
1958 guix pull
1959 @end example
1960
1961 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1962
1963 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1964 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1965 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1966
1967 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1968
1969 @example
1970 sudo -i guix pull
1971 @end example
1972
1973 @noindent
1974 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1975 tool):
1976
1977 @example
1978 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1979 @end example
1980
1981 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1982 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1983
1984 @c TODO What else?
1985
1986 @c *********************************************************************
1987 @node System Installation
1988 @chapter System Installation
1989
1990 @cindex installing Guix System
1991 @cindex Guix System, installation
1992 This section explains how to install Guix System
1993 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1994 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1995 @pxref{Installation}.
1996
1997 @ifinfo
1998 @quotation Note
1999 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
2000 @c installation image.
2001 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
2002 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
2003 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
2004 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
2005
2006 Alternatively, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
2007 available.
2008 @end quotation
2009 @end ifinfo
2010
2011 @menu
2012 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
2013 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
2014 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
2015 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
2016 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
2017 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
2018 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
2019 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
2020 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
2021 @end menu
2022
2023 @node Limitations
2024 @section Limitations
2025
2026 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
2027 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
2028 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
2029
2030 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
2031 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
2032
2033 @itemize
2034 @item
2035 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
2036 may be missing.
2037
2038 @item
2039 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
2040 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
2041 missing.
2042 @end itemize
2043
2044 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
2045 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
2046 info.
2047
2048
2049 @node Hardware Considerations
2050 @section Hardware Considerations
2051
2052 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
2053 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
2054 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
2055 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
2056 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
2057 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
2058 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
2059 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
2060 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
2061
2062 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
2063 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
2064 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
2065 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
2066 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
2067 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
2068 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
2069 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
2070 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
2071
2072 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
2073 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
2074 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
2075 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
2076 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
2077 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
2078
2079 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
2080 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
2081 about their support in GNU/Linux.
2082
2083
2084 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
2085 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
2086
2087 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
2088 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
2089 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz},
2090 where you can replace @code{x86_64-linux} with one of:
2091
2092 @table @code
2093 @item x86_64-linux
2094 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
2095
2096 @item i686-linux
2097 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
2098 @end table
2099
2100 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
2101 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
2102 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
2103
2104 @example
2105 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2106 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2107 @end example
2108
2109 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
2110 then run this command to import it:
2111
2112 @example
2113 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
2114 -qO - | gpg --import -
2115 @end example
2116
2117 @noindent
2118 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
2119
2120 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
2121 signature!'' is normal.
2122
2123 @c end duplication
2124
2125 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
2126 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
2127
2128 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
2129
2130 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
2131
2132 @enumerate
2133 @item
2134 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2135
2136 @example
2137 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2138 @end example
2139
2140 @item
2141 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
2142 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
2143 copy the image with:
2144
2145 @example
2146 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX status=progress
2147 sync
2148 @end example
2149
2150 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
2151 @end enumerate
2152
2153 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
2154
2155 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
2156
2157 @enumerate
2158 @item
2159 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2160
2161 @example
2162 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2163 @end example
2164
2165 @item
2166 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
2167 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
2168 copy the image with:
2169
2170 @example
2171 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso
2172 @end example
2173
2174 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2175 @end enumerate
2176
2177 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2178
2179 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2180 the USB stick or DVD@. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2181 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2182 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2183 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2184
2185 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2186 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2187
2188
2189 @node Preparing for Installation
2190 @section Preparing for Installation
2191
2192 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2193 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternatively,
2194 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2195 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2196 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2197
2198 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2199 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2200 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2201 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2202 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2203 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2204 with the middle button.
2205
2206 @quotation Note
2207 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2208 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2209 ``Networking'' section below.
2210 @end quotation
2211
2212 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2213 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2214
2215 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2216 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2217
2218 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2219 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2220 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2221 the networking dialog.
2222
2223 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2224
2225 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2226 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2227 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2228 things.
2229
2230 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2231
2232 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2233 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2234
2235 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2236
2237 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2238 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2239 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2240 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2241
2242
2243 @node Manual Installation
2244 @section Manual Installation
2245
2246 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2247 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2248 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2249 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2250 Installation}).
2251
2252 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2253 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2254 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2255 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2256 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2257
2258 @menu
2259 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2260 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2261 @end menu
2262
2263 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2264 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2265
2266 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2267 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2268 guide you through this.
2269
2270 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2271
2272 @cindex keyboard layout
2273 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2274 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2275 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2276
2277 @example
2278 loadkeys dvorak
2279 @end example
2280
2281 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2282 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2283 more information.
2284
2285 @subsubsection Networking
2286
2287 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2288
2289 @example
2290 ifconfig -a
2291 @end example
2292
2293 @noindent
2294 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2295
2296 @example
2297 ip address
2298 @end example
2299
2300 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2301 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2302 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2303 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2304 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2305
2306 @table @asis
2307 @item Wired connection
2308 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2309 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2310
2311 @example
2312 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2313 @end example
2314
2315 @noindent
2316 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2317
2318 @example
2319 ip link set @var{interface} up
2320 @end example
2321
2322 @item Wireless connection
2323 @cindex wireless
2324 @cindex WiFi
2325 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2326 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2327 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2328 @command{nano}:
2329
2330 @example
2331 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2332 @end example
2333
2334 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2335 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2336 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2337
2338 @example
2339 network=@{
2340 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2341 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2342 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2343 @}
2344 @end example
2345
2346 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2347 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2348 network interface you want to use):
2349
2350 @example
2351 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2352 @end example
2353
2354 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2355 @end table
2356
2357 @cindex DHCP
2358 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2359 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2360
2361 @example
2362 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2363 @end example
2364
2365 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2366
2367 @example
2368 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2369 @end example
2370
2371 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2372 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2373
2374 @cindex proxy, during system installation
2375 If you need HTTP and HTTPS access to go through a proxy, run the
2376 following command:
2377
2378 @example
2379 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon @var{URL}
2380 @end example
2381
2382 @noindent
2383 where @var{URL} is the proxy URL, for example
2384 @code{http://example.org:8118}.
2385
2386 @cindex installing over SSH
2387 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2388 an SSH server:
2389
2390 @example
2391 herd start ssh-daemon
2392 @end example
2393
2394 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2395 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2396
2397 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2398
2399 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2400 then format the target partition(s).
2401
2402 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2403 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2404 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2405 the partition layout you want:
2406
2407 @example
2408 cfdisk
2409 @end example
2410
2411 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2412 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2413 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2414 manual}).
2415
2416 @cindex EFI, installation
2417 @cindex UEFI, installation
2418 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2419 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2420 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2421 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2422
2423 @example
2424 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2425 @end example
2426
2427 @quotation Note
2428 @vindex grub-bootloader
2429 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2430 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2431 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2432 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2433 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2434 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2435 bootloaders.
2436 @end quotation
2437
2438 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2439 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2440 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, JFS, and F2FS file systems. In
2441 particular, code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these
2442 file system types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2443 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2444
2445 @example
2446 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2447 @end example
2448
2449 For the root file system, ext4 is the most widely used format. Other
2450 file systems, such as Btrfs, support compression, which is reported to
2451 nicely complement file deduplication that the daemon performs
2452 independently of the file system (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2453 deduplication}).
2454
2455 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2456 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2457 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2458 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2459 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2460 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2461
2462 @example
2463 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2464 @end example
2465
2466 @cindex encrypted disk
2467 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2468 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2469 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2470 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information). Assuming you want to
2471 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2472 be along these lines:
2473
2474 @example
2475 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2476 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2477 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2478 @end example
2479
2480 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2481 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2482 root file system):
2483
2484 @example
2485 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2486 @end example
2487
2488 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2489 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2490 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2491 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2492
2493 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2494 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2495 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2496 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2497
2498 @example
2499 mkswap /dev/sda3
2500 swapon /dev/sda3
2501 @end example
2502
2503 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2504 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2505 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2506 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2507 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2508 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2509
2510 @example
2511 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2512 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2513 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2514 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2515 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2516 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2517 @end example
2518
2519 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2520 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2521 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2522
2523 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2524 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2525
2526 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2527 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2528
2529 @example
2530 herd start cow-store /mnt
2531 @end example
2532
2533 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2534 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2535 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2536 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2537 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2538
2539 Next, you have to edit a file and
2540 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2541 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2542 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2543 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2544 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2545 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2546 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2547 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2548 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2549
2550 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2551 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2552 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2553 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2554 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2555 something along these lines:
2556
2557 @example
2558 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2559 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2560 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2561 @end example
2562
2563 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2564 in particular:
2565
2566 @itemize
2567 @item
2568 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2569 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2570 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2571 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2572 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2573 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2574 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2575 configuration.
2576
2577 @item
2578 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2579 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2580 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2581 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2582
2583 @item
2584 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2585 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2586 @end itemize
2587
2588 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2589 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2590 under @file{/mnt}):
2591
2592 @example
2593 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2594 @end example
2595
2596 @noindent
2597 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2598 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2599 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2600 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2601
2602 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2603 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2604 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2605 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2606 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2607 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2608 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2609
2610
2611 @node After System Installation
2612 @section After System Installation
2613
2614 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2615 system whenever you want by running, say:
2616
2617 @example
2618 guix pull
2619 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2620 @end example
2621
2622 @noindent
2623 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2624 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2625 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2626
2627 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2628 @quotation Note
2629 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2630 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2631 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @env{PATH} unchanged. To
2632 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2633
2634 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2635 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is run
2636 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2637 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2638 @end quotation
2639
2640 Now, @pxref{Getting Started}, and
2641 join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2642 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2643
2644
2645 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2646 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2647
2648 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2649 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2650 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2651 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2652 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2653 section is for you.
2654
2655 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2656 disk image, follow these steps:
2657
2658 @enumerate
2659 @item
2660 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2661 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2662
2663 @item
2664 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2665 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2666
2667 @example
2668 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2669 @end example
2670
2671 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2672 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2673
2674 @item
2675 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2676
2677 @example
2678 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2679 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2680 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2681 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2682 @end example
2683
2684 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2685 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2686
2687 @item
2688 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2689 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2690 @end enumerate
2691
2692 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2693 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2694 that.
2695
2696 @node Building the Installation Image
2697 @section Building the Installation Image
2698
2699 @cindex installation image
2700 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2701 system} command, specifically:
2702
2703 @example
2704 guix system image -t iso9660 gnu/system/install.scm
2705 @end example
2706
2707 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2708 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2709 about the installation image.
2710
2711 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2712
2713 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2714 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2715
2716 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2717 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2718 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2719
2720 @example
2721 guix system image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2722 @end example
2723
2724 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2725 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2726
2727 @c *********************************************************************
2728 @node Getting Started
2729 @chapter Getting Started
2730
2731 Presumably, you've reached this section because either you have
2732 installed Guix on top of another distribution (@pxref{Installation}), or
2733 you've installed the standalone Guix System (@pxref{System
2734 Installation}). It's time for you to get started using Guix and this
2735 section aims to help you do that and give you a feel of what it's like.
2736
2737 Guix is about installing software, so probably the first thing you'll
2738 want to do is to actually look for software. Let's say you're looking
2739 for a text editor, you can run:
2740
2741 @example
2742 guix search text editor
2743 @end example
2744
2745 This command shows you a number of matching @dfn{packages}, each time
2746 showing the package's name, version, a description, and additional info.
2747 Once you've found out the one you want to use, let's say Emacs (ah ha!),
2748 you can go ahead and install it (run this command as a regular user,
2749 @emph{no need for root privileges}!):
2750
2751 @example
2752 guix install emacs
2753 @end example
2754
2755 @cindex profile
2756 You've installed your first package, congrats! The package is now
2757 visible in your default @dfn{profile}, @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}---a
2758 profile is a directory containing installed packages.
2759 In the process, you've
2760 probably noticed that Guix downloaded pre-built binaries; or, if you
2761 explicitly chose to @emph{not} use pre-built binaries, then probably
2762 Guix is still building software (@pxref{Substitutes}, for more info).
2763
2764 Unless you're using Guix System, the @command{guix install} command must
2765 have printed this hint:
2766
2767 @example
2768 hint: Consider setting the necessary environment variables by running:
2769
2770 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile"
2771 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2772
2773 Alternately, see `guix package --search-paths -p "$HOME/.guix-profile"'.
2774 @end example
2775
2776 Indeed, you must now tell your shell where @command{emacs} and other
2777 programs installed with Guix are to be found. Pasting the two lines
2778 above will do just that: it will add
2779 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin}---which is where the installed package
2780 is---to the @code{PATH} environment variable. You can paste these two
2781 lines in your shell so they take effect right away, but more importantly
2782 you should add them to @file{~/.bash_profile} (or equivalent file if you
2783 do not use Bash) so that environment variables are set next time you
2784 spawn a shell. You only need to do this once and other search paths
2785 environment variables will be taken care of similarly---e.g., if you
2786 eventually install @code{python} and Python libraries, @code{PYTHONPATH}
2787 will be defined.
2788
2789 You can go on installing packages at your will. To list installed
2790 packages, run:
2791
2792 @example
2793 guix package --list-installed
2794 @end example
2795
2796 To remove a package, you would unsurprisingly run @command{guix remove}.
2797 A distinguishing feature is the ability to @dfn{roll back} any operation
2798 you made---installation, removal, upgrade---by simply typing:
2799
2800 @example
2801 guix package --roll-back
2802 @end example
2803
2804 This is because each operation is in fact a @dfn{transaction} that
2805 creates a new @dfn{generation}. These generations and the difference
2806 between them can be displayed by running:
2807
2808 @example
2809 guix package --list-generations
2810 @end example
2811
2812 Now you know the basics of package management!
2813
2814 @quotation Going further
2815 @xref{Package Management}, for more about package management. You may
2816 like @dfn{declarative} package management with @command{guix package
2817 --manifest}, managing separate @dfn{profiles} with @option{--profile},
2818 deleting old generations, collecting garbage, and other nifty features
2819 that will come in handy as you become more familiar with Guix. If you
2820 are a developer, @pxref{Development} for additional tools. And if
2821 you're curious, @pxref{Features}, to peek under the hood.
2822 @end quotation
2823
2824 Once you've installed a set of packages, you will want to periodically
2825 @emph{upgrade} them to the latest and greatest version. To do that, you
2826 will first pull the latest revision of Guix and its package collection:
2827
2828 @example
2829 guix pull
2830 @end example
2831
2832 The end result is a new @command{guix} command, under
2833 @file{~/.config/guix/current/bin}. Unless you're on Guix System, the
2834 first time you run @command{guix pull}, be sure to follow the hint that
2835 the command prints and, similar to what we saw above, paste these two
2836 lines in your terminal and @file{.bash_profile}:
2837
2838 @example
2839 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.config/guix/current"
2840 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2841 @end example
2842
2843 @noindent
2844 You must also instruct your shell to point to this new @command{guix}:
2845
2846 @example
2847 hash guix
2848 @end example
2849
2850 At this point, you're running a brand new Guix. You can thus go ahead
2851 and actually upgrade all the packages you previously installed:
2852
2853 @example
2854 guix upgrade
2855 @end example
2856
2857 As you run this command, you will see that binaries are downloaded (or
2858 perhaps some packages are built), and eventually you end up with the
2859 upgraded packages. Should one of these upgraded packages not be to your
2860 liking, remember you can always roll back!
2861
2862 You can display the exact revision of Guix you're currently using by
2863 running:
2864
2865 @example
2866 guix describe
2867 @end example
2868
2869 The information it displays is @emph{all it takes to reproduce the exact
2870 same Guix}, be it at a different point in time or on a different
2871 machine.
2872
2873 @quotation Going further
2874 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information. @xref{Channels}, on
2875 how to specify additional @dfn{channels} to pull packages from, how to
2876 replicate Guix, and more. You may also find @command{time-machine}
2877 handy (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
2878 @end quotation
2879
2880 If you installed Guix System, one of the first things you'll want to do
2881 is to upgrade your system. Once you've run @command{guix pull} to get
2882 the latest Guix, you can upgrade the system like this:
2883
2884 @example
2885 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2886 @end example
2887
2888 Upon completion, the system runs the latest versions of its software
2889 packages. When you eventually reboot, you'll notice a sub-menu in the
2890 bootloader that reads ``Old system generations'': it's what allows you
2891 to boot @emph{an older generation of your system}, should the latest
2892 generation be ``broken'' or otherwise unsatisfying. Just like for
2893 packages, you can always @emph{roll back} to a previous generation
2894 @emph{of the whole system}:
2895
2896 @example
2897 sudo guix system roll-back
2898 @end example
2899
2900 There are many things you'll probably want to tweak on your system:
2901 adding new user accounts, adding new system services, fiddling with the
2902 configuration of those services, etc. The system configuration is
2903 @emph{entirely} described in the @file{/etc/config.scm} file.
2904 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, to learn how to change it.
2905
2906 Now you know enough to get started!
2907
2908 @quotation Resources
2909 The rest of this manual provides a reference for all things Guix. Here
2910 are some additional resources you may find useful:
2911
2912 @itemize
2913 @item
2914 @xref{Top,,, guix-cookbook, The GNU Guix Cookbook}, for a list of
2915 ``how-to'' style of recipes for a variety of applications.
2916
2917 @item
2918 The @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/guix-refcard.pdf, GNU Guix Reference
2919 Card} lists in two pages most of the commands and options you'll ever
2920 need.
2921
2922 @item
2923 The web site contains @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/en/videos/,
2924 instructional videos} covering topics such as everyday use of Guix, how
2925 to get help, and how to become a contributor.
2926
2927 @item
2928 @xref{Documentation}, to learn how to access documentation on your
2929 computer.
2930 @end itemize
2931
2932 We hope you will enjoy Guix as much as the community enjoys building it!
2933 @end quotation
2934
2935 @c *********************************************************************
2936 @node Package Management
2937 @chapter Package Management
2938
2939 @cindex packages
2940 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2941 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2942 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2943 features.
2944
2945 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2946 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2947 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2948 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2949 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2950 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2951 with it):
2952
2953 @example
2954 guix install emacs-guix
2955 @end example
2956
2957 @menu
2958 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2959 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2960 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2961 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2962 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2963 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2964 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2965 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2966 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2967 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2968 @end menu
2969
2970 @node Features
2971 @section Features
2972
2973 Here we assume you've already made your first steps with Guix
2974 (@pxref{Getting Started}) and would like to get an overview about what's
2975 going on under the hood.
2976
2977 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2978 own directory---something that resembles
2979 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2980
2981 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2982 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2983 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2984 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2985
2986 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2987 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2988 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2989 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2990 simply continues to point to
2991 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2992 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2993
2994 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2995 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2996 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2997
2998 @cindex transactions
2999 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
3000 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
3001 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
3002 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
3003 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
3004 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
3005
3006 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
3007 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
3008 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
3009 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
3010 system configuration on Guix is subject to
3011 transactional upgrades and roll-back
3012 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
3013
3014 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
3015 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
3016 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
3017 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
3018 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
3019 collected.
3020
3021 @cindex reproducibility
3022 @cindex reproducible builds
3023 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
3024 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
3025 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
3026 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
3027 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
3028 given package installation matches the current state of their
3029 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
3030 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
3031 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
3032 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
3033
3034 @cindex substitutes
3035 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
3036 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
3037 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
3038 downloads it and unpacks it;
3039 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
3040 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
3041 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
3042 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
3043 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
3044
3045 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
3046 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
3047 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
3048 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
3049 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3050
3051 @cindex replication, of software environments
3052 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
3053 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
3054 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
3055 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
3056 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
3057 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
3058 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
3059
3060 @node Invoking guix package
3061 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
3062
3063 @cindex installing packages
3064 @cindex removing packages
3065 @cindex package installation
3066 @cindex package removal
3067 @cindex profile
3068 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
3069 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
3070 previous configurations. These operations work on a user
3071 @dfn{profile}---a directory of installed packages. Each user has a
3072 default profile in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
3073 The command operates only on the user's own profile,
3074 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
3075 is:
3076
3077 @example
3078 guix package @var{options}
3079 @end example
3080
3081 @cindex transactions
3082 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
3083 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
3084 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
3085 want to roll back.
3086
3087 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
3088 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
3089
3090 @example
3091 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
3092 @end example
3093
3094 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
3095 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
3096
3097 @itemize
3098 @item
3099 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
3100 @item
3101 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
3102 @item
3103 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
3104 @item
3105 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
3106 @item
3107 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
3108 @end itemize
3109
3110 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
3111 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
3112 package} directly.
3113
3114 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
3115 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
3116 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
3117 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
3118
3119 @cindex profile
3120 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
3121 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
3122 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
3123 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @env{PATH} environment
3124 variable, and so on.
3125 @cindex search paths
3126 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
3127 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
3128 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
3129 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
3130
3131 @example
3132 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
3133 source "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
3134 @end example
3135
3136 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
3137 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
3138 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
3139 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
3140 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
3141 @option{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
3142 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
3143 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
3144 package}.
3145
3146 The @var{options} can be among the following:
3147
3148 @table @code
3149
3150 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
3151 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
3152 Install the specified @var{package}s.
3153
3154 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
3155 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
3156 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
3157 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected).
3158
3159 If no version number is specified, the
3160 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
3161 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
3162 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
3163 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
3164 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
3165 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3166
3167 @cindex propagated inputs
3168 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
3169 that automatically get installed along with the required package
3170 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
3171 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
3172 package definitions).
3173
3174 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
3175 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
3176 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
3177 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
3178 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
3179 also been explicitly installed by the user.
3180
3181 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
3182 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
3183 @option{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
3184 environment variable definitions are reported here.
3185
3186 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
3187 @itemx -e @var{exp}
3188 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
3189
3190 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
3191 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
3192 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
3193 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
3194
3195 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
3196 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
3197 multiple-output package.
3198
3199 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
3200 @itemx -f @var{file}
3201 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
3202
3203 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
3204 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
3205
3206 @lisp
3207 @include package-hello.scm
3208 @end lisp
3209
3210 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
3211 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
3212 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
3213 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3214
3215 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
3216 package definitions. Running @code{guix package -f} on
3217 @file{hello.json} with the following contents would result in installing
3218 the package @code{greeter} after building @code{myhello}:
3219
3220 @example
3221 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
3222 @end example
3223
3224 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
3225 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
3226 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
3227
3228 As for @option{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
3229 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
3230 @samp{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
3231 @code{glibc}.
3232
3233 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3234 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3235 @cindex upgrading packages
3236 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
3237 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
3238 @var{regexp}. Also see the @option{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
3239
3240 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
3241 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
3242 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
3243 pull}).
3244
3245 @cindex package transformations, upgrades
3246 When upgrading, package transformations that were originally applied
3247 when creating the profile are automatically re-applied (@pxref{Package
3248 Transformation Options}). For example, assume you first installed Emacs
3249 from the tip of its development branch with:
3250
3251 @example
3252 guix install emacs-next --with-branch=emacs-next=master
3253 @end example
3254
3255 Next time you run @command{guix upgrade}, Guix will again pull the tip
3256 of the Emacs development branch and build @code{emacs-next} from that
3257 checkout.
3258
3259 Note that transformation options such as @option{--with-branch} and
3260 @option{--with-source} depend on external state; it is up to you to
3261 ensure that they work as expected. You can also discard a
3262 transformations that apply to a package by running:
3263
3264 @example
3265 guix install @var{package}
3266 @end example
3267
3268 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3269 When used together with the @option{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
3270 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
3271 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
3272 substring ``emacs'':
3273
3274 @example
3275 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
3276 @end example
3277
3278 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
3279 @itemx -m @var{file}
3280 @cindex profile declaration
3281 @cindex profile manifest
3282 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
3283 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
3284 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
3285
3286 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
3287 constructing it through a sequence of @option{--install} and similar
3288 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
3289 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
3290 so on.
3291
3292 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
3293 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
3294 of packages:
3295
3296 @findex packages->manifest
3297 @lisp
3298 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
3299
3300 (packages->manifest
3301 (list emacs
3302 guile-2.0
3303 ;; Use a specific package output.
3304 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
3305 @end lisp
3306
3307 @findex specifications->manifest
3308 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
3309 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
3310 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
3311 instead provide regular package specifications and let
3312 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
3313 objects, like this:
3314
3315 @lisp
3316 (specifications->manifest
3317 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
3318 @end lisp
3319
3320 @xref{export-manifest, @option{--export-manifest}}, to learn how to
3321 obtain a manifest file from an existing profile.
3322
3323 @item --roll-back
3324 @cindex rolling back
3325 @cindex undoing transactions
3326 @cindex transactions, undoing
3327 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
3328 the last transaction.
3329
3330 When combined with options such as @option{--install}, roll back occurs
3331 before any other actions.
3332
3333 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
3334 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
3335 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
3336
3337 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
3338 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
3339 generations in a profile is always linear.
3340
3341 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3342 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3343 @cindex generations
3344 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3345
3346 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3347 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3348 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3349 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
3350 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
3351
3352 The difference between @option{--roll-back} and
3353 @option{--switch-generation=-1} is that @option{--switch-generation} will
3354 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
3355 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
3356
3357 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
3358 @cindex search paths
3359 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
3360 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
3361 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
3362 of the installed packages.
3363
3364 For example, GCC needs the @env{CPATH} and @env{LIBRARY_PATH}
3365 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
3366 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
3367 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
3368 library are installed in the profile, then @option{--search-paths} will
3369 suggest setting these variables to @file{@var{profile}/include} and
3370 @file{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
3371
3372 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
3373 shell:
3374
3375 @example
3376 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
3377 @end example
3378
3379 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
3380 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
3381 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
3382 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
3383
3384 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
3385 of several profiles. Consider this example:
3386
3387 @example
3388 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
3389 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
3390 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
3391 @end example
3392
3393 The last command above reports about the @env{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
3394 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
3395 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
3396
3397
3398 @cindex profile, choosing
3399 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3400 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3401 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
3402
3403 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
3404 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
3405 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
3406 installed:
3407
3408 @example
3409 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
3410 @dots{}
3411 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
3412 Hello, world!
3413 @end example
3414
3415 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
3416 siblings that point to specific generations:
3417
3418 @example
3419 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
3420 @end example
3421
3422 @item --list-profiles
3423 List all the user's profiles:
3424
3425 @example
3426 $ guix package --list-profiles
3427 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
3428 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
3429 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
3430 /home/charlie/tmp/test
3431 @end example
3432
3433 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
3434
3435 @cindex collisions, in a profile
3436 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
3437 @cindex profile collisions
3438 @item --allow-collisions
3439 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3440
3441 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3442 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3443 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3444
3445 @item --bootstrap
3446 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3447 useful to distribution developers.
3448
3449 @end table
3450
3451 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3452 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3453 availability of packages:
3454
3455 @table @option
3456
3457 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3458 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3459 @anchor{guix-search}
3460 @cindex searching for packages
3461 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3462 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3463 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3464 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3465 GNU recutils manual}).
3466
3467 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3468 command, for instance:
3469
3470 @example
3471 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3472 name: jemalloc
3473 version: 4.5.0
3474 relevance: 6
3475
3476 name: glibc
3477 version: 2.25
3478 relevance: 1
3479
3480 name: libgc
3481 version: 7.6.0
3482 relevance: 1
3483 @end example
3484
3485 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3486 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3487
3488 @example
3489 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3490 name: elfutils
3491
3492 name: gmp
3493 @dots{}
3494 @end example
3495
3496 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3497 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3498 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3499 the @command{guix search} alias):
3500
3501 @example
3502 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3503 name: gnubg
3504 @dots{}
3505 @end example
3506
3507 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3508 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3509 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3510 keyboards.
3511
3512 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3513 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3514 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3515
3516 @example
3517 $ guix search crypto library | \
3518 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3519 @end example
3520
3521 @noindent
3522 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3523 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3524
3525 @item --show=@var{package}
3526 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3527 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3528 recutils manual}).
3529
3530 @example
3531 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3532 name: python
3533 version: 2.7.6
3534
3535 name: python
3536 version: 3.3.5
3537 @end example
3538
3539 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3540 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3541 @example
3542 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3543 name: python
3544 version: 3.4.3
3545 @end example
3546
3547
3548
3549 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3550 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3551 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3552 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3553 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3554
3555 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3556 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3557 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3558 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3559 the store.
3560
3561 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3562 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3563 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3564 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3565 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3566
3567 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3568 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3569 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3570
3571 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3572 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3573 @cindex generations
3574 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3575 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3576 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3577 shown.
3578
3579 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3580 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3581 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3582 location of this package in the store.
3583
3584 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3585 generations. Valid patterns include:
3586
3587 @itemize
3588 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3589 generation numbers. For instance, @option{--list-generations=1} returns
3590 the first one.
3591
3592 And @option{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3593 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3594
3595 @item @emph{Ranges}. @option{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3596 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3597 a range must be smaller than its end.
3598
3599 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3600 @option{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3601 second one.
3602
3603 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3604 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3605 duration. For example, @option{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3606 that are up to 20 days old.
3607 @end itemize
3608
3609 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3610 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3611 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3612 one.
3613
3614 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3615 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3616 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3617 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3618 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3619
3620 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3621 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3622
3623 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3624 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3625
3626 @cindex manifest, exporting
3627 @anchor{export-manifest}
3628 @item --export-manifest
3629 Write to standard output a manifest suitable for @option{--manifest}
3630 corresponding to the chosen profile(s).
3631
3632 This option is meant to help you migrate from the ``imperative''
3633 operating mode---running @command{guix install}, @command{guix upgrade},
3634 etc.---to the declarative mode that @option{--manifest} offers.
3635
3636 Be aware that the resulting manifest @emph{approximates} what your
3637 profile actually contains; for instance, depending on how your profile
3638 was created, it can refer to packages or package versions that are not
3639 exactly what you specified.
3640
3641 Keep in mind that a manifest is purely symbolic: it only contains
3642 package names and possibly versions, and their meaning varies over time.
3643 If you wish to ``pin'' channels to the revisions that were used to build
3644 the profile(s), see @option{--export-channels} below.
3645
3646 @cindex pinning, channel revisions of a profile
3647 @item --export-channels
3648 Write to standard output the list of channels used by the chosen
3649 profile(s), in a format suitable for @command{guix pull --channels} or
3650 @command{guix time-machine --channels} (@pxref{Channels}).
3651
3652 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this option provides
3653 information allowing you to replicate the current profile
3654 (@pxref{Replicating Guix}).
3655
3656 However, note that the output of this command @emph{approximates} what
3657 was actually used to build this profile. In particular, a single
3658 profile might have been built from several different revisions of the
3659 same channel. In that case, @option{--export-manifest} chooses the last
3660 one and writes the list of other revisions in a comment. If you really
3661 need to pick packages from different channel revisions, you can use
3662 inferiors in your manifest to do so (@pxref{Inferiors}).
3663
3664 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this is a good starting point
3665 if you are willing to migrate from the ``imperative'' model to the fully
3666 declarative model consisting of a manifest file along with a channels
3667 file pinning the exact channel revision(s) you want.
3668 @end table
3669
3670 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3671 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3672 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3673 @option{--with-source}, and preserves them across upgrades
3674 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3675
3676 @node Substitutes
3677 @section Substitutes
3678
3679 @cindex substitutes
3680 @cindex pre-built binaries
3681 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3682 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3683 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3684 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3685 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3686
3687 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3688 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3689 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3690 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3691
3692 @menu
3693 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3694 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3695 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
3696 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3697 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3698 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3699 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3700 @end menu
3701
3702 @node Official Substitute Server
3703 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3704
3705 @cindex build farm
3706 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3707 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3708 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3709 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3710 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3711 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3712 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3713 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3714 option}).
3715
3716 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3717 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3718 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3719 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3720 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3721
3722 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3723 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3724 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3725 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3726 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3727 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3728 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3729 other substitute server.
3730
3731 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3732 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3733
3734 @cindex security
3735 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3736 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3737 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3738 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3739 mirror thereof, you
3740 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3741 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3742 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3743 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3744
3745 @quotation Note
3746 If you are using Guix System, you can skip this section: Guix System
3747 authorizes substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} by default.
3748 @end quotation
3749
3750 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3751 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3752 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3753 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3754 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3755 Then, you can run something like this:
3756
3757 @example
3758 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3759 @end example
3760
3761 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3762 should change from something like:
3763
3764 @example
3765 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3766 The following derivations would be built:
3767 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3768 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3769 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3770 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3771 @dots{}
3772 @end example
3773
3774 @noindent
3775 to something like:
3776
3777 @example
3778 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3779 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3780 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3781 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3782 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3783 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3784 @dots{}
3785 @end example
3786
3787 @noindent
3788 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3789 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3790 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and will be downloaded, when
3791 possible, for future builds.
3792
3793 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3794 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3795 @code{guix-daemon} with @option{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3796 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3797 @option{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package},
3798 @command{guix build}, and other command-line tools.
3799
3800 @node Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3801 @subsection Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3802
3803 @cindex substitute servers, adding more
3804 Guix can look up and fetch substitutes from several servers. This is
3805 useful when you are using packages from additional channels for which
3806 the official server does not have substitutes but another server
3807 provides them. Another situation where this is useful is when you would
3808 prefer to download from your organization's substitute server, resorting
3809 to the official server only as a fallback or dismissing it altogether.
3810
3811 You can give Guix a list of substitute server URLs and it will check
3812 them in the specified order. You also need to explicitly authorize the
3813 public keys of substitute servers to instruct Guix to accept the
3814 substitutes they sign.
3815
3816 On Guix System, this is achieved by modifying the configuration of the
3817 @code{guix} service. Since the @code{guix} service is part of the
3818 default lists of services, @code{%base-services} and
3819 @code{%desktop-services}, you can use @code{modify-services} to change
3820 its configuration and add the URLs and substitute keys that you want
3821 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}).
3822
3823 As an example, suppose you want to fetch substitutes from
3824 @code{guix.example.org} and to authorize the signing key of that server,
3825 in addition to the default @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. The
3826 resulting operating system configuration will look something like:
3827
3828 @lisp
3829 (operating-system
3830 ;; @dots{}
3831 (services
3832 ;; Assume we're starting from '%desktop-services'. Replace it
3833 ;; with the list of services you're actually using.
3834 (modify-services %desktop-services
3835 (guix-service-type config =>
3836 (guix-configuration
3837 (inherit config)
3838 (substitute-urls
3839 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
3840 %default-substitute-urls))
3841 (authorized-keys
3842 (append (list (local-file "./key.pub"))
3843 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))))))
3844 @end lisp
3845
3846 This assumes that the file @file{key.pub} contains the signing key of
3847 @code{guix.example.org}. With this change in place in your operating
3848 system configuration file (say @file{/etc/config.scm}), you can
3849 reconfigure and restart the @code{guix-daemon} service or reboot so the
3850 changes take effect:
3851
3852 @example
3853 $ sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
3854 $ sudo herd restart guix-daemon
3855 @end example
3856
3857 If you're running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', you would instead take
3858 the following steps to get substitutes from additional servers:
3859
3860 @enumerate
3861 @item
3862 Edit the service configuration file for @code{guix-daemon}; when using
3863 systemd, this is normally
3864 @file{/etc/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}. Add the
3865 @option{--substitute-urls} option on the @command{guix-daemon} command
3866 line and list the URLs of interest (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,
3867 @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}}):
3868
3869 @example
3870 @dots{} --substitute-urls='https://guix.example.org https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'
3871 @end example
3872
3873 @item
3874 Restart the daemon. For systemd, it goes like this:
3875
3876 @example
3877 systemctl daemon-reload
3878 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
3879 @end example
3880
3881 @item
3882 Authorize the key of the new server (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
3883
3884 @example
3885 guix archive --authorize < key.pub
3886 @end example
3887
3888 Again this assumes @file{key.pub} contains the public key that
3889 @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign substitutes.
3890 @end enumerate
3891
3892 Now you're all set! Substitutes will be preferably taken from
3893 @code{https://guix.example.org}, using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
3894 as a fallback. Of course you can list as many substitute servers as you
3895 like, with the caveat that substitute lookup can be slowed down if too
3896 many servers need to be contacted.
3897
3898 Note that there are also situations where one may want to add the URL of
3899 a substitute server @emph{without} authorizing its key.
3900 @xref{Substitute Authentication}, to understand this fine point.
3901
3902 @node Substitute Authentication
3903 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3904
3905 @cindex digital signatures
3906 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3907 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3908 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3909
3910 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3911 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3912 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3913 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3914 with this option:
3915
3916 @example
3917 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3918 @end example
3919
3920 @noindent
3921 @cindex reproducible builds
3922 If the ACL contains only the key for @samp{b.example.org}, and if
3923 @samp{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3924 then Guix will download substitutes from @samp{a.example.org} because it
3925 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3926 @samp{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3927 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3928 below).
3929
3930 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3931 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3932 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3933 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3934 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3935 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys).
3936
3937 @node Proxy Settings
3938 @subsection Proxy Settings
3939
3940 @vindex http_proxy
3941 @vindex https_proxy
3942 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS@. The @env{http_proxy} and
3943 @env{https_proxy} environment variables can be set in the environment of
3944 @command{guix-daemon} and are honored for downloads of substitutes.
3945 Note that the value of those environment variables in the environment
3946 where @command{guix build}, @command{guix package}, and other client
3947 commands are run has @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3948
3949 @node Substitution Failure
3950 @subsection Substitution Failure
3951
3952 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3953 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3954 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3955 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3956 etc.
3957
3958 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3959 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3960 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3961 @option{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3962 option @option{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @option{--fallback} was
3963 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3964 considered to have failed. However, if @option{--fallback} was given,
3965 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3966 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3967 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3968 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3969 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3970 @option{--fallback} was given.
3971
3972 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3973 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3974 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3975 by a server.
3976
3977 @node On Trusting Binaries
3978 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3979
3980 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3981 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3982 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3983 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3984 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3985 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3986 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3987 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3988 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3989 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3990
3991 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3992 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3993 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3994 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3995 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3996 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3997 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3998 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3999 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
4000 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
4001 @command{guix build --check}}).
4002
4003 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
4004 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
4005 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
4006
4007 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
4008 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
4009
4010 @cindex multiple-output packages
4011 @cindex package outputs
4012 @cindex outputs
4013
4014 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
4015 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
4016 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
4017 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
4018 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
4019 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
4020 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
4021 files.
4022
4023 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
4024 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
4025 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
4026 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
4027 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
4028 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
4029 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
4030
4031 @example
4032 guix install glib
4033 @end example
4034
4035 @cindex documentation
4036 The command to install its documentation is:
4037
4038 @example
4039 guix install glib:doc
4040 @end example
4041
4042 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
4043 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
4044 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
4045 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
4046 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
4047 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
4048 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
4049 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
4050 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
4051
4052 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
4053 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
4054 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
4055 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
4056 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
4057 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
4058 guix package}).
4059
4060
4061 @node Invoking guix gc
4062 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
4063
4064 @cindex garbage collector
4065 @cindex disk space
4066 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
4067 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
4068 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
4069 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
4070 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
4071
4072 @cindex GC roots
4073 @cindex garbage collector roots
4074 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
4075 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
4076 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
4077 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
4078 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
4079 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
4080 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
4081 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
4082
4083 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
4084 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
4085 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
4086 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
4087 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4088
4089 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
4090 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
4091 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
4092
4093 @example
4094 guix gc -F 5G
4095 @end example
4096
4097 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
4098 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
4099 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
4100 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
4101 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
4102 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
4103 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
4104
4105 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
4106 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
4107 files (the @option{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
4108 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
4109 options are as follows:
4110
4111 @table @code
4112 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
4113 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
4114 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
4115 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
4116 specified.
4117
4118 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
4119 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4120 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
4121 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
4122
4123 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
4124
4125 @item --free-space=@var{free}
4126 @itemx -F @var{free}
4127 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
4128 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
4129 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
4130
4131 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
4132 nothing and exit immediately.
4133
4134 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
4135 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
4136 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
4137 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
4138 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
4139
4140 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
4141 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
4142 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
4143
4144 @example
4145 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
4146 @end example
4147
4148 @item --delete
4149 @itemx -D
4150 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
4151 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
4152 they are still live.
4153
4154 @item --list-failures
4155 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
4156
4157 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
4158 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
4159 @option{--cache-failures}}).
4160
4161 @item --list-roots
4162 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
4163 roots.
4164
4165 @item --list-busy
4166 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
4167 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
4168
4169 @item --clear-failures
4170 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
4171
4172 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
4173 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
4174
4175 @item --list-dead
4176 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
4177 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
4178
4179 @item --list-live
4180 Show the list of live store files and directories.
4181
4182 @end table
4183
4184 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
4185
4186 @table @code
4187
4188 @item --references
4189 @itemx --referrers
4190 @cindex package dependencies
4191 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
4192 as arguments.
4193
4194 @item --requisites
4195 @itemx -R
4196 @cindex closure
4197 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
4198 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
4199 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
4200 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
4201
4202 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
4203 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
4204 the graph of references.
4205
4206 @item --derivers
4207 @cindex derivation
4208 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
4209 (@pxref{Derivations}).
4210
4211 For example, this command:
4212
4213 @example
4214 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
4215 @end example
4216
4217 @noindent
4218 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
4219 installed in your profile.
4220
4221 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
4222 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
4223 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
4224 @end table
4225
4226 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
4227 store and to control disk usage.
4228
4229 @table @option
4230
4231 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
4232 @cindex integrity, of the store
4233 @cindex integrity checking
4234 Verify the integrity of the store.
4235
4236 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
4237 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
4238
4239 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
4240 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
4241
4242 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
4243 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
4244 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
4245 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
4246 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
4247
4248 @cindex repairing the store
4249 @cindex corruption, recovering from
4250 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
4251 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
4252 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
4253 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
4254 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
4255 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
4256 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
4257
4258 @item --optimize
4259 @cindex deduplication
4260 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
4261 @dfn{deduplication}.
4262
4263 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
4264 import, unless it was started with @option{--disable-deduplication}
4265 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
4266 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
4267 @option{--disable-deduplication}.
4268
4269 @end table
4270
4271 @node Invoking guix pull
4272 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
4273
4274 @cindex upgrading Guix
4275 @cindex updating Guix
4276 @cindex @command{guix pull}
4277 @cindex pull
4278 @cindex security, @command{guix pull}
4279 @cindex authenticity, of code obtained with @command{guix pull}
4280 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
4281 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
4282 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
4283 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
4284 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
4285 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
4286 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized. @command{guix
4287 pull} ensures that the code it downloads is @emph{authentic} by
4288 verifying that commits are signed by Guix developers.
4289
4290 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
4291 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
4292
4293 @enumerate
4294 @item
4295 the @option{--channels} option;
4296 @item
4297 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
4298 @item
4299 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
4300 @item
4301 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
4302 variable.
4303 @end enumerate
4304
4305 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
4306 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
4307 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
4308 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
4309 become available.
4310
4311 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
4312 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
4313 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
4314 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
4315 versa.
4316
4317 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
4318 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
4319 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
4320 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
4321 (@pxref{Documentation}):
4322
4323 @example
4324 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
4325 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
4326 @end example
4327
4328 The @option{--list-generations} or @option{-l} option lists past generations
4329 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
4330
4331 @example
4332 $ guix pull -l
4333 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
4334 guix 65956ad
4335 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4336 branch: origin/master
4337 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
4338
4339 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
4340 guix e0cc7f6
4341 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4342 branch: origin/master
4343 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
4344 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
4345 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
4346 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
4347 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
4348
4349 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
4350 guix 844cc1c
4351 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4352 branch: origin/master
4353 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
4354 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
4355 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
4356 @end example
4357
4358 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
4359 describe the current status of Guix.
4360
4361 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
4362 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
4363 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
4364 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
4365
4366 @example
4367 $ guix pull --roll-back
4368 switched from generation 3 to 2
4369 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
4370 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4371 @end example
4372
4373 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
4374 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
4375 @example
4376 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
4377 switched from generation 3 to 2
4378 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
4379 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4380 @end example
4381
4382 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
4383 but it supports the following options:
4384
4385 @table @code
4386 @item --url=@var{url}
4387 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4388 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4389 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4390 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4391 string), or @var{branch}.
4392
4393 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4394 @cindex configuration file for channels
4395 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
4396 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
4397 @option{--channels} option (see below).
4398
4399 @item --channels=@var{file}
4400 @itemx -C @var{file}
4401 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
4402 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
4403 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
4404 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
4405 information.
4406
4407 @cindex channel news
4408 @item --news
4409 @itemx -N
4410 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
4411 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
4412 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
4413
4414 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
4415 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
4416 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
4417
4418 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4419 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
4420 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
4421 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
4422 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
4423 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4424
4425 @item --roll-back
4426 @cindex rolling back
4427 @cindex undoing transactions
4428 @cindex transactions, undoing
4429 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
4430 undo the last transaction.
4431
4432 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
4433 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
4434 @cindex generations
4435 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
4436
4437 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
4438 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
4439 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
4440 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
4441 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
4442
4443 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4444 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
4445 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
4446 one.
4447
4448 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
4449 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
4450 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
4451 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
4452 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
4453
4454 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
4455
4456 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
4457 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
4458
4459 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
4460 current generation only.
4461
4462 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4463 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4464 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
4465
4466 @item --dry-run
4467 @itemx -n
4468 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
4469 substituted but do not actually do it.
4470
4471 @item --allow-downgrades
4472 Allow pulling older or unrelated revisions of channels than those
4473 currently in use.
4474
4475 @cindex downgrade attacks, protection against
4476 By default, @command{guix pull} protects against so-called ``downgrade
4477 attacks'' whereby the Git repository of a channel would be reset to an
4478 earlier or unrelated revision of itself, potentially leading you to
4479 install older, known-vulnerable versions of software packages.
4480
4481 @quotation Note
4482 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4483 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
4484 @end quotation
4485
4486 @item --disable-authentication
4487 Allow pulling channel code without authenticating it.
4488
4489 @cindex authentication, of channel code
4490 By default, @command{guix pull} authenticates code downloaded from
4491 channels by verifying that its commits are signed by authorized
4492 developers, and raises an error if this is not the case. This option
4493 instructs it to not perform any such verification.
4494
4495 @quotation Note
4496 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4497 @option{--disable-authentication}.
4498 @end quotation
4499
4500 @item --system=@var{system}
4501 @itemx -s @var{system}
4502 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4503 the system type of the build host.
4504
4505 @item --bootstrap
4506 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
4507 useful to Guix developers.
4508 @end table
4509
4510 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
4511 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
4512 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
4513 information.
4514
4515 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
4516 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4517
4518 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4519 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4520
4521 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4522 @cindex pinning, channels
4523 @cindex replicating Guix
4524 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4525
4526 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4527 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4528 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4529 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4530 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4531 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4532
4533 The general syntax is:
4534
4535 @example
4536 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4537 @end example
4538
4539 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4540 @command{guix} command of the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4541 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4542
4543 @table @code
4544 @item --url=@var{url}
4545 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4546 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4547 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4548 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4549 string), or @var{branch}.
4550
4551 @item --channels=@var{file}
4552 @itemx -C @var{file}
4553 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4554 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4555 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4556 @end table
4557
4558 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4559 latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4560
4561 @example
4562 guix time-machine -- build hello
4563 @end example
4564
4565 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4566 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4567 Time travel works in both directions!
4568
4569 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4570 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4571 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4572
4573 @node Inferiors
4574 @section Inferiors
4575
4576 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4577 @quotation Note
4578 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4579 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4580 @end quotation
4581
4582 @cindex inferiors
4583 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4584 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4585 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4586 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4587 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4588
4589 @cindex inferior packages
4590 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4591 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4592 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4593 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4594 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4595
4596 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4597 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4598 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4599 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4600 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4601 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4602 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4603 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4604 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4605
4606 @lisp
4607 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4608 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4609
4610 (define channels
4611 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4612 ;; extract guile-json.
4613 (list (channel
4614 (name 'guix)
4615 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4616 (commit
4617 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4618
4619 (define inferior
4620 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4621 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4622
4623 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4624 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4625 (packages->manifest
4626 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4627 (specification->package "guile")))
4628 @end lisp
4629
4630 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4631 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4632 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4633
4634 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4635 inferior:
4636
4637 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4638 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4639 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4640 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4641 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4642
4643 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4644 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4645 @end deffn
4646
4647 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4648 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4649 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4650 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4651 the inferior could not be launched.
4652 @end deffn
4653
4654 @cindex inferior packages
4655 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4656 packages.
4657
4658 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4659 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4660 @end deffn
4661
4662 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4663 [@var{version}]
4664 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4665 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4666 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4667 @end deffn
4668
4669 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4670 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4671 @end deffn
4672
4673 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4674 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4675 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4676 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4677 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4678 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4679 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4680 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4681 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4682 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4683 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4684 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4685 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4686 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4687 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4688 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4689 these procedures.
4690 @end deffn
4691
4692 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4693 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4694 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4695 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4696 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4697 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4698 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4699 declaration, and so on.
4700
4701 @node Invoking guix describe
4702 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4703
4704 @cindex reproducibility
4705 @cindex replicating Guix
4706 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4707 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4708 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4709 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4710 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4711 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4712 command answers these questions.
4713
4714 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4715 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4716 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4717
4718 @example
4719 $ guix describe
4720 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4721 guix e0fa68c
4722 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4723 branch: master
4724 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4725 @end example
4726
4727 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4728 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4729 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4730 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4731 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4732 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4733 also to replicate it.
4734
4735 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4736 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4737
4738 @example
4739 $ guix describe -f channels
4740 (list (channel
4741 (name 'guix)
4742 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4743 (commit
4744 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")
4745 (introduction
4746 (make-channel-introduction
4747 "9edb3f66fd807b096b48283debdcddccfea34bad"
4748 (openpgp-fingerprint
4749 "BBB0 2DDF 2CEA F6A8 0D1D E643 A2A0 6DF2 A33A 54FA")))))
4750 @end example
4751
4752 @noindent
4753 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4754 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4755 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4756 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4757 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4758 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4759
4760 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4761 follows:
4762
4763 @table @code
4764 @item --format=@var{format}
4765 @itemx -f @var{format}
4766 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4767
4768 @table @code
4769 @item human
4770 produce human-readable output;
4771 @item channels
4772 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4773 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4774 guix pull});
4775 @item channels-sans-intro
4776 like @code{channels}, but omit the @code{introduction} field; use it to
4777 produce a channel specification suitable for Guix version 1.1.0 or
4778 earlier---the @code{introduction} field has to do with channel
4779 authentication (@pxref{Channels, Channel Authentication}) and is not
4780 supported by these older versions;
4781 @item json
4782 @cindex JSON
4783 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4784 @item recutils
4785 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4786 @end table
4787
4788 @item --list-formats
4789 Display available formats for @option{--format} option.
4790
4791 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4792 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4793 Display information about @var{profile}.
4794 @end table
4795
4796 @node Invoking guix archive
4797 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4798
4799 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4800 @cindex archive
4801 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4802 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4803 a machine that runs Guix.
4804 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4805 to the store on another machine.
4806
4807 @quotation Note
4808 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4809 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4810 @end quotation
4811
4812 @cindex exporting store items
4813 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4814
4815 @example
4816 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4817 @end example
4818
4819 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4820 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4821 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4822 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4823 output of @code{emacs}:
4824
4825 @example
4826 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4827 @end example
4828
4829 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4830 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4831 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4832
4833 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4834 one would run:
4835
4836 @example
4837 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4838 @end example
4839
4840 @noindent
4841 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4842 to another like this:
4843
4844 @example
4845 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4846 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4847 @end example
4848
4849 @noindent
4850 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4851 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4852 @option{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on
4853 the target machine. The @option{--missing} option can help figure out
4854 which items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4855 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4856 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4857
4858 @cindex nar, archive format
4859 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4860 @cindex nar bundle, archive format
4861 Each store item is written in the @dfn{normalized archive} or @dfn{nar}
4862 format (described below), and the output of @command{guix archive
4863 --export} (and input of @command{guix archive --import}) is a @dfn{nar
4864 bundle}.
4865
4866 The nar format is
4867 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4868 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4869 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4870 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4871 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4872 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4873 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4874 deterministic.
4875
4876 That nar bundle format is essentially the concatenation of zero or more
4877 nars along with metadata for each store item it contains: its file name,
4878 references, corresponding derivation, and a digital signature.
4879
4880 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4881 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4882 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4883 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4884 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4885
4886 The main options are:
4887
4888 @table @code
4889 @item --export
4890 Export the specified store files or packages (see below). Write the
4891 resulting archive to the standard output.
4892
4893 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4894 @option{--recursive} is passed.
4895
4896 @item -r
4897 @itemx --recursive
4898 When combined with @option{--export}, this instructs @command{guix archive}
4899 to include dependencies of the given items in the archive. Thus, the
4900 resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure of the
4901 exported store items.
4902
4903 @item --import
4904 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4905 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4906 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4907 keys (see @option{--authorize} below).
4908
4909 @item --missing
4910 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4911 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4912 the store.
4913
4914 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4915 @cindex signing, archives
4916 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4917 archives can be exported with @option{--export}. This
4918 operation is usually instantaneous but it can take time if the system's
4919 entropy pool needs to be refilled. On Guix System,
4920 @code{guix-service-type} takes care of generating this key pair the
4921 first boot.
4922
4923 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4924 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4925 key, which must be kept secret). When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4926 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4927 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4928 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4929 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4930 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4931 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4932
4933 @item --authorize
4934 @cindex authorizing, archives
4935 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4936 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4937 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4938
4939 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4940 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4941 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4942 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4943 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4944 (SPKI)}.
4945
4946 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4947 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4948 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4949 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4950 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4951
4952 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4953 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4954
4955 @example
4956 $ wget -O - \
4957 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/gzip/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4958 | gunzip | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4959 @end example
4960
4961 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4962 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4963 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4964 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4965 unsafe.
4966
4967 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4968 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers
4969 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
4970
4971 @item --list
4972 @itemx -t
4973 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4974 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4975 this example:
4976
4977 @example
4978 $ wget -O - \
4979 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4980 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4981 @end example
4982
4983 @end table
4984
4985 @c *********************************************************************
4986 @node Channels
4987 @chapter Channels
4988
4989 @cindex channels
4990 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4991 @cindex configuration file for channels
4992 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
4993 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
4994 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
4995 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
4996 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
4997 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
4998 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
4999 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
5000 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used
5001 to @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
5002 Guix is able to take into account security concerns and deal with authenticated
5003 updates.
5004
5005 @menu
5006 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
5007 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
5008 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
5009 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
5010 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
5011 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
5012 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
5013 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
5014 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
5015 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
5016 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
5017 @end menu
5018
5019 @node Specifying Additional Channels
5020 @section Specifying Additional Channels
5021
5022 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
5023 @cindex variant packages (channels)
5024 You can specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. To use a channel, write
5025 @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct @command{guix pull} to pull from it
5026 @emph{in addition} to the default Guix channel(s):
5027
5028 @vindex %default-channels
5029 @lisp
5030 ;; Add variant packages to those Guix provides.
5031 (cons (channel
5032 (name 'variant-packages)
5033 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git"))
5034 %default-channels)
5035 @end lisp
5036
5037 @noindent
5038 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
5039 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
5040 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5041 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
5042 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
5043 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
5044 modules:
5045
5046 @example
5047 $ guix pull --list-generations
5048 @dots{}
5049 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
5050 guix d894ab8
5051 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
5052 branch: master
5053 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
5054 variant-packages dd3df5e
5055 repository URL: https://example.org/variant-packages.git
5056 branch: master
5057 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
5058 11 new packages: variant-gimp, variant-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
5059 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
5060 @end example
5061
5062 @noindent
5063 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
5064 both Guix and packages from the @code{variant-personal-packages} channel. Among
5065 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{variant-gimp} and
5066 @code{variant-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
5067 @code{variant-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
5068
5069 @node Using a Custom Guix Channel
5070 @section Using a Custom Guix Channel
5071
5072 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
5073 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
5074 suppose you want to update from another copy of the Guix repository at
5075 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
5076 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
5077
5078 @lisp
5079 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use another repo.
5080 (list (channel
5081 (name 'guix)
5082 (url "https://example.org/another-guix.git")
5083 (branch "super-hacks")))
5084 @end lisp
5085
5086 @noindent
5087 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
5088 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}. The authentication concern is
5089 addressed below ((@pxref{Channel Authentication}).
5090
5091 @node Replicating Guix
5092 @section Replicating Guix
5093
5094 @cindex pinning, channels
5095 @cindex replicating Guix
5096 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
5097 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
5098 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
5099 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
5100 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
5101
5102 @lisp
5103 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
5104 (list (channel
5105 (name 'guix)
5106 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
5107 (commit "6298c3ffd9654d3231a6f25390b056483e8f407c"))
5108 (channel
5109 (name 'variant-packages)
5110 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git")
5111 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
5112 @end lisp
5113
5114 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
5115 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
5116 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
5117 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
5118 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
5119
5120 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
5121 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
5122 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
5123 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
5124 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
5125 package it defines.
5126
5127 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
5128 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
5129 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
5130 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
5131
5132 @node Channel Authentication
5133 @section Channel Authentication
5134
5135 @anchor{channel-authentication}
5136 @cindex authentication, of channel code
5137 The @command{guix pull} and @command{guix time-machine} commands
5138 @dfn{authenticate} the code retrieved from channels: they make sure each
5139 commit that is fetched is signed by an authorized developer. The goal
5140 is to protect from unauthorized modifications to the channel that would
5141 lead users to run malicious code.
5142
5143 As a user, you must provide a @dfn{channel introduction} in your
5144 channels file so that Guix knows how to authenticate its first commit.
5145 A channel specification, including its introduction, looks something
5146 along these lines:
5147
5148 @lisp
5149 (channel
5150 (name 'some-channel)
5151 (url "https://example.org/some-channel.git")
5152 (introduction
5153 (make-channel-introduction
5154 "6f0d8cc0d88abb59c324b2990bfee2876016bb86"
5155 (openpgp-fingerprint
5156 "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5157 @end lisp
5158
5159 The specification above shows the name and URL of the channel. The call
5160 to @code{make-channel-introduction} above specifies that authentication
5161 of this channel starts at commit @code{6f0d8cc@dots{}}, which is signed
5162 by the OpenPGP key with fingerprint @code{CABB A931@dots{}}.
5163
5164 For the main channel, called @code{guix}, you automatically get that
5165 information from your Guix installation. For other channels, include
5166 the channel introduction provided by the channel authors in your
5167 @file{channels.scm} file. Make sure you retrieve the channel
5168 introduction from a trusted source since that is the root of your trust.
5169
5170 If you're curious about the authentication mechanics, read on!
5171
5172 @node Creating a Channel
5173 @section Creating a Channel
5174
5175 @cindex personal packages (channels)
5176 @cindex channels, for personal packages
5177 Let's say you have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages
5178 that you think would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but
5179 would like to have these packages transparently available to you at the
5180 command line. You would first write modules containing those package
5181 definitions (@pxref{Package Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and
5182 then you and anyone else can use it as an additional channel to get packages
5183 from. Neat, no?
5184
5185 @c What follows stems from discussions at
5186 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
5187 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
5188 @quotation Warning
5189 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
5190 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
5191 of caution:
5192
5193 @itemize
5194 @item
5195 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
5196 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
5197 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
5198 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
5199 process.
5200
5201 @item
5202 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
5203 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
5204 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
5205 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
5206 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
5207 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
5208 either.
5209
5210 @item
5211 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
5212 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
5213 @end itemize
5214
5215 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
5216 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
5217 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
5218 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
5219 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
5220 @end quotation
5221
5222 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
5223 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
5224 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
5225 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
5226 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
5227 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
5228 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
5229 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
5230 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
5231 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5232
5233 As a channel author, consider bundling authentication material with your
5234 channel so that users can authenticate it. @xref{Channel
5235 Authentication}, and @ref{Specifying Channel Authorizations}, for info
5236 on how to do it.
5237
5238
5239 @node Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5240 @section Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5241
5242 @cindex subdirectory, channels
5243 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
5244 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
5245 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
5246
5247 @lisp
5248 (channel
5249 (version 0)
5250 (directory "guix"))
5251 @end lisp
5252
5253 @node Declaring Channel Dependencies
5254 @section Declaring Channel Dependencies
5255
5256 @cindex dependencies, channels
5257 @cindex meta-data, channels
5258 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
5259 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
5260 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
5261 the channel repository.
5262
5263 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
5264
5265 @lisp
5266 (channel
5267 (version 0)
5268 (dependencies
5269 (channel
5270 (name 'some-collection)
5271 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git")
5272
5273 ;; The 'introduction' bit below is optional: you would
5274 ;; provide it for dependencies that can be authenticated.
5275 (introduction
5276 (channel-introduction
5277 (version 0)
5278 (commit "a8883b58dc82e167c96506cf05095f37c2c2c6cd")
5279 (signer "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5280 (channel
5281 (name 'some-other-collection)
5282 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
5283 (branch "testing"))))
5284 @end lisp
5285
5286 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
5287 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
5288 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
5289 channels are available.
5290
5291 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
5292 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
5293 dependencies to a minimum.
5294
5295 @node Specifying Channel Authorizations
5296 @section Specifying Channel Authorizations
5297
5298 @cindex channel authorizations
5299 @anchor{channel-authorizations}
5300 As we saw above, Guix ensures the source code it pulls from channels
5301 comes from authorized developers. As a channel author, you need to
5302 specify the list of authorized developers in the
5303 @file{.guix-authorizations} file in the channel's Git repository. The
5304 authentication rule is simple: each commit must be signed by a key
5305 listed in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its parent
5306 commit(s)@footnote{Git commits form a @dfn{directed acyclic graph}
5307 (DAG). Each commit can have zero or more parents; ``regular'' commits
5308 have one parent and merge commits have two parent commits. Read
5309 @uref{https://eagain.net/articles/git-for-computer-scientists/, @i{Git
5310 for Computer Scientists}} for a great overview.} The
5311 @file{.guix-authorizations} file looks like this:
5312
5313 @lisp
5314 ;; Example '.guix-authorizations' file.
5315
5316 (authorizations
5317 (version 0) ;current file format version
5318
5319 (("AD17 A21E F8AE D8F1 CC02 DBD9 F8AE D8F1 765C 61E3"
5320 (name "alice"))
5321 ("2A39 3FFF 68F4 EF7A 3D29 12AF 68F4 EF7A 22FB B2D5"
5322 (name "bob"))
5323 ("CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"
5324 (name "charlie"))))
5325 @end lisp
5326
5327 Each fingerprint is followed by optional key/value pairs, as in the
5328 example above. Currently these key/value pairs are ignored.
5329
5330 This authentication rule creates a chicken-and-egg issue: how do we
5331 authenticate the first commit? Related to that: how do we deal with
5332 channels whose repository history contains unsigned commits and lack
5333 @file{.guix-authorizations}? And how do we fork existing channels?
5334
5335 @cindex channel introduction
5336 Channel introductions answer these questions by describing the first
5337 commit of a channel that should be authenticated. The first time a
5338 channel is fetched with @command{guix pull} or @command{guix
5339 time-machine}, the command looks up the introductory commit and verifies
5340 that it is signed by the specified OpenPGP key. From then on, it
5341 authenticates commits according to the rule above.
5342
5343 Additionally, your channel must provide all the OpenPGP keys that were
5344 ever mentioned in @file{.guix-authorizations}, stored as @file{.key}
5345 files, which can be either binary or ``ASCII-armored''. By default,
5346 those @file{.key} files are searched for in the branch named
5347 @code{keyring} but you can specify a different branch name in
5348 @code{.guix-channel} like so:
5349
5350 @lisp
5351 (channel
5352 (version 0)
5353 (keyring-reference "my-keyring-branch"))
5354 @end lisp
5355
5356 To summarize, as the author of a channel, there are three things you have
5357 to do to allow users to authenticate your code:
5358
5359 @enumerate
5360 @item
5361 Export the OpenPGP keys of past and present committers with @command{gpg
5362 --export} and store them in @file{.key} files, by default in a branch
5363 named @code{keyring} (we recommend making it an @dfn{orphan branch}).
5364
5365 @item
5366 Introduce an initial @file{.guix-authorizations} in the channel's
5367 repository. Do that in a signed commit (@pxref{Commit Access}, for
5368 information on how to sign Git commits.)
5369
5370 @item
5371 Advertise the channel introduction, for instance on your channel's web
5372 page. The channel introduction, as we saw above, is the commit/key
5373 pair---i.e., the commit that introduced @file{.guix-authorizations}, and
5374 the fingerprint of the OpenPGP used to sign it.
5375 @end enumerate
5376
5377 Before pushing to your public Git repository, you can run @command{guix
5378 git-authenticate} to verify that you did sign all the commits you are
5379 about to push with an authorized key:
5380
5381 @example
5382 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer}
5383 @end example
5384
5385 @noindent
5386 where @var{commit} and @var{signer} are your channel introduction.
5387 @xref{Invoking guix git authenticate}, for details.
5388
5389 Publishing a signed channel requires discipline: any mistake, such as an
5390 unsigned commit or a commit signed by an unauthorized key, will prevent
5391 users from pulling from your channel---well, that's the whole point of
5392 authentication! Pay attention to merges in particular: merge commits
5393 are considered authentic if and only if they are signed by a key present
5394 in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of @emph{both} branches.
5395
5396 @node Primary URL
5397 @section Primary URL
5398
5399 @cindex primary URL, channels
5400 Channel authors can indicate the primary URL of their channel's Git
5401 repository in the @file{.guix-channel} file, like so:
5402
5403 @lisp
5404 (channel
5405 (version 0)
5406 (url "https://example.org/guix.git"))
5407 @end lisp
5408
5409 This allows @command{guix pull} to determine whether it is pulling code
5410 from a mirror of the channel; when that is the case, it warns the user
5411 that the mirror might be stale and displays the primary URL@. That way,
5412 users cannot be tricked into fetching code from a stale mirror that does
5413 not receive security updates.
5414
5415 This feature only makes sense for authenticated repositories, such as
5416 the official @code{guix} channel, for which @command{guix pull} ensures
5417 the code it fetches is authentic.
5418
5419 @node Writing Channel News
5420 @section Writing Channel News
5421
5422 @cindex news, for channels
5423 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
5424 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
5425 an email, but that's not convenient.
5426
5427 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
5428 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
5429 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
5430 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
5431
5432 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
5433 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
5434
5435 @lisp
5436 (channel
5437 (version 0)
5438 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
5439 @end lisp
5440
5441 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
5442 something like this:
5443
5444 @lisp
5445 (channel-news
5446 (version 0)
5447 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
5448 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
5449 (fr "Oh la la"))
5450 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
5451 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
5452 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
5453 (title (en "Added a great package")
5454 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
5455 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
5456 @end lisp
5457
5458 While the news file is using the Scheme syntax, avoid naming it with a
5459 @file{.scm} extension or else it will get picked up when building the
5460 channel and yield an error since it is not a valid module.
5461 Alternatively, you can move the channel module to a subdirectory and
5462 store the news file in another directory.
5463
5464 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
5465 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
5466 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
5467 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
5468
5469 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
5470 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
5471 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
5472 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
5473 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
5474
5475 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
5476 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
5477 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
5478 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
5479 file containing the strings to translate:
5480
5481 @example
5482 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.txt
5483 @end example
5484
5485 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
5486 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
5487
5488 @node Channels with Substitutes
5489 @section Channels with Substitutes
5490
5491 When running @command{guix pull}, Guix will first compile the
5492 definitions of every available package. This is an expensive operation
5493 for which substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}) may be available. The
5494 following snippet in @file{channels.scm} will ensure that @command{guix
5495 pull} uses the latest commit with available substitutes for the package
5496 definitions: this is done by querying the continuous integration
5497 server at @url{https://ci.guix.gnu.org}.
5498
5499 @lisp
5500 (use-modules (guix ci))
5501
5502 (list (channel-with-substitutes-available
5503 %default-guix-channel
5504 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))
5505 @end lisp
5506
5507 Note that this does not mean that all the packages that you will
5508 install after running @command{guix pull} will have available
5509 substitutes. It only ensures that @command{guix pull} will not try to
5510 compile package definitions. This is particularly useful when using
5511 machines with limited resources.
5512
5513 @c *********************************************************************
5514 @node Development
5515 @chapter Development
5516
5517 @cindex software development
5518 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
5519 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
5520 this chapter is about.
5521
5522 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
5523 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
5524 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
5525 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
5526 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
5527
5528 @menu
5529 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
5530 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
5531 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
5532 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
5533 @end menu
5534
5535 @node Invoking guix environment
5536 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5537
5538 @cindex reproducible build environments
5539 @cindex development environments
5540 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5541 @cindex environment, package build environment
5542 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5543 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5544 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5545 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5546 environment to use them.
5547
5548 The general syntax is:
5549
5550 @example
5551 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5552 @end example
5553
5554 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5555 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5556
5557 @example
5558 guix environment guile
5559 @end example
5560
5561 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5562 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an
5563 augmented version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was
5564 run in. It contains the necessary search paths for building the given
5565 package added to the existing environment variables. To create
5566 a ``pure'' environment, in which the original environment variables have
5567 been unset, use the @option{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes
5568 wrongfully augment environment variables such as @env{PATH} in their
5569 @file{~/.bashrc} file. As a consequence, when @command{guix
5570 environment} launches it, Bash may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby
5571 introducing ``impurities'' in these environment variables. It is an
5572 error to define such environment variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead,
5573 they should be defined in @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by
5574 log-in shells. @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference
5575 Manual}, for details on Bash start-up files.}.
5576
5577 Exiting from a Guix environment is the same as exiting from the shell,
5578 and will place the user back in the old environment before @command{guix
5579 environment} was invoked. The next garbage collection (@pxref{Invoking
5580 guix gc}) will clean up packages that were installed from within the
5581 environment and are no longer used outside of it.
5582
5583 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5584 @command{guix environment} defines the @env{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5585 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5586 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5587 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5588 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5589
5590 @example
5591 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5592 then
5593 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5594 fi
5595 @end example
5596
5597 @noindent
5598 ...@: or to browse the profile:
5599
5600 @example
5601 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5602 @end example
5603
5604 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5605 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5606 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5607 and Emacs are available:
5608
5609 @example
5610 guix environment guile emacs
5611 @end example
5612
5613 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5614 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5615 command from the rest of the arguments:
5616
5617 @example
5618 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5619 @end example
5620
5621 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5622 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5623 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5624 NumPy:
5625
5626 @example
5627 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5628 @end example
5629
5630 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5631 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5632 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5633 @option{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5634 @option{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5635 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5636 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5637 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5638 additionally includes Git and strace:
5639
5640 @example
5641 guix environment --pure guix --ad-hoc git strace
5642 @end example
5643
5644 @cindex container
5645 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5646 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5647 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
5648 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5649 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5650 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5651 working directory are mounted:
5652
5653 @example
5654 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5655 @end example
5656
5657 @quotation Note
5658 The @option{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5659 @end quotation
5660
5661 @cindex certificates
5662 Another typical use case for containers is to run security-sensitive
5663 applications such as a web browser. To run Eolie, we must expose and
5664 share some files and directories; we include @code{nss-certs} and expose
5665 @file{/etc/ssl/certs/} for HTTPS authentication; finally we preserve the
5666 @env{DISPLAY} environment variable since containerized graphical
5667 applications won't display without it.
5668
5669 @example
5670 guix environment --preserve='^DISPLAY$' --container --network \
5671 --expose=/etc/machine-id \
5672 --expose=/etc/ssl/certs/ \
5673 --share=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/ \
5674 --ad-hoc eolie nss-certs dbus -- eolie
5675 @end example
5676
5677 The available options are summarized below.
5678
5679 @table @code
5680 @item --root=@var{file}
5681 @itemx -r @var{file}
5682 @cindex persistent environment
5683 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
5684 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
5685 register it as a garbage collector root.
5686
5687 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
5688 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
5689
5690 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
5691 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
5692 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
5693 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
5694 gc}, for more on GC roots.
5695
5696 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5697 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5698 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5699 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5700
5701 For example, running:
5702
5703 @example
5704 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5705 @end example
5706
5707 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5708 PETSc package.
5709
5710 Running:
5711
5712 @example
5713 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5714 @end example
5715
5716 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
5717
5718 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
5719 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5720
5721 @example
5722 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5723 @end example
5724
5725 @item --load=@var{file}
5726 @itemx -l @var{file}
5727 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5728 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5729
5730 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5731 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5732
5733 @lisp
5734 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5735 @end lisp
5736
5737 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5738 @itemx -m @var{file}
5739 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
5740 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
5741 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
5742
5743 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
5744 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
5745 manifest files.
5746
5747 @item --ad-hoc
5748 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5749 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5750 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5751 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5752
5753 For instance, the command:
5754
5755 @example
5756 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5757 @end example
5758
5759 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5760 available.
5761
5762 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5763 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5764 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5765 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5766
5767 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5768 environment}. Packages appearing before @option{--ad-hoc} are
5769 interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be added to the
5770 environment, the default behavior. Packages appearing after are
5771 interpreted as packages that will be added to the environment directly.
5772
5773 @item --pure
5774 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
5775 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below). This has the effect of
5776 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
5777
5778 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
5779 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
5780 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
5781 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
5782 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
5783 several times.
5784
5785 @example
5786 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
5787 -- mpirun @dots{}
5788 @end example
5789
5790 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
5791 variables defined are @env{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
5792 with @samp{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@env{HOME},
5793 @env{USER}, etc.).
5794
5795 @item --search-paths
5796 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5797 environment.
5798
5799 @item --system=@var{system}
5800 @itemx -s @var{system}
5801 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5802
5803 @item --container
5804 @itemx -C
5805 @cindex container
5806 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5807 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5808 Additionally, unless overridden with @option{--user}, a dummy home
5809 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
5810 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5811
5812 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
5813 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
5814 @option{--user} is passed (see below).
5815
5816 @item --network
5817 @itemx -N
5818 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5819 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5820 device.
5821
5822 @item --link-profile
5823 @itemx -P
5824 For containers, link the environment profile to @file{~/.guix-profile}
5825 within the container and set @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT} to that.
5826 This is equivalent to making @file{~/.guix-profile} a symlink to the
5827 actual profile within the container.
5828 Linking will fail and abort the environment if the directory already
5829 exists, which will certainly be the case if @command{guix environment}
5830 was invoked in the user's home directory.
5831
5832 Certain packages are configured to look in @file{~/.guix-profile} for
5833 configuration files and data;@footnote{For example, the
5834 @code{fontconfig} package inspects @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts}
5835 for additional fonts.} @option{--link-profile} allows these programs to
5836 behave as expected within the environment.
5837
5838 @item --user=@var{user}
5839 @itemx -u @var{user}
5840 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
5841 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
5842 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
5843 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
5844 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
5845 need not exist on the system.
5846
5847 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @option{--share} and
5848 @option{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
5849 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
5850 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
5851
5852 @example
5853 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
5854 cd $HOME/wd
5855 guix environment --container --user=foo \
5856 --expose=$HOME/test \
5857 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
5858 @end example
5859
5860 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
5861 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
5862 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
5863
5864 @item --no-cwd
5865 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
5866 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
5867 directory within the container. If this is undesirable,
5868 @option{--no-cwd} will cause the current working directory to @emph{not}
5869 be automatically shared and will change to the user's home directory
5870 within the container instead. See also @option{--user}.
5871
5872 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5873 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5874 For containers, @option{--expose} (resp. @option{--share}) exposes the
5875 file system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
5876 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
5877 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5878 point in the container.
5879
5880 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5881 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5882 directory:
5883
5884 @example
5885 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
5886 @end example
5887
5888 @end table
5889
5890 @command{guix environment}
5891 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5892 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
5893 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5894
5895 @node Invoking guix pack
5896 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
5897
5898 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
5899 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
5900 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
5901 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
5902
5903 @quotation Note
5904 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5905 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5906 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5907 @end quotation
5908
5909 @cindex pack
5910 @cindex bundle
5911 @cindex application bundle
5912 @cindex software bundle
5913 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5914 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5915 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5916 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5917 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5918 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5919 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5920 that you pretend to be shipping.
5921
5922 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5923 their dependencies, you can run:
5924
5925 @example
5926 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5927 @dots{}
5928 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5929 @end example
5930
5931 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5932 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5933 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5934 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5935 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5936 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5937
5938 Users of this pack would have to run
5939 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5940 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5941 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5942
5943 @example
5944 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5945 @end example
5946
5947 @noindent
5948 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5949
5950 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5951 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5952 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5953 that case, you will want to use the @option{--relocatable} option (see
5954 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5955 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5956 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5957 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5958
5959 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5960 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5961 the following command:
5962
5963 @example
5964 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5965 @end example
5966
5967 @noindent
5968 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5969 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5970
5971 @example
5972 docker load < @var{file}
5973 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5974 @end example
5975
5976 @noindent
5977 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
5978 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
5979 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5980 documentation} for more information.
5981
5982 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5983 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5984 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5985 command:
5986
5987 @example
5988 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5989 @end example
5990
5991 @noindent
5992 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5993 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5994 @uref{https://www.sylabs.io/docs/, Singularity container execution
5995 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5996 @command{singularity exec}.
5997
5998 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5999
6000 @table @code
6001 @item --format=@var{format}
6002 @itemx -f @var{format}
6003 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
6004
6005 The available formats are:
6006
6007 @table @code
6008 @item tarball
6009 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
6010 specified binaries and symlinks.
6011
6012 @item docker
6013 This produces a tarball that follows the
6014 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
6015 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
6016 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
6017 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
6018
6019 @item squashfs
6020 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
6021 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
6022 procfs.
6023
6024 @quotation Note
6025 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
6026 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
6027 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
6028 with something like:
6029
6030 @example
6031 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
6032 @end example
6033
6034 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
6035 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
6036 such file or directory'' message.
6037 @end quotation
6038 @end table
6039
6040 @cindex relocatable binaries
6041 @item --relocatable
6042 @itemx -R
6043 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
6044 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
6045
6046 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
6047 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
6048 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
6049 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
6050 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to
6051 other techniques if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially
6052 work anywhere---see below for the implications.
6053
6054 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
6055
6056 @example
6057 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
6058 @end example
6059
6060 @noindent
6061 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
6062 home directory as a normal user, run:
6063
6064 @example
6065 tar xf pack.tar.gz
6066 ./mybin/sh
6067 @end example
6068
6069 @noindent
6070 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
6071 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
6072 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
6073 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
6074 software on a non-Guix machine.
6075
6076 @quotation Note
6077 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
6078 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
6079 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
6080 turn it off.
6081
6082 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
6083 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
6084 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to another
6085 @dfn{execution engine} if user namespaces are not supported. The
6086 following execution engines are supported:
6087
6088 @table @code
6089 @item default
6090 Try user namespaces and fall back to PRoot if user namespaces are not
6091 supported (see below).
6092
6093 @item performance
6094 Try user namespaces and fall back to Fakechroot if user namespaces are
6095 not supported (see below).
6096
6097 @item userns
6098 Run the program through user namespaces and abort if they are not
6099 supported.
6100
6101 @item proot
6102 Run through PRoot. The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program
6103 provides the necessary
6104 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
6105 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
6106 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
6107 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
6108
6109 @item fakechroot
6110 Run through Fakechroot. @uref{https://github.com/dex4er/fakechroot/,
6111 Fakechroot} virtualizes file system accesses by intercepting calls to C
6112 library functions such as @code{open}, @code{stat}, @code{exec}, and so
6113 on. Unlike PRoot, it incurs very little overhead. However, it does not
6114 always work: for example, some file system accesses made from within the
6115 C library are not intercepted, and file system accesses made @i{via}
6116 direct syscalls are not intercepted either, leading to erratic behavior.
6117 @end table
6118
6119 @vindex GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE
6120 When running a wrapped program, you can explicitly request one of the
6121 execution engines listed above by setting the
6122 @env{GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE} environment variable accordingly.
6123 @end quotation
6124
6125 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
6126 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
6127 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
6128 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
6129 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
6130 pack.
6131
6132 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
6133 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
6134 do:
6135
6136 @example
6137 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
6138 @end example
6139
6140 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
6141 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
6142
6143 @example
6144 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
6145 docker run @var{image-id}
6146 @end example
6147
6148 @item --expression=@var{expr}
6149 @itemx -e @var{expr}
6150 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
6151
6152 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6153 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @option{--expression} in
6154 @command{guix build}}).
6155
6156 @item --manifest=@var{file}
6157 @itemx -m @var{file}
6158 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
6159 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
6160 case the manifests are concatenated.
6161
6162 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6163 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
6164 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
6165 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
6166 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
6167 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
6168 but not both.
6169
6170 @item --system=@var{system}
6171 @itemx -s @var{system}
6172 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
6173 the system type of the build host.
6174
6175 @item --target=@var{triplet}
6176 @cindex cross-compilation
6177 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
6178 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
6179 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6180
6181 @item --compression=@var{tool}
6182 @itemx -C @var{tool}
6183 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
6184 @code{zstd}, @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no
6185 compression.
6186
6187 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
6188 @itemx -S @var{spec}
6189 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
6190 appear several times.
6191
6192 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
6193 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
6194 symlink target.
6195
6196 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
6197 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
6198
6199 @item --save-provenance
6200 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
6201 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
6202 (@pxref{Channels}).
6203
6204 Provenance information is saved in the
6205 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
6206 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
6207 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
6208 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
6209
6210 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
6211 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
6212 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
6213 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
6214 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
6215
6216 @item --root=@var{file}
6217 @itemx -r @var{file}
6218 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
6219 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
6220 collector root.
6221
6222 @item --localstatedir
6223 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
6224 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
6225 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
6226 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
6227 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
6228
6229 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
6230 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
6231 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
6232 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
6233 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
6234
6235 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
6236 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
6237
6238 @item --derivation
6239 @itemx -d
6240 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
6241
6242 @item --bootstrap
6243 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
6244 useful to Guix developers.
6245 @end table
6246
6247 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
6248 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
6249 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6250
6251
6252 @node The GCC toolchain
6253 @section The GCC toolchain
6254
6255 @cindex GCC
6256 @cindex ld-wrapper
6257 @cindex linker wrapper
6258 @cindex toolchain, for C development
6259 @cindex toolchain, for Fortran development
6260
6261 If you need a complete toolchain for compiling and linking C or C++
6262 source code, use the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This package
6263 provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development, including GCC
6264 itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus debugging symbols
6265 in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker wrapper.
6266
6267 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
6268 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
6269 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
6270 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
6271 @env{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
6272
6273 The package @code{gfortran-toolchain} provides a complete GCC toolchain
6274 for Fortran development. For other languages, please use
6275 @samp{guix search gcc toolchain} (@pxref{guix-search,, Invoking guix package}).
6276
6277
6278 @node Invoking guix git authenticate
6279 @section Invoking @command{guix git authenticate}
6280
6281 The @command{guix git authenticate} command authenticates a Git checkout
6282 following the same rule as for channels (@pxref{channel-authentication,
6283 channel authentication}). That is, starting from a given commit, it
6284 ensures that all subsequent commits are signed by an OpenPGP key whose
6285 fingerprint appears in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its
6286 parent commit(s).
6287
6288 You will find this command useful if you maintain a channel. But in
6289 fact, this authentication mechanism is useful in a broader context, so
6290 you might want to use it for Git repositories that have nothing to do
6291 with Guix.
6292
6293 The general syntax is:
6294
6295 @example
6296 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer} [@var{options}@dots{}]
6297 @end example
6298
6299 By default, this command authenticates the Git checkout in the current
6300 directory; it outputs nothing and exits with exit code zero on success
6301 and non-zero on failure. @var{commit} above denotes the first commit
6302 where authentication takes place, and @var{signer} is the OpenPGP
6303 fingerprint of public key used to sign @var{commit}. Together, they
6304 form a ``channel introduction'' (@pxref{channel-authentication, channel
6305 introduction}). The options below allow you to fine-tune the process.
6306
6307 @table @code
6308 @item --repository=@var{directory}
6309 @itemx -r @var{directory}
6310 Open the Git repository in @var{directory} instead of the current
6311 directory.
6312
6313 @item --keyring=@var{reference}
6314 @itemx -k @var{reference}
6315 Load OpenPGP keyring from @var{reference}, the reference of a branch
6316 such as @code{origin/keyring} or @code{my-keyring}. The branch must
6317 contain OpenPGP public keys in @file{.key} files, either in binary form
6318 or ``ASCII-armored''. By default the keyring is loaded from the branch
6319 named @code{keyring}.
6320
6321 @item --stats
6322 Display commit signing statistics upon completion.
6323
6324 @item --cache-key=@var{key}
6325 Previously-authenticated commits are cached in a file under
6326 @file{~/.cache/guix/authentication}. This option forces the cache to be
6327 stored in file @var{key} in that directory.
6328
6329 @item --historical-authorizations=@var{file}
6330 By default, any commit whose parent commit(s) lack the
6331 @file{.guix-authorizations} file is considered inauthentic. In
6332 contrast, this option considers the authorizations in @var{file} for any
6333 commit that lacks @file{.guix-authorizations}. The format of @var{file}
6334 is the same as that of @file{.guix-authorizations}
6335 (@pxref{channel-authorizations, @file{.guix-authorizations} format}).
6336 @end table
6337
6338
6339 @c *********************************************************************
6340 @node Programming Interface
6341 @chapter Programming Interface
6342
6343 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
6344 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
6345 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
6346 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
6347 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
6348 turned into concrete build actions.
6349
6350 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
6351 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
6352 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
6353 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under specific
6354 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
6355
6356 @cindex derivation
6357 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
6358 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
6359 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
6360 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
6361 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
6362 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
6363 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
6364
6365 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
6366 package definitions.
6367
6368 @menu
6369 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6370 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
6371 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
6372 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
6373 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
6374 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
6375 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
6376 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
6377 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
6378 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
6379 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
6380 @end menu
6381
6382 @node Package Modules
6383 @section Package Modules
6384
6385 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
6386 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
6387 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
6388 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
6389 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
6390 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
6391 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
6392 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
6393 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
6394 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
6395 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6396
6397 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
6398 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
6399 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
6400 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
6401 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
6402 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
6403
6404 @cindex customization, of packages
6405 @cindex package module search path
6406 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
6407 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
6408 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
6409 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
6410 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
6411 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
6412 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
6413 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
6414
6415 @enumerate
6416 @item
6417 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
6418 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
6419 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
6420 environment variable described below.
6421
6422 @item
6423 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
6424 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
6425 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
6426 channels.
6427 @end enumerate
6428
6429 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
6430
6431 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6432 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
6433 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
6434 over the own modules of the distribution.
6435 @end defvr
6436
6437 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
6438 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
6439 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
6440 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
6441 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
6442 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
6443
6444 @node Defining Packages
6445 @section Defining Packages
6446
6447 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
6448 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
6449 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
6450 package looks like this:
6451
6452 @lisp
6453 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
6454 #:use-module (guix packages)
6455 #:use-module (guix download)
6456 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
6457 #:use-module (guix licenses)
6458 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
6459
6460 (define-public hello
6461 (package
6462 (name "hello")
6463 (version "2.10")
6464 (source (origin
6465 (method url-fetch)
6466 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6467 ".tar.gz"))
6468 (sha256
6469 (base32
6470 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
6471 (build-system gnu-build-system)
6472 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
6473 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
6474 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
6475 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
6476 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
6477 (license gpl3+)))
6478 @end lisp
6479
6480 @noindent
6481 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
6482 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
6483 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
6484 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6485 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
6486 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
6487 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
6488
6489 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
6490 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
6491 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
6492
6493 In the example above, @code{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
6494 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
6495 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
6496 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
6497 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6498
6499 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
6500
6501 @itemize
6502 @item
6503 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
6504 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
6505 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
6506 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
6507
6508 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
6509 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
6510
6511 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
6512 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
6513 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6514 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
6515 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
6516 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
6517
6518 @cindex patches
6519 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
6520 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
6521 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
6522
6523 @item
6524 @cindex GNU Build System
6525 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
6526 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @code{gnu-build-system}
6527 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
6528 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
6529 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
6530
6531 When you start packaging non-trivial software, you may need tools to
6532 manipulate those build phases, manipulate files, and so on. @xref{Build
6533 Utilities}, for more on this.
6534
6535 @item
6536 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
6537 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
6538 @code{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
6539 @option{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
6540
6541 @cindex quote
6542 @cindex quoting
6543 @findex '
6544 @findex quote
6545 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
6546 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
6547 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
6548 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
6549 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
6550 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6551 Manual}).
6552
6553 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
6554 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
6555 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
6556 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
6557 Reference Manual}).
6558
6559 @item
6560 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
6561 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
6562 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @code{gawk}
6563 variable; @code{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
6564
6565 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
6566 @findex `
6567 @findex quasiquote
6568 @cindex comma (unquote)
6569 @findex ,
6570 @findex unquote
6571 @findex ,@@
6572 @findex unquote-splicing
6573 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
6574 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
6575 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
6576 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
6577 Reference Manual}).
6578
6579 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
6580 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @code{gnu-build-system} takes care
6581 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
6582
6583 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
6584 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
6585 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
6586 @end itemize
6587
6588 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
6589
6590 Once a package definition is in place, the
6591 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
6592 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
6593 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
6594 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
6595 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
6596 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
6597 more information on how to test package definitions, and
6598 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
6599 for style conformance.
6600 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6601 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
6602 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
6603 in a ``channel''.
6604
6605 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
6606 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
6607 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
6608
6609 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
6610 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
6611 That derivation is stored in a @file{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
6612 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
6613 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
6614
6615 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
6616 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
6617 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6618
6619 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
6620 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
6621 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
6622 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
6623 (@pxref{The Store}).
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 @noindent
6627 @cindex cross-compilation
6628 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
6629 package for some other system:
6630
6631 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
6632 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
6633 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
6634 @var{system} to @var{target}.
6635
6636 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
6637 and operating system, such as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"}
6638 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6639 @end deffn
6640
6641 Once you have package definitions, you can easily define @emph{variants}
6642 of those packages. @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for more on that.
6643
6644 @menu
6645 * package Reference:: The package data type.
6646 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
6647 @end menu
6648
6649
6650 @node package Reference
6651 @subsection @code{package} Reference
6652
6653 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
6654 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6655
6656 @deftp {Data Type} package
6657 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
6658
6659 @table @asis
6660 @item @code{name}
6661 The name of the package, as a string.
6662
6663 @item @code{version}
6664 The version of the package, as a string.
6665
6666 @item @code{source}
6667 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
6668 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
6669 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
6670 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
6671 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6672 @code{local-file}}).
6673
6674 @item @code{build-system}
6675 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
6676 Systems}).
6677
6678 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6679 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
6680 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
6681
6682 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6683 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6684 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6685 @cindex inputs, of packages
6686 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
6687 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
6688 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
6689 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
6690 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
6691 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
6692 inputs:
6693
6694 @lisp
6695 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
6696 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
6697 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
6698 @end lisp
6699
6700 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
6701 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
6702 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
6703 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
6704 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
6705 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
6706
6707 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
6708 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
6709 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
6710 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
6711
6712 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
6713 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
6714 specified packages will be automatically installed to profiles
6715 (@pxref{Features, the role of profiles in Guix}) alongside the package
6716 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
6717 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
6718 propagated inputs).
6719
6720 For example this is necessary when packaging a C/C++ library that needs
6721 headers of another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers
6722 to another one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
6723
6724 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
6725 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
6726 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
6727 more. When packaging libraries written in those languages, ensure they
6728 can find library code they depend on at run time by listing run-time
6729 dependencies in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
6730
6731 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
6732 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
6733 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
6734
6735 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6736 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6737 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
6738 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
6739
6740 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
6741 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
6742 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
6743 for details.
6744
6745 @item @code{synopsis}
6746 A one-line description of the package.
6747
6748 @item @code{description}
6749 A more elaborate description of the package.
6750
6751 @item @code{license}
6752 @cindex license, of packages
6753 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
6754 or a list of such values.
6755
6756 @item @code{home-page}
6757 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
6758
6759 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @code{%supported-systems})
6760 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
6761 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
6762
6763 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
6764 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
6765 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
6766 automatically corrected.
6767 @end table
6768 @end deftp
6769
6770 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
6771 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
6772 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
6773
6774 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
6775 cross-compiling:
6776
6777 @lisp
6778 (package
6779 (name "guile")
6780 ;; ...
6781
6782 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
6783 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
6784 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
6785 `(("self" ,this-package))
6786 '())))
6787 @end lisp
6788
6789 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 Because packages are regular Scheme objects that capture a complete
6793 dependency graph and associated build procedures, it is often useful to
6794 write procedures that take a package and return a modified version
6795 thereof according to some parameters. Below are a few examples.
6796
6797 @cindex tool chain, choosing a package's tool chain
6798 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-with-c-toolchain @var{package} @var{toolchain}
6799 Return a variant of @var{package} that uses @var{toolchain} instead of
6800 the default GNU C/C++ toolchain. @var{toolchain} must be a list of
6801 inputs (label/package tuples) providing equivalent functionality, such
6802 as the @code{gcc-toolchain} package.
6803
6804 The example below returns a variant of the @code{hello} package built
6805 with GCC@tie{}10.x and the rest of the GNU tool chain (Binutils and the
6806 GNU C Library) instead of the default tool chain:
6807
6808 @lisp
6809 (let ((toolchain (specification->package "gcc-toolchain@@10")))
6810 (package-with-c-toolchain hello `(("toolchain" ,toolchain))))
6811 @end lisp
6812
6813 The build tool chain is part of the @dfn{implicit inputs} of
6814 packages---it's usually not listed as part of the various ``inputs''
6815 fields and is instead pulled in by the build system. Consequently, this
6816 procedure works by changing the build system of @var{package} so that it
6817 pulls in @var{toolchain} instead of the defaults. @ref{Build Systems},
6818 for more on build systems.
6819 @end deffn
6820
6821 @node origin Reference
6822 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
6823
6824 This section documents @dfn{origins}. An @code{origin} declaration
6825 specifies data that must be ``produced''---downloaded, usually---and
6826 whose content hash is known in advance. Origins are primarily used to
6827 represent the source code of packages (@pxref{Defining Packages}). For
6828 that reason, the @code{origin} form allows you to declare patches to
6829 apply to the original source code as well as code snippets to modify it.
6830
6831 @deftp {Data Type} origin
6832 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
6833
6834 @table @asis
6835 @item @code{uri}
6836 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
6837 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
6838 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
6839 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
6840
6841 @cindex fixed-output derivations, for download
6842 @item @code{method}
6843 A monadic procedure that handles the given URI@. The procedure must
6844 accept at least three arguments: the value of the @code{uri} field and
6845 the hash algorithm and hash value specified by the @code{hash} field.
6846 It must return a store item or a derivation in the store monad
6847 (@pxref{The Store Monad}); most methods return a fixed-output derivation
6848 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6849
6850 Commonly used methods include @code{url-fetch}, which fetches data from
6851 a URL, and @code{git-fetch}, which fetches data from a Git repository
6852 (see below).
6853
6854 @item @code{sha256}
6855 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. This is
6856 equivalent to providing a @code{content-hash} SHA256 object in the
6857 @code{hash} field described below.
6858
6859 @item @code{hash}
6860 The @code{content-hash} object of the source---see below for how to use
6861 @code{content-hash}.
6862
6863 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
6864 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
6865 guix hash}).
6866
6867 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
6868 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
6869 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
6870 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
6871 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
6872 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
6873
6874 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
6875 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6876 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
6877
6878 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
6879 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
6880 @code{%current-target-system}.
6881
6882 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
6883 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
6884 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
6885 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
6886
6887 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
6888 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
6889 command.
6890
6891 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
6892 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
6893 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
6894 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
6895
6896 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
6897 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
6898 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
6899
6900 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
6901 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
6902 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
6903 @end table
6904 @end deftp
6905
6906 @deftp {Data Type} content-hash @var{value} [@var{algorithm}]
6907 Construct a content hash object for the given @var{algorithm}, and with
6908 @var{value} as its hash value. When @var{algorithm} is omitted, assume
6909 it is @code{sha256}.
6910
6911 @var{value} can be a literal string, in which case it is base32-decoded,
6912 or it can be a bytevector.
6913
6914 The following forms are all equivalent:
6915
6916 @lisp
6917 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj")
6918 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"
6919 sha256)
6920 (content-hash (base32
6921 "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"))
6922 (content-hash (base64 "kkb+RPaP7uyMZmu4eXPVkM4BN8yhRd8BTHLslb6f/Rc=")
6923 sha256)
6924 @end lisp
6925
6926 Technically, @code{content-hash} is currently implemented as a macro.
6927 It performs sanity checks at macro-expansion time, when possible, such
6928 as ensuring that @var{value} has the right size for @var{algorithm}.
6929 @end deftp
6930
6931 As we have seen above, how exactly the data an origin refers to is
6932 retrieved is determined by its @code{method} field. The @code{(guix
6933 download)} module provides the most common method, @code{url-fetch},
6934 described below.
6935
6936 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} url-fetch @var{url} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6937 [name] [#:executable? #f]
6938 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches data from @var{url} (a
6939 string, or a list of strings denoting alternate URLs), which is expected
6940 to have hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). By default,
6941 the file name is the base name of URL; optionally, @var{name} can
6942 specify a different file name. When @var{executable?} is true, make the
6943 downloaded file executable.
6944
6945 When one of the URL starts with @code{mirror://}, then its host part is
6946 interpreted as the name of a mirror scheme, taken from @file{%mirror-file}.
6947
6948 Alternatively, when URL starts with @code{file://}, return the
6949 corresponding file name in the store.
6950 @end deffn
6951
6952 Likewise, the @code{(guix git-download)} module defines the
6953 @code{git-fetch} origin method, which fetches data from a Git version
6954 control repository, and the @code{git-reference} data type to describe
6955 the repository and revision to fetch.
6956
6957 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash}
6958 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6959 @code{<git-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6960 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6961 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#f}.
6962 @end deffn
6963
6964 @deftp {Data Type} git-reference
6965 This data type represents a Git reference for @code{git-fetch} to
6966 retrieve.
6967
6968 @table @asis
6969 @item @code{url}
6970 The URL of the Git repository to clone.
6971
6972 @item @code{commit}
6973 This string denotes either the commit to fetch (a hexadecimal string,
6974 either the full SHA1 commit or a ``short'' commit string; the latter is
6975 not recommended) or the tag to fetch.
6976
6977 @item @code{recursive?} (default: @code{#f})
6978 This Boolean indicates whether to recursively fetch Git sub-modules.
6979 @end table
6980
6981 The example below denotes the @code{v2.10} tag of the GNU@tie{}Hello
6982 repository:
6983
6984 @lisp
6985 (git-reference
6986 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6987 (commit "v2.10"))
6988 @end lisp
6989
6990 This is equivalent to the reference below, which explicitly names the
6991 commit:
6992
6993 @lisp
6994 (git-reference
6995 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6996 (commit "dc7dc56a00e48fe6f231a58f6537139fe2908fb9"))
6997 @end lisp
6998 @end deftp
6999
7000 For Mercurial repositories, the module @code{(guix hg-download)} defines
7001 the @code{hg-fetch} origin method and @code{hg-reference} data type for
7002 support of the Mercurial version control system.
7003
7004 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} hg-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
7005 [name]
7006 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
7007 @code{<hg-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
7008 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
7009 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#false}.
7010 @end deffn
7011
7012 @node Defining Package Variants
7013 @section Defining Package Variants
7014
7015 @cindex customizing packages
7016 @cindex variants, of packages
7017 One of the nice things with Guix is that, given a package definition,
7018 you can easily @emph{derive} variants of that package---for a different
7019 upstream version, with different dependencies, different compilation
7020 options, and so on. Some of these custom packages can be defined
7021 straight from the command line (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
7022 This section describes how to define package variants in code. This can
7023 be useful in ``manifests'' (@pxref{profile-manifest,
7024 @option{--manifest}}) and in your own package collection
7025 (@pxref{Creating a Channel}), among others!
7026
7027 @cindex inherit, for package definitions
7028 As discussed earlier, packages are first-class objects in the Scheme
7029 language. The @code{(guix packages)} module provides the @code{package}
7030 construct to define new package objects (@pxref{package Reference}).
7031 The easiest way to define a package variant is using the @code{inherit}
7032 keyword together with @code{package}. This allows you to inherit from a
7033 package definition while overriding the fields you want.
7034
7035 For example, given the @code{hello} variable, which contains a
7036 definition for the current version of GNU@tie{}Hello, here's how you
7037 would define a variant for version 2.2 (released in 2006, it's
7038 vintage!):
7039
7040 @lisp
7041 (use-modules (gnu packages base)) ;for 'hello'
7042
7043 (define hello-2.2
7044 (package
7045 (inherit hello)
7046 (version "2.2")
7047 (source (origin
7048 (method url-fetch)
7049 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
7050 ".tar.gz"))
7051 (sha256
7052 (base32
7053 "0lappv4slgb5spyqbh6yl5r013zv72yqg2pcl30mginf3wdqd8k9"))))))
7054 @end lisp
7055
7056 The example above corresponds to what the @option{--with-source} package
7057 transformation option does. Essentially @code{hello-2.2} preserves all
7058 the fields of @code{hello}, except @code{version} and @code{source},
7059 which it overrides. Note that the original @code{hello} variable is
7060 still there, in the @code{(gnu packages base)} module, unchanged. When
7061 you define a custom package like this, you are really @emph{adding} a
7062 new package definition; the original one remains available.
7063
7064 You can just as well define variants with a different set of
7065 dependencies than the original package. For example, the default
7066 @code{gdb} package depends on @code{guile}, but since that is an
7067 optional dependency, you can define a variant that removes that
7068 dependency like so:
7069
7070 @lisp
7071 (use-modules (gnu packages gdb) ;for 'gdb'
7072 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'alist-delete'
7073
7074 (define gdb-sans-guile
7075 (package
7076 (inherit gdb)
7077 (inputs (alist-delete "guile"
7078 (package-inputs gdb)))))
7079 @end lisp
7080
7081 The @code{alist-delete} call above removes the tuple from the
7082 @code{inputs} field that has @code{"guile"} as its first element
7083 (@pxref{SRFI-1 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7084 Manual}).
7085
7086 In some cases, you may find it useful to write functions
7087 (``procedures'', in Scheme parlance) that return a package based on some
7088 parameters. For example, consider the @code{luasocket} library for the
7089 Lua programming language. We want to create @code{luasocket} packages
7090 for major versions of Lua. One way to do that is to define a procedure
7091 that takes a Lua package and returns a @code{luasocket} package that
7092 depends on it:
7093
7094 @lisp
7095 (define (make-lua-socket name lua)
7096 ;; Return a luasocket package built with LUA.
7097 (package
7098 (name name)
7099 (version "3.0")
7100 ;; several fields omitted
7101 (inputs
7102 `(("lua" ,lua)))
7103 (synopsis "Socket library for Lua")))
7104
7105 (define-public lua5.1-socket
7106 (make-lua-socket "lua5.1-socket" lua-5.1))
7107
7108 (define-public lua5.2-socket
7109 (make-lua-socket "lua5.2-socket" lua-5.2))
7110 @end lisp
7111
7112 Here we have defined packages @code{lua5.1-socket} and
7113 @code{lua5.2-socket} by calling @code{make-lua-socket} with different
7114 arguments. @xref{Procedures,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
7115 more info on procedures. Having top-level public definitions for these
7116 two packages means that they can be referred to from the command line
7117 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7118
7119 @cindex package transformations
7120 These are pretty simple package variants. As a convenience, the
7121 @code{(guix transformations)} module provides a high-level interface
7122 that directly maps to the more sophisticated package transformation
7123 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}):
7124
7125 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} options->transformation @var{opts}
7126 Return a procedure that, when passed an object to build (package,
7127 derivation, etc.), applies the transformations specified by @var{opts} and returns
7128 the resulting objects. @var{opts} must be a list of symbol/string pairs such as:
7129
7130 @lisp
7131 ((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7132 (without-tests . "libgcrypt"))
7133 @end lisp
7134
7135 Each symbol names a transformation and the corresponding string is an argument
7136 to that transformation.
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 For instance, a manifest equivalent to this command:
7140
7141 @example
7142 guix build guix \
7143 --with-branch=guile-gcrypt=master \
7144 --with-debug-info=zlib
7145 @end example
7146
7147 @noindent
7148 ... would look like this:
7149
7150 @lisp
7151 (use-modules (guix transformations))
7152
7153 (define transform
7154 ;; The package transformation procedure.
7155 (options->transformation
7156 '((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7157 (with-debug-info . "zlib"))))
7158
7159 (packages->manifest
7160 (list (transform (specification->package "guix"))))
7161 @end lisp
7162
7163 @cindex input rewriting
7164 @cindex dependency graph rewriting
7165 The @code{options->transformation} procedure is convenient, but it's
7166 perhaps also not as flexible as you may like. How is it implemented?
7167 The astute reader probably noticed that most package transformation
7168 options go beyond the superficial changes shown in the first examples of
7169 this section: they involve @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency
7170 graph of a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others.
7171
7172 Dependency graph rewriting, for the purposes of swapping packages in the
7173 graph, is what the @code{package-input-rewriting} procedure in
7174 @code{(guix packages)} implements.
7175
7176 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
7177 [@var{rewrite-name}] [#:deep? #t]
7178 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
7179 indirect dependencies, including implicit inputs when @var{deep?} is
7180 true, according to @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of
7181 package pairs; the first element of each pair is the package to replace,
7182 and the second one is the replacement.
7183
7184 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
7185 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188 @noindent
7189 Consider this example:
7190
7191 @lisp
7192 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7193 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
7194 ;; recursively.
7195 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
7196
7197 (define git-with-libressl
7198 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
7199 @end lisp
7200
7201 @noindent
7202 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
7203 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
7204 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
7205 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
7206 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
7207
7208 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
7209 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
7210
7211 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements} [#:deep? #t]
7212 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given
7213 @var{replacements} to all the package graph, including implicit inputs
7214 unless @var{deep?} is false. @var{replacements} is a list of
7215 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as
7216 @code{"gcc"} or @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching
7217 package and returns a replacement for that package.
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 The example above could be rewritten this way:
7221
7222 @lisp
7223 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7224 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
7225 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
7226 @end lisp
7227
7228 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
7229 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
7230 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
7231
7232 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
7233 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
7234 graph.
7235
7236 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}] [#:deep? #f]
7237 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
7238 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
7239 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package. When @var{deep?} is true, @var{proc} is
7240 applied to implicit inputs as well.
7241 @end deffn
7242
7243
7244 @node Build Systems
7245 @section Build Systems
7246
7247 @cindex build system
7248 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
7249 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
7250 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
7251 dependencies of that build procedure.
7252
7253 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
7254 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
7255 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
7256
7257 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
7258 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
7259 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
7260 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
7261 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
7262 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
7263 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
7264 The @code{package-with-c-toolchain} is an example of a way to change the
7265 implicit inputs that a package's build system pulls in (@pxref{package
7266 Reference, @code{package-with-c-toolchain}}).
7267
7268 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
7269 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
7270 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
7271 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
7272 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
7273 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
7274 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
7275
7276 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
7277 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
7278 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
7279
7280 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
7281 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
7282 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
7283 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
7284
7285 @cindex build phases
7286 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
7287 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
7288 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
7289 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
7290 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
7291 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
7292
7293 @table @code
7294 @item unpack
7295 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
7296 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
7297 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
7298
7299 @item patch-source-shebangs
7300 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
7301 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
7302 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
7303
7304 @item configure
7305 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
7306 as @option{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
7307 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
7308
7309 @item build
7310 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
7311 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7312 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
7313
7314 @item check
7315 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
7316 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
7317 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
7318 check -j}.
7319
7320 @item install
7321 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
7322
7323 @item patch-shebangs
7324 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
7325
7326 @item strip
7327 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
7328 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
7329 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
7330 @end table
7331
7332 @vindex %standard-phases
7333 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
7334 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
7335 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
7336 procedure implements the actual phase.
7337
7338 @xref{Build Phases}, for more info on build phases and ways to customize
7339 them.
7340
7341 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
7342 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
7343 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
7344 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
7345 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
7346 have to mention them.
7347 @end defvr
7348
7349 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
7350 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
7351 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
7352 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
7353 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
7354
7355 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
7356 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
7357 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
7358 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
7359
7360 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
7361 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
7362 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
7363 parameters, respectively.
7364
7365 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
7366 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
7367 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
7368 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
7369 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
7370
7371 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
7372 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
7373 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
7374 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
7375 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
7376 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
7377 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
7378
7379 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
7380 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
7381 ``jar'' task will be run.
7382
7383 @end defvr
7384
7385 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
7386 @cindex Android distribution
7387 @cindex Android NDK build system
7388 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
7389 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
7390 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
7391
7392 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
7393 (header) files to the subdirectory @file{include} of the @code{out} output and
7394 their libraries to the subdirectory @file{lib} the @code{out} output.
7395
7396 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
7397 has no conflicting files.
7398
7399 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
7400 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
7401
7402 @end defvr
7403
7404 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
7405 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
7406 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
7407
7408 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
7409 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
7410 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
7411 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
7412
7413 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
7414 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
7415 ASDF@. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
7416 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
7417 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
7418 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
7419
7420 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
7421 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
7422 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
7423
7424 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
7425 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
7426 the @code{cl-} prefix.
7427
7428 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
7429 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
7430 They should be called in a build phase after the
7431 @code{create-asdf-configuration} phase, so that the system which was
7432 just built can be used within the resulting image. @code{build-program}
7433 requires a list of Common Lisp expressions to be passed as the
7434 @code{#:entry-program} argument.
7435
7436 By default, all the @file{.asd} files present in the sources are read to
7437 find system definitions. The @code{#:asd-files} parameter can be used
7438 to specify the list of @file{.asd} files to read. Furthermore, if the
7439 package defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be
7440 loaded before the tests are run if it is specified by the
7441 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
7442 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
7443 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
7444
7445 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
7446 naming conventions suggest, or if several systems must be compiled, the
7447 @code{#:asd-systems} parameter can be used to specify the list of system
7448 names.
7449
7450 @end defvr
7451
7452 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
7453 @cindex Rust programming language
7454 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
7455 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
7456 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
7457 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
7458
7459 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
7460 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
7461
7462 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition similarly
7463 to other packages; those needed only at build time to native-inputs, others to
7464 inputs. If you need to add source-only crates then you should add them to via
7465 the @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
7466 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
7467 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
7468 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
7469 should be added to the package definition via the
7470 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
7471
7472 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
7473 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
7474 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
7475 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
7476 @code{build} phase. The @code{package} phase will run @code{cargo package}
7477 to create a source crate for future use. The @code{install} phase installs
7478 the binaries defined by the crate. Unless @code{install-source? #f} is
7479 defined it will also install a source crate repository of itself and unpacked
7480 sources, to ease in future hacking on rust packages.
7481 @end defvr
7482
7483 @defvr {Scheme Variable} chicken-build-system
7484 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system chicken)}. It
7485 builds @uref{https://call-cc.org/, CHICKEN Scheme} modules, also called
7486 ``eggs'' or ``extensions''. CHICKEN generates C source code, which then
7487 gets compiled by a C compiler, in this case GCC.
7488
7489 This build system adds @code{chicken} to the package inputs, as well as
7490 the packages of @code{gnu-build-system}.
7491
7492 The build system can't (yet) deduce the egg's name automatically, so just like
7493 with @code{go-build-system} and its @code{#:import-path}, you should define
7494 @code{#:egg-name} in the package's @code{arguments} field.
7495
7496 For example, if you are packaging the @code{srfi-1} egg:
7497
7498 @lisp
7499 (arguments '(#:egg-name "srfi-1"))
7500 @end lisp
7501
7502 Egg dependencies must be defined in @code{propagated-inputs}, not @code{inputs}
7503 because CHICKEN doesn't embed absolute references in compiled eggs.
7504 Test dependencies should go to @code{native-inputs}, as usual.
7505 @end defvr
7506
7507 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
7508 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
7509 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
7510 mostly just moving files around.
7511
7512 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
7513 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
7514 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
7515 @code{trivial-build-system}.
7516
7517 To further simplify the file installation process, an
7518 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
7519 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
7520 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
7521
7522 @itemize
7523 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
7524 @itemize
7525 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
7526 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
7527 @end itemize
7528
7529 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
7530 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
7531 as above.
7532 @itemize
7533 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
7534 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
7535 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
7536 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
7537 @itemize
7538 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
7539 at least one of the elements in the given list.
7540 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
7541 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
7542 list.
7543 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
7544 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
7545 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
7546 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
7547 on top of the inclusions.
7548 @end itemize
7549 @end itemize
7550 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
7551 @var{target}.
7552 @end itemize
7553
7554 Examples:
7555
7556 @itemize
7557 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
7558 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
7559 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
7560 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7561 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
7562 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7563 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
7564 @file{share/my-app/file}.
7565 @end itemize
7566 @end defvr
7567
7568
7569 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
7570 @cindex simple Clojure build system
7571 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
7572 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
7573 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
7574 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
7575 yet.
7576
7577 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
7578 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
7579 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
7580
7581 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
7582 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
7583 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
7584 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
7585 Other parameters are documented below.
7586
7587 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
7588 following phases changed:
7589
7590 @table @code
7591
7592 @item build
7593 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
7594 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
7595 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
7596 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
7597 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
7598 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
7599 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
7600 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
7601
7602 @item check
7603 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
7604 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
7605 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
7606 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
7607 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
7608 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
7609
7610 @item install
7611 This phase installs all jars built previously.
7612 @end table
7613
7614 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
7615
7616 @table @code
7617
7618 @item install-doc
7619 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
7620 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
7621 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
7622 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
7623 @end table
7624 @end defvr
7625
7626 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
7627 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
7628 implements the build procedure for packages using the
7629 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
7630
7631 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
7632 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
7633 parameter.
7634
7635 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
7636 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
7637 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
7638 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
7639 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
7640 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7641 @end defvr
7642
7643 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
7644 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
7645 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
7646 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
7647 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
7648 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
7649 system.
7650
7651 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
7652 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
7653 parameter.
7654
7655 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
7656 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
7657 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
7658
7659 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
7660 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
7661 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
7662
7663 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
7664 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
7665 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
7666 @code{dune}.
7667 @end defvr
7668
7669 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
7670 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
7671 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
7672 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
7673 Go build mechanisms}.
7674
7675 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
7676 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
7677 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
7678 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
7679 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
7680 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
7681 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
7682 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
7683 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
7684 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
7685
7686 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
7687 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
7688 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
7689 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
7690 @end defvr
7691
7692 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
7693 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
7694 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
7695
7696 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7697 @code{gnu-build-system}:
7698
7699 @table @code
7700 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
7701 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
7702 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
7703 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
7704 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
7705 that appropriately set the @env{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @env{GTK_PATH}
7706 environment variables.
7707
7708 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
7709 process by listing their names in the
7710 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
7711 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
7712 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
7713 GLib and GTK+.
7714
7715 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
7716 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
7717 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
7718 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
7719 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
7720 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
7721 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
7722 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
7723 @end table
7724
7725 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
7726 @end defvr
7727
7728 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
7729 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
7730 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
7731 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
7732 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
7733 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
7734 installs documentation.
7735
7736 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the
7737 @option{--target} option of @samp{guild compile}.
7738
7739 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
7740 their @code{native-inputs} field.
7741 @end defvr
7742
7743 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
7744 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It
7745 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/,
7746 julia} packages, which essentially is similar to running @samp{julia -e
7747 'using Pkg; Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where
7748 @env{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the paths to all Julia package inputs.
7749 Tests are run by calling @code{/test/runtests.jl}.
7750
7751 The Julia package name is read from the file @file{Project.toml}. This
7752 value can be overridden by passing the argument @code{#:julia-file-name}
7753 (which must be correctly capitalized).
7754
7755 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
7756 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
7757 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
7758 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
7759
7760 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
7761 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
7762 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
7763 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
7764 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
7765 and their uuid.
7766 @end defvr
7767
7768 @defvr {Scheme Variable} maven-build-system
7769 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system maven)}. It implements
7770 a build procedure for @uref{https://maven.apache.org, Maven} packages. Maven
7771 is a dependency and lifecycle management tool for Java. A user of Maven
7772 specifies dependencies and plugins in a @file{pom.xml} file that Maven reads.
7773 When Maven does not have one of the dependencies or plugins in its repository,
7774 it will download them and use them to build the package.
7775
7776 The maven build system ensures that maven will not try to download any
7777 dependency by running in offline mode. Maven will fail if a dependency is
7778 missing. Before running Maven, the @file{pom.xml} (and subprojects) are
7779 modified to specify the version of dependencies and plugins that match the
7780 versions available in the guix build environment. Dependencies and plugins
7781 must be installed in the fake maven repository at @file{lib/m2}, and are
7782 symlinked into a proper repository before maven is run. Maven is instructed
7783 to use that repository for the build and installs built artifacts there.
7784 Changed files are copied to the @file{lib/m2} directory of the package output.
7785
7786 You can specify a @file{pom.xml} file with the @code{#:pom-file} argument,
7787 or let the build system use the default @file{pom.xml} file in the sources.
7788
7789 In case you need to specify a dependency's version manually, you can use the
7790 @code{#:local-packages} argument. It takes an association list where the key
7791 is the groupId of the package and its value is an association list where the
7792 key is the artifactId of the package and its value is the version you want to
7793 override in the @file{pom.xml}.
7794
7795 Some packages use dependencies or plugins that are not useful at runtime nor
7796 at build time in Guix. You can alter the @file{pom.xml} file to remove them
7797 using the @code{#:exclude} argument. Its value is an association list where
7798 the key is the groupId of the plugin or dependency you want to remove, and
7799 the value is a list of artifactId you want to remove.
7800
7801 You can override the default @code{jdk} and @code{maven} packages with the
7802 corresponding argument, @code{#:jdk} and @code{#:maven}.
7803
7804 The @code{#:maven-plugins} argument is a list of maven plugins used during
7805 the build, with the same format as the @code{inputs} fields of the package
7806 declaration. Its default value is @code{(default-maven-plugins)} which is
7807 also exported.
7808 @end defvr
7809
7810 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
7811 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
7812 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
7813
7814 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
7815 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
7816 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
7817 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
7818 output.
7819
7820 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
7821 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
7822 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
7823 @end defvr
7824
7825 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
7826 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
7827 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
7828 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
7829 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
7830 try some of them.
7831
7832 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
7833 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
7834 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
7835 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
7836 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
7837 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
7838 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
7839 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
7840 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
7841
7842 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
7843 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
7844 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
7845 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
7846
7847 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
7848 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
7849 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
7850
7851 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
7852 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
7853 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
7854 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
7855 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
7856 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
7857 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
7858
7859 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
7860 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
7861 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
7862 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
7863 libraries cannot be found and we use @env{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
7864 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
7865 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
7866 @end defvr
7867
7868 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
7869 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
7870 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
7871 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
7872 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
7873
7874 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
7875 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @env{PYTHONPATH}
7876 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
7877
7878 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
7879 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
7880 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
7881 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
7882 interpreter version.
7883
7884 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
7885 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
7886 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
7887 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
7888 @end defvr
7889
7890 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
7891 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
7892 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
7893 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
7894 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
7895 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
7896 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
7897 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
7898 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
7899 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
7900 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
7901 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
7902
7903 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
7904 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
7905 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7906
7907 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
7908 @end defvr
7909
7910 @defvr {Scheme Variable} renpy-build-system
7911 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system renpy)}. It implements
7912 the more or less standard build procedure used by Ren'py games, which consists
7913 of loading @code{#:game} once, thereby creating bytecode for it.
7914
7915 It further creates a wrapper script in @code{bin/} and a desktop entry in
7916 @code{share/applications}, both of which can be used to launch the game.
7917
7918 Which Ren'py package is used can be specified with @code{#:renpy}.
7919 Games can also be installed in outputs other than ``out'' by using
7920 @code{#:output}.
7921 @end defvr
7922
7923 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
7924 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
7925 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
7926
7927 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7928 @code{cmake-build-system}:
7929
7930 @table @code
7931 @item check-setup
7932 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
7933 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
7934 For now this only sets some environment variables:
7935 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
7936 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
7937 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
7938
7939 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
7940 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
7941
7942 @item qt-wrap
7943 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
7944 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
7945 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
7946 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
7947 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
7948
7949 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
7950 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
7951 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
7952 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
7953 or such.
7954
7955 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
7956 @end table
7957 @end defvr
7958
7959 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
7960 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
7961 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
7962 packages, which essentially is little more than running @samp{R CMD
7963 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
7964 @env{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests are
7965 run after installation using the R function
7966 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
7967 @end defvr
7968
7969 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
7970 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
7971 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
7972 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
7973 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
7974 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
7975 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
7976 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
7977
7978 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
7979 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
7980 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7981 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
7982 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
7983 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7984 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
7985 @end defvr
7986
7987 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
7988 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
7989 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
7990 build system sets the @env{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
7991 files in the inputs.
7992
7993 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
7994 different engine and format can be specified with the
7995 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
7996 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
7997 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
7998 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
7999 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
8000 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
8001
8002 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
8003 install the built files under the texmf tree.
8004 @end defvr
8005
8006 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
8007 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
8008 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
8009 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
8010
8011 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
8012 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
8013 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
8014 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
8015 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
8016 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
8017 a traditional source release tarball.
8018
8019 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
8020 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
8021 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
8022 @end defvr
8023
8024 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
8025 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
8026 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
8027 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
8028 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
8029 script.
8030
8031 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
8032 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
8033 @code{#:python} parameter.
8034 @end defvr
8035
8036 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
8037 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
8038 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
8039 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
8040 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
8041 the package.
8042
8043 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
8044 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
8045 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
8046 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
8047 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
8048 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
8049 @end defvr
8050
8051 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
8052 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
8053 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
8054 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
8055 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
8056 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
8057 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
8058 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
8059 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
8060 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
8061 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
8062 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
8063 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
8064 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
8065
8066 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
8067 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
8068 @end defvr
8069
8070 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
8071 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
8072 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
8073 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
8074 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
8075
8076 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
8077 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
8078 @end defvr
8079
8080 @anchor{emacs-build-system}
8081 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
8082 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
8083 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
8084 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8085
8086 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
8087 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
8088 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
8089 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. The Elisp
8090 package files are installed directly under @file{share/emacs/site-lisp}.
8091 @end defvr
8092
8093 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
8094 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
8095 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
8096 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
8097 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
8098 locations in the output directory.
8099 @end defvr
8100
8101 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
8102 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
8103 implements the build procedure for packages that use
8104 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
8105
8106 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
8107 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
8108 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
8109 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
8110 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
8111
8112 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8113 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
8114
8115 @table @code
8116
8117 @item configure
8118 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
8119 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @option{--buildtype} is always set to
8120 @code{debugoptimized} unless something else is specified in
8121 @code{#:build-type}.
8122
8123 @item build
8124 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
8125 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
8126
8127 @item check
8128 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
8129 which is @code{"test"} by default.
8130
8131 @item install
8132 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
8133 @end table
8134
8135 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
8136
8137 @table @code
8138
8139 @item fix-runpath
8140 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
8141 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
8142 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
8143 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
8144 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
8145 required for the program to run.
8146
8147 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
8148 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8149 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8150
8151 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
8152 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8153 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8154 @end table
8155 @end defvr
8156
8157 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
8158 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
8159
8160 @cindex build phases
8161 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8162 following phases changed:
8163
8164 @table @code
8165
8166 @item configure
8167 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
8168 can be used to build the external kernel module.
8169
8170 @item build
8171 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
8172 kernel module.
8173
8174 @item install
8175 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
8176 kernel module.
8177 @end table
8178
8179 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
8180 the module (in the @code{arguments} form of a package using the
8181 @code{linux-module-build-system}, use the key @code{#:linux} to specify it).
8182 @end defvr
8183
8184 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
8185 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
8186 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
8187 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
8188 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
8189
8190 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
8191 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
8192 @code{node}.
8193 @end defvr
8194
8195 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
8196 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
8197 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
8198 and does not have a notion of build phases.
8199
8200 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
8201 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
8202
8203 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
8204 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
8205 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
8206 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
8207 @end defvr
8208
8209 @node Build Phases
8210 @section Build Phases
8211
8212 @cindex build phases, for packages
8213 Almost all package build systems implement a notion @dfn{build phases}:
8214 a sequence of actions that the build system executes, when you build the
8215 package, leading to the installed byproducts in the store. A notable
8216 exception is the ``bare-bones'' @code{trivial-build-system}
8217 (@pxref{Build Systems}).
8218
8219 As discussed in the previous section, those build systems provide a
8220 standard list of phases. For @code{gnu-build-system}, the standard
8221 phases include an @code{unpack} phase to unpack the source code tarball,
8222 a @command{configure} phase to run @code{./configure}, a @code{build}
8223 phase to run @command{make}, and (among others) an @code{install} phase
8224 to run @command{make install}; @pxref{Build Systems}, for a more
8225 detailed view of these phases. Likewise, @code{cmake-build-system}
8226 inherits these phases, but its @code{configure} phase runs
8227 @command{cmake} instead of @command{./configure}. Other build systems,
8228 such as @code{python-build-system}, have a wholly different list of
8229 standard phases. All this code runs on the @dfn{build side}: it is
8230 evaluated when you actually build the package, in a dedicated build
8231 process spawned by the build daemon (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
8232
8233 Build phases are represented as association lists or ``alists''
8234 (@pxref{Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where
8235 each key is a symbol for the name of the phase and the associated value
8236 is a procedure that accepts an arbitrary number of arguments. By
8237 convention, those procedures receive information about the build in the
8238 form of @dfn{keyword parameters}, which they can use or ignore.
8239
8240 For example, here is how @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
8241 @code{%standard-phases}, the variable holding its alist of build
8242 phases@footnote{We present a simplified view of those build phases, but
8243 do take a look at @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} to see all the
8244 details!}:
8245
8246 @lisp
8247 ;; The build phases of 'gnu-build-system'.
8248
8249 (define* (unpack #:key source #:allow-other-keys)
8250 ;; Extract the source tarball.
8251 (invoke "tar" "xvf" source))
8252
8253 (define* (configure #:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8254 ;; Run the 'configure' script. Install to output "out".
8255 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8256 (invoke "./configure"
8257 (string-append "--prefix=" out))))
8258
8259 (define* (build #:allow-other-keys)
8260 ;; Compile.
8261 (invoke "make"))
8262
8263 (define* (check #:key (test-target "check") (tests? #true)
8264 #:allow-other-keys)
8265 ;; Run the test suite.
8266 (if tests?
8267 (invoke "make" test-target)
8268 (display "test suite not run\n")))
8269
8270 (define* (install #:allow-other-keys)
8271 ;; Install files to the prefix 'configure' specified.
8272 (invoke "make" "install"))
8273
8274 (define %standard-phases
8275 ;; The list of standard phases (quite a few are omitted
8276 ;; for brevity). Each element is a symbol/procedure pair.
8277 (list (cons 'unpack unpack)
8278 (cons 'configure configure)
8279 (cons 'build build)
8280 (cons 'check check)
8281 (cons 'install install)))
8282 @end lisp
8283
8284 This shows how @code{%standard-phases} is defined as a list of
8285 symbol/procedure pairs (@pxref{Pairs,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
8286 Manual}). The first pair associates the @code{unpack} procedure with
8287 the @code{unpack} symbol---a name; the second pair defines the
8288 @code{configure} phase similarly, and so on. When building a package
8289 that uses @code{gnu-build-system} with its default list of phases, those
8290 phases are executed sequentially. You can see the name of each phase
8291 started and completed in the build log of packages that you build.
8292
8293 Let's now look at the procedures themselves. Each one is defined with
8294 @code{define*}: @code{#:key} lists keyword parameters the procedure
8295 accepts, possibly with a default value, and @code{#:allow-other-keys}
8296 specifies that other keyword parameters are ignored (@pxref{Optional
8297 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8298
8299 The @code{unpack} procedure honors the @code{source} parameter, which
8300 the build system uses to pass the file name of the source tarball (or
8301 version control checkout), and it ignores other parameters. The
8302 @code{configure} phase only cares about the @code{outputs} parameter, an
8303 alist mapping package output names to their store file name
8304 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). It extracts the file name of
8305 for @code{out}, the default output, and passes it to
8306 @command{./configure} as the installation prefix, meaning that
8307 @command{make install} will eventually copy all the files in that
8308 directory (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile
8309 conventions,, standards, GNU Coding Standards}). @code{build} and
8310 @code{install} ignore all their arguments. @code{check} honors the
8311 @code{test-target} argument, which specifies the name of the Makefile
8312 target to run tests; it prints a message and skips tests when
8313 @code{tests?} is false.
8314
8315 @cindex build phases, customizing
8316 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
8317 @code{#:phases} parameter of the build system. Changing the set of
8318 build phases boils down to building a new alist of phases based on the
8319 @code{%standard-phases} alist described above. This can be done with
8320 standard alist procedures such as @code{alist-delete} (@pxref{SRFI-1
8321 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); however, it is
8322 more convenient to do so with @code{modify-phases} (@pxref{Build
8323 Utilities, @code{modify-phases}}).
8324
8325 Here is an example of a package definition that removes the
8326 @code{configure} phase of @code{%standard-phases} and inserts a new
8327 phase before the @code{build} phase, called
8328 @code{set-prefix-in-makefile}:
8329
8330 @lisp
8331 (define-public example
8332 (package
8333 (name "example")
8334 ;; other fields omitted
8335 (build-system gnu-build-system)
8336 (arguments
8337 '(#:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases
8338 (delete 'configure)
8339 (add-before 'build 'set-prefix-in-makefile
8340 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8341 ;; Modify the makefile so that its
8342 ;; 'PREFIX' variable points to "out".
8343 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8344 (substitute* "Makefile"
8345 (("PREFIX =.*")
8346 (string-append "PREFIX = "
8347 out "\n")))
8348 #true))))))))
8349 @end lisp
8350
8351 The new phase that is inserted is written as an anonymous procedure,
8352 introduced with @code{lambda*}; it honors the @code{outputs} parameter
8353 we have seen before. @xref{Build Utilities}, for more about the helpers
8354 used by this phase, and for more examples of @code{modify-phases}.
8355
8356 @cindex code staging
8357 @cindex staging, of code
8358 Keep in mind that build phases are code evaluated at the time the
8359 package is actually built. This explains why the whole
8360 @code{modify-phases} expression above is quoted (it comes after the
8361 @code{'} or apostrophe): it is @dfn{staged} for later execution.
8362 @xref{G-Expressions}, for an explanation of code staging and the
8363 @dfn{code strata} involved.
8364
8365 @node Build Utilities
8366 @section Build Utilities
8367
8368 As soon as you start writing non-trivial package definitions
8369 (@pxref{Defining Packages}) or other build actions
8370 (@pxref{G-Expressions}), you will likely start looking for helpers for
8371 ``shell-like'' actions---creating directories, copying and deleting
8372 files recursively, manipulating build phases, and so on. The
8373 @code{(guix build utils)} module provides such utility procedures.
8374
8375 Most build systems load @code{(guix build utils)} (@pxref{Build
8376 Systems}). Thus, when writing custom build phases for your package
8377 definitions, you can usually assume those procedures are in scope.
8378
8379 When writing G-expressions, you can import @code{(guix build utils)} on
8380 the ``build side'' using @code{with-imported-modules} and then put it in
8381 scope with the @code{use-modules} form (@pxref{Using Guile Modules,,,
8382 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}):
8383
8384 @lisp
8385 (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils)) ;import it
8386 (computed-file "empty-tree"
8387 #~(begin
8388 ;; Put it in scope.
8389 (use-modules (guix build utils))
8390
8391 ;; Happily use its 'mkdir-p' procedure.
8392 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/a/b/c")))))
8393 @end lisp
8394
8395 The remainder of this section is the reference for most of the utility
8396 procedures provided by @code{(guix build utils)}.
8397
8398 @c TODO Document what's missing.
8399
8400 @subsection Dealing with Store File Names
8401
8402 This section documents procedures that deal with store file names.
8403
8404 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} %store-directory
8405 Return the directory name of the store.
8406 @end deffn
8407
8408 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} store-file-name? @var{file}
8409 Return true if @var{file} is in the store.
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} strip-store-file-name @var{file}
8413 Strip the @file{/gnu/store} and hash from @var{file}, a store file name.
8414 The result is typically a @code{"@var{package}-@var{version}"} string.
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-name->name+version @var{name}
8418 Given @var{name}, a package name like @code{"foo-0.9.1b"}, return two
8419 values: @code{"foo"} and @code{"0.9.1b"}. When the version part is
8420 unavailable, @var{name} and @code{#f} are returned. The first hyphen
8421 followed by a digit is considered to introduce the version part.
8422 @end deffn
8423
8424 @subsection File Types
8425
8426 The procedures below deal with files and file types.
8427
8428 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-exists? @var{dir}
8429 Return @code{#t} if @var{dir} exists and is a directory.
8430 @end deffn
8431
8432 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} executable-file? @var{file}
8433 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} exists and is executable.
8434 @end deffn
8435
8436 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} symbolic-link? @var{file}
8437 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is a symbolic link (aka. a ``symlink'').
8438 @end deffn
8439
8440 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elf-file? @var{file}
8441 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} ar-file? @var{file}
8442 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} gzip-file? @var{file}
8443 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is, respectively, an ELF file, an
8444 @code{ar} archive (such as a @file{.a} static library), or a gzip file.
8445 @end deffn
8446
8447 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} reset-gzip-timestamp @var{file} [#:keep-mtime? #t]
8448 If @var{file} is a gzip file, reset its embedded timestamp (as with
8449 @command{gzip --no-name}) and return true. Otherwise return @code{#f}.
8450 When @var{keep-mtime?} is true, preserve @var{file}'s modification time.
8451 @end deffn
8452
8453 @subsection File Manipulation
8454
8455 The following procedures and macros help create, modify, and delete
8456 files. They provide functionality comparable to common shell utilities
8457 such as @command{mkdir -p}, @command{cp -r}, @command{rm -r}, and
8458 @command{sed}. They complement Guile's extensive, but low-level, file
8459 system interface (@pxref{POSIX,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8460
8461 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-directory-excursion @var{directory} @var{body}@dots{}
8462 Run @var{body} with @var{directory} as the process's current directory.
8463
8464 Essentially, this macro changes the current directory to @var{directory}
8465 before evaluating @var{body}, using @code{chdir} (@pxref{Processes,,,
8466 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). It changes back to the initial
8467 directory when the dynamic extent of @var{body} is left, be it @i{via}
8468 normal procedure return or @i{via} a non-local exit such as an
8469 exception.
8470 @end deffn
8471
8472 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mkdir-p @var{dir}
8473 Create directory @var{dir} and all its ancestors.
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} install-file @var{file} @var{directory}
8477 Create @var{directory} if it does not exist and copy @var{file} in there
8478 under the same name.
8479 @end deffn
8480
8481 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} make-file-writable @var{file}
8482 Make @var{file} writable for its owner.
8483 @end deffn
8484
8485 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} copy-recursively @var{source} @var{destination} @
8486 [#:log (current-output-port)] [#:follow-symlinks? #f] [#:keep-mtime? #f]
8487 Copy @var{source} directory to @var{destination}. Follow symlinks if
8488 @var{follow-symlinks?} is true; otherwise, just preserve them. When
8489 @var{keep-mtime?} is true, keep the modification time of the files in
8490 @var{source} on those of @var{destination}. Write verbose output to the
8491 @var{log} port.
8492 @end deffn
8493
8494 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} delete-file-recursively @var{dir} @
8495 [#:follow-mounts? #f]
8496 Delete @var{dir} recursively, like @command{rm -rf}, without following
8497 symlinks. Don't follow mount points either, unless @var{follow-mounts?}
8498 is true. Report but ignore errors.
8499 @end deffn
8500
8501 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} substitute* @var{file} @
8502 ((@var{regexp} @var{match-var}@dots{}) @var{body}@dots{}) @dots{}
8503 Substitute @var{regexp} in @var{file} by the string returned by
8504 @var{body}. @var{body} is evaluated with each @var{match-var} bound to
8505 the corresponding positional regexp sub-expression. For example:
8506
8507 @lisp
8508 (substitute* file
8509 (("hello")
8510 "good morning\n")
8511 (("foo([a-z]+)bar(.*)$" all letters end)
8512 (string-append "baz" letter end)))
8513 @end lisp
8514
8515 Here, anytime a line of @var{file} contains @code{hello}, it is replaced
8516 by @code{good morning}. Anytime a line of @var{file} matches the second
8517 regexp, @code{all} is bound to the complete match, @code{letters} is bound
8518 to the first sub-expression, and @code{end} is bound to the last one.
8519
8520 When one of the @var{match-var} is @code{_}, no variable is bound to the
8521 corresponding match substring.
8522
8523 Alternatively, @var{file} may be a list of file names, in which case
8524 they are all subject to the substitutions.
8525
8526 Be careful about using @code{$} to match the end of a line; by itself it
8527 won't match the terminating newline of a line.
8528 @end deffn
8529
8530 @subsection File Search
8531
8532 @cindex file, searching
8533 This section documents procedures to search and filter files.
8534
8535 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-name-predicate @var{regexp}
8536 Return a predicate that returns true when passed a file name whose base
8537 name matches @var{regexp}.
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} find-files @var{dir} [@var{pred}] @
8541 [#:stat lstat] [#:directories? #f] [#:fail-on-error? #f]
8542 Return the lexicographically sorted list of files under @var{dir} for
8543 which @var{pred} returns true. @var{pred} is passed two arguments: the
8544 absolute file name, and its stat buffer; the default predicate always
8545 returns true. @var{pred} can also be a regular expression, in which
8546 case it is equivalent to @code{(file-name-predicate @var{pred})}.
8547 @var{stat} is used to obtain file information; using @code{lstat} means
8548 that symlinks are not followed. If @var{directories?} is true, then
8549 directories will also be included. If @var{fail-on-error?} is true,
8550 raise an exception upon error.
8551 @end deffn
8552
8553 Here are a few examples where we assume that the current directory is
8554 the root of the Guix source tree:
8555
8556 @lisp
8557 ;; List all the regular files in the current directory.
8558 (find-files ".")
8559 @result{} ("./.dir-locals.el" "./.gitignore" @dots{})
8560
8561 ;; List all the .scm files under gnu/services.
8562 (find-files "gnu/services" "\\.scm$")
8563 @result{} ("gnu/services/admin.scm" "gnu/services/audio.scm" @dots{})
8564
8565 ;; List ar files in the current directory.
8566 (find-files "." (lambda (file stat) (ar-file? file)))
8567 @result{} ("./libformat.a" "./libstore.a" @dots{})
8568 @end lisp
8569
8570 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} which @var{program}
8571 Return the complete file name for @var{program} as found in
8572 @code{$PATH}, or @code{#f} if @var{program} could not be found.
8573 @end deffn
8574
8575 @subsection Build Phases
8576
8577 @cindex build phases
8578 The @code{(guix build utils)} also contains tools to manipulate build
8579 phases as used by build systems (@pxref{Build Systems}). Build phases
8580 are represented as association lists or ``alists'' (@pxref{Association
8581 Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where each key is a symbol
8582 naming the phase and the associated value is a procedure (@pxref{Build
8583 Phases}).
8584
8585 Guile core and the @code{(srfi srfi-1)} module both provide tools to
8586 manipulate alists. The @code{(guix build utils)} module complements
8587 those with tools written with build phases in mind.
8588
8589 @cindex build phases, modifying
8590 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-phases @var{phases} @var{clause}@dots{}
8591 Modify @var{phases} sequentially as per each @var{clause}, which may
8592 have one of the following forms:
8593
8594 @lisp
8595 (delete @var{old-phase-name})
8596 (replace @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8597 (add-before @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8598 (add-after @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8599 @end lisp
8600
8601 Where every @var{phase-name} above is an expression evaluating to a
8602 symbol, and @var{new-phase} an expression evaluating to a procedure.
8603 @end deffn
8604
8605 The example below is taken from the definition of the @code{grep}
8606 package. It adds a phase to run after the @code{install} phase, called
8607 @code{fix-egrep-and-fgrep}. That phase is a procedure (@code{lambda*}
8608 is for anonymous procedures) that takes a @code{#:outputs} keyword
8609 argument and ignores extra keyword arguments (@pxref{Optional
8610 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for more on
8611 @code{lambda*} and optional and keyword arguments.) The phase uses
8612 @code{substitute*} to modify the installed @file{egrep} and @file{fgrep}
8613 scripts so that they refer to @code{grep} by its absolute file name:
8614
8615 @lisp
8616 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8617 (add-after 'install 'fix-egrep-and-fgrep
8618 ;; Patch 'egrep' and 'fgrep' to execute 'grep' via its
8619 ;; absolute file name instead of searching for it in $PATH.
8620 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8621 (let* ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out"))
8622 (bin (string-append out "/bin")))
8623 (substitute* (list (string-append bin "/egrep")
8624 (string-append bin "/fgrep"))
8625 (("^exec grep")
8626 (string-append "exec " bin "/grep")))
8627 #t))))
8628 @end lisp
8629
8630 In the example below, phases are modified in two ways: the standard
8631 @code{configure} phase is deleted, presumably because the package does
8632 not have a @file{configure} script or anything similar, and the default
8633 @code{install} phase is replaced by one that manually copies the
8634 executable files to be installed:
8635
8636 @lisp
8637 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8638 (delete 'configure) ;no 'configure' script
8639 (replace 'install
8640 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8641 ;; The package's Makefile doesn't provide an "install"
8642 ;; rule so do it by ourselves.
8643 (let ((bin (string-append (assoc-ref outputs "out")
8644 "/bin")))
8645 (install-file "footswitch" bin)
8646 (install-file "scythe" bin)
8647 #t))))
8648 @end lisp
8649
8650 @c TODO: Add more examples.
8651
8652 @node The Store
8653 @section The Store
8654
8655 @cindex store
8656 @cindex store items
8657 @cindex store paths
8658
8659 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
8660 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
8661 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
8662 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
8663 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
8664 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
8665 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
8666 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
8667 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
8668
8669 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
8670 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
8671 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
8672 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
8673
8674 @quotation Note
8675 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
8676 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
8677 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
8678
8679 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
8680 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
8681 accidental modifications.
8682 @end quotation
8683
8684 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
8685 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
8686 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
8687 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
8688 @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
8689
8690 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
8691 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
8692 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
8693 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
8694 supported URI schemes are:
8695
8696 @table @code
8697 @item file
8698 @itemx unix
8699 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
8700 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
8701 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
8702
8703 @item guix
8704 @cindex daemon, remote access
8705 @cindex remote access to the daemon
8706 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
8707 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
8708 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
8709 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
8710 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
8711
8712 @example
8713 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
8714 @end example
8715
8716 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
8717 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
8718 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
8719
8720 The @option{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
8721 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
8722 @option{--listen}}).
8723
8724 @item ssh
8725 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
8726 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH@. This
8727 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
8728 @command{guile} binary in @env{PATH} on the destination machine. It
8729 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
8730 like this:
8731
8732 @example
8733 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
8734 @end example
8735
8736 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
8737 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
8738 @end table
8739
8740 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
8741
8742 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
8743 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
8744 @quotation Note
8745 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
8746 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
8747 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
8748 @end quotation
8749 @end defvr
8750
8751 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
8752 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
8753 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
8754 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
8755 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
8756
8757 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
8758 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
8759 @end deffn
8760
8761 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
8762 Close the connection to @var{server}.
8763 @end deffn
8764
8765 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
8766 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
8767 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
8768 @end defvr
8769
8770 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
8771 argument.
8772
8773 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
8774 @cindex invalid store items
8775 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
8776 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
8777 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
8778 build).
8779
8780 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
8781 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
8782 @end deffn
8783
8784 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
8785 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
8786 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
8787 resulting store path.
8788 @end deffn
8789
8790 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
8791 [@var{mode}]
8792 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
8793 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
8794 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
8795 @end deffn
8796
8797 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
8798 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
8799 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
8800 Store Monad}).
8801
8802 @c FIXME
8803 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
8804
8805 @node Derivations
8806 @section Derivations
8807
8808 @cindex derivations
8809 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
8810 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
8811 following pieces of information:
8812
8813 @itemize
8814 @item
8815 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
8816 directory in the store, but may produce more.
8817
8818 @item
8819 @cindex build-time dependencies
8820 @cindex dependencies, build-time
8821 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
8822 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
8823 etc.).
8824
8825 @item
8826 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
8827
8828 @item
8829 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
8830 to be passed.
8831
8832 @item
8833 A list of environment variables to be defined.
8834
8835 @end itemize
8836
8837 @cindex derivation path
8838 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
8839 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
8840 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
8841 name end in @file{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
8842 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
8843 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
8844 Store}).
8845
8846 @cindex fixed-output derivations
8847 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
8848 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
8849 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
8850 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
8851 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
8852 method and tools being used.
8853
8854 @cindex references
8855 @cindex run-time dependencies
8856 @cindex dependencies, run-time
8857 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
8858 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
8859 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
8860 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
8861 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
8862 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
8863
8864 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
8865 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
8866 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
8867 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
8868
8869 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
8870 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8871 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
8872 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
8873 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8874 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
8875 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
8876 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
8877 @code{<derivation>} object.
8878
8879 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
8880 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
8881 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
8882 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
8883 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
8884 containing this output.
8885
8886 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
8887 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
8888 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
8889 a simple text format.
8890
8891 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
8892 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
8893 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
8894 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
8895
8896 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
8897 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
8898 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
8899 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
8900 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
8901 derivations that download files.
8902
8903 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
8904 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
8905 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
8906 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
8907
8908 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
8909 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
8910 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
8911 host CPU instruction set.
8912
8913 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
8914 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
8915 @end deffn
8916
8917 @noindent
8918 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
8919 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
8920 to a Bash executable in the store:
8921
8922 @lisp
8923 (use-modules (guix utils)
8924 (guix store)
8925 (guix derivations))
8926
8927 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
8928 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
8929 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
8930 (derivation store "foo"
8931 bash `("-e" ,builder)
8932 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
8933 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
8934 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
8935 @end lisp
8936
8937 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
8938 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
8939 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
8940 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
8941 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
8942
8943 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
8944 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
8945 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
8946 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
8947
8948 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
8949 @var{name} @var{exp} @
8950 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
8951 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8952 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
8953 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
8954 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8955 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
8956 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
8957 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
8958 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
8959 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
8960 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
8961 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
8962 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
8963 gnu-build-system))}.
8964
8965 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
8966 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
8967 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
8968 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
8969 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
8970 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
8971 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
8972
8973 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
8974 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
8975 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
8976
8977 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
8978 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
8979 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
8980 @var{substitutable?}.
8981 @end deffn
8982
8983 @noindent
8984 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
8985 containing one file:
8986
8987 @lisp
8988 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
8989 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
8990 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
8991 (lambda (p)
8992 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
8993 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
8994
8995 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
8996 @end lisp
8997
8998
8999 @node The Store Monad
9000 @section The Store Monad
9001
9002 @cindex monad
9003
9004 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
9005 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
9006 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
9007 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
9008
9009 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
9010 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
9011 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
9012 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
9013 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
9014
9015 @cindex monadic values
9016 @cindex monadic functions
9017 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
9018 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
9019 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
9020 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
9021 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
9022 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
9023 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
9024 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
9025 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
9026
9027 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
9028
9029 @lisp
9030 (define (sh-symlink store)
9031 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
9032 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
9033 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
9034 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
9035 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
9036 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
9037 @end lisp
9038
9039 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
9040 as a monadic function:
9041
9042 @lisp
9043 (define (sh-symlink)
9044 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
9045 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
9046 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9047 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
9048 #$output))))
9049 @end lisp
9050
9051 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
9052 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
9053 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
9054 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
9055 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
9056
9057 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
9058 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
9059 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
9060
9061 @lisp
9062 (define (sh-symlink)
9063 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9064 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
9065 #$output)))
9066 @end lisp
9067
9068 @c See
9069 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
9070 @c for the funny quote.
9071 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
9072 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
9073 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
9074 @code{run-with-store}:
9075
9076 @lisp
9077 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
9078 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
9079 @end lisp
9080
9081 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
9082 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
9083 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
9084 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
9085
9086 @example
9087 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
9088 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9089 @end example
9090
9091 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
9092 automatically run through the store:
9093
9094 @example
9095 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
9096 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
9097 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9098 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
9099 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
9100 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
9101 scheme@@(guile-user)>
9102 @end example
9103
9104 @noindent
9105 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
9106 @code{store-monad} REPL.
9107
9108 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
9109 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
9110
9111 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
9112 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
9113 in @var{monad}.
9114 @end deffn
9115
9116 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
9117 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
9118 @end deffn
9119
9120 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
9121 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
9122 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
9123 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
9124 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
9125 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
9126 in this example:
9127
9128 @lisp
9129 (run-with-state
9130 (with-monad %state-monad
9131 (>>= (return 1)
9132 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
9133 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
9134 'some-state)
9135
9136 @result{} 4
9137 @result{} some-state
9138 @end lisp
9139 @end deffn
9140
9141 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9142 @var{body} ...
9143 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9144 @var{body} ...
9145 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
9146 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
9147 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
9148 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
9149 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
9150 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
9151 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
9152 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
9153 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
9154 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
9155
9156 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
9157 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9158 @end deffn
9159
9160 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
9161 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
9162 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
9163 sequence must be a monadic expression.
9164
9165 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
9166 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
9167 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
9168 @end deffn
9169
9170 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9171 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9172 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9173 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9174 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9175 @end deffn
9176
9177 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9178 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9179 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9180 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9181 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @cindex state monad
9185 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
9186 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
9187 monadic procedure calls.
9188
9189 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
9190 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
9191 the state that is threaded.
9192
9193 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
9194 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
9195 increments the current state value:
9196
9197 @lisp
9198 (define (square x)
9199 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
9200 (mbegin %state-monad
9201 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
9202 (return (* x x)))))
9203
9204 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
9205 @result{} (0 1 4)
9206 @result{} 3
9207 @end lisp
9208
9209 When ``run'' through @code{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
9210 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
9211 @end defvr
9212
9213 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
9214 Return the current state as a monadic value.
9215 @end deffn
9216
9217 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
9218 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
9219 monadic value.
9220 @end deffn
9221
9222 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
9223 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
9224 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
9225 @end deffn
9226
9227 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
9228 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
9229 The state is assumed to be a list.
9230 @end deffn
9231
9232 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
9233 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
9234 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
9235 @end deffn
9236
9237 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
9238 store)} module, is as follows.
9239
9240 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
9241 The store monad---an alias for @code{%state-monad}.
9242
9243 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
9244 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
9245 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below).
9246 @end defvr
9247
9248 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
9249 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
9250 open store connection.
9251 @end deffn
9252
9253 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
9254 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9255 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
9256 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9257 @end deffn
9258
9259 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
9260 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9261 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
9262 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9263 @end deffn
9264
9265 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9266 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
9267 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
9268 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
9269 @var{name} is omitted.
9270
9271 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
9272 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
9273 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
9274
9275 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9276 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9277 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9278 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9279
9280 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
9281
9282 @lisp
9283 (run-with-store (open-connection)
9284 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
9285 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
9286 (return (list a b))))
9287
9288 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
9289 @end lisp
9290
9291 @end deffn
9292
9293 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
9294 monadic procedures:
9295
9296 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
9297 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
9298 [#:output "out"]
9299 Return as a monadic
9300 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
9301 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
9302 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
9303 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
9304
9305 Note that this procedure does @emph{not} build @var{package}. Thus, the
9306 result might or might not designate an existing file. We recommend not
9307 using this procedure unless you know what you are doing.
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
9311 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
9312 @var{target} [@var{system}]
9313 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
9314 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9315 @end deffn
9316
9317
9318 @node G-Expressions
9319 @section G-Expressions
9320
9321 @cindex G-expression
9322 @cindex build code quoting
9323 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
9324 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
9325 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
9326 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
9327 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
9328
9329 @cindex code staging
9330 @cindex staging, of code
9331 @cindex strata of code
9332 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
9333 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
9334 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
9335 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
9336 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
9337 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
9338 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
9339 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
9340 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
9341 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
9342 @command{make}, and so on (@pxref{Build Phases}).
9343
9344 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
9345 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
9346 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
9347 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
9348 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
9349 expressions.
9350
9351 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
9352 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
9353 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
9354 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
9355 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
9356 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
9357 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
9358 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
9359
9360 @itemize
9361 @item
9362 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
9363 processes.
9364
9365 @item
9366 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
9367 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
9368 introduced.
9369
9370 @item
9371 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
9372 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
9373 processes that use them.
9374 @end itemize
9375
9376 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9377 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
9378 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
9379 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
9380 such that these objects can also be inserted
9381 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
9382 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
9383 add files to the store and to refer to them in
9384 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
9385 below).
9386
9387 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
9388
9389 @lisp
9390 (define build-exp
9391 #~(begin
9392 (mkdir #$output)
9393 (chdir #$output)
9394 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
9395 "list-files")))
9396 @end lisp
9397
9398 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
9399 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
9400 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
9401
9402 @lisp
9403 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
9404 @end lisp
9405
9406 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
9407 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
9408 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
9409 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
9410 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
9411 output of the derivation.
9412
9413 @cindex cross compilation
9414 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
9415 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
9416 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
9417 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
9418 native package build:
9419
9420 @lisp
9421 (gexp->derivation "vi"
9422 #~(begin
9423 (mkdir #$output)
9424 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
9425 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
9426 "-s"
9427 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
9428 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
9429 #:target "aarch64-linux-gnu")
9430 @end lisp
9431
9432 @noindent
9433 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
9434 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
9435 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
9436
9437 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
9438 @findex with-imported-modules
9439 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
9440 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
9441 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
9442 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
9443
9444 @lisp
9445 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
9446 #~(begin
9447 (use-modules (guix build utils))
9448 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
9449 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
9450 #~(begin
9451 #$build
9452 (display "success!\n")
9453 #t)))
9454 @end lisp
9455
9456 @noindent
9457 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
9458 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
9459 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
9460
9461 @cindex module closure
9462 @findex source-module-closure
9463 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
9464 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
9465 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
9466 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
9467 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
9468 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
9469
9470 @lisp
9471 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
9472
9473 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
9474 '((guix build utils)
9475 (gnu build vm)))
9476 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
9477 #~(begin
9478 (use-modules (guix build utils)
9479 (gnu build vm))
9480 @dots{})))
9481 @end lisp
9482
9483 @cindex extensions, for gexps
9484 @findex with-extensions
9485 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
9486 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
9487 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
9488 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
9489
9490 @lisp
9491 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
9492
9493 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
9494 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
9495 #~(begin
9496 (use-modules (json))
9497 @dots{})))
9498 @end lisp
9499
9500 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
9501
9502 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
9503 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
9504 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
9505 or more of the following forms:
9506
9507 @table @code
9508 @item #$@var{obj}
9509 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
9510 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
9511 supported types, for example a package or a
9512 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
9513 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
9514
9515 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
9516 objects are substituted similarly.
9517
9518 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
9519 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
9520
9521 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
9522
9523 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
9524 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
9525 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
9526 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
9527 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
9528
9529 @item #+@var{obj}
9530 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
9531 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
9532 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
9533 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
9534 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
9535
9536 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
9537 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
9538 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
9539 output when @var{output} is omitted.
9540
9541 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9542
9543 @item #$@@@var{lst}
9544 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
9545 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
9546 containing list.
9547
9548 @item #+@@@var{lst}
9549 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
9550 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
9551 @var{lst}.
9552
9553 @end table
9554
9555 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
9556 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below).
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
9560 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
9561 in their execution environment.
9562
9563 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
9564 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
9565 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
9566
9567 @lisp
9568 `((guix build utils)
9569 (guix gcrypt)
9570 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
9571 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
9572 @end lisp
9573
9574 @noindent
9575 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
9576 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
9577
9578 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
9579 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
9580 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
9581 @end deffn
9582
9583 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
9584 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
9585 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
9586 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
9587 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
9588
9589 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
9590 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
9591 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
9592 @var{body}@dots{}.
9593 @end deffn
9594
9595 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
9596 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
9597 @end deffn
9598
9599 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
9600 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
9601 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
9602 information about monads).
9603
9604 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
9605 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
9606 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9607 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
9608 [#:module-path @code{%load-path}] @
9609 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
9610 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
9611 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9612 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
9613 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
9614 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
9615 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
9616 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
9617 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
9618 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
9619 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
9620 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
9621 to by @var{exp}.
9622
9623 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
9624 Its meaning is to
9625 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
9626 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
9627 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
9628 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
9629 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
9630
9631 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
9632 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
9633
9634 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
9635 applicable.
9636
9637 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
9638 following forms:
9639
9640 @example
9641 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
9642 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
9643 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
9644 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
9645 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
9646 @end example
9647
9648 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
9649 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
9650 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
9651 text format.
9652
9653 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
9654 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
9655 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
9656 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
9657 referenced by the outputs.
9658
9659 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
9660 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
9661
9662 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
9663 @end deffn
9664
9665 @cindex file-like objects
9666 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
9667 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
9668 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
9669 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
9670
9671 @lisp
9672 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
9673 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
9674 @end lisp
9675
9676 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
9677 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
9678 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
9679 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
9680 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
9681 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
9682 content is directly passed as a string.
9683
9684 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9685 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
9686 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
9687 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
9688 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
9689 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
9690 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
9691 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
9692 base name of @var{file}.
9693
9694 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
9695 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
9696 permission bits are kept.
9697
9698 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9699 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9700 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9701 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9702
9703 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
9704 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
9705 @end deffn
9706
9707 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
9708 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
9709 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
9710
9711 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
9712 @end deffn
9713
9714 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
9715 [#:local-build? #t]
9716 [#:options '()]
9717 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
9718 directory computed by @var{gexp}. When @var{local-build?} is true (the
9719 default), the derivation is built locally. @var{options} is a list of
9720 additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9721
9722 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
9723 @end deffn
9724
9725 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
9726 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9727 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
9728 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
9729 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
9730 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
9731
9732 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
9733 command:
9734
9735 @lisp
9736 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
9737
9738 (gexp->script "list-files"
9739 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
9740 "ls"))
9741 @end lisp
9742
9743 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
9744 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
9745 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
9746
9747 @example
9748 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
9749 !#
9750 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
9751 @end example
9752 @end deffn
9753
9754 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9755 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
9756 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
9757 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
9758 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
9759
9760 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
9761 @end deffn
9762
9763 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9764 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9765 [#:splice? #f] @
9766 [#:guile (default-guile)]
9767 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
9768 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
9769 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
9770
9771 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
9772 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
9773 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
9774 @var{module-path}.
9775
9776 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
9777 or a subset thereof.
9778 @end deffn
9779
9780 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9781 [#:splice? #f] [#:set-load-path? #t]
9782 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
9783 @var{exp}.
9784
9785 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
9786 @end deffn
9787
9788 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9789 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
9790 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
9791 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
9792 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
9793 references to all these.
9794
9795 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
9796 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
9797 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
9798 like this:
9799
9800 @lisp
9801 (define (profile.sh)
9802 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
9803 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
9804 (text-file* "profile.sh"
9805 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
9806 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
9807 @end lisp
9808
9809 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
9810 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
9811 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
9812 @end deffn
9813
9814 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9815 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
9816 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
9817 as in:
9818
9819 @lisp
9820 (mixed-text-file "profile"
9821 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
9822 @end lisp
9823
9824 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
9825 @end deffn
9826
9827 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
9828 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
9829 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
9830 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
9831 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
9832
9833 @lisp
9834 (file-union "etc"
9835 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
9836 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
9837 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
9838 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
9839 @end lisp
9840
9841 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
9842 @end deffn
9843
9844 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
9845 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
9846 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
9847
9848 @lisp
9849 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
9850 @end lisp
9851
9852 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
9853 @end deffn
9854
9855 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
9856 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
9857 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
9858 @var{suffix} is a string.
9859
9860 As an example, consider this gexp:
9861
9862 @lisp
9863 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9864 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
9865 "/bin/uname")))
9866 @end lisp
9867
9868 The same effect could be achieved with:
9869
9870 @lisp
9871 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9872 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
9873 "/bin/uname")))
9874 @end lisp
9875
9876 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
9877 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
9878 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
9879 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
9880 @end deffn
9881
9882 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} let-system @var{system} @var{body}@dots{}
9883 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} let-system (@var{system} @var{target}) @var{body}@dots{}
9884 Bind @var{system} to the currently targeted system---e.g.,
9885 @code{"x86_64-linux"}---within @var{body}.
9886
9887 In the second case, additionally bind @var{target} to the current
9888 cross-compilation target---a GNU triplet such as
9889 @code{"arm-linux-gnueabihf"}---or @code{#f} if we are not
9890 cross-compiling.
9891
9892 @code{let-system} is useful in the occasional case where the object
9893 spliced into the gexp depends on the target system, as in this example:
9894
9895 @lisp
9896 #~(system*
9897 #+(let-system system
9898 (cond ((string-prefix? "armhf-" system)
9899 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-arm"))
9900 ((string-prefix? "x86_64-" system)
9901 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-x86_64"))
9902 (else
9903 (error "dunno!"))))
9904 "-net" "user" #$image)
9905 @end lisp
9906 @end deffn
9907
9908 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
9909 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
9910 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
9911 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
9912 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
9913 derivation or store item.
9914
9915 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
9916 for a given object:
9917
9918 @lisp
9919 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
9920 coreutils)
9921 @end lisp
9922
9923 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
9924 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
9925 @end deffn
9926
9927
9928 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
9929 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
9930 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
9931 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
9932
9933 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9934 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
9935 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
9936 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
9937 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
9938
9939 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
9940 [#:target #f]
9941 Return as a value in @code{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
9942 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
9943 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
9944 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
9945 @end deffn
9946
9947 @node Invoking guix repl
9948 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
9949
9950 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop, script
9951 The @command{guix repl} command makes it easier to program Guix in Guile
9952 by launching a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop} (REPL) for interactive
9953 programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
9954 GNU Guile Reference Manual}), or by running Guile scripts
9955 (@pxref{Running Guile Scripts,,, guile,
9956 GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9957 Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
9958 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
9959 dependencies are available in the search path.
9960
9961 The general syntax is:
9962
9963 @example
9964 guix repl @var{options} [@var{file} @var{args}]
9965 @end example
9966
9967 When a @var{file} argument is provided, @var{file} is
9968 executed as a Guile scripts:
9969
9970 @example
9971 guix repl my-script.scm
9972 @end example
9973
9974 To pass arguments to the script, use @code{--} to prevent them from
9975 being interpreted as arguments to @command{guix repl} itself:
9976
9977 @example
9978 guix repl -- my-script.scm --input=foo.txt
9979 @end example
9980
9981 To make a script executable directly from the shell, using the guix
9982 executable that is on the user's search path, add the following two
9983 lines at the top of the script:
9984
9985 @example
9986 @code{#!/usr/bin/env -S guix repl --}
9987 @code{!#}
9988 @end example
9989
9990 Without a file name argument, a Guile REPL is started:
9991
9992 @example
9993 $ guix repl
9994 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
9995 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
9996 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
9997 @end example
9998
9999 @cindex inferiors
10000 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
10001 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
10002 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
10003 of Guix.
10004
10005 The available options are as follows:
10006
10007 @table @code
10008 @item --type=@var{type}
10009 @itemx -t @var{type}
10010 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
10011
10012 @table @code
10013 @item guile
10014 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
10015 @item machine
10016 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
10017 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
10018 @end table
10019
10020 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
10021 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
10022 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
10023 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
10024
10025 @table @code
10026 @item --listen=tcp:37146
10027 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
10028
10029 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
10030 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
10031 @end table
10032
10033 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10034 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10035 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10036 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10037
10038 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10039 the script or REPL.
10040
10041 @item -q
10042 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
10043 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
10044 @end table
10045
10046 @c *********************************************************************
10047 @node Utilities
10048 @chapter Utilities
10049
10050 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
10051 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
10052 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
10053 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
10054
10055 @menu
10056 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
10057 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
10058 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
10059 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
10060 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
10061 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
10062 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
10063 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
10064 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
10065 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
10066 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
10067 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
10068 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
10069 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
10070 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
10071 @end menu
10072
10073 @node Invoking guix build
10074 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
10075
10076 @cindex package building
10077 @cindex @command{guix build}
10078 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
10079 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
10080 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
10081 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
10082 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
10083
10084 The general syntax is:
10085
10086 @example
10087 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
10088 @end example
10089
10090 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
10091 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
10092 resulting directories:
10093
10094 @example
10095 guix build emacs guile
10096 @end example
10097
10098 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
10099
10100 @example
10101 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
10102 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
10103 @end example
10104
10105 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
10106 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
10107 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
10108 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
10109 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
10110 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10111
10112 Alternatively, the @option{--expression} option may be used to specify a
10113 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
10114 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
10115 needed.
10116
10117 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
10118 described in the subsections below.
10119
10120 @menu
10121 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
10122 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
10123 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
10124 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
10125 @end menu
10126
10127 @node Common Build Options
10128 @subsection Common Build Options
10129
10130 A number of options that control the build process are common to
10131 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
10132 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
10133 following:
10134
10135 @table @code
10136
10137 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10138 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10139 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10140 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10141
10142 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10143 the command-line tools.
10144
10145 @item --keep-failed
10146 @itemx -K
10147 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
10148 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
10149 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
10150 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
10151 build issues.
10152
10153 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
10154 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
10155 Store, the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
10156
10157 @item --keep-going
10158 @itemx -k
10159 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
10160 all the builds have either completed or failed.
10161
10162 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
10163 derivations has failed.
10164
10165 @item --dry-run
10166 @itemx -n
10167 Do not build the derivations.
10168
10169 @anchor{fallback-option}
10170 @item --fallback
10171 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
10172 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
10173
10174 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10175 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
10176 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10177 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
10178 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
10179
10180 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
10181 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
10182 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10183
10184 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
10185 disabled.
10186
10187 @item --no-substitutes
10188 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
10189 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
10190 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10191
10192 @item --no-grafts
10193 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
10194 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10195 information on grafts.
10196
10197 @item --rounds=@var{n}
10198 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
10199 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
10200
10201 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
10202 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
10203 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
10204 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
10205
10206 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10207 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10208 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10209
10210 @item --no-offload
10211 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10212 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
10213 builds to remote machines.
10214
10215 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
10216 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
10217 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10218
10219 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10220 guix-daemon, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
10221
10222 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
10223 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
10224 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10225
10226 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10227 guix-daemon, @option{--timeout}}).
10228
10229 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
10230 @c most programs honor it.
10231 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
10232 @cindex build logs, verbosity
10233 @item -v @var{level}
10234 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
10235 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
10236 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
10237 output on standard error.
10238
10239 @item --cores=@var{n}
10240 @itemx -c @var{n}
10241 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
10242 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
10243
10244 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
10245 @itemx -M @var{n}
10246 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
10247 guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
10248 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
10249
10250 @item --debug=@var{level}
10251 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
10252 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
10253 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
10254
10255 @end table
10256
10257 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
10258 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
10259 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
10260 derivations)} module.
10261
10262 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
10263 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
10264 building honor the @env{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
10265
10266 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
10267 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
10268 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
10269 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
10270 below:
10271
10272 @example
10273 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
10274 @end example
10275
10276 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
10277 the parsed command-line options.
10278 @end defvr
10279
10280
10281 @node Package Transformation Options
10282 @subsection Package Transformation Options
10283
10284 @cindex package variants
10285 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
10286 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
10287 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
10288 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
10289 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
10290 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
10291 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10292
10293 Package transformation options are preserved across upgrades:
10294 @command{guix upgrade} attempts to apply transformation options
10295 initially used when creating the profile to the upgraded packages.
10296
10297 The available options are listed below. Most commands support them and
10298 also support a @option{--help-transform} option that lists all the
10299 available options and a synopsis (these options are not shown in the
10300 @option{--help} output for brevity).
10301
10302 @table @code
10303
10304 @item --with-source=@var{source}
10305 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
10306 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
10307 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
10308 its version number.
10309 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
10310 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
10311
10312 When @var{package} is omitted,
10313 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
10314 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
10315 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
10316 package is @code{guile}.
10317
10318 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
10319 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
10320
10321 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
10322 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
10323 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
10324 the @code{ed} package:
10325
10326 @example
10327 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
10328 @end example
10329
10330 As a developer, @option{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
10331 candidates:
10332
10333 @example
10334 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
10335 @end example
10336
10337 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
10338
10339 @example
10340 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
10341 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
10342 @end example
10343
10344 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10345 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
10346 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
10347 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
10348 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
10349
10350 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
10351 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
10352 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
10353
10354 @example
10355 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
10356 @end example
10357
10358 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
10359 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
10360 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
10361
10362 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
10363 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
10364
10365 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10366 This is similar to @option{--with-input} but with an important difference:
10367 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
10368 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
10369 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10370 information on grafts.
10371
10372 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
10373 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
10374 they currently refer to:
10375
10376 @example
10377 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
10378 @end example
10379
10380 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
10381 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
10382 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
10383 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
10384 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
10385 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
10386 care!
10387
10388 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
10389 @item --with-debug-info=@var{package}
10390 Build @var{package} in a way that preserves its debugging info and graft
10391 it onto packages that depend on it. This is useful if @var{package}
10392 does not already provide debugging info as a @code{debug} output
10393 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
10394
10395 For example, suppose you're experiencing a crash in Inkscape and would
10396 like to see what's up in GLib, a library deep down in Inkscape's
10397 dependency graph. GLib lacks a @code{debug} output, so debugging is
10398 tough. Fortunately, you rebuild GLib with debugging info and tack it on
10399 Inkscape:
10400
10401 @example
10402 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
10403 @end example
10404
10405 Only GLib needs to be recompiled so this takes a reasonable amount of
10406 time. @xref{Installing Debugging Files}, for more info.
10407
10408 @quotation Note
10409 Under the hood, this option works by passing the @samp{#:strip-binaries?
10410 #f} to the build system of the package of interest (@pxref{Build
10411 Systems}). Most build systems support that option but some do not. In
10412 that case, an error is raised.
10413
10414 Likewise, if a C/C++ package is built without @code{-g} (which is rarely
10415 the case), debugging info will remain unavailable even when
10416 @code{#:strip-binaries?} is false.
10417 @end quotation
10418
10419 @cindex tool chain, changing the build tool chain of a package
10420 @item --with-c-toolchain=@var{package}=@var{toolchain}
10421 This option changes the compilation of @var{package} and everything that
10422 depends on it so that they get built with @var{toolchain} instead of the
10423 default GNU tool chain for C/C++.
10424
10425 Consider this example:
10426
10427 @example
10428 guix build octave-cli \
10429 --with-c-toolchain=fftw=gcc-toolchain@@10 \
10430 --with-c-toolchain=fftwf=gcc-toolchain@@10
10431 @end example
10432
10433 The command above builds a variant of the @code{fftw} and @code{fftwf}
10434 packages using version 10 of @code{gcc-toolchain} instead of the default
10435 tool chain, and then builds a variant of the GNU@tie{}Octave
10436 command-line interface using them. GNU@tie{}Octave itself is also built
10437 with @code{gcc-toolchain@@10}.
10438
10439 This other example builds the Hardware Locality (@code{hwloc}) library
10440 and its dependents up to @code{intel-mpi-benchmarks} with the Clang C
10441 compiler:
10442
10443 @example
10444 guix build --with-c-toolchain=hwloc=clang-toolchain \
10445 intel-mpi-benchmarks
10446 @end example
10447
10448 @quotation Note
10449 There can be application binary interface (ABI) incompatibilities among
10450 tool chains. This is particularly true of the C++ standard library and
10451 run-time support libraries such as that of OpenMP@. By rebuilding all
10452 dependents with the same tool chain, @option{--with-c-toolchain} minimizes
10453 the risks of incompatibility but cannot entirely eliminate them. Choose
10454 @var{package} wisely.
10455 @end quotation
10456
10457 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
10458 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
10459 @cindex latest commit, building
10460 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
10461 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
10462 recursively.
10463
10464 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
10465 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
10466
10467 @example
10468 guix build python-numpy \
10469 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
10470 @end example
10471
10472 This option can also be combined with @option{--with-branch} or
10473 @option{--with-commit} (see below).
10474
10475 @cindex continuous integration
10476 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
10477 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
10478 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
10479 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
10480 integration (CI).
10481
10482 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
10483 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
10484 in a while to save disk space.
10485
10486 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
10487 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
10488 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
10489 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
10490 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
10491 @option{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
10492
10493 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
10494 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
10495 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
10496 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
10497
10498 @example
10499 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
10500 @end example
10501
10502 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
10503 This is similar to @option{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
10504 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
10505 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
10506
10507 @item --with-patch=@var{package}=@var{file}
10508 Add @var{file} to the list of patches applied to @var{package}, where
10509 @var{package} is a spec such as @code{python@@3.8} or @code{glibc}.
10510 @var{file} must contain a patch; it is applied with the flags specified
10511 in the @code{origin} of @var{package} (@pxref{origin Reference}), which
10512 by default includes @code{-p1} (@pxref{patch Directories,,, diffutils,
10513 Comparing and Merging Files}).
10514
10515 As an example, the command below rebuilds Coreutils with the GNU C
10516 Library (glibc) patched with the given patch:
10517
10518 @example
10519 guix build coreutils --with-patch=glibc=./glibc-frob.patch
10520 @end example
10521
10522 In this example, glibc itself as well as everything that leads to
10523 Coreutils in the dependency graph is rebuilt.
10524
10525 @cindex upstream, latest version
10526 @item --with-latest=@var{package}
10527 So you like living on the bleeding edge? This option is for you! It
10528 replaces occurrences of @var{package} in the dependency graph with its
10529 latest upstream version, as reported by @command{guix refresh}
10530 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
10531
10532 It does so by determining the latest upstream release of @var{package}
10533 (if possible), downloading it, and authenticating it @emph{if} it comes
10534 with an OpenPGP signature.
10535
10536 As an example, the command below builds Guix against the latest version
10537 of Guile-JSON:
10538
10539 @example
10540 guix build guix --with-latest=guile-json
10541 @end example
10542
10543 There are limitations. First, in cases where the tool cannot or does
10544 not know how to authenticate source code, you are at risk of running
10545 malicious code; a warning is emitted in this case. Second, this option
10546 simply changes the source used in the existing package definitions,
10547 which is not always sufficient: there might be additional dependencies
10548 that need to be added, patches to apply, and more generally the quality
10549 assurance work that Guix developers normally do will be missing.
10550
10551 You've been warned! In all the other cases, it's a snappy way to stay
10552 on top. We encourage you to submit patches updating the actual package
10553 definitions once you have successfully tested an upgrade
10554 (@pxref{Contributing}).
10555
10556 @cindex test suite, skipping
10557 @item --without-tests=@var{package}
10558 Build @var{package} without running its tests. This can be useful in
10559 situations where you want to skip the lengthy test suite of a
10560 intermediate package, or if a package's test suite fails in a
10561 non-deterministic fashion. It should be used with care because running
10562 the test suite is a good way to ensure a package is working as intended.
10563
10564 Turning off tests leads to a different store item. Consequently, when
10565 using this option, anything that depends on @var{package} must be
10566 rebuilt, as in this example:
10567
10568 @example
10569 guix install --without-tests=python python-notebook
10570 @end example
10571
10572 The command above installs @code{python-notebook} on top of
10573 @code{python} built without running its test suite. To do so, it also
10574 rebuilds everything that depends on @code{python}, including
10575 @code{python-notebook} itself.
10576
10577 Internally, @option{--without-tests} relies on changing the
10578 @code{#:tests?} option of a package's @code{check} phase (@pxref{Build
10579 Systems}). Note that some packages use a customized @code{check} phase
10580 that does not respect a @code{#:tests? #f} setting. Therefore,
10581 @option{--without-tests} has no effect on these packages.
10582
10583 @end table
10584
10585 Wondering how to achieve the same effect using Scheme code, for example
10586 in your manifest, or how to write your own package transformation?
10587 @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for an overview of the programming
10588 interfaces available.
10589
10590 @node Additional Build Options
10591 @subsection Additional Build Options
10592
10593 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
10594 build}.
10595
10596 @table @code
10597
10598 @item --quiet
10599 @itemx -q
10600 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
10601 @option{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
10602 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
10603
10604 @item --file=@var{file}
10605 @itemx -f @var{file}
10606 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
10607 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
10608
10609 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
10610 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
10611
10612 @lisp
10613 @include package-hello.scm
10614 @end lisp
10615
10616 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
10617 package definitions. Running @code{guix build -f} on @file{hello.json}
10618 with the following contents would result in building the packages
10619 @code{myhello} and @code{greeter}:
10620
10621 @example
10622 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
10623 @end example
10624
10625 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
10626 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
10627 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
10628 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
10629
10630 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10631 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10632 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
10633
10634 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
10635 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
10636 version 1.8 of Guile.
10637
10638 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
10639 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
10640 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10641
10642 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
10643 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
10644 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
10645
10646 @item --source
10647 @itemx -S
10648 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
10649 themselves.
10650
10651 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
10652 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
10653 source tarball.
10654
10655 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
10656 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
10657 Packages}).
10658
10659 @cindex source, verification
10660 As with other derivations, the result of building a source derivation
10661 can be verified using the @option{--check} option (@pxref{build-check}).
10662 This is useful to validate that a (potentially already built or
10663 substituted, thus cached) package source matches against its declared
10664 hash.
10665
10666 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
10667 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
10668 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
10669 the packages.
10670
10671 @item --sources
10672 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
10673 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
10674 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
10675 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
10676 of the @option{--source} option and can accept one of the following
10677 optional argument values:
10678
10679 @table @code
10680 @item package
10681 This value causes the @option{--sources} option to behave in the same way
10682 as the @option{--source} option.
10683
10684 @item all
10685 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
10686 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
10687
10688 @example
10689 $ guix build --sources tzdata
10690 The following derivations will be built:
10691 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
10692 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10693 @end example
10694
10695 @item transitive
10696 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
10697 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
10698 prefetch package source for later offline building.
10699
10700 @example
10701 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
10702 The following derivations will be built:
10703 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10704 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
10705 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
10706 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
10707 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
10708 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
10709 @dots{}
10710 @end example
10711
10712 @end table
10713
10714 @item --system=@var{system}
10715 @itemx -s @var{system}
10716 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
10717 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
10718 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
10719 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
10720
10721 @quotation Note
10722 The @option{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
10723 be confused with cross-compilation. See @option{--target} below for
10724 information on cross-compilation.
10725 @end quotation
10726
10727 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
10728 different personalities. For instance, passing
10729 @option{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
10730 @option{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows
10731 you to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
10732
10733 @quotation Note
10734 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
10735 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
10736 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
10737 @end quotation
10738
10739 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
10740 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
10741 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
10742 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
10743
10744 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
10745 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
10746 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
10747
10748 @item --target=@var{triplet}
10749 @cindex cross-compilation
10750 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
10751 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
10752 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
10753
10754 @anchor{build-check}
10755 @item --check
10756 @cindex determinism, checking
10757 @cindex reproducibility, checking
10758 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
10759 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
10760 identical.
10761
10762 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
10763 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
10764 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
10765 background information and tools.
10766
10767 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10768 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10769 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10770
10771 @item --repair
10772 @cindex repairing store items
10773 @cindex corruption, recovering from
10774 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
10775 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
10776
10777 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
10778
10779 @item --derivations
10780 @itemx -d
10781 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
10782 packages.
10783
10784 @item --root=@var{file}
10785 @itemx -r @var{file}
10786 @cindex GC roots, adding
10787 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
10788 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
10789 collector root.
10790
10791 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
10792 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
10793 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
10794 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
10795 more on GC roots.
10796
10797 @item --log-file
10798 @cindex build logs, access
10799 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
10800 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
10801 missing.
10802
10803 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
10804 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
10805
10806 @example
10807 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
10808 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
10809 guix build --log-file guile
10810 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
10811 @end example
10812
10813 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @option{--no-substitutes} is
10814 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
10815 substitute servers (as specified with @option{--substitute-urls}).
10816
10817 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
10818 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
10819
10820 @example
10821 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s aarch64-linux
10822 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
10823 @end example
10824
10825 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
10826 @end table
10827
10828 @node Debugging Build Failures
10829 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
10830
10831 @cindex build failures, debugging
10832 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
10833 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
10834 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
10835 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
10836 build daemon uses.
10837
10838 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
10839 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
10840 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
10841 @env{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--keep-failed}}).
10842
10843 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
10844 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
10845 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
10846 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
10847 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
10848
10849 @example
10850 $ guix build foo -K
10851 @dots{} @i{build fails}
10852 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10853 $ source ./environment-variables
10854 $ cd foo-1.2
10855 @end example
10856
10857 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
10858 troubleshoot your build process.
10859
10860 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
10861 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
10862 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
10863 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
10864 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
10865
10866 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
10867 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
10868
10869 @example
10870 $ guix build -K foo
10871 @dots{}
10872 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10873 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
10874 [env]# source ./environment-variables
10875 [env]# cd foo-1.2
10876 @end example
10877
10878 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
10879 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
10880 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
10881 the container, which you may find handy while debugging. The
10882 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
10883 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
10884 info on grafts).
10885
10886 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
10887 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
10888
10889 @example
10890 [env]# rm /bin/sh
10891 @end example
10892
10893 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
10894 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
10895
10896 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
10897 can run:
10898
10899 @example
10900 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
10901 @end example
10902
10903 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
10904 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
10905 similar to the one the daemon uses.
10906
10907
10908 @node Invoking guix edit
10909 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
10910
10911 @cindex @command{guix edit}
10912 @cindex package definition, editing
10913 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
10914 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
10915 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
10916 For instance:
10917
10918 @example
10919 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
10920 @end example
10921
10922 @noindent
10923 launches the program specified in the @env{VISUAL} or in the
10924 @env{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
10925 and that of Vim.
10926
10927 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
10928 have created your own packages on @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
10929 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
10930 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
10931 for packages currently in the store.
10932
10933 Instead of @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
10934 @option{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @option{-L
10935 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
10936 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
10937
10938 @node Invoking guix download
10939 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
10940
10941 @cindex @command{guix download}
10942 @cindex downloading package sources
10943 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
10944 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
10945 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
10946 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
10947 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
10948 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
10949
10950 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
10951 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
10952 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
10953 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
10954 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
10955 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10956
10957 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
10958 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
10959 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
10960 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
10961 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
10962 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
10963 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
10964
10965 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
10966 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
10967 the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
10968 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
10969
10970 The following options are available:
10971
10972 @table @code
10973 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10974 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10975 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}. @xref{Invoking guix
10976 hash}, for more information.
10977
10978 @item --format=@var{fmt}
10979 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
10980 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
10981 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
10982
10983 @item --no-check-certificate
10984 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
10985
10986 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
10987 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
10988 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
10989
10990 @item --output=@var{file}
10991 @itemx -o @var{file}
10992 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
10993 store.
10994 @end table
10995
10996 @node Invoking guix hash
10997 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
10998
10999 @cindex @command{guix hash}
11000 The @command{guix hash} command computes the hash of a file.
11001 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
11002 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
11003 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11004
11005 The general syntax is:
11006
11007 @example
11008 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
11009 @end example
11010
11011 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
11012 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
11013 following options:
11014
11015 @table @code
11016
11017 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
11018 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
11019 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}, @code{sha256} by
11020 default.
11021
11022 @var{algorithm} must the name of a cryptographic hash algorithm
11023 supported by Libgcrypt @i{via} Guile-Gcrypt---e.g., @code{sha512} or
11024 @code{sha3-256} (@pxref{Hash Functions,,, guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt
11025 Reference Manual}).
11026
11027 @item --format=@var{fmt}
11028 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
11029 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
11030
11031 Supported formats: @code{base64}, @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
11032 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
11033
11034 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
11035 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
11036 in the definitions of packages.
11037
11038 @item --recursive
11039 @itemx -r
11040 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
11041
11042 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
11043 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
11044 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
11045 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
11046 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
11047 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
11048 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
11049 @c it exists.
11050
11051 @item --exclude-vcs
11052 @itemx -x
11053 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
11054 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.).
11055
11056 @vindex git-fetch
11057 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
11058 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
11059 Reference}):
11060
11061 @example
11062 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
11063 $ cd foo
11064 $ guix hash -rx .
11065 @end example
11066 @end table
11067
11068 @node Invoking guix import
11069 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
11070
11071 @cindex importing packages
11072 @cindex package import
11073 @cindex package conversion
11074 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
11075 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
11076 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
11077 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
11078 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
11079 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
11080 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11081
11082 The general syntax is:
11083
11084 @example
11085 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
11086 @end example
11087
11088 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
11089 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
11090 options specific to @var{importer}.
11091
11092 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
11093 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
11094 gnupg} if needed.
11095
11096 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
11097
11098 @table @code
11099 @item gnu
11100 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
11101 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
11102 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
11103
11104 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
11105 license needs to be figured out manually.
11106
11107 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
11108 GNU@tie{}Hello:
11109
11110 @example
11111 guix import gnu hello
11112 @end example
11113
11114 Specific command-line options are:
11115
11116 @table @code
11117 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11118 As for @command{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing
11119 OpenPGP keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
11120 refresh, @option{--key-download}}.
11121 @end table
11122
11123 @item pypi
11124 @cindex pypi
11125 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
11126 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
11127 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
11128 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
11129 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
11130 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
11131
11132 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
11133 package:
11134
11135 @example
11136 guix import pypi itsdangerous
11137 @end example
11138
11139 @table @code
11140 @item --recursive
11141 @itemx -r
11142 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11143 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11144 in Guix.
11145 @end table
11146
11147 @item gem
11148 @cindex gem
11149 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
11150 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
11151 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
11152 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
11153 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
11154 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
11155 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
11156 as an exercise to the packager.
11157
11158 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
11159
11160 @example
11161 guix import gem rails
11162 @end example
11163
11164 @table @code
11165 @item --recursive
11166 @itemx -r
11167 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11168 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11169 in Guix.
11170 @end table
11171
11172 @item cpan
11173 @cindex CPAN
11174 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
11175 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
11176 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
11177 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
11178 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
11179 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
11180 list of dependencies.
11181
11182 The command command below imports metadata for the Acme::Boolean Perl
11183 module:
11184
11185 @example
11186 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
11187 @end example
11188
11189 @item cran
11190 @cindex CRAN
11191 @cindex Bioconductor
11192 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
11193 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
11194 statistical and graphical environment}.
11195
11196 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
11197
11198 The command command below imports metadata for the Cairo R package:
11199
11200 @example
11201 guix import cran Cairo
11202 @end example
11203
11204 When @option{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
11205 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
11206 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
11207
11208 When @option{--style=specification} is added, the importer will generate
11209 package definitions whose inputs are package specifications instead of
11210 references to package variables. This is useful when generated package
11211 definitions are to be appended to existing user modules, as the list of
11212 used package modules need not be changed. The default is
11213 @option{--style=variable}.
11214
11215 When @option{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
11216 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
11217 packages for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
11218 genomic data in bioinformatics.
11219
11220 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
11221 package archive.
11222
11223 The command below imports metadata for the GenomicRanges R package:
11224
11225 @example
11226 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
11227 @end example
11228
11229 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
11230 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
11231 @option{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
11232
11233 @example
11234 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
11235 @end example
11236
11237 @item texlive
11238 @cindex TeX Live
11239 @cindex CTAN
11240 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
11241 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
11242 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
11243
11244 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
11245 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
11246 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
11247 versioned archives.
11248
11249 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
11250 TeX package:
11251
11252 @example
11253 guix import texlive fontspec
11254 @end example
11255
11256 When @option{--archive=@var{directory}} is added, the source code is
11257 downloaded not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the
11258 @file{texmf-dist/source} tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from
11259 the specified sibling @var{directory} under the same root.
11260
11261 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
11262 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
11263 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
11264
11265 @example
11266 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
11267 @end example
11268
11269 @item json
11270 @cindex JSON, import
11271 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
11272 example package definition in JSON format:
11273
11274 @example
11275 @{
11276 "name": "hello",
11277 "version": "2.10",
11278 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11279 "build-system": "gnu",
11280 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
11281 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
11282 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
11283 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
11284 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
11285 @}
11286 @end example
11287
11288 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
11289 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
11290 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
11291 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
11292
11293 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
11294 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
11295
11296 @example
11297 @{
11298 @dots{}
11299 "source": @{
11300 "method": "url-fetch",
11301 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11302 "sha256": @{
11303 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
11304 @}
11305 @}
11306 @dots{}
11307 @}
11308 @end example
11309
11310 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
11311 and outputs a package expression:
11312
11313 @example
11314 guix import json hello.json
11315 @end example
11316
11317 @item nix
11318 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
11319 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
11320 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
11321 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
11322 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
11323 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
11324 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
11325 package definition.
11326
11327 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
11328 by their canonical upstream variant.
11329
11330 Usually, you will first need to do:
11331
11332 @example
11333 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
11334 @end example
11335
11336 @noindent
11337 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
11338
11339 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
11340 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
11341 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
11342
11343 @example
11344 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
11345 @end example
11346
11347 @item hackage
11348 @cindex hackage
11349 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
11350 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
11351 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
11352 dependencies.
11353
11354 Specific command-line options are:
11355
11356 @table @code
11357 @item --stdin
11358 @itemx -s
11359 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
11360 @item --no-test-dependencies
11361 @itemx -t
11362 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11363 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
11364 @itemx -e @var{alist}
11365 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
11366 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
11367 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
11368 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
11369 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
11370 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
11371 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
11372 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
11373 @item --recursive
11374 @itemx -r
11375 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11376 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11377 in Guix.
11378 @end table
11379
11380 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
11381 HTTP Haskell package without including test dependencies and
11382 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
11383
11384 @example
11385 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
11386 @end example
11387
11388 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
11389 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
11390
11391 @example
11392 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
11393 @end example
11394
11395 @item stackage
11396 @cindex stackage
11397 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
11398 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
11399 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
11400 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
11401 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
11402 GHC compiler used by Guix.
11403
11404 Specific command-line options are:
11405
11406 @table @code
11407 @item --no-test-dependencies
11408 @itemx -t
11409 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11410 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
11411 @itemx -l @var{version}
11412 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
11413 release is used.
11414 @item --recursive
11415 @itemx -r
11416 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11417 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11418 in Guix.
11419 @end table
11420
11421 The command below imports metadata for the HTTP Haskell package
11422 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
11423
11424 @example
11425 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
11426 @end example
11427
11428 @item elpa
11429 @cindex elpa
11430 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
11431 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11432
11433 Specific command-line options are:
11434
11435 @table @code
11436 @item --archive=@var{repo}
11437 @itemx -a @var{repo}
11438 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
11439 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
11440 are:
11441 @itemize -
11442 @item
11443 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
11444 identifier. This is the default.
11445
11446 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
11447 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
11448 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
11449 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
11450 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11451
11452 @item
11453 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
11454 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
11455
11456 @item
11457 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
11458 identifier.
11459 @end itemize
11460
11461 @item --recursive
11462 @itemx -r
11463 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11464 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11465 in Guix.
11466 @end table
11467
11468 @item crate
11469 @cindex crate
11470 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
11471 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
11472
11473 @example
11474 guix import crate blake2-rfc
11475 @end example
11476
11477 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
11478
11479 @example
11480 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
11481 @end example
11482
11483 Additional options include:
11484
11485 @table @code
11486 @item --recursive
11487 @itemx -r
11488 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11489 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11490 in Guix.
11491 @end table
11492
11493 @item opam
11494 @cindex OPAM
11495 @cindex OCaml
11496 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
11497 repository used by the OCaml community.
11498
11499 Additional options include:
11500
11501 @table @code
11502 @item --recursive
11503 @itemx -r
11504 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11505 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11506 in Guix.
11507 @item --repo
11508 Select the given repository (a repository name). Possible values include:
11509 @itemize
11510 @item @code{opam}, the default opam repository,
11511 @item @code{coq} or @code{coq-released}, the stable repository for coq packages,
11512 @item @code{coq-core-dev}, the repository that contains development versions of coq,
11513 @item @code{coq-extra-dev}, the repository that contains development versions
11514 of coq packages.
11515 @end itemize
11516 @end table
11517
11518 @item go
11519 @cindex go
11520 Import metadata for a Go module using
11521 @uref{https://proxy.golang.org, proxy.golang.org}.
11522
11523 This importer is highly experimental. See the source code for more info
11524 about the current state.
11525
11526 @example
11527 guix import go gopkg.in/yaml.v2
11528 @end example
11529
11530 Additional options include:
11531
11532 @table @code
11533 @item --recursive
11534 @itemx -r
11535 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11536 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11537 in Guix.
11538 @end table
11539 @end table
11540
11541 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
11542 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
11543 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
11544
11545 @node Invoking guix refresh
11546 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
11547
11548 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
11549 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
11550 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
11551 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
11552 upstream version, like this:
11553
11554 @example
11555 $ guix refresh
11556 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
11557 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
11558 @end example
11559
11560 Alternatively, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
11561 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
11562
11563 @example
11564 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
11565 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
11566 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
11567 @end example
11568
11569 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
11570 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
11571 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
11572 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
11573 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
11574 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
11575 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
11576
11577 @table @code
11578
11579 @item --recursive
11580 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
11581
11582 @example
11583 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
11584 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
11585 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
11586 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
11587 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
11588 @dots{}
11589 @end example
11590
11591 @end table
11592
11593 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
11594 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
11595 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
11596 to that effect:
11597
11598 @lisp
11599 (define-public network-manager
11600 (package
11601 (name "network-manager")
11602 ;; @dots{}
11603 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
11604 @end lisp
11605
11606 When passed @option{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
11607 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
11608 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
11609 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
11610 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
11611 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
11612 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
11613
11614 When the public
11615 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
11616 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
11617 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
11618 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
11619
11620 The following options are supported:
11621
11622 @table @code
11623
11624 @item --expression=@var{expr}
11625 @itemx -e @var{expr}
11626 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
11627
11628 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
11629
11630 @example
11631 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
11632 @end example
11633
11634 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
11635 the packages).
11636
11637 @item --update
11638 @itemx -u
11639 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
11640 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
11641 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11642
11643 @example
11644 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
11645 @end example
11646
11647 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
11648
11649 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
11650 @itemx -s @var{subset}
11651 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
11652 @code{non-core}.
11653
11654 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
11655 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
11656 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
11657 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
11658 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
11659 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
11660
11661 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
11662 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
11663 inconvenient.
11664
11665 @item --manifest=@var{file}
11666 @itemx -m @var{file}
11667 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
11668 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
11669
11670 @item --type=@var{updater}
11671 @itemx -t @var{updater}
11672 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
11673 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
11674
11675 @table @code
11676 @item gnu
11677 the updater for GNU packages;
11678 @item savannah
11679 the updater for packages hosted at @uref{https://savannah.gnu.org, Savannah};
11680 @item gnome
11681 the updater for GNOME packages;
11682 @item kde
11683 the updater for KDE packages;
11684 @item xorg
11685 the updater for X.org packages;
11686 @item kernel.org
11687 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
11688 @item elpa
11689 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
11690 @item cran
11691 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
11692 @item bioconductor
11693 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
11694 @item cpan
11695 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
11696 @item pypi
11697 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
11698 @item gem
11699 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
11700 @item github
11701 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
11702 @item hackage
11703 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
11704 @item stackage
11705 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
11706 @item crate
11707 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
11708 @item launchpad
11709 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
11710 @end table
11711
11712 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
11713 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
11714
11715 @example
11716 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
11717 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
11718 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
11719 @end example
11720
11721 @end table
11722
11723 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
11724 names, as in this example:
11725
11726 @example
11727 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
11728 @end example
11729
11730 @noindent
11731 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
11732 @code{idutils} packages. The @option{--select} option would have no
11733 effect in this case.
11734
11735 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
11736 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
11737 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
11738 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
11739
11740 @table @code
11741
11742 @item --list-updaters
11743 @itemx -L
11744 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above).
11745
11746 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
11747 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
11748
11749 @item --list-dependent
11750 @itemx -l
11751 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
11752 result of upgrading one or more packages.
11753
11754 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
11755 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
11756 dependents of a package.
11757
11758 @end table
11759
11760 Be aware that the @option{--list-dependent} option only
11761 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
11762 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
11763
11764 @example
11765 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
11766 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
11767 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
11768 @end example
11769
11770 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
11771 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
11772
11773 @table @code
11774
11775 @item --list-transitive
11776 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
11777
11778 @example
11779 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
11780 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
11781 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
11782 @end example
11783
11784 @end table
11785
11786 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
11787 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
11788
11789 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
11790
11791 @table @code
11792
11793 @item --gpg=@var{command}
11794 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
11795 for in @code{$PATH}.
11796
11797 @item --keyring=@var{file}
11798 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
11799 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
11800 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
11801 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
11802 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
11803
11804 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
11805 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
11806 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
11807 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
11808 @option{--key-download} below).
11809
11810 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
11811 commands like this one:
11812
11813 @example
11814 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
11815 @end example
11816
11817 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
11818
11819 @example
11820 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
11821 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
11822 @end example
11823
11824 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
11825 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
11826
11827 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11828 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
11829 of:
11830
11831 @table @code
11832 @item always
11833 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
11834 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
11835
11836 @item never
11837 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
11838
11839 @item interactive
11840 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
11841 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
11842 @end table
11843
11844 @item --key-server=@var{host}
11845 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
11846
11847 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11848 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11849 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11850
11851 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11852 the command-line tools.
11853
11854 @end table
11855
11856 The @code{github} updater uses the
11857 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
11858 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
11859 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
11860 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
11861 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
11862 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
11863 an API token, set the environment variable @env{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
11864 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
11865 otherwise.
11866
11867
11868 @node Invoking guix lint
11869 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
11870
11871 @cindex @command{guix lint}
11872 @cindex package, checking for errors
11873 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
11874 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
11875 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
11876 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
11877 @option{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
11878
11879 @table @code
11880 @item synopsis
11881 @itemx description
11882 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
11883 descriptions and synopses.
11884
11885 @item inputs-should-be-native
11886 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
11887
11888 @item source
11889 @itemx home-page
11890 @itemx mirror-url
11891 @itemx github-url
11892 @itemx source-file-name
11893 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
11894 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
11895 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
11896 URL@. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
11897 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
11898 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
11899
11900 @item source-unstable-tarball
11901 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
11902 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
11903 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
11904
11905 @item derivation
11906 Check that the derivation of the given packages can be successfully
11907 computed for all the supported systems (@pxref{Derivations}).
11908
11909 @item profile-collisions
11910 Check whether installing the given packages in a profile would lead to
11911 collisions. Collisions occur when several packages with the same name
11912 but a different version or a different store file name are propagated.
11913 @xref{package Reference, @code{propagated-inputs}}, for more information
11914 on propagated inputs.
11915
11916 @item archival
11917 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
11918 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
11919 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
11920 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
11921
11922 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
11923 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
11924 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
11925 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
11926 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
11927 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
11928 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
11929
11930 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
11931 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
11932 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
11933 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
11934
11935 Software Heritage
11936 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
11937 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
11938 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
11939 that limit has been reset.
11940
11941 @item cve
11942 @cindex security vulnerabilities
11943 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
11944 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
11945 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
11946 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
11947 NIST}.
11948
11949 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
11950
11951 @itemize
11952 @item
11953 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11954 @item
11955 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11956 @end itemize
11957
11958 @noindent
11959 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
11960 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
11961
11962 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
11963 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
11964 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
11965 that Guix uses, as in this example:
11966
11967 @lisp
11968 (package
11969 (name "grub")
11970 ;; @dots{}
11971 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
11972 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
11973 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
11974 @end lisp
11975
11976 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
11977 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
11978 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
11979 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
11980 declare them as in this example:
11981
11982 @lisp
11983 (package
11984 (name "t1lib")
11985 ;; @dots{}
11986 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
11987 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
11988 "CVE-2011-1553"
11989 "CVE-2011-1554"
11990 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
11991 @end lisp
11992
11993 @item formatting
11994 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
11995 use of tabulations, etc.
11996 @end table
11997
11998 The general syntax is:
11999
12000 @example
12001 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
12002 @end example
12003
12004 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
12005 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
12006
12007 @table @code
12008 @item --list-checkers
12009 @itemx -l
12010 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
12011 and exit.
12012
12013 @item --checkers
12014 @itemx -c
12015 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
12016 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
12017
12018 @item --exclude
12019 @itemx -x
12020 Only disable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
12021 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
12022
12023 @item --no-network
12024 @itemx -n
12025 Only enable the checkers that do not depend on Internet access.
12026
12027 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12028 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12029 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12030 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12031
12032 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12033 the command-line tools.
12034
12035 @end table
12036
12037 @node Invoking guix size
12038 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
12039
12040 @cindex size
12041 @cindex package size
12042 @cindex closure
12043 @cindex @command{guix size}
12044 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
12045 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
12046 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
12047 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
12048 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
12049 @command{guix size} can highlight.
12050
12051 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
12052 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
12053 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
12054 example:
12055
12056 @example
12057 $ guix size coreutils
12058 store item total self
12059 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
12060 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
12061 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
12062 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
12063 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
12064 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
12065 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
12066 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
12067 total: 78.9 MiB
12068 @end example
12069
12070 @cindex closure
12071 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
12072 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
12073 would be returned by:
12074
12075 @example
12076 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
12077 @end example
12078
12079 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
12080 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
12081 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
12082 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
12083 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
12084 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
12085
12086 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
12087 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
12088 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
12089 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
12090 on the system anyway.)
12091
12092 Since the command also accepts store file names, assessing the size of
12093 a build result is straightforward:
12094
12095 @example
12096 guix size $(guix system build config.scm)
12097 @end example
12098
12099 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
12100 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
12101 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
12102 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
12103 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
12104 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
12105 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
12106 Coreutils}).
12107
12108 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
12109 reports information based on the available substitutes
12110 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
12111 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
12112
12113 You can also specify several package names:
12114
12115 @example
12116 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
12117 store item total self
12118 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
12119 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
12120 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
12121 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
12122 @dots{}
12123 total: 102.3 MiB
12124 @end example
12125
12126 @noindent
12127 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
12128 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
12129 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
12130
12131 When looking at the profile returned by @command{guix size}, you may
12132 find yourself wondering why a given package shows up in the profile at
12133 all. To understand it, you can use @command{guix graph --path -t
12134 references} to display the shortest path between the two packages
12135 (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
12136
12137 The available options are:
12138
12139 @table @option
12140
12141 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12142 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
12143 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
12144
12145 @item --sort=@var{key}
12146 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
12147
12148 @table @code
12149 @item self
12150 the size of each item (the default);
12151 @item closure
12152 the total size of the item's closure.
12153 @end table
12154
12155 @item --map-file=@var{file}
12156 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
12157
12158 For the example above, the map looks like this:
12159
12160 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
12161 produced by @command{guix size}}
12162
12163 This option requires that
12164 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
12165 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
12166 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
12167
12168 @item --system=@var{system}
12169 @itemx -s @var{system}
12170 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
12171
12172 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12173 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12174 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12175 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12176
12177 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12178 the command-line tools.
12179 @end table
12180
12181 @node Invoking guix graph
12182 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
12183
12184 @cindex DAG
12185 @cindex @command{guix graph}
12186 @cindex package dependencies
12187 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
12188 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
12189 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
12190 provides a visual representation of the DAG@. By default,
12191 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
12192 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
12193 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
12194 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
12195 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
12196 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
12197 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language. With
12198 @option{--path}, it simply displays the shortest path between two
12199 packages. The general syntax is:
12200
12201 @example
12202 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
12203 @end example
12204
12205 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
12206 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
12207 dependencies:
12208
12209 @example
12210 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
12211 @end example
12212
12213 The output looks like this:
12214
12215 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12216
12217 Nice little graph, no?
12218
12219 You may find it more pleasant to navigate the graph interactively with
12220 @command{xdot} (from the @code{xdot} package):
12221
12222 @example
12223 guix graph coreutils | xdot -
12224 @end example
12225
12226 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
12227 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
12228 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
12229 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
12230 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
12231
12232 @table @code
12233 @item package
12234 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
12235 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
12236 filters out many details.
12237
12238 @item reverse-package
12239 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
12240
12241 @example
12242 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
12243 @end example
12244
12245 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
12246 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
12247 @code{reverse-bag} below).
12248
12249 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
12250 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
12251 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
12252 @option{--list-dependent}}).
12253
12254 @item bag-emerged
12255 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
12256
12257 For instance, the following command:
12258
12259 @example
12260 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils
12261 @end example
12262
12263 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
12264
12265 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12266
12267 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
12268 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
12269
12270 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
12271 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
12272 here, for conciseness.
12273
12274 @item bag
12275 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
12276 dependencies.
12277
12278 @item bag-with-origins
12279 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
12280
12281 @item reverse-bag
12282 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
12283 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
12284
12285 @example
12286 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
12287 @end example
12288
12289 @noindent
12290 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
12291 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
12292 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
12293 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
12294
12295 @item derivation
12296 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
12297 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
12298 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
12299 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
12300
12301 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
12302 name instead of a package name, as in:
12303
12304 @example
12305 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
12306 @end example
12307
12308 @item module
12309 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12310 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
12311 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
12312
12313 @example
12314 guix graph -t module guile | xdot -
12315 @end example
12316 @end table
12317
12318 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
12319 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
12320
12321 @table @code
12322 @item references
12323 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
12324 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12325
12326 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
12327 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
12328
12329 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
12330 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
12331 (which can be big!):
12332
12333 @example
12334 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12335 @end example
12336
12337 @item referrers
12338 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
12339 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12340
12341 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
12342 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
12343 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
12344 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
12345 to it.
12346
12347 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
12348 collected.
12349
12350 @end table
12351
12352 @cindex shortest path, between packages
12353 Often, the graph of the package you are interested in does not fit on
12354 your screen, and anyway all you want to know is @emph{why} that package
12355 actually depends on some seemingly unrelated package. The
12356 @option{--path} option instructs @command{guix graph} to display the
12357 shortest path between two packages (or derivations, or store items,
12358 etc.):
12359
12360 @example
12361 $ guix graph --path emacs libunistring
12362 emacs@@26.3
12363 mailutils@@3.9
12364 libunistring@@0.9.10
12365 $ guix graph --path -t derivation emacs libunistring
12366 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3.drv
12367 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mailutils-3.9.drv
12368 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10.drv
12369 $ guix graph --path -t references emacs libunistring
12370 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3
12371 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libidn2-2.2.0
12372 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10
12373 @end example
12374
12375 The available options are the following:
12376
12377 @table @option
12378 @item --type=@var{type}
12379 @itemx -t @var{type}
12380 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
12381 the values listed above.
12382
12383 @item --list-types
12384 List the supported graph types.
12385
12386 @item --backend=@var{backend}
12387 @itemx -b @var{backend}
12388 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
12389
12390 @item --list-backends
12391 List the supported graph backends.
12392
12393 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
12394
12395 @item --path
12396 Display the shortest path between two nodes of the type specified by
12397 @option{--type}. The example below shows the shortest path between
12398 @code{libreoffice} and @code{llvm} according to the references of
12399 @code{libreoffice}:
12400
12401 @example
12402 $ guix graph --path -t references libreoffice llvm
12403 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libreoffice-6.4.2.2
12404 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libepoxy-1.5.4
12405 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mesa-19.3.4
12406 /gnu/store/@dots{}-llvm-9.0.1
12407 @end example
12408
12409 @item --expression=@var{expr}
12410 @itemx -e @var{expr}
12411 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
12412
12413 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
12414
12415 @example
12416 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
12417 @end example
12418
12419 @item --system=@var{system}
12420 @itemx -s @var{system}
12421 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
12422
12423 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
12424 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
12425
12426 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12427 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12428 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12429 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12430
12431 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12432 the command-line tools.
12433 @end table
12434
12435 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
12436 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
12437 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
12438 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
12439 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
12440 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
12441
12442 @example
12443 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
12444 @end example
12445
12446 So many possibilities, so much fun!
12447
12448 @node Invoking guix publish
12449 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
12450
12451 @cindex @command{guix publish}
12452 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
12453 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
12454 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12455
12456 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
12457 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
12458 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
12459 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
12460 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
12461
12462 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
12463 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
12464 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
12465 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
12466 @option{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
12467
12468 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
12469 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12470 guix archive}).
12471
12472 When the @option{--advertise} option is passed, the server advertises
12473 its availability on the local network using multicast DNS (mDNS) and DNS
12474 service discovery (DNS-SD), currently @i{via} Guile-Avahi (@pxref{Top,,,
12475 guile-avahi, Using Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}).
12476
12477 The general syntax is:
12478
12479 @example
12480 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
12481 @end example
12482
12483 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
12484 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
12485
12486 @example
12487 guix publish
12488 @end example
12489
12490 Once a publishing server has been authorized, the daemon may download
12491 substitutes from it. @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}.
12492
12493 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
12494 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
12495 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
12496 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
12497 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
12498 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
12499 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
12500
12501 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
12502 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
12503 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
12504 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
12505 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
12506 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
12507
12508 @example
12509 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
12510 @end example
12511
12512 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
12513 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
12514
12515 @cindex build logs, publication
12516 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
12517
12518 @example
12519 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
12520 @end example
12521
12522 @noindent
12523 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
12524 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
12525 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
12526 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
12527 running @command{guix-daemon} with @option{--log-compression=gzip} since
12528 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
12529 Bzip2 compression.
12530
12531 The following options are available:
12532
12533 @table @code
12534 @item --port=@var{port}
12535 @itemx -p @var{port}
12536 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
12537
12538 @item --listen=@var{host}
12539 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
12540 accept connections from any interface.
12541
12542 @item --user=@var{user}
12543 @itemx -u @var{user}
12544 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
12545 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
12546
12547 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12548 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12549 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
12550 one of @code{lzip}, @code{zstd}, and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is
12551 omitted, @code{gzip} is used.
12552
12553 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
12554 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
12555 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
12556
12557 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a
12558 small increase in CPU usage; see
12559 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip
12560 Web page}. However, @code{lzip} achieves low decompression throughput
12561 (on the order of 50@tie{}MiB/s on modern hardware), which can be a
12562 bottleneck for someone who downloads over a fast network connection.
12563
12564 The compression ratio of @code{zstd} is between that of @code{lzip} and
12565 that of @code{gzip}; its main advantage is a
12566 @uref{https://facebook.github.io/zstd/,high decompression speed}.
12567
12568 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
12569 the compressed streams are not
12570 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
12571 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
12572 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
12573 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
12574 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
12575 to its responses.
12576
12577 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
12578 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
12579 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
12580 the one they support.
12581
12582 @item --cache=@var{directory}
12583 @itemx -c @var{directory}
12584 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
12585 and only serve archives that are in cache.
12586
12587 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
12588 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
12589 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
12590 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
12591 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
12592 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
12593 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
12594
12595 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
12596 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) triggers a
12597 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
12598 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
12599 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
12600 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
12601 the best possible bandwidth.
12602
12603 That first @code{.narinfo} request nonetheless returns 200, provided the
12604 requested store item is ``small enough'', below the cache bypass
12605 threshold---see @option{--cache-bypass-threshold} below. That way,
12606 clients do not have to wait until the archive is baked. For larger
12607 store items, the first @code{.narinfo} request returns 404, meaning that
12608 clients have to wait until the archive is baked.
12609
12610 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
12611 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
12612 @option{--workers} below.
12613
12614 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
12615 when they have expired.
12616
12617 @item --workers=@var{N}
12618 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
12619 threads to ``bake'' archives.
12620
12621 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
12622 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
12623 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
12624 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
12625
12626 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
12627 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
12628 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
12629 for as long as @var{ttl}.
12630
12631 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
12632 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
12633 item in the store, may be deleted.
12634
12635 @item --cache-bypass-threshold=@var{size}
12636 When used in conjunction with @option{--cache}, store items smaller than
12637 @var{size} are immediately available, even when they are not yet in
12638 cache. @var{size} is a size in bytes, or it can be suffixed by @code{M}
12639 for megabytes and so on. The default is @code{10M}.
12640
12641 ``Cache bypass'' allows you to reduce the publication delay for clients
12642 at the expense of possibly additional I/O and CPU use on the server
12643 side: depending on the client access patterns, those store items can end
12644 up being baked several times until a copy is available in cache.
12645
12646 Increasing the threshold may be useful for sites that have few users, or
12647 to guarantee that users get substitutes even for store items that are
12648 not popular.
12649
12650 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
12651 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
12652 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
12653
12654 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
12655 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
12656 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
12657
12658 @item --public-key=@var{file}
12659 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
12660 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
12661 the store items being published.
12662
12663 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
12664 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
12665 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
12666 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12667 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
12668 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
12669
12670 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
12671 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
12672 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
12673 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
12674 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
12675 @end table
12676
12677 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
12678 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
12679 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
12680 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
12681
12682 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
12683 instructions:
12684
12685 @itemize
12686 @item
12687 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
12688
12689 @example
12690 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
12691 /etc/systemd/system/
12692 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
12693 @end example
12694
12695 @item
12696 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
12697
12698 @example
12699 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
12700 # start guix-publish
12701 @end example
12702
12703 @item
12704 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
12705 @end itemize
12706
12707 @node Invoking guix challenge
12708 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
12709
12710 @cindex reproducible builds
12711 @cindex verifiable builds
12712 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
12713 @cindex challenge
12714 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
12715 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
12716 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
12717 answer.
12718
12719 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
12720 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
12721 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
12722 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
12723 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
12724 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
12725 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
12726
12727 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
12728 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
12729 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
12730 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
12731 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
12732 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
12733 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
12734 any given store item.
12735
12736 The command output looks like this:
12737
12738 @smallexample
12739 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12740 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
12741 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12742 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
12743 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12744 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12745 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
12746 differing files:
12747 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
12748 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
12749
12750 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
12751 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
12752 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
12753 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
12754 differing file:
12755 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
12756
12757 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
12758 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12759 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12760 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
12761 differing file:
12762 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
12763
12764 @dots{}
12765
12766 6,406 store items were analyzed:
12767 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
12768 - 525 (8.2%) differed
12769 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
12770 @end smallexample
12771
12772 @noindent
12773 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
12774 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
12775 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
12776 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
12777 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
12778
12779 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
12780 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
12781 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
12782 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
12783 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
12784 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
12785 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
12786 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
12787 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
12788 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
12789 more information.
12790
12791 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
12792 to run:
12793
12794 @example
12795 guix challenge git \
12796 --diff=diffoscope \
12797 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12798 @end example
12799
12800 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
12801 information about files that differ.
12802
12803 Alternatively, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
12804 archive}):
12805
12806 @example
12807 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
12808 | lzip -d | guix archive -x /tmp/git
12809 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
12810 @end example
12811
12812 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
12813 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
12814 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
12815 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
12816 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
12817 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
12818 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
12819
12820 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
12821 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
12822 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
12823 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
12824 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
12825 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
12826 the problem.
12827
12828 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
12829 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
12830 same build result as you did with:
12831
12832 @example
12833 $ guix challenge @var{package}
12834 @end example
12835
12836 @noindent
12837 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
12838 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
12839
12840 The general syntax is:
12841
12842 @example
12843 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
12844 @end example
12845
12846 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
12847 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
12848 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
12849 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
12850 errors).
12851
12852 The one option that matters is:
12853
12854 @table @code
12855
12856 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12857 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
12858 URLs to compare to.
12859
12860 @item --diff=@var{mode}
12861 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
12862
12863 @table @asis
12864 @item @code{simple} (the default)
12865 Show the list of files that differ.
12866
12867 @item @code{diffoscope}
12868 @itemx @var{command}
12869 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
12870 two directories whose contents do not match.
12871
12872 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
12873 of Diffoscope.
12874
12875 @item @code{none}
12876 Do not show further details about the differences.
12877 @end table
12878
12879 Thus, unless @option{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
12880 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
12881 can compare them.
12882
12883 @item --verbose
12884 @itemx -v
12885 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
12886 information about mismatches.
12887
12888 @end table
12889
12890 @node Invoking guix copy
12891 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
12892
12893 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
12894 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
12895 @cindex sharing store items across machines
12896 @cindex transferring store items across machines
12897 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
12898 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
12899 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
12900 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
12901 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
12902 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
12903
12904 @example
12905 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
12906 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12907 @end example
12908
12909 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
12910 they are not actually sent.
12911
12912 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
12913 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
12914
12915 @example
12916 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
12917 @end example
12918
12919 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
12920 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
12921 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
12922
12923 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
12924 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
12925 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
12926 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
12927 store item authentication.
12928
12929 The general syntax is:
12930
12931 @example
12932 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
12933 @end example
12934
12935 You must always specify one of the following options:
12936
12937 @table @code
12938 @item --to=@var{spec}
12939 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
12940 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
12941 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
12942 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
12943 @end table
12944
12945 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
12946 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
12947
12948 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
12949 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
12950 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
12951
12952
12953 @node Invoking guix container
12954 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
12955 @cindex container
12956 @cindex @command{guix container}
12957 @quotation Note
12958 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
12959 is subject to radical change in the future.
12960 @end quotation
12961
12962 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
12963 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
12964 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
12965 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
12966 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
12967
12968 The general syntax is:
12969
12970 @example
12971 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
12972 @end example
12973
12974 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
12975 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
12976
12977 The following actions are available:
12978
12979 @table @code
12980 @item exec
12981 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
12982
12983 The syntax is:
12984
12985 @example
12986 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
12987 @end example
12988
12989 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
12990 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
12991 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
12992 will be passed to @var{program}.
12993
12994 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
12995 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
12996 process ID is 9001:
12997
12998 @example
12999 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
13000 @end example
13001
13002 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
13003 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
13004
13005 @end table
13006
13007 @node Invoking guix weather
13008 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
13009
13010 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
13011 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
13012 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
13013 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
13014 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
13015 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
13016 publish}).
13017
13018 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
13019 @cindex availability of substitutes
13020 @cindex substitute availability
13021 @cindex weather, substitute availability
13022 Here's a sample run:
13023
13024 @example
13025 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
13026 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
13027 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
13028 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
13029 https://guix.example.org
13030 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
13031 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
13032 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
13033 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
13034 33.5 requests per second
13035
13036 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
13037 867 queued builds
13038 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
13039 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
13040 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
13041 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
13042 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
13043 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
13044 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
13045 @end example
13046
13047 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
13048 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
13049 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
13050 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
13051 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
13052 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
13053 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
13054 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
13055 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
13056 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
13057 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
13058
13059 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
13060 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
13061 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
13062 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
13063 those substitutes.
13064
13065 The general syntax is:
13066
13067 @example
13068 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
13069 @end example
13070
13071 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
13072 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
13073 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
13074 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
13075 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
13076 available substitutes is below 100%.
13077
13078 The available options are listed below.
13079
13080 @table @code
13081 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
13082 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
13083 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
13084 servers is queried.
13085
13086 @item --system=@var{system}
13087 @itemx -s @var{system}
13088 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
13089 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
13090 substitutes for several system types.
13091
13092 @item --manifest=@var{file}
13093 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
13094 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
13095 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
13096 guix package}).
13097
13098 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
13099 are concatenated.
13100
13101 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
13102 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
13103 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
13104 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
13105 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
13106 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
13107 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
13108
13109 @example
13110 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
13111 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
13112 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
13113 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
13114 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
13115 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
13116 @dots{}
13117 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
13118 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
13119 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
13120 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
13121 @dots{}
13122 @end example
13123
13124 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
13125 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at
13126 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}; likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46
13127 packages that depend on it.
13128
13129 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
13130 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
13131 fail to build.
13132
13133 @item --display-missing
13134 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
13135 @end table
13136
13137 @node Invoking guix processes
13138 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
13139
13140 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
13141 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
13142 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
13143 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
13144 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
13145 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
13146
13147 @example
13148 $ sudo guix processes
13149 SessionPID: 19002
13150 ClientPID: 19090
13151 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
13152
13153 SessionPID: 19402
13154 ClientPID: 19367
13155 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
13156
13157 SessionPID: 19444
13158 ClientPID: 19419
13159 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13160 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
13161 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
13162 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
13163 ChildPID: 20495
13164 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13165 ChildPID: 27733
13166 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13167 ChildPID: 27793
13168 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13169 @end example
13170
13171 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
13172 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
13173 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
13174 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
13175 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
13176
13177 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked
13178 by this session, which corresponds to store items being built or
13179 substituted (the @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when
13180 @command{guix processes} is not running as root). Last, by looking at
13181 the @code{ChildPID} and @code{ChildCommand} fields, we understand that
13182 these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
13183
13184 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
13185 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
13186 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
13187 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
13188
13189 @example
13190 $ sudo guix processes | \
13191 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
13192 ClientPID: 19419
13193 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13194 @end example
13195
13196 Additional options are listed below.
13197
13198 @table @code
13199 @item --format=@var{format}
13200 @itemx -f @var{format}
13201 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
13202
13203 @table @code
13204 @item recutils
13205 The default option. It outputs a set of Session recutils records
13206 that include each @code{ChildProcess} as a field.
13207
13208 @item normalized
13209 Normalize the output records into record sets (@pxref{Record Sets,,,
13210 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). Normalizing into record sets allows
13211 joins across record types. The example below lists the PID of each
13212 @code{ChildProcess} and the associated PID for @code{Session} that
13213 spawned the @code{ChildProcess} where the @code{Session} was started
13214 using @command{guix build}.
13215
13216 @example
13217 $ guix processes --format=normalized | \
13218 recsel \
13219 -j Session \
13220 -t ChildProcess \
13221 -p Session.PID,PID \
13222 -e 'Session.ClientCommand ~ "guix build"'
13223 PID: 4435
13224 Session_PID: 4278
13225
13226 PID: 4554
13227 Session_PID: 4278
13228
13229 PID: 4646
13230 Session_PID: 4278
13231 @end example
13232 @end table
13233 @end table
13234
13235 @node System Configuration
13236 @chapter System Configuration
13237
13238 @cindex system configuration
13239 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
13240 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
13241 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
13242 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
13243 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
13244
13245 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
13246 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
13247 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
13248 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
13249 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
13250 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
13251 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
13252 the own tools of the system.
13253 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
13254
13255 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
13256 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
13257 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
13258 instance to support new system services.
13259
13260 @menu
13261 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
13262 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
13263 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
13264 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
13265 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
13266 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
13267 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
13268 * Services:: Specifying system services.
13269 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
13270 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
13271 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
13272 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
13273 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
13274 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
13275 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
13276 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
13277 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
13278 @end menu
13279
13280 @node Using the Configuration System
13281 @section Using the Configuration System
13282
13283 The operating system is configured by providing an
13284 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
13285 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
13286 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
13287 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
13288
13289 @findex operating-system
13290 @lisp
13291 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
13292 @end lisp
13293
13294 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
13295 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
13296 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
13297 which case they get a default value.
13298
13299 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
13300 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
13301 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
13302 @command{guix system}.
13303
13304 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
13305
13306 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
13307 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
13308 @cindex UEFI boot
13309 @cindex EFI boot
13310 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
13311 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
13312 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
13313 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
13314 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
13315
13316 @lisp
13317 (bootloader-configuration
13318 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
13319 (target "/boot/efi"))
13320 @end lisp
13321
13322 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
13323 configuration options.
13324
13325 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
13326
13327 @vindex %base-packages
13328 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
13329 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @env{PATH}
13330 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
13331 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
13332 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
13333 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
13334 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
13335 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
13336 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
13337 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
13338 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
13339 of a package:
13340
13341 @lisp
13342 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13343 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
13344
13345 (operating-system
13346 ;; ...
13347 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
13348 %base-packages)))
13349 @end lisp
13350
13351 @findex specification->package
13352 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
13353 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
13354 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
13355 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
13356 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
13357 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
13358 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
13359 version:
13360
13361 @lisp
13362 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13363
13364 (operating-system
13365 ;; ...
13366 (packages (append (map specification->package
13367 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
13368 %base-packages)))
13369 @end lisp
13370
13371 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
13372
13373 @cindex services
13374 @vindex %base-services
13375 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
13376 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
13377 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
13378 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
13379 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
13380 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
13381 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
13382 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
13383 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
13384
13385 @cindex customization, of services
13386 @findex modify-services
13387 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
13388 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
13389 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
13390
13391 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
13392 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
13393 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
13394 following in your operating system declaration:
13395
13396 @lisp
13397 (define %my-services
13398 ;; My very own list of services.
13399 (modify-services %base-services
13400 (guix-service-type config =>
13401 (guix-configuration
13402 (inherit config)
13403 ;; Fetch substitutes from example.org.
13404 (substitute-urls
13405 (list "https://example.org/guix"
13406 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))))
13407 (mingetty-service-type config =>
13408 (mingetty-configuration
13409 (inherit config)
13410 ;; Automatially log in as "guest".
13411 (auto-login "guest")))))
13412
13413 (operating-system
13414 ;; @dots{}
13415 (services %my-services))
13416 @end lisp
13417
13418 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
13419 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
13420 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
13421 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
13422 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
13423 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
13424 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
13425 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
13426 configuration, but with a few modifications.
13427
13428 @cindex encrypted disk
13429 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
13430 root partition, the X11 display
13431 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
13432 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
13433 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
13434
13435 @lisp
13436 @include os-config-desktop.texi
13437 @end lisp
13438
13439 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
13440 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
13441
13442 @lisp
13443 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
13444 @end lisp
13445
13446 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
13447 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
13448 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
13449
13450 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
13451 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
13452 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
13453
13454 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
13455 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
13456 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
13457 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
13458 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
13459 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
13460
13461 @lisp
13462 (remove (lambda (service)
13463 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
13464 %desktop-services)
13465 @end lisp
13466
13467 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
13468
13469 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
13470 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
13471 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
13472 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
13473 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
13474
13475 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
13476 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
13477 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
13478 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
13479 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
13480 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
13481 system, should you ever need to.
13482
13483 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
13484 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
13485 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
13486 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
13487 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
13488 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
13489 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
13490 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
13491 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
13492 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
13493
13494 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
13495 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
13496 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
13497 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
13498 system}).
13499
13500 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
13501
13502 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
13503 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
13504 Monad}):
13505
13506 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
13507 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
13508 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
13509
13510 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
13511 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
13512 instantiate @var{os}.
13513 @end deffn
13514
13515 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
13516 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
13517 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
13518
13519
13520 @node operating-system Reference
13521 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
13522
13523 This section summarizes all the options available in
13524 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
13525 System}).
13526
13527 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
13528 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
13529 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
13530 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
13531
13532 @table @asis
13533 @item @code{kernel} (default: @code{linux-libre})
13534 The package object of the operating system kernel to
13535 use@footnote{Currently only the Linux-libre kernel is fully supported.
13536 Using GNU@tie{}mach with the GNU@tie{}Hurd is experimental and only
13537 available when building a virtual machine disk image.}.
13538
13539 @cindex hurd
13540 @item @code{hurd} (default: @code{#f})
13541 The package object of the Hurd to be started by the kernel. When this
13542 field is set, produce a GNU/Hurd operating system. In that case,
13543 @code{kernel} must also be set to the @code{gnumach} package---the
13544 microkernel the Hurd runs on.
13545
13546 @quotation Warning
13547 This feature is experimental and only supported for disk images.
13548 @end quotation
13549
13550 @item @code{kernel-loadable-modules} (default: '())
13551 A list of objects (usually packages) to collect loadable kernel modules
13552 from--e.g. @code{(list ddcci-driver-linux)}.
13553
13554 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{%default-kernel-arguments})
13555 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
13556 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
13557
13558 @item @code{bootloader}
13559 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
13560
13561 @item @code{label}
13562 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
13563 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
13564
13565 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13566 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
13567 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
13568 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record. @xref{Keyboard Layout},
13569 for more information.
13570
13571 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
13572 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
13573 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
13574 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13575
13576 @quotation Note
13577 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
13578 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
13579 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
13580 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
13581 Window System.
13582 @end quotation
13583
13584 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
13585 @cindex initrd
13586 @cindex initial RAM disk
13587 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
13588 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13589
13590 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
13591 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
13592 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
13593 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13594
13595 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
13596 @cindex firmware
13597 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
13598
13599 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
13600 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
13601 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
13602 supported hardware.
13603
13604 @item @code{host-name}
13605 The host name.
13606
13607 @item @code{hosts-file}
13608 @cindex hosts file
13609 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
13610 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
13611 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
13612 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
13613
13614 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13615 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
13616
13617 @item @code{file-systems}
13618 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
13619
13620 @cindex swap devices
13621 @cindex swap space
13622 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13623 A list of UUIDs, file system labels, or strings identifying devices or
13624 files to be used for ``swap
13625 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13626 Manual}). Here are some examples:
13627
13628 @table @code
13629 @item (list (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb"))
13630 Use the swap partition with the given UUID@. You can learn the UUID of a
13631 Linux swap partition by running @command{swaplabel @var{device}}, where
13632 @var{device} is the @file{/dev} file name of that partition.
13633
13634 @item (list (file-system-label "swap"))
13635 Use the partition with label @code{swap}. Again, the
13636 @command{swaplabel} command allows you to view and change the label of a
13637 Linux swap partition.
13638
13639 @item (list "/swapfile")
13640 Use the file @file{/swapfile} as swap space.
13641
13642 @item (list "/dev/sda3" "/dev/sdb2")
13643 Use the @file{/dev/sda3} and @file{/dev/sdb2} partitions as swap space.
13644 We recommend referring to swap devices by UUIDs or labels as shown above
13645 instead.
13646 @end table
13647
13648 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
13649 device (under @file{/dev/mapper}), provided that the necessary device
13650 mapping and file system are also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and
13651 @ref{File Systems}.
13652
13653 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
13654 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
13655 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
13656
13657 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
13658 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
13659
13660 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
13661 A list of target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13662 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
13663 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
13664
13665 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
13666
13667 @lisp
13668 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
13669 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
13670 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
13671 (activate-readline)")))
13672 @end lisp
13673
13674 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
13675 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
13676 displayed when users log in on a text console.
13677
13678 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
13679 A list of packages to be installed in the global profile, which is accessible
13680 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Each element is either a package
13681 variable or a package/output tuple. Here's a simple example of both:
13682
13683 @lisp
13684 (cons* git ; the default "out" output
13685 (list git "send-email") ; another output of git
13686 %base-packages) ; the default set
13687 @end lisp
13688
13689 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
13690 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
13691 package}).
13692
13693 @item @code{timezone}
13694 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
13695
13696 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
13697 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
13698 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
13699
13700 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
13701 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
13702 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
13703
13704 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
13705 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
13706 run time. @xref{Locales}.
13707
13708 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
13709 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
13710 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
13711 considerations that justify this option.
13712
13713 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
13714 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
13715 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
13716 details.
13717
13718 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
13719 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
13720
13721 @cindex essential services
13722 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
13723 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
13724 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
13725 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
13726 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
13727
13728 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
13729 @cindex PAM
13730 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
13731 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
13732 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
13733
13734 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @code{%setuid-programs})
13735 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
13736 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
13737
13738 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @code{%sudoers-specification})
13739 @cindex sudoers file
13740 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
13741 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
13742
13743 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
13744 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
13745 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
13746 @code{sudo}.
13747
13748 @end table
13749
13750 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
13751 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
13752 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
13753
13754 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
13755 the definition of the @code{label} field:
13756
13757 @lisp
13758 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13759
13760 (operating-system
13761 ;; ...
13762 (label (package-full-name
13763 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
13764 @end lisp
13765
13766 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
13767 system definition.
13768 @end deffn
13769
13770 @end deftp
13771
13772 @node File Systems
13773 @section File Systems
13774
13775 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
13776 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
13777 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
13778 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
13779
13780 @lisp
13781 (file-system
13782 (mount-point "/home")
13783 (device "/dev/sda3")
13784 (type "ext4"))
13785 @end lisp
13786
13787 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
13788 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
13789
13790 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
13791 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
13792 contain the following members:
13793
13794 @table @asis
13795 @item @code{type}
13796 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
13797 @code{"ext4"}.
13798
13799 @item @code{mount-point}
13800 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
13801
13802 @item @code{device}
13803 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
13804 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
13805 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
13806 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
13807 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
13808 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
13809 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
13810 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
13811 mounted.}.
13812
13813 @findex file-system-label
13814 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
13815 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
13816 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
13817 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
13818
13819 @lisp
13820 (file-system
13821 (mount-point "/home")
13822 (type "ext4")
13823 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13824 @end lisp
13825
13826 @findex uuid
13827 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
13828 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
13829 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
13830 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
13831 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
13832 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
13833 like this:
13834
13835 @lisp
13836 (file-system
13837 (mount-point "/home")
13838 (type "ext4")
13839 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
13840 @end lisp
13841
13842 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
13843 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
13844 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
13845 This is required so that
13846 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
13847 corresponding device mapping established.
13848
13849 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
13850 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
13851 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
13852 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
13853 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
13854 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
13855 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
13856 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
13857 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13858 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
13859
13860 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
13861 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to
13862 the file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
13863 Library Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for
13864 options for various file systems. Note that the
13865 @code{file-system-options->alist} and @code{alist->file-system-options}
13866 procedures from @code{(gnu system file-systems)} can be used to convert
13867 file system options given as an association list to the string
13868 representation, and vice-versa.
13869
13870 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
13871 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
13872 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
13873 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
13874 is not automatically mounted.
13875
13876 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
13877 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
13878 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
13879 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
13880 instance, for the root file system.
13881
13882 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
13883 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
13884 errors before being mounted.
13885
13886 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
13887 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
13888
13889 @item @code{mount-may-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
13890 When true, this indicates that mounting this file system can fail but
13891 that should not be considered an error. This is useful in unusual
13892 cases; an example of this is @code{efivarfs}, a file system that can
13893 only be mounted on EFI/UEFI systems.
13894
13895 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
13896 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
13897 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
13898 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
13899
13900 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
13901 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
13902 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
13903
13904 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
13905 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13906 @end table
13907 @end deftp
13908
13909 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-system-label @var{str}
13910 This procedure returns an opaque file system label from @var{str}, a
13911 string:
13912
13913 @lisp
13914 (file-system-label "home")
13915 @result{} #<file-system-label "home">
13916 @end lisp
13917
13918 File system labels are used to refer to file systems by label rather
13919 than by device name. See above for examples.
13920 @end deffn
13921
13922 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
13923 variables.
13924
13925 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
13926 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
13927 such as @code{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @code{%immutable-store} (see
13928 below). Operating system declarations should always contain at least
13929 these.
13930 @end defvr
13931
13932 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
13933 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
13934 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
13935 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13936 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
13937 @command{xterm}.
13938 @end defvr
13939
13940 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
13941 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
13942 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
13943 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
13944 @end defvr
13945
13946 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
13947 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
13948 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
13949 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
13950 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
13951
13952 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
13953 read-write in its own ``name space.''
13954 @end defvr
13955
13956 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
13957 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
13958 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
13959 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13960 @end defvr
13961
13962 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
13963 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
13964 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
13965 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13966 @end defvr
13967
13968 The @code{(gnu system uuid)} module provides tools to deal with file
13969 system ``unique identifiers'' (UUIDs).
13970
13971 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} uuid @var{str} [@var{type}]
13972 Return an opaque UUID (unique identifier) object of the given @var{type}
13973 (a symbol) by parsing @var{str} (a string):
13974
13975 @lisp
13976 (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")
13977 @result{} #<<uuid> type: dce bv: @dots{}>
13978
13979 (uuid "1234-ABCD" 'fat)
13980 @result{} #<<uuid> type: fat bv: @dots{}>
13981 @end lisp
13982
13983 @var{type} may be one of @code{dce}, @code{iso9660}, @code{fat},
13984 @code{ntfs}, or one of the commonly found synonyms for these.
13985
13986 UUIDs are another way to unambiguously refer to file systems in
13987 operating system configuration. See the examples above.
13988 @end deffn
13989
13990
13991 @node Btrfs file system
13992 @subsection Btrfs file system
13993
13994 The Btrfs has special features, such as subvolumes, that merit being
13995 explained in more details. The following section attempts to cover
13996 basic as well as complex uses of a Btrfs file system with the Guix
13997 System.
13998
13999 In its simplest usage, a Btrfs file system can be described, for
14000 example, by:
14001
14002 @lisp
14003 (file-system
14004 (mount-point "/home")
14005 (type "btrfs")
14006 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
14007 @end lisp
14008
14009 The example below is more complex, as it makes use of a Btrfs
14010 subvolume, named @code{rootfs}. The parent Btrfs file system is labeled
14011 @code{my-btrfs-pool}, and is located on an encrypted device (hence the
14012 dependency on @code{mapped-devices}):
14013
14014 @lisp
14015 (file-system
14016 (device (file-system-label "my-btrfs-pool"))
14017 (mount-point "/")
14018 (type "btrfs")
14019 (options "subvol=rootfs")
14020 (dependencies mapped-devices))
14021 @end lisp
14022
14023 Some bootloaders, for example GRUB, only mount a Btrfs partition at its
14024 top level during the early boot, and rely on their configuration to
14025 refer to the correct subvolume path within that top level. The
14026 bootloaders operating in this way typically produce their configuration
14027 on a running system where the Btrfs partitions are already mounted and
14028 where the subvolume information is readily available. As an example,
14029 @command{grub-mkconfig}, the configuration generator command shipped
14030 with GRUB, reads @file{/proc/self/mountinfo} to determine the top-level
14031 path of a subvolume.
14032
14033 The Guix System produces a bootloader configuration using the operating
14034 system configuration as its sole input; it is therefore necessary to
14035 extract the subvolume name on which @file{/gnu/store} lives (if any)
14036 from that operating system configuration. To better illustrate,
14037 consider a subvolume named 'rootfs' which contains the root file system
14038 data. In such situation, the GRUB bootloader would only see the top
14039 level of the root Btrfs partition, e.g.:
14040
14041 @example
14042 / (top level)
14043 ├── rootfs (subvolume directory)
14044 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14045 ├── store (normal directory)
14046 [...]
14047 @end example
14048
14049 Thus, the subvolume name must be prepended to the @file{/gnu/store} path
14050 of the kernel, initrd binaries and any other files referred to in the
14051 GRUB configuration that must be found during the early boot.
14052
14053 The next example shows a nested hierarchy of subvolumes and
14054 directories:
14055
14056 @example
14057 / (top level)
14058 ├── rootfs (subvolume)
14059 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14060 ├── store (subvolume)
14061 [...]
14062 @end example
14063
14064 This scenario would work without mounting the 'store' subvolume.
14065 Mounting 'rootfs' is sufficient, since the subvolume name matches its
14066 intended mount point in the file system hierarchy. Alternatively, the
14067 'store' subvolume could be referred to by setting the @code{subvol}
14068 option to either @code{/rootfs/gnu/store} or @code{rootfs/gnu/store}.
14069
14070 Finally, a more contrived example of nested subvolumes:
14071
14072 @example
14073 / (top level)
14074 ├── root-snapshots (subvolume)
14075 ├── root-current (subvolume)
14076 ├── guix-store (subvolume)
14077 [...]
14078 @end example
14079
14080 Here, the 'guix-store' subvolume doesn't match its intended mount point,
14081 so it is necessary to mount it. The subvolume must be fully specified,
14082 by passing its file name to the @code{subvol} option. To illustrate,
14083 the 'guix-store' subvolume could be mounted on @file{/gnu/store} by using
14084 a file system declaration such as:
14085
14086 @lisp
14087 (file-system
14088 (device (file-system-label "btrfs-pool-1"))
14089 (mount-point "/gnu/store")
14090 (type "btrfs")
14091 (options "subvol=root-snapshots/root-current/guix-store,\
14092 compress-force=zstd,space_cache=v2"))
14093 @end lisp
14094
14095 @node Mapped Devices
14096 @section Mapped Devices
14097
14098 @cindex device mapping
14099 @cindex mapped devices
14100 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
14101 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
14102 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
14103 with additional processing over the data that flows through
14104 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
14105 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
14106 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
14107 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
14108 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
14109 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
14110 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
14111 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
14112 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
14113 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
14114 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
14115 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
14116
14117 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
14118 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
14119
14120 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
14121 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
14122 the system boots up.
14123
14124 @table @code
14125 @item source
14126 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
14127 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
14128 need to be assembled for creating a new one. In case of LVM this is a
14129 string specifying name of the volume group to be mapped.
14130
14131 @item target
14132 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
14133 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
14134 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
14135 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
14136 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
14137 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
14138 LVM logical volumes of type @code{lvm-device-mapping} need to
14139 be specified as @code{"VGNAME-LVNAME"}.
14140
14141 @item targets
14142 This list of strings specifies names of the resulting mapped devices in case
14143 there are several. The format is identical to @var{target}.
14144
14145 @item type
14146 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
14147 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
14148 @end table
14149 @end deftp
14150
14151 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
14152 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
14153 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
14154 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
14155 @end defvr
14156
14157 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
14158 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
14159 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
14160 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
14161 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
14162 @end defvr
14163
14164 @cindex LVM, logical volume manager
14165 @defvr {Scheme Variable} lvm-device-mapping
14166 This defines one or more logical volumes for the Linux
14167 @uref{https://www.sourceware.org/lvm2/, Logical Volume Manager (LVM)}.
14168 The volume group is activated by the @command{vgchange} command from the
14169 @code{lvm2} package.
14170 @end defvr
14171
14172 @cindex disk encryption
14173 @cindex LUKS
14174 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
14175 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
14176 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
14177 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
14178 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
14179 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
14180 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14181
14182 @lisp
14183 (mapped-device
14184 (source "/dev/sda3")
14185 (target "home")
14186 (type luks-device-mapping))
14187 @end lisp
14188
14189 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
14190 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
14191 command like:
14192
14193 @example
14194 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
14195 @end example
14196
14197 and use it as follows:
14198
14199 @lisp
14200 (mapped-device
14201 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
14202 (target "home")
14203 (type luks-device-mapping))
14204 @end lisp
14205
14206 @cindex swap encryption
14207 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
14208 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
14209 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
14210 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
14211 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
14212
14213 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
14214 may be declared as follows:
14215
14216 @lisp
14217 (mapped-device
14218 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
14219 (target "/dev/md0")
14220 (type raid-device-mapping))
14221 @end lisp
14222
14223 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
14224 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14225 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
14226 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
14227 automatically later.
14228
14229 LVM logical volumes ``alpha'' and ``beta'' from volume group ``vg0'' can
14230 be declared as follows:
14231
14232 @lisp
14233 (mapped-device
14234 (source "vg0")
14235 (targets (list "vg0-alpha" "vg0-beta"))
14236 (type lvm-device-mapping))
14237 @end lisp
14238
14239 Devices @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-alpha} and @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-beta} can
14240 then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system} declaration
14241 (@pxref{File Systems}).
14242
14243 @node User Accounts
14244 @section User Accounts
14245
14246 @cindex users
14247 @cindex accounts
14248 @cindex user accounts
14249 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
14250 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
14251 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
14252
14253 @lisp
14254 (user-account
14255 (name "alice")
14256 (group "users")
14257 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
14258 "audio" ;sound card
14259 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
14260 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
14261 (comment "Bob's sister"))
14262 @end lisp
14263
14264 Here's a user account that uses a different shell and a custom home
14265 directory (the default would be @file{"/home/bob"}):
14266
14267 @lisp
14268 (user-account
14269 (name "bob")
14270 (group "users")
14271 (comment "Alice's bro")
14272 (shell (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh"))
14273 (home-directory "/home/robert"))
14274 @end lisp
14275
14276 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
14277 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
14278 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
14279 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
14280 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
14281 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
14282 as declared.
14283
14284 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
14285 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
14286 be specified:
14287
14288 @table @asis
14289 @item @code{name}
14290 The name of the user account.
14291
14292 @item @code{group}
14293 @cindex groups
14294 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
14295 this account belongs to.
14296
14297 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
14298 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
14299 account belongs to.
14300
14301 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
14302 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
14303 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
14304 account is created.
14305
14306 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
14307 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
14308
14309 @item @code{home-directory}
14310 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
14311
14312 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
14313 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
14314 if it does not exist yet.
14315
14316 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
14317 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
14318 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}). For example, you would refer to the
14319 Bash executable like this:
14320
14321 @lisp
14322 (file-append bash "/bin/bash")
14323 @end lisp
14324
14325 @noindent
14326 ... and to the Zsh executable like that:
14327
14328 @lisp
14329 (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh")
14330 @end lisp
14331
14332 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14333 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
14334 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
14335 graphical login managers do not list them.
14336
14337 @anchor{user-account-password}
14338 @cindex password, for user accounts
14339 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14340 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
14341 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
14342 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
14343 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
14344 reconfiguration.
14345
14346 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
14347 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
14348 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
14349
14350 @lisp
14351 (user-account
14352 (name "charlie")
14353 (group "users")
14354
14355 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
14356 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
14357 @end lisp
14358
14359 @quotation Note
14360 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
14361 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
14362 care.
14363 @end quotation
14364
14365 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
14366 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
14367 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
14368
14369 @end table
14370 @end deftp
14371
14372 @cindex groups
14373 User group declarations are even simpler:
14374
14375 @lisp
14376 (user-group (name "students"))
14377 @end lisp
14378
14379 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
14380 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
14381
14382 @table @asis
14383 @item @code{name}
14384 The name of the group.
14385
14386 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
14387 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
14388 automatically allocated when the group is created.
14389
14390 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14391 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
14392 System groups have low numerical IDs.
14393
14394 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14395 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
14396 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
14397
14398 @end table
14399 @end deftp
14400
14401 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
14402 expect:
14403
14404 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
14405 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
14406 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
14407 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
14408 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
14409 @end defvr
14410
14411 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
14412 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
14413 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
14414
14415 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
14416 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
14417 @end defvr
14418
14419 @node Keyboard Layout
14420 @section Keyboard Layout
14421
14422 @cindex keyboard layout
14423 @cindex keymap
14424 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
14425 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
14426 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
14427 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
14428 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
14429 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
14430 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
14431
14432 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
14433 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
14434
14435 @itemize
14436 @item
14437 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
14438 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
14439 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
14440 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
14441
14442 @item
14443 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
14444 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14445 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14446
14447 @item
14448 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
14449 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14450 @end itemize
14451
14452 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
14453 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
14454
14455 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
14456 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
14457 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
14458 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
14459 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
14460 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
14461 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
14462 about.
14463
14464 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} keyboard-layout @var{name} [@var{variant}] @
14465 [#:model] [#:options '()]
14466 Return a new keyboard layout with the given @var{name} and @var{variant}.
14467
14468 @var{name} must be a string such as @code{"fr"}; @var{variant} must be a
14469 string such as @code{"bepo"} or @code{"nodeadkeys"}. See the
14470 @code{xkeyboard-config} package for valid options.
14471 @end deffn
14472
14473 Here are a few examples:
14474
14475 @lisp
14476 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
14477 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
14478 (keyboard-layout "de")
14479
14480 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
14481 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
14482
14483 ;; The Catalan layout.
14484 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
14485
14486 ;; Arabic layout with "Alt-Shift" to switch to US layout.
14487 (keyboard-layout "ar,us" #:options '("grp:alt_shift_toggle"))
14488
14489 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
14490 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
14491 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
14492 ;; accented letters.
14493 (keyboard-layout "latam"
14494 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
14495
14496 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
14497 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
14498
14499 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
14500 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
14501 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
14502 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
14503 @end lisp
14504
14505 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
14506 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
14507
14508 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
14509 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
14510 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
14511 configuration would look like:
14512
14513 @findex set-xorg-configuration
14514 @lisp
14515 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
14516 ;; and for Xorg.
14517
14518 (operating-system
14519 ;; ...
14520 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
14521 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
14522 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
14523 (target "/boot/efi")
14524 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
14525 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
14526 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
14527 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
14528 %desktop-services)))
14529 @end lisp
14530
14531 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
14532 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
14533 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
14534 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
14535 GDM.
14536
14537 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
14538 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
14539
14540 @itemize
14541 @item
14542 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
14543 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
14544
14545 @item
14546 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
14547 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
14548 change the layout to US Dvorak:
14549
14550 @example
14551 setxkbmap us dvorak
14552 @end example
14553
14554 @item
14555 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
14556 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
14557 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
14558 French bépo layout:
14559
14560 @example
14561 loadkeys fr-bepo
14562 @end example
14563 @end itemize
14564
14565 @node Locales
14566 @section Locales
14567
14568 @cindex locale
14569 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
14570 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14571 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
14572 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
14573 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
14574 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
14575
14576 @cindex locale definition
14577 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
14578 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
14579 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
14580
14581 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
14582 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
14583 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
14584 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
14585 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
14586 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
14587 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
14588 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
14589
14590 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
14591 that field may be:
14592
14593 @lisp
14594 (cons (locale-definition
14595 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
14596 %default-locale-definitions)
14597 @end lisp
14598
14599 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
14600 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
14601
14602 @lisp
14603 (list (locale-definition
14604 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
14605 (charset "EUC-JP")))
14606 @end lisp
14607
14608 @vindex LOCPATH
14609 The compiled locale definitions are available at
14610 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
14611 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
14612 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
14613 @env{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14614 @env{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14615
14616 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
14617 locale)} module. Details are given below.
14618
14619 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
14620 This is the data type of a locale definition.
14621
14622 @table @asis
14623
14624 @item @code{name}
14625 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14626 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
14627
14628 @item @code{source}
14629 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
14630 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
14631
14632 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
14633 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
14634 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
14635 IANA}.
14636
14637 @end table
14638 @end deftp
14639
14640 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
14641 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
14642 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
14643 declarations.
14644
14645 @cindex locale name
14646 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
14647 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
14648 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
14649 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
14650 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
14651 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
14652 @end defvr
14653
14654 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
14655
14656 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
14657 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
14658 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
14659 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
14660 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
14661 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
14662 another.
14663
14664 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
14665 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
14666 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
14667 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
14668 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
14669 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
14670 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
14671 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
14672 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @env{LC_COLLATE}
14673 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
14674 programs will not abort.
14675
14676 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
14677 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
14678 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
14679 used to build the system-wide locale data.
14680
14681 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
14682 and define @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14683 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14684
14685 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
14686 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
14687 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
14688 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
14689 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
14690 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
14691
14692 @lisp
14693 (use-package-modules base)
14694
14695 (operating-system
14696 ;; @dots{}
14697 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
14698 @end lisp
14699
14700 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
14701 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
14702 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
14703
14704
14705 @node Services
14706 @section Services
14707
14708 @cindex system services
14709 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
14710 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
14711 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
14712 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
14713 configuring network access.
14714
14715 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
14716 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
14717 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
14718 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
14719 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
14720 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
14721
14722 @example
14723 # herd status
14724 @end example
14725
14726 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
14727 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
14728 service and its associated actions:
14729
14730 @example
14731 # herd doc nscd
14732 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
14733
14734 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
14735 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
14736 @end example
14737
14738 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
14739 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
14740 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
14741
14742 @example
14743 # herd stop nscd
14744 Service nscd has been stopped.
14745 # herd restart xorg-server
14746 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
14747 Service xorg-server has been started.
14748 @end example
14749
14750 The following sections document the available services, starting with
14751 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
14752 declaration.
14753
14754 @menu
14755 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
14756 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
14757 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
14758 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
14759 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
14760 * X Window:: Graphical display.
14761 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
14762 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
14763 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
14764 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
14765 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
14766 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
14767 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
14768 * File-Sharing Services:: File-sharing services.
14769 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
14770 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
14771 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
14772 * Web Services:: Web servers.
14773 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
14774 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
14775 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
14776 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
14777 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
14778 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
14779 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
14780 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
14781 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
14782 * Game Services:: Game servers.
14783 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
14784 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
14785 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
14786 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
14787 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
14788 @end menu
14789
14790 @node Base Services
14791 @subsection Base Services
14792
14793 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
14794 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
14795 this module are listed below.
14796
14797 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
14798 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
14799 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
14800 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
14801 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
14802 more.
14803
14804 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
14805 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
14806 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
14807 this:
14808
14809 @lisp
14810 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
14811 (service openssh-service-type))
14812 %base-services)
14813 @end lisp
14814 @end defvr
14815
14816 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
14817 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
14818 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
14819
14820 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
14821 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
14822 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
14823
14824 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
14825 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
14826 @lisp
14827 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
14828 @end lisp
14829
14830 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
14831 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
14832 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
14833 change it to:
14834
14835 @lisp
14836 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
14837 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
14838 @end lisp
14839
14840 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
14841 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
14842 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
14843 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
14844 (see below).
14845 @end defvr
14846
14847 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
14848 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
14849
14850 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
14851 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
14852 symlink:
14853
14854 @lisp
14855 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
14856 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
14857 @end lisp
14858 @end deffn
14859
14860 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
14861 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
14862 @end deffn
14863
14864 @defvr {Scheme Variable} console-font-service-type
14865 Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
14866 virtual console on the kernel Linux). The value of this service is a list of
14867 tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the @code{kbd}
14868 package or any valid argument to @command{setfont}, as in this example:
14869
14870 @lisp
14871 `(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
14872 ("tty2" . ,(file-append
14873 font-tamzen
14874 "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
14875 ("tty3" . ,(file-append
14876 font-terminus
14877 "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
14878 @end lisp
14879 @end defvr
14880
14881 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
14882 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
14883 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
14884 among other things.
14885 @end deffn
14886
14887 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
14888 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
14889
14890 @table @asis
14891
14892 @item @code{motd}
14893 @cindex message of the day
14894 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
14895
14896 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14897 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
14898 the 'root' account has just been created.
14899
14900 @end table
14901 @end deftp
14902
14903 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
14904 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
14905 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
14906 other things.
14907 @end deffn
14908
14909 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
14910 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
14911 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
14912
14913 @table @asis
14914
14915 @item @code{tty}
14916 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
14917
14918 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14919 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
14920 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
14921 user name and password must be entered to log in.
14922
14923 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
14924 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
14925 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
14926 the name of the log-in program.
14927
14928 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
14929 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
14930 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
14931
14932 @item @code{clear-on-logout?} (default: @code{#t})
14933 When set to @code{#t}, the screen will be cleared after logout.
14934
14935 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
14936 The Mingetty package to use.
14937
14938 @end table
14939 @end deftp
14940
14941 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
14942 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
14943 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
14944 among other things.
14945 @end deffn
14946
14947 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
14948 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
14949 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
14950 man page for more information.
14951
14952 @table @asis
14953
14954 @item @code{tty}
14955 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
14956 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
14957 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
14958
14959 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
14960 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
14961 from it and use that.
14962
14963 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
14964 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
14965 serial port from it and use that.
14966
14967 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
14968 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
14969 correct values.
14970
14971 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
14972 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
14973 descending order.
14974
14975 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
14976 A string containing the value used for the @env{TERM} environment
14977 variable.
14978
14979 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
14980 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
14981 disabled.
14982
14983 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14984 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
14985 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
14986
14987 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
14988 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
14989
14990 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
14991 This accepts a string containing the ``login_host'', which will be written
14992 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
14993
14994 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
14995 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
14996 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
14997 specified in @var{login-program}.
14998
14999 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
15000 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
15001
15002 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
15003 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
15004 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
15005
15006 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
15007 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
15008 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
15009
15010 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
15011 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
15012 the login prompt.
15013
15014 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
15015 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
15016 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
15017 Shadow tool suite.
15018
15019 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
15020 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
15021 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
15022 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
15023
15024 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
15025 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
15026 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
15027
15028 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
15029 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
15030 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
15031 systems.
15032
15033 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
15034 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
15035 @file{/etc/issue} file.
15036
15037 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
15038 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
15039 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
15040 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
15041 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
15042 options that could be parsed by the login program.
15043
15044 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
15045 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
15046 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
15047 lazily spawning shells.
15048
15049 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
15050 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
15051 path as a string.
15052
15053 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
15054 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
15055 specified terminal.
15056
15057 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
15058 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
15059 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
15060 character.
15061
15062 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
15063 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
15064 within @var{timeout} seconds.
15065
15066 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
15067 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
15068 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
15069 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
15070 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
15071 Unicode characters.
15072
15073 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
15074 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
15075 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
15076 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
15077 @var{init-string} option.
15078
15079 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
15080 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
15081 locks.
15082
15083 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15084 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
15085 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
15086
15087 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15088 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
15089 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
15090 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
15091
15092 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15093 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
15094 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
15095
15096 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15097 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean ``ignore
15098 all previous characters'' (also called a ``kill'' character) when the user
15099 types their login name.
15100
15101 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
15102 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
15103 to before login.
15104
15105 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
15106 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
15107 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
15108
15109 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
15110 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
15111 @command{login} program.
15112
15113 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15114 This option provides an ``escape hatch'' for the user to provide arbitrary
15115 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
15116
15117 @end table
15118 @end deftp
15119
15120 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
15121 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
15122 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
15123 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
15124 @end deffn
15125
15126 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
15127 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
15128 implements virtual console log-in.
15129
15130 @table @asis
15131
15132 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
15133 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
15134
15135 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
15136 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
15137 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
15138
15139 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
15140 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
15141
15142 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
15143 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
15144 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
15145
15146 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
15147 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
15148
15149 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
15150 The Kmscon package to use.
15151
15152 @end table
15153 @end deftp
15154
15155 @cindex name service cache daemon
15156 @cindex nscd
15157 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
15158 [#:name-services '()]
15159 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
15160 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
15161 Service Switch}, for an example.
15162
15163 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
15164
15165 @table @code
15166 @item invalidate
15167 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
15168 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
15169 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
15170
15171 @example
15172 herd invalidate nscd hosts
15173 @end example
15174
15175 @noindent
15176 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
15177
15178 @item statistics
15179 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
15180 and caches.
15181 @end table
15182
15183 @end deffn
15184
15185 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
15186 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
15187 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
15188 @code{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
15189 @end defvr
15190
15191 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
15192 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
15193 configuration.
15194
15195 @table @asis
15196
15197 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
15198 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
15199 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
15200
15201 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
15202 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
15203 command.
15204
15205 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
15206 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
15207 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
15208
15209 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
15210 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
15211 debugging output is logged.
15212
15213 @item @code{caches} (default: @code{%nscd-default-caches})
15214 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
15215 below.
15216
15217 @end table
15218 @end deftp
15219
15220 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
15221 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
15222
15223 @table @asis
15224
15225 @item @code{database}
15226 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
15227 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
15228 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
15229 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
15230
15231 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
15232 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
15233 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
15234 negative lookup result remains in cache.
15235
15236 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
15237 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
15238 @var{database}.
15239
15240 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
15241 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
15242 them into account.
15243
15244 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
15245 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
15246
15247 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
15248 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
15249
15250 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
15251 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
15252
15253 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
15254 @c settings, so leave them out.
15255
15256 @end table
15257 @end deftp
15258
15259 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
15260 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
15261 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
15262
15263 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
15264 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
15265 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
15266 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
15267 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
15268 @end defvr
15269
15270 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
15271 @cindex syslog
15272 @cindex logging
15273 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
15274 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
15275
15276 @table @asis
15277 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
15278 The syslog daemon to use.
15279
15280 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
15281 The syslog configuration file to use.
15282
15283 @end table
15284 @end deftp
15285
15286 @anchor{syslog-service}
15287 @cindex syslog
15288 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
15289 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
15290
15291 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
15292 information on the configuration file syntax.
15293 @end deffn
15294
15295 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
15296 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
15297 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
15298 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
15299 @end defvr
15300
15301 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
15302 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
15303 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
15304 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
15305
15306 @table @asis
15307 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
15308 The Guix package to use.
15309
15310 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
15311 Name of the group for build user accounts.
15312
15313 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
15314 Number of build user accounts to create.
15315
15316 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
15317 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
15318 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
15319 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
15320 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15321
15322 When @code{authorize-key?} is true, @file{/etc/guix/acl} cannot be
15323 changed by invoking @command{guix archive --authorize}. You must
15324 instead adjust @code{guix-configuration} as you wish and reconfigure the
15325 system. This ensures that your operating system configuration file is
15326 self-contained.
15327
15328 @quotation Note
15329 When booting or reconfiguring to a system where @code{authorize-key?}
15330 is true, the existing @file{/etc/guix/acl} file is backed up as
15331 @file{/etc/guix/acl.bak} if it was determined to be a manually modified
15332 file. This is to facilitate migration from earlier versions, which
15333 allowed for in-place modifications to @file{/etc/guix/acl}.
15334 @end quotation
15335
15336 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
15337 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
15338 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
15339 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
15340 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15341 See @code{substitute-urls} below for an example on how to change it.
15342
15343 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
15344 Whether to use substitutes.
15345
15346 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
15347 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
15348
15349 Suppose you would like to fetch substitutes from @code{guix.example.org}
15350 in addition to @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. You will need to do
15351 two things: (1) add @code{guix.example.org} to @code{substitute-urls},
15352 and (2) authorize its signing key, having done appropriate checks
15353 (@pxref{Substitute Server Authorization}). The configuration below does
15354 exactly that:
15355
15356 @lisp
15357 (guix-configuration
15358 (substitute-urls
15359 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
15360 %default-substitute-urls))
15361 (authorized-keys
15362 (append (list (local-file "./guix.example.org-key.pub"))
15363 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))
15364 @end lisp
15365
15366 This example assumes that the file @file{./guix.example.org-key.pub}
15367 contains the public key that @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign
15368 substitutes.
15369
15370 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
15371 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
15372 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
15373 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
15374 disables the timeout.
15375
15376 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
15377 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
15378 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
15379
15380 @item @code{discover?} (default: @code{#f})
15381 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
15382 and DNS-SD.
15383
15384 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15385 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
15386
15387 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
15388 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
15389 are written.
15390
15391 @cindex HTTP proxy, for @code{guix-daemon}
15392 @cindex proxy, for @code{guix-daemon} HTTP access
15393 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
15394 The URL of the HTTP and HTTPS proxy used for downloading fixed-output
15395 derivations and substitutes.
15396
15397 It is also possible to change the daemon's proxy at run time through the
15398 @code{set-http-proxy} action, which restarts it:
15399
15400 @example
15401 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon http://localhost:8118
15402 @end example
15403
15404 To clear the proxy settings, run:
15405
15406 @example
15407 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon
15408 @end example
15409
15410 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
15411 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
15412
15413 @end table
15414 @end deftp
15415
15416 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
15417 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
15418 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
15419 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule}, @code{udev-rules-service}
15420 and @code{file->udev-rule} from @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the
15421 creation of such rule files.
15422
15423 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
15424 directory containing all the active udev rules.
15425 @end deffn
15426
15427 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
15428 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
15429 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
15430
15431 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
15432 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
15433 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
15434
15435 @lisp
15436 (define %example-udev-rule
15437 (udev-rule
15438 "90-usb-thing.rules"
15439 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
15440 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
15441 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
15442 @end lisp
15443 @end deffn
15444
15445 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rules-service [@var{name} @var{rules}] @
15446 [#:groups @var{groups}]
15447 Return a service that extends @code{udev-service-type } with @var{rules}
15448 and @code{account-service-type} with @var{groups} as system groups.
15449 This works by creating a singleton service type
15450 @code{@var{name}-udev-rules}, of which the returned service is an
15451 instance.
15452
15453 Here we show how it can be used to extend @code{udev-service-type} with the
15454 previously defined rule @code{%example-udev-rule}.
15455
15456 @lisp
15457 (operating-system
15458 ;; @dots{}
15459 (services
15460 (cons (udev-rules-service 'usb-thing %example-udev-rule)
15461 %desktop-services)))
15462 @end lisp
15463 @end deffn
15464
15465 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
15466 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
15467 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
15468
15469 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
15470
15471 @lisp
15472 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
15473 (guix packages) ;for origin
15474 @dots{})
15475
15476 (define %android-udev-rules
15477 (file->udev-rule
15478 "51-android-udev.rules"
15479 (let ((version "20170910"))
15480 (origin
15481 (method url-fetch)
15482 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
15483 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
15484 (sha256
15485 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
15486 @end lisp
15487 @end deffn
15488
15489 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
15490 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
15491 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
15492 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
15493 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
15494 packages android)} module.
15495
15496 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
15497 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
15498 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
15499 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
15500 the rules defined within the @code{android-udev-rules} package. To
15501 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
15502 @code{supplementary-groups} of our @code{user-account} declaration, as
15503 well as in the @var{groups} of the @code{udev-rules-service} procedure.
15504
15505 @lisp
15506 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
15507 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
15508 @dots{})
15509
15510 (operating-system
15511 ;; @dots{}
15512 (users (cons (user-account
15513 ;; @dots{}
15514 (supplementary-groups
15515 '("adbusers" ;for adb
15516 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
15517 ;; @dots{}
15518 (services
15519 (cons (udev-rules-service 'android android-udev-rules
15520 #:groups '("adbusers"))
15521 %desktop-services)))
15522 @end lisp
15523
15524 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
15525 Save some entropy in @code{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
15526 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
15527 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
15528 readable.
15529 @end defvr
15530
15531 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
15532 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
15533 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
15534 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
15535 @end defvr
15536
15537 @cindex mouse
15538 @cindex gpm
15539 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
15540 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
15541 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
15542 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
15543 and paste text.
15544
15545 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
15546 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
15547 @end defvr
15548
15549 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
15550 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
15551
15552 @table @asis
15553 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
15554 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
15555 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
15556 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
15557 more information.
15558
15559 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
15560 The GPM package to use.
15561
15562 @end table
15563 @end deftp
15564
15565 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
15566 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
15567 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
15568 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
15569 object, as described below.
15570
15571 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
15572 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
15573 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
15574 @end deffn
15575
15576 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
15577 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
15578 service.
15579
15580 @table @asis
15581 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
15582 The Guix package to use.
15583
15584 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
15585 The TCP port to listen for connections.
15586
15587 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
15588 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
15589 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
15590
15591 @item @code{advertise?} (default: @code{#f})
15592 When true, advertise the service on the local network @i{via} the DNS-SD
15593 protocol, using Avahi.
15594
15595 This allows neighboring Guix devices with discovery on (see
15596 @code{guix-configuration} above) to discover this @command{guix publish}
15597 instance and to automatically download substitutes from it.
15598
15599 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
15600 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
15601 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
15602 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
15603
15604 @lisp
15605 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
15606 @end lisp
15607
15608 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
15609 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression. @xref{Invoking guix
15610 publish}, for more information on the available compression methods and
15611 the tradeoffs involved.
15612
15613 An empty list disables compression altogether.
15614
15615 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
15616 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
15617 publish, @option{--nar-path}}, for details.
15618
15619 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
15620 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
15621 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
15622 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
15623 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15624 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
15625
15626 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
15627 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
15628 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
15629 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
15630
15631 @item @code{cache-bypass-threshold} (default: 10 MiB)
15632 When @code{cache} is true, this is the maximum size in bytes of a store
15633 item for which @command{guix publish} may bypass its cache in case of a
15634 cache miss. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15635 @option{--cache-bypass-threshold}}, for more information.
15636
15637 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
15638 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
15639 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
15640 for more information.
15641 @end table
15642 @end deftp
15643
15644 @anchor{rngd-service}
15645 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
15646 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
15647 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
15648 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
15649 @var{device} does not exist.
15650 @end deffn
15651
15652 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
15653 @cindex session limits
15654 @cindex ulimit
15655 @cindex priority
15656 @cindex realtime
15657 @cindex jackd
15658 @cindex nofile
15659 @cindex open file descriptors
15660 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
15661
15662 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
15663 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
15664 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
15665 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
15666 @code{ulimit} limits and @code{nice} priority limits to user sessions.
15667
15668 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
15669 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
15670
15671 @lisp
15672 (pam-limits-service
15673 (list
15674 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
15675 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
15676 @end lisp
15677
15678 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
15679 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
15680 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
15681 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
15682
15683 Another useful example is raising the maximum number of open file
15684 descriptors that can be used:
15685
15686 @lisp
15687 (pam-limits-service
15688 (list
15689 (pam-limits-entry "*" 'both 'nofile 100000)))
15690 @end lisp
15691
15692 In the above example, the asterisk means the limit should apply to any
15693 user. It is important to ensure the chosen value doesn't exceed the
15694 maximum system value visible in the @file{/proc/sys/fs/file-max} file,
15695 else the users would be prevented from login in. For more information
15696 about the Pluggable Authentication Module (PAM) limits, refer to the
15697 @samp{pam_limits} man page from the @code{linux-pam} package.
15698 @end deffn
15699
15700 @node Scheduled Job Execution
15701 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
15702
15703 @cindex cron
15704 @cindex mcron
15705 @cindex scheduling jobs
15706 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
15707 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
15708 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
15709 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
15710 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
15711 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
15712
15713 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
15714 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
15715 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
15716 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
15717 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
15718 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
15719 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
15720
15721 @lisp
15722 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
15723 (use-package-modules base idutils)
15724
15725 (define updatedb-job
15726 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
15727 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
15728 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
15729 (lambda ()
15730 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
15731 "updatedb"
15732 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
15733
15734 (define garbage-collector-job
15735 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
15736 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
15737 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
15738 "guix gc -F 1G"))
15739
15740 (define idutils-job
15741 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
15742 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
15743 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
15744 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
15745 #:user "charlie"))
15746
15747 (operating-system
15748 ;; @dots{}
15749
15750 ;; %BASE-SERVICES already includes an instance of
15751 ;; 'mcron-service-type', which we extend with additional
15752 ;; jobs using 'simple-service'.
15753 (services (cons (simple-service 'my-cron-jobs
15754 mcron-service-type
15755 (list garbage-collector-job
15756 updatedb-job
15757 idutils-job))
15758 %base-services)))
15759 @end lisp
15760
15761 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
15762 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
15763 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
15764 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
15765 illustrates that.
15766
15767 @lisp
15768 (define %battery-alert-job
15769 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
15770 #~(job
15771 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
15772 #$(program-file
15773 "battery-alert.scm"
15774 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
15775 '((guix build utils)))
15776 #~(begin
15777 (use-modules (guix build utils)
15778 (ice-9 popen)
15779 (ice-9 regex)
15780 (ice-9 textual-ports)
15781 (srfi srfi-2))
15782
15783 (define %min-level 20)
15784
15785 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
15786 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
15787 OPEN_READ
15788 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
15789 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
15790 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
15791 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
15792 ((< level %min-level)))
15793 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
15794 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
15795 @end lisp
15796
15797 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
15798 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
15799 reference of the mcron service.
15800
15801 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
15802 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
15803
15804 @example
15805 # herd schedule mcron
15806 @end example
15807
15808 @noindent
15809 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
15810 also specify the number of tasks to display:
15811
15812 @example
15813 # herd schedule mcron 10
15814 @end example
15815
15816 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
15817 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
15818 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
15819
15820 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
15821 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
15822 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
15823 mcron jobs to run.
15824 @end defvr
15825
15826 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
15827 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
15828
15829 @table @asis
15830 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
15831 The mcron package to use.
15832
15833 @item @code{jobs}
15834 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
15835 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
15836 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
15837 @end table
15838 @end deftp
15839
15840
15841 @node Log Rotation
15842 @subsection Log Rotation
15843
15844 @cindex rottlog
15845 @cindex log rotation
15846 @cindex logging
15847 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
15848 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
15849 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
15850 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
15851 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15852
15853 This service is part of @code{%base-services}, and thus enabled by
15854 default, with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
15855 The example below shows how to extend it with an additional
15856 @dfn{rotation}, should you need to do that (usually, services that
15857 produce log files already take care of that):
15858
15859 @lisp
15860 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
15861 (use-service-modules admin)
15862
15863 (define my-log-files
15864 ;; Log files that I want to rotate.
15865 '("/var/log/something.log" "/var/log/another.log"))
15866
15867 (operating-system
15868 ;; @dots{}
15869 (services (cons (simple-service 'rotate-my-stuff
15870 rottlog-service-type
15871 (list (log-rotation
15872 (frequency 'daily)
15873 (files my-log-files))))
15874 %base-services)))
15875 @end lisp
15876
15877 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
15878 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
15879 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
15880
15881 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
15882 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
15883
15884 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
15885 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
15886 @end defvr
15887
15888 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
15889 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
15890
15891 @table @asis
15892 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
15893 The Rottlog package to use.
15894
15895 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
15896 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
15897 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15898
15899 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
15900 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
15901
15902 @item @code{jobs}
15903 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
15904 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
15905 @end table
15906 @end deftp
15907
15908 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
15909 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
15910
15911 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
15912 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
15913 defined like this:
15914
15915 @lisp
15916 (log-rotation
15917 (frequency 'daily)
15918 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
15919 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
15920 "rotate 6"
15921 "notifempty"
15922 "nocompress")))
15923 @end lisp
15924
15925 The list of fields is as follows:
15926
15927 @table @asis
15928 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
15929 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
15930
15931 @item @code{files}
15932 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
15933
15934 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
15935 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
15936 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
15937
15938 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
15939 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
15940 @end table
15941 @end deftp
15942
15943 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
15944 Specifies weekly rotation of @code{%rotated-files} and of
15945 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
15946 @end defvr
15947
15948 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
15949 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
15950 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
15951 "/var/log/maillog")}.
15952 @end defvr
15953
15954 @node Networking Services
15955 @subsection Networking Services
15956
15957 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
15958 the network interface.
15959
15960 @cindex DHCP, networking service
15961 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
15962 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
15963 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
15964 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
15965 @end defvr
15966
15967 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
15968 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
15969 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
15970 For example:
15971
15972 @lisp
15973 (service dhcpd-service-type
15974 (dhcpd-configuration
15975 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
15976 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
15977 @end lisp
15978 @end deffn
15979
15980 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
15981 @table @asis
15982 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
15983 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
15984 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
15985 directory. The default package is the
15986 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
15987 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
15988 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
15989 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
15990 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
15991 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
15992 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
15993 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
15994 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
15995 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
15996 details.
15997 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
15998 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
15999 will be created if it does not exist.
16000 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
16001 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
16002 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
16003 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
16004 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
16005 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
16006 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
16007 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
16008 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
16009 @end table
16010 @end deftp
16011
16012 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
16013 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
16014 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
16015 @end defvr
16016
16017 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
16018 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
16019 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
16020 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
16021 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
16022 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
16023 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
16024 interface.
16025
16026 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
16027 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
16028 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
16029 to handle.
16030
16031 For example:
16032
16033 @lisp
16034 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
16035 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
16036 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
16037 @end lisp
16038 @end deffn
16039
16040 @cindex wicd
16041 @cindex wireless
16042 @cindex WiFi
16043 @cindex network management
16044 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
16045 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
16046 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
16047
16048 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
16049 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
16050 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
16051 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
16052 @end deffn
16053
16054 @cindex ModemManager
16055
16056 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
16057 This is the service type for the
16058 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
16059 service. The value for this service type is a
16060 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
16061
16062 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16063 Services}).
16064 @end defvr
16065
16066 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
16067 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
16068
16069 @table @asis
16070 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
16071 The ModemManager package to use.
16072
16073 @end table
16074 @end deftp
16075
16076 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
16077 @cindex Modeswitching
16078
16079 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
16080 This is the service type for the
16081 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch}
16082 service. The value for this service type is
16083 a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
16084
16085 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
16086 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
16087 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
16088 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
16089 plugged in.
16090
16091 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16092 Services}).
16093 @end defvr
16094
16095 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
16096 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
16097
16098 @table @asis
16099 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
16100 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
16101
16102 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
16103 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
16104 USB_ModeSwitch.
16105
16106 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
16107 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
16108 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
16109 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
16110 file is used.
16111
16112 @end table
16113 @end deftp
16114
16115 @cindex NetworkManager
16116
16117 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
16118 This is the service type for the
16119 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
16120 service. The value for this service type is a
16121 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
16122
16123 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16124 Services}).
16125 @end defvr
16126
16127 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
16128 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
16129
16130 @table @asis
16131 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
16132 The NetworkManager package to use.
16133
16134 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
16135 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
16136 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
16137
16138 @table @samp
16139 @item default
16140 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
16141 provided by currently active connections.
16142
16143 @item dnsmasq
16144 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
16145 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
16146 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
16147
16148 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
16149 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
16150 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
16151 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
16152 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
16153
16154 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
16155 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
16156 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
16157 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
16158 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
16159 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
16160
16161 @example
16162 nmcli connection add type tun \
16163 connection.interface-name tap0 \
16164 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
16165 ipv4.method shared \
16166 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
16167 @end example
16168
16169 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
16170 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
16171 @command{qemu-system-...}.
16172
16173 @item none
16174 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
16175 @end table
16176
16177 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
16178 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
16179 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
16180 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
16181
16182 @end table
16183 @end deftp
16184
16185 @cindex Connman
16186 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
16187 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
16188 a network connection manager.
16189
16190 Its value must be an
16191 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
16192
16193 @lisp
16194 (service connman-service-type
16195 (connman-configuration
16196 (disable-vpn? #t)))
16197 @end lisp
16198
16199 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
16200 @end deffn
16201
16202 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
16203 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
16204
16205 @table @asis
16206 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
16207 The connman package to use.
16208
16209 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
16210 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
16211 @end table
16212 @end deftp
16213
16214 @cindex WPA Supplicant
16215 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
16216 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
16217 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
16218 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
16219 @end defvr
16220
16221 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
16222 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
16223
16224 It takes the following parameters:
16225
16226 @table @asis
16227 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
16228 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
16229
16230 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'(user-processes loopback syslogd)}
16231 List of services that should be started before WPA Supplicant starts.
16232
16233 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
16234 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
16235
16236 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
16237 Where to store the PID file.
16238
16239 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
16240 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
16241 WPA supplicant will control.
16242
16243 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16244 Optional configuration file to use.
16245
16246 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
16247 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
16248 @end table
16249 @end deftp
16250
16251 @cindex hostapd service, for Wi-Fi access points
16252 @cindex Wi-Fi access points, hostapd service
16253 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hostapd-service-type
16254 This is the service type to run the @uref{https://w1.fi/hostapd/,
16255 hostapd} daemon to set up WiFi (IEEE 802.11) access points and
16256 authentication servers. Its associated value must be a
16257 @code{hostapd-configuration} as shown below:
16258
16259 @lisp
16260 ;; Use wlan1 to run the access point for "My Network".
16261 (service hostapd-service-type
16262 (hostapd-configuration
16263 (interface "wlan1")
16264 (ssid "My Network")
16265 (channel 12)))
16266 @end lisp
16267 @end defvr
16268
16269 @deftp {Data Type} hostapd-configuration
16270 This data type represents the configuration of the hostapd service, with
16271 the following fields:
16272
16273 @table @asis
16274 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hostapd})
16275 The hostapd package to use.
16276
16277 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wlan0"})
16278 The network interface to run the WiFi access point.
16279
16280 @item @code{ssid}
16281 The SSID (@dfn{service set identifier}), a string that identifies this
16282 network.
16283
16284 @item @code{broadcast-ssid?} (default: @code{#t})
16285 Whether to broadcast this SSID.
16286
16287 @item @code{channel} (default: @code{1})
16288 The WiFi channel to use.
16289
16290 @item @code{driver} (default: @code{"nl80211"})
16291 The driver interface type. @code{"nl80211"} is used with all Linux
16292 mac80211 drivers. Use @code{"none"} if building hostapd as a standalone
16293 RADIUS server that does # not control any wireless/wired driver.
16294
16295 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
16296 Extra settings to append as-is to the hostapd configuration file. See
16297 @uref{https://w1.fi/cgit/hostap/plain/hostapd/hostapd.conf} for the
16298 configuration file reference.
16299 @end table
16300 @end deftp
16301
16302 @defvr {Scheme Variable} simulated-wifi-service-type
16303 This is the type of a service to simulate WiFi networking, which can be
16304 useful in virtual machines for testing purposes. The service loads the
16305 Linux kernel
16306 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/mac80211_hwsim/mac80211_hwsim.html,
16307 @code{mac80211_hwsim} module} and starts hostapd to create a pseudo WiFi
16308 network that can be seen on @code{wlan0}, by default.
16309
16310 The service's value is a @code{hostapd-configuration} record.
16311 @end defvr
16312
16313 @cindex iptables
16314 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
16315 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
16316 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
16317 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
16318 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
16319 22 is shown below.
16320
16321 @lisp
16322 (service iptables-service-type
16323 (iptables-configuration
16324 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
16325 :INPUT ACCEPT
16326 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16327 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16328 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16329 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
16330 COMMIT
16331 "))
16332 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
16333 :INPUT ACCEPT
16334 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16335 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16336 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16337 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
16338 COMMIT
16339 "))))
16340 @end lisp
16341 @end defvr
16342
16343 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
16344 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
16345
16346 @table @asis
16347 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
16348 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
16349 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16350 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16351 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
16352 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16353 objects}).
16354 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16355 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16356 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16357 objects}).
16358 @end table
16359 @end deftp
16360
16361 @cindex nftables
16362 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
16363 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
16364 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
16365 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
16366 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
16367 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
16368 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
16369 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
16370
16371 @lisp
16372 (service nftables-service-type)
16373 @end lisp
16374 @end defvr
16375
16376 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
16377 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
16378
16379 @table @asis
16380 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
16381 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
16382 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
16383 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
16384 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
16385 @end table
16386 @end deftp
16387
16388 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
16389 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
16390 @cindex real time clock
16391 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
16392 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
16393 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
16394 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
16395
16396 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
16397 below.
16398 @end defvr
16399
16400 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
16401 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
16402
16403 @table @asis
16404 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
16405 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
16406 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
16407 definition below.
16408
16409 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
16410 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
16411 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
16412
16413 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
16414 The NTP package to use.
16415 @end table
16416 @end deftp
16417
16418 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
16419 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
16420 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
16421 @end defvr
16422
16423 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
16424 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
16425
16426 @table @asis
16427 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
16428 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
16429 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
16430
16431 @item @code{address}
16432 The address of the server, as a string.
16433
16434 @item @code{options}
16435 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
16436 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
16437 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
16438 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
16439
16440 @example
16441 (ntp-server
16442 (type 'server)
16443 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
16444 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
16445 @end example
16446 @end table
16447 @end deftp
16448
16449 @cindex OpenNTPD
16450 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
16451 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
16452 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
16453 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
16454
16455 @lisp
16456 (service
16457 openntpd-service-type
16458 (openntpd-configuration
16459 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
16460 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
16461 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
16462 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))))
16463
16464 @end lisp
16465 @end deffn
16466
16467 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
16468 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
16469 @code{%ntp-servers}.
16470 @end defvr
16471
16472 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
16473 @table @asis
16474 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
16475 The openntpd executable to use.
16476 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
16477 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
16478 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
16479 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
16480 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
16481 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
16482 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
16483 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
16484 information.
16485 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
16486 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
16487 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%openntp-servers})
16488 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
16489 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
16490 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
16491 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
16492 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
16493 man-in-the-middle attacks.
16494 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
16495 a constraint.
16496 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
16497 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
16498 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
16499 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
16500 @end table
16501 @end deftp
16502
16503 @cindex inetd
16504 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
16505 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
16506 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
16507 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
16508 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
16509
16510 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
16511 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
16512 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
16513 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
16514 gateway @code{hostname}:
16515
16516 @lisp
16517 (service
16518 inetd-service-type
16519 (inetd-configuration
16520 (entries (list
16521 (inetd-entry
16522 (name "echo")
16523 (socket-type 'stream)
16524 (protocol "tcp")
16525 (wait? #f)
16526 (user "root"))
16527 (inetd-entry
16528 (node "127.0.0.1")
16529 (name "smtp")
16530 (socket-type 'stream)
16531 (protocol "tcp")
16532 (wait? #f)
16533 (user "root")
16534 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
16535 (arguments
16536 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
16537 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
16538 @end lisp
16539
16540 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
16541 @end deffn
16542
16543 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
16544 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
16545
16546 @table @asis
16547 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
16548 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
16549
16550 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
16551 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
16552 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
16553 @end table
16554 @end deftp
16555
16556 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
16557 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
16558 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
16559 requests.
16560
16561 @table @asis
16562 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
16563 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
16564 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
16565 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
16566 description of all options.
16567 @item @code{name}
16568 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
16569 @item @code{socket-type}
16570 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
16571 @code{'seqpacket}.
16572 @item @code{protocol}
16573 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
16574 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
16575 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
16576 listening to new service requests.
16577 @item @code{user}
16578 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
16579 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
16580 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
16581 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
16582 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
16583 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
16584 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
16585 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
16586 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
16587 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
16588 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
16589 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
16590 @end table
16591
16592 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
16593 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
16594 @end deftp
16595
16596 @cindex Tor
16597 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
16598 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
16599 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
16600 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
16601 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
16602
16603 @end defvr
16604
16605 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
16606 @table @asis
16607 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
16608 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
16609 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
16610 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
16611 implementation.
16612
16613 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
16614 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
16615 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
16616 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
16617 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
16618 syntax.
16619
16620 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
16621 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
16622 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
16623 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
16624 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
16625 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
16626
16627 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
16628 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
16629 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
16630 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
16631 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
16632 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16633 @code{tor} group.
16634
16635 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
16636 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
16637 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
16638 @code{SocksPort} option.
16639
16640 @item @code{control-socket?} (default: @code{#f})
16641 Whether or not to provide a ``control socket'' by which Tor can be
16642 controlled to, for instance, dynamically instantiate tor onion services.
16643 If @code{#t}, Tor will listen for control commands on the UNIX domain socket
16644 @file{/var/run/tor/control-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16645 @code{tor} group.
16646
16647 @end table
16648 @end deftp
16649
16650 @cindex hidden service
16651 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
16652 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
16653 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
16654
16655 @example
16656 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
16657 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
16658 @end example
16659
16660 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
16661 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
16662
16663 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
16664 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
16665 service.
16666
16667 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
16668 project's documentation} for more information.
16669 @end deffn
16670
16671 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
16672
16673 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
16674 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
16675 files.
16676
16677 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
16678 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
16679 The value for this service type is a
16680 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
16681
16682 @lisp
16683 (service rsync-service-type)
16684 @end lisp
16685
16686 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
16687 @end deffn
16688
16689 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
16690 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
16691
16692 @table @asis
16693 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
16694 @code{rsync} package to use.
16695
16696 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
16697 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
16698 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
16699 @code{root} user and group.
16700
16701 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
16702 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
16703
16704 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
16705 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
16706
16707 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
16708 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
16709
16710 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
16711 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
16712
16713 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
16714 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16715
16716 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
16717 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16718
16719 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
16720 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
16721
16722 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
16723 I/O timeout in seconds.
16724
16725 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
16726 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
16727
16728 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
16729 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
16730
16731 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16732 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
16733 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
16734
16735 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16736 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
16737
16738 @end table
16739 @end deftp
16740
16741 The @code{(gnu services syncthing)} module provides the following services:
16742 @cindex syncthing
16743
16744 You might want a syncthing daemon if you have files between two or more
16745 computers and want to sync them in real time, safely protected from
16746 prying eyes.
16747
16748 @deffn {Scheme Variable} syncthing-service-type
16749 This is the service type for the @uref{https://syncthing.net/,
16750 syncthing} daemon, The value for this service type is a
16751 @command{syncthing-configuration} record as in this example:
16752
16753 @lisp
16754 (service syncthing-service-type
16755 (syncthing-configuration (user "alice")))
16756 @end lisp
16757
16758 See below for details about @code{syncthing-configuration}.
16759
16760 @deftp {Data Type} syncthing-configuration
16761 Data type representing the configuration for @code{syncthing-service-type}.
16762
16763 @table @asis
16764 @item @code{syncthing} (default: @var{syncthing})
16765 @code{syncthing} package to use.
16766
16767 @item @code{arguments} (default: @var{'()})
16768 List of command-line arguments passing to @code{syncthing} binary.
16769
16770 @item @code{logflags} (default: @var{0})
16771 Sum of loging flags, see
16772 @uref{https://docs.syncthing.net/users/syncthing.html#cmdoption-logflags, Syncthing documentation logflags}.
16773
16774 @item @code{user} (default: @var{#f})
16775 The user as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16776 This assumes that the specified user exists.
16777
16778 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"users"})
16779 The group as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16780 This assumes that the specified group exists.
16781
16782 @item @code{home} (default: @var{#f})
16783 Common configuration and data directory. The default configuration
16784 directory is @file{$HOME} of the specified Syncthing @code{user}.
16785
16786 @end table
16787 @end deftp
16788 @end deffn
16789
16790 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
16791 @cindex SSH
16792 @cindex SSH server
16793
16794 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
16795 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
16796 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
16797 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
16798 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
16799 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
16800 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
16801 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
16802 only by root.
16803
16804 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
16805 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
16806 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
16807 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
16808 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
16809
16810 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
16811 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
16812 require interaction.
16813
16814 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
16815 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
16816 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
16817 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
16818
16819 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
16820 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
16821 or addresses.
16822
16823 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
16824 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
16825 root.
16826
16827 The other options should be self-descriptive.
16828 @end deffn
16829
16830 @cindex SSH
16831 @cindex SSH server
16832 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
16833 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
16834 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
16835 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
16836
16837 @lisp
16838 (service openssh-service-type
16839 (openssh-configuration
16840 (x11-forwarding? #t)
16841 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
16842 (authorized-keys
16843 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
16844 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
16845 @end lisp
16846
16847 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
16848
16849 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
16850 example:
16851
16852 @lisp
16853 (service-extension openssh-service-type
16854 (const `(("charlie"
16855 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
16856 @end lisp
16857 @end deffn
16858
16859 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
16860 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
16861
16862 @table @asis
16863 @item @code{openssh} (default @var{openssh})
16864 The Openssh package to use.
16865
16866 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
16867 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
16868
16869 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
16870 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
16871
16872 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
16873 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
16874 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
16875 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
16876 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
16877
16878 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16879 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
16880 not.
16881
16882 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16883 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
16884 other authentication methods.
16885
16886 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16887 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
16888 false, users have to use other authentication method.
16889
16890 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16891 This is used only by protocol version 2.
16892
16893 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
16894 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
16895 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
16896 @option{-Y} will work.
16897
16898 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16899 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
16900
16901 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16902 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
16903
16904 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
16905 Whether to allow gateway ports.
16906
16907 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
16908 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
16909 PAM).
16910
16911 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
16912 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
16913 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
16914 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
16915 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
16916 module processing for all authentication types.
16917
16918 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
16919 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
16920 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
16921 @code{password-authentication?}.
16922
16923 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
16924 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
16925 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
16926
16927 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
16928 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
16929
16930 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
16931 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
16932 subsystem request.
16933
16934 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
16935 server. Alternatively, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
16936 @lisp
16937 (service openssh-service-type
16938 (openssh-configuration
16939 (subsystems
16940 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
16941 @end lisp
16942
16943 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
16944 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
16945
16946 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
16947 @code{man sshd_config}.
16948
16949 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @env{COLORTERM} variable.
16950 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
16951 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
16952 if this variable is set.
16953
16954 @lisp
16955 (service openssh-service-type
16956 (openssh-configuration
16957 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
16958 @end lisp
16959
16960 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
16961 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
16962 @cindex SSH authorized keys
16963 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
16964 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
16965 keys. For example:
16966
16967 @lisp
16968 (openssh-configuration
16969 (authorized-keys
16970 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
16971 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
16972 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
16973 @end lisp
16974
16975 @noindent
16976 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
16977 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
16978
16979 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
16980 @code{service-extension}.
16981
16982 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
16983 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16984
16985 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
16986 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
16987 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
16988 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
16989
16990 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
16991 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
16992 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
16993 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
16994 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
16995
16996 @lisp
16997 (openssh-configuration
16998 (extra-content "\
16999 Match Address 192.168.0.1
17000 PermitRootLogin yes"))
17001 @end lisp
17002
17003 @end table
17004 @end deftp
17005
17006 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
17007 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
17008 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
17009 object.
17010
17011 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
17012 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
17013
17014 @lisp
17015 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
17016 (port-number 1234)))
17017 @end lisp
17018 @end deffn
17019
17020 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
17021 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
17022
17023 @table @asis
17024 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
17025 The Dropbear package to use.
17026
17027 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
17028 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
17029
17030 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
17031 Whether to enable syslog output.
17032
17033 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
17034 File name of the daemon's PID file.
17035
17036 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17037 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
17038
17039 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
17040 Whether to allow empty passwords.
17041
17042 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
17043 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
17044 @end table
17045 @end deftp
17046
17047 @cindex AutoSSH
17048 @deffn {Scheme Variable} autossh-service-type
17049 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.harding.motd.ca/autossh,
17050 AutoSSH} program that runs a copy of @command{ssh} and monitors it,
17051 restarting it as necessary should it die or stop passing traffic.
17052 AutoSSH can be run manually from the command-line by passing arguments
17053 to the binary @command{autossh} from the package @code{autossh}, but it
17054 can also be run as a Guix service. This latter use case is documented
17055 here.
17056
17057 AutoSSH can be used to forward local traffic to a remote machine using
17058 an SSH tunnel, and it respects the @file{~/.ssh/config} of the user it
17059 is run as.
17060
17061 For example, to specify a service running autossh as the user
17062 @code{pino} and forwarding all local connections to port @code{8081} to
17063 @code{remote:8081} using an SSH tunnel, add this call to the operating
17064 system's @code{services} field:
17065
17066 @lisp
17067 (service autossh-service-type
17068 (autossh-configuration
17069 (user "pino")
17070 (ssh-options (list "-T" "-N" "-L" "8081:localhost:8081" "remote.net"))))
17071 @end lisp
17072 @end deffn
17073
17074 @deftp {Data Type} autossh-configuration
17075 This data type represents the configuration of an AutoSSH service.
17076
17077 @table @asis
17078
17079 @item @code{user} (default @code{"autossh"})
17080 The user as which the AutoSSH service is to be run.
17081 This assumes that the specified user exists.
17082
17083 @item @code{poll} (default @code{600})
17084 Specifies the connection poll time in seconds.
17085
17086 @item @code{first-poll} (default @code{#f})
17087 Specifies how many seconds AutoSSH waits before the first connection
17088 test. After this first test, polling is resumed at the pace defined in
17089 @code{poll}. When set to @code{#f}, the first poll is not treated
17090 specially and will also use the connection poll specified in
17091 @code{poll}.
17092
17093 @item @code{gate-time} (default @code{30})
17094 Specifies how many seconds an SSH connection must be active before it is
17095 considered successful.
17096
17097 @item @code{log-level} (default @code{1})
17098 The log level, corresponding to the levels used by syslog---so @code{0}
17099 is the most silent while @code{7} is the chattiest.
17100
17101 @item @code{max-start} (default @code{#f})
17102 The maximum number of times SSH may be (re)started before AutoSSH exits.
17103 When set to @code{#f}, no maximum is configured and AutoSSH may restart indefinitely.
17104
17105 @item @code{message} (default @code{""})
17106 The message to append to the echo message sent when testing connections.
17107
17108 @item @code{port} (default @code{"0"})
17109 The ports used for monitoring the connection. When set to @code{"0"},
17110 monitoring is disabled. When set to @code{"@var{n}"} where @var{n} is
17111 a positive integer, ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for
17112 monitoring the connection, such that port @var{n} is the base
17113 monitoring port and @code{n+1} is the echo port. When set to
17114 @code{"@var{n}:@var{m}"} where @var{n} and @var{m} are positive
17115 integers, the ports @var{n} and @var{m} are used for monitoring the
17116 connection, such that port @var{n} is the base monitoring port and
17117 @var{m} is the echo port.
17118
17119 @item @code{ssh-options} (default @code{'()})
17120 The list of command-line arguments to pass to @command{ssh} when it is
17121 run. Options @option{-f} and @option{-M} are reserved for AutoSSH and
17122 may cause undefined behaviour.
17123
17124 @end table
17125 @end deftp
17126
17127 @cindex WebSSH
17128 @deffn {Scheme Variable} webssh-service-type
17129 This is the type for the @uref{https://webssh.huashengdun.org/, WebSSH}
17130 program that runs a web SSH client. WebSSH can be run manually from the
17131 command-line by passing arguments to the binary @command{wssh} from the
17132 package @code{webssh}, but it can also be run as a Guix service. This
17133 latter use case is documented here.
17134
17135 For example, to specify a service running WebSSH on loopback interface
17136 on port @code{8888} with reject policy with a list of allowed to
17137 connection hosts, and NGINX as a reverse-proxy to this service listening
17138 for HTTPS connection, add this call to the operating system's
17139 @code{services} field:
17140
17141 @lisp
17142 (service webssh-service-type
17143 (webssh-configuration (address "127.0.0.1")
17144 (port 8888)
17145 (policy 'reject)
17146 (known-hosts '("localhost ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"
17147 "127.0.0.1 ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"))))
17148
17149 (service nginx-service-type
17150 (nginx-configuration
17151 (server-blocks
17152 (list
17153 (nginx-server-configuration
17154 (inherit %webssh-configuration-nginx)
17155 (server-name '("webssh.example.com"))
17156 (listen '("443 ssl"))
17157 (ssl-certificate (letsencrypt-certificate "webssh.example.com"))
17158 (ssl-certificate-key (letsencrypt-key "webssh.example.com"))
17159 (locations
17160 (cons (nginx-location-configuration
17161 (uri "/.well-known")
17162 (body '("root /var/www;")))
17163 (nginx-server-configuration-locations %webssh-configuration-nginx))))))))
17164 @end lisp
17165 @end deffn
17166
17167 @deftp {Data Type} webssh-configuration
17168 Data type representing the configuration for @code{webssh-service}.
17169
17170 @table @asis
17171 @item @code{package} (default: @var{webssh})
17172 @code{webssh} package to use.
17173
17174 @item @code{user-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17175 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
17176 place.
17177
17178 @item @code{group-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17179 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
17180
17181 @item @code{address} (default: @var{#f})
17182 IP address on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17183
17184 @item @code{port} (default: @var{8888})
17185 TCP port on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17186
17187 @item @code{policy} (default: @var{#f})
17188 Connection policy. @var{reject} policy requires to specify @var{known-hosts}.
17189
17190 @item @code{known-hosts} (default: @var{'()})
17191 List of hosts which allowed for SSH connection from @command{webssh}.
17192
17193 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/webssh.log"})
17194 Name of the file where @command{webssh} writes its log file.
17195
17196 @item @code{log-level} (default: @var{#f})
17197 Logging level.
17198
17199 @end table
17200 @end deftp
17201
17202 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
17203 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
17204 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
17205 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
17206 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
17207 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
17208
17209 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
17210 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
17211 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
17212
17213 @lisp
17214 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
17215
17216 (operating-system
17217 (host-name "mymachine")
17218 ;; ...
17219 (hosts-file
17220 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
17221 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
17222 (plain-file "hosts"
17223 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
17224 %facebook-host-aliases))))
17225 @end lisp
17226
17227 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
17228 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
17229 @end defvr
17230
17231 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
17232
17233 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
17234 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
17235 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
17236 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
17237 Its value must be an @code{avahi-configuration} record---see below.
17238
17239 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
17240 resolve @code{.local} host names using
17241 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
17242 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
17243
17244 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
17245 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
17246 @end defvr
17247
17248 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
17249 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
17250
17251 @table @asis
17252
17253 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
17254 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
17255 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
17256
17257 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
17258 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
17259 network.
17260
17261 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
17262 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
17263 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
17264 your local network, you can run:
17265
17266 @example
17267 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
17268 @end example
17269
17270 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
17271 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
17272
17273 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
17274 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
17275 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
17276
17277 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
17278 This is a list of domains to browse.
17279 @end table
17280 @end deftp
17281
17282 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
17283 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
17284 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
17285 object.
17286 @end deffn
17287
17288 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
17289 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
17290 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
17291 through programmatic extension.
17292
17293 @table @asis
17294 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
17295 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
17296
17297 @end table
17298 @end deftp
17299
17300 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
17301 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
17302 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
17303 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
17304 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
17305
17306 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
17307
17308 @lisp
17309 (service pagekite-service-type
17310 (pagekite-configuration
17311 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
17312 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
17313 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
17314 @end lisp
17315 @end defvr
17316
17317 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
17318 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
17319
17320 @table @asis
17321 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
17322 Package object of PageKite.
17323
17324 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
17325 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
17326
17327 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
17328 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
17329 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
17330
17331 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
17332 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
17333 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
17334
17335 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
17336 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
17337 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
17338
17339 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
17340 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
17341 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
17342
17343 @end table
17344 @end deftp
17345
17346 @defvr {Scheme Variable} yggdrasil-service-type
17347 The service type for connecting to the @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/,
17348 Yggdrasil network}, an early-stage implementation of a fully end-to-end
17349 encrypted IPv6 network.
17350
17351 @quotation
17352 Yggdrasil provides name-independent routing with cryptographically generated
17353 addresses. Static addressing means you can keep the same address as long as
17354 you want, even if you move to a new location, or generate a new address (by
17355 generating new keys) whenever you want.
17356 @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/2018/07/28/addressing.html}
17357 @end quotation
17358
17359 Pass it a value of @code{yggdrasil-configuration} to connect it to public
17360 peers and/or local peers.
17361
17362 Here is an example using public peers and a static address. The static
17363 signing and encryption keys are defined in @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}
17364 (the default value for @code{config-file}).
17365
17366 @lisp
17367 ;; part of the operating-system declaration
17368 (service yggdrasil-service-type
17369 (yggdrasil-configuration
17370 (autoconf? #f) ;; use only the public peers
17371 (json-config
17372 ;; choose one from
17373 ;; https://github.com/yggdrasil-network/public-peers
17374 '((peers . #("tcp://1.2.3.4:1337"))))
17375 ;; /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf is the default value for config-file
17376 ))
17377 @end lisp
17378 @example
17379 # sample content for /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf
17380 @{
17381 # Your public encryption key. Your peers may ask you for this to put
17382 # into their AllowedEncryptionPublicKeys configuration.
17383 EncryptionPublicKey: 378dc5...
17384
17385 # Your private encryption key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17386 EncryptionPrivateKey: 0777...
17387
17388 # Your public signing key. You should not ordinarily need to share
17389 # this with anyone.
17390 SigningPublicKey: e1664...
17391
17392 # Your private signing key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17393 SigningPrivateKey: 0589d...
17394 @}
17395 @end example
17396 @end defvr
17397
17398 @deftp {Data Type} yggdrasil-configuration
17399 Data type representing the configuration of Yggdrasil.
17400
17401 @table @asis
17402 @item @code{package} (default: @code{yggdrasil})
17403 Package object of Yggdrasil.
17404
17405 @item @code{json-config} (default: @code{'()})
17406 Contents of @file{/etc/yggdrasil.conf}. Will be merged with
17407 @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}. Note that these settings are stored in
17408 the Guix store, which is readable to all users. @strong{Do not store your
17409 private keys in it}. See the output of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} for a
17410 quick overview of valid keys and their default values.
17411
17412 @item @code{autoconf?} (default: @code{#f})
17413 Whether to use automatic mode. Enabling it makes Yggdrasil use adynamic IP
17414 and peer with IPv6 neighbors.
17415
17416 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
17417 How much detail to include in logs. Use @code{'debug} for more detail.
17418
17419 @item @code{log-to} (default: @code{'stdout})
17420 Where to send logs. By default, the service logs standard output to
17421 @file{/var/log/yggdrasil.log}. The alternative is @code{'syslog}, which
17422 sends output to the running syslog service.
17423
17424 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{"/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf"})
17425 What HJSON file to load sensitive data from. This is where private keys
17426 should be stored, which are necessary to specify if you don't want a
17427 randomized address after each restart. Use @code{#f} to disable. Options
17428 defined in this file take precedence over @code{json-config}. Use the output
17429 of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} as a starting point. To configure a static
17430 address, delete everything except these options:
17431
17432 @itemize
17433 @item @code{EncryptionPublicKey}
17434 @item @code{EncryptionPrivateKey}
17435 @item @code{SigningPublicKey}
17436 @item @code{SigningPrivateKey}
17437 @end itemize
17438 @end table
17439 @end deftp
17440
17441 @cindex keepalived
17442 @deffn {Scheme Variable} keepalived-service-type
17443 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.keepalived.org/, Keepalived}
17444 routing software, @command{keepalived}. Its value must be an
17445 @code{keepalived-configuration} record as in this example for master
17446 machine:
17447
17448 @lisp
17449 (service keepalived-service-type
17450 (keepalived-configuration
17451 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-master.conf"))))
17452 @end lisp
17453
17454 where @file{keepalived-master.conf}:
17455
17456 @example
17457 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17458 state MASTER
17459 interface enp9s0
17460 virtual_router_id 100
17461 priority 100
17462 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.2 @}
17463 virtual_ipaddress @{
17464 10.0.0.4/24
17465 @}
17466 @}
17467 @end example
17468
17469 and for backup machine:
17470
17471 @lisp
17472 (service keepalived-service-type
17473 (keepalived-configuration
17474 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-backup.conf"))))
17475 @end lisp
17476
17477 where @file{keepalived-backup.conf}:
17478
17479 @example
17480 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17481 state BACKUP
17482 interface enp9s0
17483 virtual_router_id 100
17484 priority 99
17485 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.3 @}
17486 virtual_ipaddress @{
17487 10.0.0.4/24
17488 @}
17489 @}
17490 @end example
17491 @end deffn
17492
17493 @node Unattended Upgrades
17494 @subsection Unattended Upgrades
17495
17496 @cindex unattended upgrades
17497 @cindex upgrades, unattended
17498 Guix provides a service to perform @emph{unattended upgrades}:
17499 periodically, the system automatically reconfigures itself from the
17500 latest Guix. Guix System has several properties that make unattended
17501 upgrades safe:
17502
17503 @itemize
17504 @item
17505 upgrades are transactional (either the upgrade succeeds or it fails, but
17506 you cannot end up with an ``in-between'' system state);
17507 @item
17508 the upgrade log is kept---you can view it with @command{guix system
17509 list-generations}---and you can roll back to any previous generation,
17510 should the upgraded system fail to behave as intended;
17511 @item
17512 channel code is authenticated so you know you can only run genuine code
17513 (@pxref{Channels});
17514 @item
17515 @command{guix system reconfigure} prevents downgrades, which makes it
17516 immune to @dfn{downgrade attacks}.
17517 @end itemize
17518
17519 To set up unattended upgrades, add an instance of
17520 @code{unattended-upgrade-service-type} like the one below to the list of
17521 your operating system services:
17522
17523 @lisp
17524 (service unattended-upgrade-service-type)
17525 @end lisp
17526
17527 The defaults above set up weekly upgrades: every Sunday at midnight.
17528 You do not need to provide the operating system configuration file: it
17529 uses @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm}, which ensures it
17530 always uses your latest configuration---@pxref{provenance-service-type},
17531 for more information about this file.
17532
17533 There are several things that can be configured, in particular the
17534 periodicity and services (daemons) to be restarted upon completion.
17535 When the upgrade is successful, the service takes care of deleting
17536 system generations older that some threshold, as per @command{guix
17537 system delete-generations}. See the reference below for details.
17538
17539 To ensure that upgrades are actually happening, you can run
17540 @command{guix system describe}. To investigate upgrade failures, visit
17541 the unattended upgrade log file (see below).
17542
17543 @defvr {Scheme Variable} unattended-upgrade-service-type
17544 This is the service type for unattended upgrades. It sets up an mcron
17545 job (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) that runs @command{guix system
17546 reconfigure} from the latest version of the specified channels.
17547
17548 Its value must be a @code{unattended-upgrade-configuration} record (see
17549 below).
17550 @end defvr
17551
17552 @deftp {Data Type} unattended-upgrade-configuration
17553 This data type represents the configuration of the unattended upgrade
17554 service. The following fields are available:
17555
17556 @table @asis
17557 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{"30 01 * * 0"})
17558 This is the schedule of upgrades, expressed as a gexp containing an
17559 mcron job schedule (@pxref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,,
17560 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
17561
17562 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{#~%default-channels})
17563 This gexp specifies the channels to use for the upgrade
17564 (@pxref{Channels}). By default, the tip of the official @code{guix}
17565 channel is used.
17566
17567 @item @code{operating-system-file} (default: @code{"/run/current-system/configuration.scm"})
17568 This field specifies the operating system configuration file to use.
17569 The default is to reuse the config file of the current configuration.
17570
17571 There are cases, though, where referring to
17572 @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} is not enough, for instance
17573 because that file refers to extra files (SSH public keys, extra
17574 configuration files, etc.) @i{via} @code{local-file} and similar
17575 constructs. For those cases, we recommend something along these lines:
17576
17577 @lisp
17578 (unattended-upgrade-configuration
17579 (operating-system-file
17580 (file-append (local-file "." "config-dir" #:recursive? #t)
17581 "/config.scm")))
17582 @end lisp
17583
17584 The effect here is to import all of the current directory into the
17585 store, and to refer to @file{config.scm} within that directory.
17586 Therefore, uses of @code{local-file} within @file{config.scm} will work
17587 as expected. @xref{G-Expressions}, for information about
17588 @code{local-file} and @code{file-append}.
17589
17590 @item @code{services-to-restart} (default: @code{'(mcron)})
17591 This field specifies the Shepherd services to restart when the upgrade
17592 completes.
17593
17594 Those services are restarted right away upon completion, as with
17595 @command{herd restart}, which ensures that the latest version is
17596 running---remember that by default @command{guix system reconfigure}
17597 only restarts services that are not currently running, which is
17598 conservative: it minimizes disruption but leaves outdated services
17599 running.
17600
17601 Use @command{herd status} to find out candidates for restarting.
17602 @xref{Services}, for general information about services. Common
17603 services to restart would include @code{ntpd} and @code{ssh-daemon}.
17604
17605 By default, the @code{mcron} service is restarted. This ensures that
17606 the latest version of the unattended upgrade job will be used next time.
17607
17608 @item @code{system-expiration} (default: @code{(* 3 30 24 3600)})
17609 This is the expiration time in seconds for system generations. System
17610 generations older that this amount of time are deleted with
17611 @command{guix system delete-generations} when an upgrade completes.
17612
17613 @quotation Note
17614 The unattended upgrade service does not run the garbage collector. You
17615 will probably want to set up your own mcron job to run @command{guix gc}
17616 periodically.
17617 @end quotation
17618
17619 @item @code{maximum-duration} (default: @code{3600})
17620 Maximum duration in seconds for the upgrade; past that time, the upgrade
17621 aborts.
17622
17623 This is primarily useful to ensure the upgrade does not end up
17624 rebuilding or re-downloading ``the world''.
17625
17626 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/unattended-upgrade.log"})
17627 File where unattended upgrades are logged.
17628 @end table
17629 @end deftp
17630
17631 @node X Window
17632 @subsection X Window
17633
17634 @cindex X11
17635 @cindex X Window System
17636 @cindex login manager
17637 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
17638 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
17639 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
17640 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
17641
17642 @cindex GDM
17643 @cindex GNOME, login manager
17644 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
17645 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
17646 features such as automatic screen locking.
17647
17648 @cindex window manager
17649 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
17650 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
17651 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
17652 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
17653
17654 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
17655 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
17656 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
17657 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
17658 (see below).
17659
17660 @cindex session types (X11)
17661 @cindex X11 session types
17662 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
17663 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
17664 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
17665 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
17666 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
17667
17668 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
17669 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
17670 and/or other X clients.
17671 @end defvr
17672
17673 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
17674 @table @asis
17675 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17676 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
17677 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
17678
17679 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
17680 @code{default-user}.
17681
17682 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17683 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
17684
17685 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
17686 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
17687
17688 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17689 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17690
17691 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
17692 Script to run before starting a X session.
17693
17694 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
17695 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
17696
17697 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
17698 The GDM package to use.
17699 @end table
17700 @end deftp
17701
17702 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
17703 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
17704
17705 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
17706 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
17707 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
17708
17709 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
17710 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
17711 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
17712 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
17713 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
17714 and tty8.
17715
17716 @lisp
17717 (use-modules (gnu services)
17718 (gnu services desktop)
17719 (gnu services xorg)
17720 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
17721
17722 (operating-system
17723 ;; ...
17724 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17725 (display ":0")
17726 (vt "vt7")))
17727 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17728 (display ":1")
17729 (vt "vt8")))
17730 (remove (lambda (service)
17731 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
17732 %desktop-services))))
17733 @end lisp
17734
17735 @end defvr
17736
17737 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
17738 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
17739
17740 @table @asis
17741 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
17742 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
17743
17744 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17745 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
17746 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
17747
17748 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
17749 @code{default-user}.
17750
17751 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
17752 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
17753 The graphical theme to use and its name.
17754
17755 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
17756 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
17757 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
17758
17759 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
17760 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
17761 will be used.
17762
17763 @quotation Note
17764 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
17765 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
17766 false, you will be unable to log in.
17767 @end quotation
17768
17769 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17770 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17771
17772 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
17773 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17774
17775 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
17776 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17777
17778 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
17779 The XAuth package to use.
17780
17781 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
17782 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
17783 @command{reboot}.
17784
17785 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
17786 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
17787
17788 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
17789 The SLiM package to use.
17790 @end table
17791 @end deftp
17792
17793 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
17794 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
17795 The default SLiM theme and its name.
17796 @end defvr
17797
17798
17799 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17800 This is the data type representing the SDDM service configuration.
17801
17802 @table @asis
17803 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
17804 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are
17805 @samp{"x11"} or @samp{"wayland"}.
17806
17807 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
17808 Valid values are @samp{"on"}, @samp{"off"} or @samp{"none"}.
17809
17810 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
17811 Command to run when halting.
17812
17813 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
17814 Command to run when rebooting.
17815
17816 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
17817 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are @samp{"elarun"},
17818 @samp{"maldives"} or @samp{"maya"}.
17819
17820 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
17821 Directory to look for themes.
17822
17823 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
17824 Directory to look for faces.
17825
17826 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
17827 Default PATH to use.
17828
17829 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
17830 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
17831
17832 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
17833 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
17834
17835 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
17836 Remember last user.
17837
17838 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
17839 Remember last session.
17840
17841 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
17842 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
17843
17844 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
17845 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
17846
17847 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
17848 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
17849
17850 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
17851 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
17852
17853 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17854 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17855
17856 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
17857 Path to xauth.
17858
17859 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
17860 Path to Xephyr.
17861
17862 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
17863 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
17864
17865 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
17866 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
17867
17868 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
17869 Script to run before starting a X session.
17870
17871 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
17872 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
17873
17874 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
17875 Minimum VT to use.
17876
17877 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
17878 User to use for auto-login.
17879
17880 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
17881 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
17882
17883 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
17884 Relogin after logout.
17885
17886 @end table
17887 @end deftp
17888
17889 @cindex login manager
17890 @cindex X11 login
17891 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
17892 This is the type of the service to run the
17893 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
17894 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
17895
17896 Here's an example use:
17897
17898 @lisp
17899 (service sddm-service-type
17900 (sddm-configuration
17901 (auto-login-user "alice")
17902 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
17903 @end lisp
17904 @end defvr
17905
17906 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17907 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
17908 The available fields are:
17909
17910 @table @asis
17911 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
17912 The SDDM package to use.
17913
17914 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
17915 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
17916
17917 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
17918
17919 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
17920 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
17921 automatically.
17922
17923 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
17924 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
17925 auto-login session.
17926 @end table
17927 @end deftp
17928
17929 @cindex Xorg, configuration
17930 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
17931 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
17932 server. Note that there is no Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
17933 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM@. Thus, the configuration
17934 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
17935
17936 @table @asis
17937 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
17938 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
17939 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
17940
17941 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
17942 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
17943
17944 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
17945 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
17946 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
17947 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
17948
17949 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
17950 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
17951 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
17952 768) (640 480))}.
17953
17954 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
17955 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
17956 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
17957 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
17958 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
17959
17960 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
17961 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
17962 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
17963
17964 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
17965 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
17966 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
17967
17968 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
17969 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
17970
17971 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
17972 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
17973 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
17974 @end table
17975 @end deftp
17976
17977 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
17978 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
17979 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
17980 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
17981
17982 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
17983 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
17984 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
17985 @end deffn
17986
17987 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
17988 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
17989 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
17990 @code{startx}.
17991
17992 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
17993 @end deffn
17994
17995
17996 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
17997 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
17998 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
17999 for it. For example:
18000
18001 @lisp
18002 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
18003 @end lisp
18004
18005 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
18006 @end deffn
18007
18008
18009 @node Printing Services
18010 @subsection Printing Services
18011
18012 @cindex printer support with CUPS
18013 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
18014 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
18015 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
18016
18017 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
18018 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
18019 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
18020 write:
18021 @lisp
18022 (service cups-service-type)
18023 @end lisp
18024 @end deffn
18025
18026 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
18027 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
18028 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
18029 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
18030 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
18031 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
18032 secure connections to the print server.
18033
18034 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
18035 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{epson-inkjet-printer-escpr}
18036 package and for HP printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package.
18037 You can do that directly, like this (you need to use the
18038 @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
18039
18040 @lisp
18041 (service cups-service-type
18042 (cups-configuration
18043 (web-interface? #t)
18044 (extensions
18045 (list cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr hplip-minimal))))
18046 @end lisp
18047
18048 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
18049 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
18050 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
18051
18052 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
18053 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
18054 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
18055 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
18056 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
18057 from some other system; see the end for more details.
18058
18059 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
18060 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
18061 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
18062 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
18063 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
18064 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
18065 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
18066
18067
18068 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
18069
18070 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18071 The CUPS package.
18072 @end deftypevr
18073
18074 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions (default: @code{(list brlaser cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr foomatic-filters hplip-minimal splix)})
18075 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
18076 @end deftypevr
18077
18078 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
18079 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
18080 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
18081
18082 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
18083
18084 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
18085 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18086 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18087 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18088 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18089 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18090 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18091 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
18092
18093 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
18094 @end deftypevr
18095
18096 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
18097 Where CUPS should cache data.
18098
18099 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
18100 @end deftypevr
18101
18102 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
18103 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
18104 writes.
18105
18106 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
18107 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
18108 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
18109 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
18110 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
18111
18112 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
18113 @end deftypevr
18114
18115 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
18116 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18117 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18118 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18119 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18120 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18121 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18122 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
18123
18124 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
18125 @end deftypevr
18126
18127 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
18128 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
18129 kind strings are:
18130
18131 @table @code
18132 @item none
18133 No errors are fatal.
18134
18135 @item all
18136 All of the errors below are fatal.
18137
18138 @item browse
18139 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
18140 to the DNS-SD daemon.
18141
18142 @item config
18143 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
18144
18145 @item listen
18146 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
18147 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
18148
18149 @item log
18150 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
18151
18152 @item permissions
18153 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
18154 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
18155 @end table
18156
18157 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
18158 @end deftypevr
18159
18160 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
18161 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
18162 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
18163
18164 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18165 @end deftypevr
18166
18167 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
18168 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
18169 programs.
18170
18171 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18172 @end deftypevr
18173
18174 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
18175 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
18176
18177 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
18178 @end deftypevr
18179
18180 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
18181 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18182 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18183 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18184 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18185 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18186 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18187 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
18188
18189 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
18190 @end deftypevr
18191
18192 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
18193 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
18194 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
18195
18196 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
18197 @end deftypevr
18198
18199 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
18200 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
18201 data.
18202
18203 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
18204 @end deftypevr
18205
18206 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
18207 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
18208 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
18209 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
18210 used/supported on macOS.
18211
18212 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
18213 @end deftypevr
18214
18215 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
18216 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
18217 look for public and private keys in this directory: @file{.crt} files
18218 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @file{.key} files for
18219 PEM-encoded private keys.
18220
18221 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
18222 @end deftypevr
18223
18224 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
18225 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
18226
18227 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
18228 @end deftypevr
18229
18230 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
18231 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
18232 configuration or state files.
18233
18234 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18235 @end deftypevr
18236
18237 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
18238 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
18239 @end deftypevr
18240
18241 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
18242 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
18243
18244 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
18245 @end deftypevr
18246
18247 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
18248 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
18249 programs.
18250
18251 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18252 @end deftypevr
18253
18254 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
18255 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
18256
18257 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
18258 @end deftypevr
18259 @end deftypevr
18260
18261 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
18262 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
18263 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
18264 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
18265 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
18266 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
18267 level logs all requests.
18268
18269 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
18270 @end deftypevr
18271
18272 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
18273 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
18274 longer required for quotas.
18275
18276 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18277 @end deftypevr
18278
18279 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
18280 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
18281 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
18282 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
18283
18284 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
18285 @end deftypevr
18286
18287 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
18288 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
18289
18290 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
18291 @end deftypevr
18292
18293 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
18294 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
18295
18296 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18297 @end deftypevr
18298
18299 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
18300 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
18301
18302 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18303 @end deftypevr
18304
18305 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
18306 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
18307 name can be used, including @samp{"classified"}, @samp{"confidential"},
18308 @samp{"secret"}, @samp{"topsecret"}, and @samp{"unclassified"}, or the
18309 banner can be omitted to disable secure printing functions.
18310
18311 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18312 @end deftypevr
18313
18314 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
18315 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
18316 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
18317
18318 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18319 @end deftypevr
18320
18321 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
18322 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
18323
18324 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
18325 @end deftypevr
18326
18327 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
18328 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
18329
18330 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
18331 @end deftypevr
18332
18333 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
18334 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
18335
18336 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
18337 @end deftypevr
18338
18339 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
18340 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
18341 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
18342 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
18343 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
18344
18345 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
18346 @end deftypevr
18347
18348 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
18349 Specifies the default access policy to use.
18350
18351 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
18352 @end deftypevr
18353
18354 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
18355 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
18356
18357 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18358 @end deftypevr
18359
18360 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
18361 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
18362 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
18363 typically within a few milliseconds.
18364
18365 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18366 @end deftypevr
18367
18368 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
18369 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
18370 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
18371 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
18372 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
18373 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
18374
18375 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
18376 @end deftypevr
18377
18378 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
18379 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
18380 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
18381 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
18382 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
18383 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
18384 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
18385 at any time.
18386
18387 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18388 @end deftypevr
18389
18390 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
18391 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
18392 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
18393 lowest priority.
18394
18395 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18396 @end deftypevr
18397
18398 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
18399 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
18400 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
18401 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
18402 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
18403 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
18404 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
18405
18406 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18407 @end deftypevr
18408
18409 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
18410 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
18411 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
18412
18413 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18414 @end deftypevr
18415
18416 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
18417 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
18418 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18419 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18420 @code{retry-current-job}.
18421
18422 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18423 @end deftypevr
18424
18425 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
18426 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
18427 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18428 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18429 @code{retry-current-job}.
18430
18431 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18432 @end deftypevr
18433
18434 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
18435 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
18436
18437 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18438 @end deftypevr
18439
18440 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
18441 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
18442
18443 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18444 @end deftypevr
18445
18446 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
18447 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
18448 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
18449
18450 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18451 @end deftypevr
18452
18453 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
18454 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
18455 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
18456 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
18457 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
18458 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
18459 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
18460 @end deftypevr
18461
18462 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
18463 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
18464 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
18465 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
18466 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
18467 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
18468 ones.
18469
18470 Defaults to @samp{128}.
18471 @end deftypevr
18472
18473 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
18474 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
18475
18476 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
18477
18478 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
18479 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
18480 @end deftypevr
18481
18482 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18483 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
18484 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
18485
18486 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18487 @end deftypevr
18488
18489 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
18490 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
18491
18492 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18493
18494 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
18495
18496 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
18497 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
18498 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
18499
18500 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18501 @end deftypevr
18502
18503 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
18504 Methods to which this access control applies.
18505
18506 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18507 @end deftypevr
18508
18509 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18510 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
18511 one directive, such as @samp{"Order allow,deny"}.
18512
18513 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18514 @end deftypevr
18515 @end deftypevr
18516 @end deftypevr
18517
18518 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
18519 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
18520 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
18521 of the LogLevel setting.
18522
18523 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18524 @end deftypevr
18525
18526 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
18527 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
18528 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
18529
18530 Defaults to @samp{info}.
18531 @end deftypevr
18532
18533 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
18534 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
18535 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
18536
18537 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
18538 @end deftypevr
18539
18540 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
18541 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
18542 the scheduler.
18543
18544 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18545 @end deftypevr
18546
18547 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
18548 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
18549 from a single address.
18550
18551 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18552 @end deftypevr
18553
18554 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
18555 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
18556 job.
18557
18558 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
18559 @end deftypevr
18560
18561 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
18562 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
18563 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
18564 held jobs.
18565
18566 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18567 @end deftypevr
18568
18569 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
18570 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
18571 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
18572
18573 Defaults to @samp{500}.
18574 @end deftypevr
18575
18576 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
18577 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18578 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
18579
18580 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18581 @end deftypevr
18582
18583 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
18584 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18585 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
18586
18587 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18588 @end deftypevr
18589
18590 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
18591 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
18592 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of ``stuck'' jobs.
18593
18594 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
18595 @end deftypevr
18596
18597 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
18598 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
18599 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
18600
18601 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
18602 @end deftypevr
18603
18604 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
18605 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
18606 multiple file print job, in seconds.
18607
18608 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18609 @end deftypevr
18610
18611 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
18612 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
18613 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
18614 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
18615 sequences are recognized:
18616
18617 @table @samp
18618 @item %%
18619 insert a single percent character
18620
18621 @item %@{name@}
18622 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
18623
18624 @item %C
18625 insert the number of copies for the current page
18626
18627 @item %P
18628 insert the current page number
18629
18630 @item %T
18631 insert the current date and time in common log format
18632
18633 @item %j
18634 insert the job ID
18635
18636 @item %p
18637 insert the printer name
18638
18639 @item %u
18640 insert the username
18641 @end table
18642
18643 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
18644 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
18645 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
18646 standard items.
18647
18648 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18649 @end deftypevr
18650
18651 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
18652 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
18653 of strings.
18654
18655 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18656 @end deftypevr
18657
18658 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
18659 Specifies named access control policies.
18660
18661 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
18662
18663 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
18664 Name of the policy.
18665 @end deftypevr
18666
18667 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
18668 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
18669 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18670 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18671 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18672 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18673 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18674 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18675 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18676 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18677
18678 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18679 @end deftypevr
18680
18681 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
18682 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18683 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18684
18685 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
18686 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
18687 @end deftypevr
18688
18689 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
18690 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
18691 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18692 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18693 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18694 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18695 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18696 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18697 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18698 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18699
18700 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18701 @end deftypevr
18702
18703 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
18704 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18705 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18706
18707 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
18708 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
18709 @end deftypevr
18710
18711 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
18712 Access control by IPP operation.
18713
18714 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18715 @end deftypevr
18716 @end deftypevr
18717
18718 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
18719 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
18720 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
18721 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
18722 value applies indefinitely.
18723
18724 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
18725 @end deftypevr
18726
18727 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
18728 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
18729 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
18730 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
18731 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
18732
18733 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18734 @end deftypevr
18735
18736 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
18737 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
18738 restarting the scheduler.
18739
18740 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18741 @end deftypevr
18742
18743 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
18744 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
18745 into bitmaps for a printer.
18746
18747 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
18748 @end deftypevr
18749
18750 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
18751 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
18752
18753 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
18754 @end deftypevr
18755
18756 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
18757 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
18758 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
18759 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
18760 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
18761 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
18762 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
18763 @code{*}.
18764
18765 Defaults to @samp{*}.
18766 @end deftypevr
18767
18768 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
18769 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
18770
18771 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18772 @end deftypevr
18773
18774 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
18775 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
18776 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
18777 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
18778 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
18779 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
18780 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
18781 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
18782
18783 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
18784 @end deftypevr
18785
18786 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
18787 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
18788 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
18789 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
18790 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
18791
18792 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18793 @end deftypevr
18794
18795 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
18796 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
18797 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
18798 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
18799 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
18800 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
18801 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
18802 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
18803 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
18804 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
18805
18806 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18807 @end deftypevr
18808
18809 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
18810 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
18811 the IPP specifications.
18812
18813 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18814 @end deftypevr
18815
18816 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
18817 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
18818
18819 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18820
18821 @end deftypevr
18822
18823 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
18824 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
18825
18826 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18827 @end deftypevr
18828
18829 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
18830 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
18831 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
18832 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
18833 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
18834 @code{cups-service-type}.
18835
18836 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
18837
18838 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18839 The CUPS package.
18840 @end deftypevr
18841
18842 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
18843 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
18844 @end deftypevr
18845
18846 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
18847 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
18848 @end deftypevr
18849
18850 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
18851 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
18852 this:
18853
18854 @lisp
18855 (service cups-service-type
18856 (opaque-cups-configuration
18857 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
18858 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
18859 @end lisp
18860
18861
18862 @node Desktop Services
18863 @subsection Desktop Services
18864
18865 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
18866 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
18867 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
18868 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
18869 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
18870
18871 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
18872 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
18873 environment and networking:
18874
18875 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
18876 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
18877 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
18878
18879 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
18880 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
18881 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
18882 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
18883 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
18884 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
18885 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
18886 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
18887 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
18888 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
18889 @end defvr
18890
18891 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
18892 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
18893 Reference, @code{services}}).
18894
18895 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
18896 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type},
18897 @code{lxqt-desktop-service-type} and @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type}
18898 procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE and/or Enlightenment to a system. To
18899 ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the backlight adjustment
18900 helpers and the power management utilities are added to the system, extending
18901 @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with
18902 elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose system interfaces.
18903 Additionally, adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds
18904 the GNOME metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce
18905 service not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but
18906 it also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode'' file
18907 management window, if the user authenticates using the administrator's
18908 password via the standard polkit graphical interface. To ``add MATE'' means
18909 that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended appropriately, allowing MATE
18910 to operate with elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose
18911 system interfaces. Additionally, adding a service of type
18912 @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE metapackage to the system
18913 profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that @code{dbus} is extended
18914 appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries are set as setuid,
18915 allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other functionality to work as
18916 expected.
18917
18918 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
18919 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
18920 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
18921 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
18922 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM@. Alternatively you can
18923 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
18924 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
18925 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
18926
18927 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
18928 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
18929 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
18930 object (see below).
18931
18932 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
18933 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
18934 @end defvr
18935
18936 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
18937 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
18938
18939 @table @asis
18940 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
18941 The GNOME package to use.
18942 @end table
18943 @end deftp
18944
18945 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
18946 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
18947 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
18948 (see below).
18949
18950 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
18951 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
18952 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
18953 with the administrator's password.
18954
18955 Note that @code{xfce4-panel} and its plugin packages should be installed in
18956 the same profile to ensure compatibility. When using this service, you should
18957 add extra plugins (@code{xfce4-whiskermenu-plugin},
18958 @code{xfce4-weather-plugin}, etc.) to the @code{packages} field of your
18959 @code{operating-system}.
18960 @end defvr
18961
18962 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
18963 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
18964
18965 @table @asis
18966 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
18967 The Xfce package to use.
18968 @end table
18969 @end deftp
18970
18971 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
18972 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
18973 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
18974 object (see below).
18975
18976 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
18977 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
18978 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
18979 @end deffn
18980
18981 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
18982 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
18983
18984 @table @asis
18985 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
18986 The MATE package to use.
18987 @end table
18988 @end deftp
18989
18990 @deffn {Scheme Variable} lxqt-desktop-service-type
18991 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://lxqt.github.io,
18992 LXQt desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{lxqt-desktop-configuration}
18993 object (see below).
18994
18995 This service adds the @code{lxqt} package to the system
18996 profile.
18997 @end deffn
18998
18999 @deftp {Data Type} lxqt-desktop-configuration
19000 Configuration record for the LXQt desktop environment.
19001
19002 @table @asis
19003 @item @code{lxqt} (default: @code{lxqt})
19004 The LXQT package to use.
19005 @end table
19006 @end deftp
19007
19008 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
19009 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
19010 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
19011 @end deffn
19012
19013 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
19014 @table @asis
19015 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
19016 The enlightenment package to use.
19017 @end table
19018 @end deftp
19019
19020 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
19021 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
19022 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
19023 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
19024 @code{operating-system}:
19025
19026 @lisp
19027 (use-modules (gnu))
19028 (use-service-modules desktop)
19029 (operating-system
19030 ...
19031 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
19032 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
19033 (service xfce-desktop-service)
19034 %desktop-services))
19035 ...)
19036 @end lisp
19037
19038 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
19039 graphical login window.
19040
19041 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
19042 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
19043 are described below.
19044
19045 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
19046 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
19047 support for @var{services}.
19048
19049 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
19050 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
19051 and to be notified of system-wide events.
19052
19053 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
19054 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
19055 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
19056 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
19057 @end deffn
19058
19059 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
19060 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
19061 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
19062 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
19063 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
19064 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
19065
19066 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
19067 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
19068 when the power button is pressed.
19069
19070 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
19071 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
19072 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
19073 their default values are:
19074
19075 @table @code
19076 @item kill-user-processes?
19077 @code{#f}
19078 @item kill-only-users
19079 @code{()}
19080 @item kill-exclude-users
19081 @code{("root")}
19082 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
19083 @code{5}
19084 @item handle-power-key
19085 @code{poweroff}
19086 @item handle-suspend-key
19087 @code{suspend}
19088 @item handle-hibernate-key
19089 @code{hibernate}
19090 @item handle-lid-switch
19091 @code{suspend}
19092 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
19093 @code{ignore}
19094 @item handle-lid-switch-external-power
19095 @code{ignore}
19096 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
19097 @code{#f}
19098 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
19099 @code{#f}
19100 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
19101 @code{#f}
19102 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
19103 @code{#t}
19104 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
19105 @code{30}
19106 @item idle-action
19107 @code{ignore}
19108 @item idle-action-seconds
19109 @code{(* 30 60)}
19110 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
19111 @code{10}
19112 @item runtime-directory-size
19113 @code{#f}
19114 @item remove-ipc?
19115 @code{#t}
19116 @item suspend-state
19117 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
19118 @item suspend-mode
19119 @code{()}
19120 @item hibernate-state
19121 @code{("disk")}
19122 @item hibernate-mode
19123 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
19124 @item hybrid-sleep-state
19125 @code{("disk")}
19126 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
19127 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
19128 @end table
19129 @end deffn
19130
19131 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
19132 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
19133 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
19134 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
19135 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
19136 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
19137 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
19138 accountsservice web site} for more information.
19139
19140 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
19141 package to expose as a service.
19142 @end deffn
19143
19144 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
19145 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
19146 Return a service that runs the
19147 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
19148 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
19149 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
19150 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
19151 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
19152 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
19153 @end deffn
19154
19155 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
19156 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
19157 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
19158 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
19159 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
19160 @end defvr
19161
19162 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
19163 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
19164 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
19165 configuration settings.
19166
19167 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
19168 notably used by GNOME.
19169 @end defvr
19170
19171 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
19172 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
19173
19174 @table @asis
19175
19176 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
19177 Package to use for @code{upower}.
19178
19179 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
19180 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
19181
19182 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
19183 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
19184
19185 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
19186 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
19187
19188 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
19189 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
19190 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
19191
19192 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
19193 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19194 at which the battery is considered low.
19195
19196 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
19197 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19198 at which the battery is considered critical.
19199
19200 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
19201 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19202 at which action will be taken.
19203
19204 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
19205 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19206 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
19207
19208 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
19209 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19210 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
19211
19212 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
19213 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19214 seconds at which action will be taken.
19215
19216 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
19217 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
19218 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
19219
19220 Possible values are:
19221
19222 @itemize @bullet
19223 @item
19224 @code{'power-off}
19225
19226 @item
19227 @code{'hibernate}
19228
19229 @item
19230 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
19231 @end itemize
19232
19233 @end table
19234 @end deftp
19235
19236 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
19237 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
19238 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces
19239 with notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk
19240 to UDisks include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and
19241 GNOME Disks. Note that Udisks relies on the @command{mount} command, so
19242 it will only be able to use the file-system utilities installed in the
19243 system profile. For example if you want to be able to mount NTFS
19244 file-systems in read and write fashion, you'll need to have
19245 @code{ntfs-3g} installed system-wide.
19246 @end deffn
19247
19248 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
19249 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
19250 service with a D-Bus
19251 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
19252 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
19253 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
19254 site} for more information.
19255 @end deffn
19256
19257 @cindex scanner access
19258 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-service-type
19259 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
19260 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary
19261 udev rules. It is included in @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
19262 Services}) and relies by default on @code{sane-backends-minimal} package
19263 (see below) for hardware support.
19264 @end defvr
19265
19266 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends-minimal
19267 The default package which the @code{sane-service-type} installs. It
19268 supports many recent scanners.
19269 @end defvr
19270
19271 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends
19272 This package includes support for all scanners that
19273 @code{sane-backends-minimal} supports, plus older Hewlett-Packard
19274 scanners supported by @code{hplip} package. In order to use this on
19275 a system which relies on @code{%desktop-services}, you may use
19276 @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service Reference,
19277 @code{modify-services}}) as illustrated below:
19278
19279 @lisp
19280 (use-modules (gnu))
19281 (use-service-modules
19282 @dots{}
19283 desktop)
19284 (use-package-modules
19285 @dots{}
19286 scanner)
19287
19288 (define %my-desktop-services
19289 ;; List of desktop services that supports a broader range of scanners.
19290 (modify-services %desktop-services
19291 (sane-service-type _ => sane-backends)))
19292
19293 (operating-system
19294 @dots{}
19295 (services %my-desktop-services)
19296 @end lisp
19297 @end defvr
19298
19299 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
19300 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
19301 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
19302 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
19303 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
19304 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
19305 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
19306 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
19307 means that all users are allowed.
19308 @end deffn
19309
19310 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
19311 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
19312 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
19313 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
19314 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
19315 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
19316 know the user's location.
19317 @end defvr
19318
19319 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
19320 [#:whitelist '()] @
19321 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
19322 [#:submit-data? #f]
19323 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
19324 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
19325 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
19326 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
19327 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
19328 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
19329 location databases. See
19330 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
19331 web site} for more information.
19332 @end deffn
19333
19334 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
19335 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
19336 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
19337 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
19338 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
19339 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
19340 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
19341
19342 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
19343 @end deffn
19344
19345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
19346 This is the type of the service that adds the
19347 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
19348 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below).
19349
19350 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
19351 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
19352 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
19353 @end defvr
19354
19355 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
19356 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
19357
19358 @table @asis
19359 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
19360 The GNOME keyring package to use.
19361
19362 @item @code{pam-services}
19363 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
19364 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
19365 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
19366 @code{passwd}.
19367
19368 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
19369 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
19370 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
19371 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
19372 without arguments.
19373
19374 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
19375 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
19376 @end table
19377 @end deftp
19378
19379
19380 @node Sound Services
19381 @subsection Sound Services
19382
19383 @cindex sound support
19384 @cindex ALSA
19385 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
19386
19387 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
19388 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
19389 preferred ALSA output driver.
19390
19391 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
19392 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
19393 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
19394 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
19395 record as in this example:
19396
19397 @lisp
19398 (service alsa-service-type)
19399 @end lisp
19400
19401 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
19402 @end deffn
19403
19404 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
19405 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
19406
19407 @table @asis
19408 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
19409 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
19410
19411 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
19412 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
19413 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
19414
19415 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
19416 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
19417 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
19418
19419 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
19420 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
19421
19422 @end table
19423 @end deftp
19424
19425 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
19426 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
19427
19428 @example
19429 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
19430 pcm_type.jack @{
19431 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
19432 @}
19433
19434 # Routing ALSA to jack:
19435 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
19436 pcm.rawjack @{
19437 type jack
19438 playback_ports @{
19439 0 system:playback_1
19440 1 system:playback_2
19441 @}
19442
19443 capture_ports @{
19444 0 system:capture_1
19445 1 system:capture_2
19446 @}
19447 @}
19448
19449 pcm.!default @{
19450 type plug
19451 slave @{
19452 pcm "rawjack"
19453 @}
19454 @}
19455 @end example
19456
19457 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
19458 details.
19459
19460 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
19461 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
19462 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
19463 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
19464
19465 @quotation Warning
19466 This service overrides per-user configuration files. If you want
19467 PulseAudio to honor configuration files in @file{~/.config/pulse} you
19468 have to unset the environment variables @env{PULSE_CONFIG} and
19469 @env{PULSE_CLIENTCONFIG} in your @file{~/.bash_profile}.
19470 @end quotation
19471
19472 @quotation Warning
19473 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
19474 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
19475 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
19476 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
19477 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
19478 @end quotation
19479 @end deffn
19480
19481 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
19482 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
19483
19484 @table @asis
19485 @item @code{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
19486 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
19487 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
19488 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
19489 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
19490
19491 @item @code{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
19492 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
19493 @var{client-conf}.
19494
19495 @item @code{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
19496 Script file to use as @file{default.pa}.
19497
19498 @item @code{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
19499 Script file to use as @file{system.pa}.
19500 @end table
19501 @end deftp
19502
19503 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
19504 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
19505 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
19506
19507 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
19508 @code{swh-plugins} package:
19509
19510 @lisp
19511 (service ladspa-service-type
19512 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
19513 @end lisp
19514
19515 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
19516 details.
19517
19518 @end deffn
19519
19520 @node Database Services
19521 @subsection Database Services
19522
19523 @cindex database
19524 @cindex SQL
19525 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
19526
19527 @subsubheading PostgreSQL
19528
19529 The following example describes a PostgreSQL service with the default
19530 configuration.
19531
19532 @lisp
19533 (service postgresql-service-type
19534 (postgresql-configuration
19535 (postgresql postgresql-10)))
19536 @end lisp
19537
19538 If the services fails to start, it may be due to an incompatible
19539 cluster already present in @var{data-directory}. Adjust it (or, if you
19540 don't need the cluster anymore, delete @var{data-directory}), then
19541 restart the service.
19542
19543 Peer authentication is used by default and the @code{postgres} user
19544 account has no shell, which prevents the direct execution of @code{psql}
19545 commands as this user. To use @code{psql}, you can temporarily log in
19546 as @code{postgres} using a shell, create a PostgreSQL superuser with the
19547 same name as one of the system users and then create the associated
19548 database.
19549
19550 @example
19551 sudo -u postgres -s /bin/sh
19552 createuser --interactive
19553 createdb $MY_USER_LOGIN # Replace appropriately.
19554 @end example
19555
19556 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-configuration
19557 Data type representing the configuration for the
19558 @code{postgresql-service-type}.
19559
19560 @table @asis
19561 @item @code{postgresql}
19562 PostgreSQL package to use for the service.
19563
19564 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5432})
19565 Port on which PostgreSQL should listen.
19566
19567 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
19568 Locale to use as the default when creating the database cluster.
19569
19570 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(postgresql-config-file)})
19571 The configuration file to use when running PostgreSQL@. The default
19572 behaviour uses the postgresql-config-file record with the default values
19573 for the fields.
19574
19575 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql"})
19576 The directory where @command{pg_ctl} output will be written in a file
19577 named @code{"pg_ctl.log"}. This file can be useful to debug PostgreSQL
19578 configuration errors for instance.
19579
19580 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/postgresql/data"})
19581 Directory in which to store the data.
19582
19583 @item @code{extension-packages} (default: @code{'()})
19584 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
19585 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
19586 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
19587 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
19588 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
19589
19590 @cindex postgis
19591 @lisp
19592 (use-package-modules databases geo)
19593
19594 (operating-system
19595 ...
19596 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
19597 ;; proper operation.
19598 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
19599 (services
19600 (cons*
19601 (service postgresql-service-type
19602 (postgresql-configuration
19603 (postgresql postgresql-10)
19604 (extension-packages (list postgis))))
19605 %base-services)))
19606 @end lisp
19607
19608 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
19609 database in this way:
19610
19611 @example
19612 psql -U postgres
19613 > create database postgistest;
19614 > \connect postgistest;
19615 > create extension postgis;
19616 > create extension postgis_topology;
19617 @end example
19618
19619 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
19620 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
19621 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
19622
19623 @end table
19624 @end deftp
19625
19626 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-config-file
19627 Data type representing the PostgreSQL configuration file. As shown in
19628 the following example, this can be used to customize the configuration
19629 of PostgreSQL@. Note that you can use any G-expression or filename in
19630 place of this record, if you already have a configuration file you'd
19631 like to use for example.
19632
19633 @lisp
19634 (service postgresql-service-type
19635 (postgresql-configuration
19636 (config-file
19637 (postgresql-config-file
19638 (log-destination "stderr")
19639 (hba-file
19640 (plain-file "pg_hba.conf"
19641 "
19642 local all all trust
19643 host all all 127.0.0.1/32 md5
19644 host all all ::1/128 md5"))
19645 (extra-config
19646 '(("session_preload_libraries" "auto_explain")
19647 ("random_page_cost" 2)
19648 ("auto_explain.log_min_duration" "100 ms")
19649 ("work_mem" "500 MB")
19650 ("logging_collector" #t)
19651 ("log_directory" "/var/log/postgresql")))))))
19652 @end lisp
19653
19654 @table @asis
19655 @item @code{log-destination} (default: @code{"syslog"})
19656 The logging method to use for PostgreSQL@. Multiple values are accepted,
19657 separated by commas.
19658
19659 @item @code{hba-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-hba})
19660 Filename or G-expression for the host-based authentication
19661 configuration.
19662
19663 @item @code{ident-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-ident})
19664 Filename or G-expression for the user name mapping configuration.
19665
19666 @item @code{socket-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
19667 Specifies the directory of the Unix-domain socket(s) on which PostgreSQL
19668 is to listen for connections from client applications. If set to
19669 @code{#false} PostgreSQL does not listen on any Unix-domain sockets, in
19670 which case only TCP/IP sockets can be used to connect to the server.
19671
19672 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
19673 List of additional keys and values to include in the PostgreSQL config
19674 file. Each entry in the list should be a list where the first element
19675 is the key, and the remaining elements are the values.
19676
19677 The values can be numbers, booleans or strings and will be mapped to
19678 PostgreSQL parameters types @code{Boolean}, @code{String},
19679 @code{Numeric}, @code{Numeric with Unit} and @code{Enumerated} described
19680 @uref{https://www.postgresql.org/docs/current/config-setting.html,
19681 here}.
19682
19683 @end table
19684 @end deftp
19685
19686 @deffn {Scheme Variable} postgresql-role-service-type
19687 This service allows to create PostgreSQL roles and databases after
19688 PostgreSQL service start. Here is an example of its use.
19689
19690 @lisp
19691 (service postgresql-role-service-type
19692 (postgresql-role-configuration
19693 (roles
19694 (list (postgresql-role
19695 (name "test")
19696 (create-database? #t))))))
19697 @end lisp
19698
19699 This service can be extended with extra roles, as in this
19700 example:
19701
19702 @lisp
19703 (service-extension postgresql-role-service-type
19704 (const (postgresql-role
19705 (name "alice")
19706 (create-database? #t))))
19707 @end lisp
19708 @end deffn
19709
19710 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role
19711 PostgreSQL manages database access permissions using the concept of
19712 roles. A role can be thought of as either a database user, or a group
19713 of database users, depending on how the role is set up. Roles can own
19714 database objects (for example, tables) and can assign privileges on
19715 those objects to other roles to control who has access to which objects.
19716
19717 @table @asis
19718 @item @code{name}
19719 The role name.
19720
19721 @item @code{permissions} (default: @code{'(createdb login)})
19722 The role permissions list. Supported permissions are @code{bypassrls},
19723 @code{createdb}, @code{createrole}, @code{login}, @code{replication} and
19724 @code{superuser}.
19725
19726 @item @code{create-database?} (default: @code{#f})
19727 Whether to create a database with the same name as the role.
19728
19729 @end table
19730 @end deftp
19731
19732 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role-configuration
19733 Data type representing the configuration of
19734 @var{postgresql-role-service-type}.
19735
19736 @table @asis
19737 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
19738 The PostgreSQL host to connect to.
19739
19740 @item @code{log} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql_roles.log"})
19741 File name of the log file.
19742
19743 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'()})
19744 The initial PostgreSQL roles to create.
19745 @end table
19746 @end deftp
19747
19748 @subsubheading MariaDB/MySQL
19749
19750 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mysql-service-type
19751 This is the service type for a MySQL or MariaDB database server. Its value
19752 is a @code{mysql-configuration} object that specifies which package to use,
19753 as well as various settings for the @command{mysqld} daemon.
19754 @end defvr
19755
19756 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
19757 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service-type}.
19758
19759 @table @asis
19760 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
19761 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
19762 or @var{mysql}.
19763
19764 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
19765 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
19766
19767 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19768 The IP on which to listen for network connections. Use @code{"0.0.0.0"}
19769 to bind to all available network interfaces.
19770
19771 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
19772 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
19773
19774 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{"/run/mysqld/mysqld.sock"})
19775 Socket file to use for local (non-network) connections.
19776
19777 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19778 Additional settings for the @file{my.cnf} configuration file.
19779
19780 @item @code{auto-upgrade?} (default: @code{#t})
19781 Whether to automatically run @command{mysql_upgrade} after starting the
19782 service. This is necessary to upgrade the @dfn{system schema} after
19783 ``major'' updates (such as switching from MariaDB 10.4 to 10.5), but can
19784 be disabled if you would rather do that manually.
19785
19786 @end table
19787 @end deftp
19788
19789 @subsubheading Memcached
19790
19791 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
19792 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
19793 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
19794 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
19795 @end defvr
19796
19797 @lisp
19798 (service memcached-service-type)
19799 @end lisp
19800
19801 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
19802 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
19803
19804 @table @asis
19805 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
19806 The Memcached package to use.
19807
19808 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
19809 Network interfaces on which to listen.
19810
19811 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19812 Port on which to accept connections.
19813
19814 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19815 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19816 listening on a UDP socket.
19817
19818 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
19819 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
19820 @end table
19821 @end deftp
19822
19823 @subsubheading Redis
19824
19825 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
19826 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
19827 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
19828 @end defvr
19829
19830 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
19831 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
19832
19833 @table @asis
19834 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
19835 The Redis package to use.
19836
19837 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19838 Network interface on which to listen.
19839
19840 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
19841 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19842 listening on a TCP socket.
19843
19844 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
19845 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
19846 @end table
19847 @end deftp
19848
19849 @node Mail Services
19850 @subsection Mail Services
19851
19852 @cindex mail
19853 @cindex email
19854 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
19855 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
19856 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
19857 in the subsections below.
19858
19859 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
19860
19861 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
19862 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
19863 @end deffn
19864
19865 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
19866 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
19867 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
19868 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
19869 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
19870 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
19871 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
19872 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
19873
19874 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
19875 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
19876
19877 @lisp
19878 (dovecot-service #:config
19879 (dovecot-configuration
19880 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
19881 @end lisp
19882
19883 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
19884 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
19885 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
19886 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
19887 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
19888 from some other system; see the end for more details.
19889
19890 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
19891 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
19892 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
19893 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
19894 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
19895 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
19896 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
19897
19898 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
19899
19900 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
19901 The dovecot package.
19902 @end deftypevr
19903
19904 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
19905 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
19906 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
19907 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
19908 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
19909 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
19910 @end deftypevr
19911
19912 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
19913 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
19914 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
19915
19916 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
19917
19918 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
19919 The name of the protocol.
19920 @end deftypevr
19921
19922 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
19923 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
19924 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
19925 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
19926 @end deftypevr
19927
19928 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
19929 Space separated list of plugins to load.
19930 @end deftypevr
19931
19932 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
19933 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
19934 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
19935 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19936 @end deftypevr
19937
19938 @end deftypevr
19939
19940 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
19941 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
19942 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
19943 @samp{lmtp}.
19944
19945 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
19946
19947 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
19948 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
19949 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
19950 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
19951 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
19952 @end deftypevr
19953
19954 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
19955 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
19956 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
19957 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
19958 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19959
19960 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
19961
19962 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19963 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19964 the section name.
19965 @end deftypevr
19966
19967 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19968 The access mode for the socket.
19969 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19970 @end deftypevr
19971
19972 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19973 The user to own the socket.
19974 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19975 @end deftypevr
19976
19977 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19978 The group to own the socket.
19979 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19980 @end deftypevr
19981
19982
19983 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
19984
19985 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19986 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19987 the section name.
19988 @end deftypevr
19989
19990 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19991 The access mode for the socket.
19992 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19993 @end deftypevr
19994
19995 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19996 The user to own the socket.
19997 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19998 @end deftypevr
19999
20000 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
20001 The group to own the socket.
20002 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20003 @end deftypevr
20004
20005
20006 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
20007
20008 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
20009 The protocol to listen for.
20010 @end deftypevr
20011
20012 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
20013 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
20014 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20015 @end deftypevr
20016
20017 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
20018 The port on which to listen.
20019 @end deftypevr
20020
20021 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
20022 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
20023 @samp{required}.
20024 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20025 @end deftypevr
20026
20027 @end deftypevr
20028
20029 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
20030 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
20031 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
20032 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
20033 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
20034
20035 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20036
20037 @end deftypevr
20038
20039 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
20040 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
20041 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
20042 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
20043 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20044
20045 @end deftypevr
20046
20047 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
20048 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
20049 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
20050
20051 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20052
20053 @end deftypevr
20054
20055 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
20056 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
20057 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20058 @end deftypevr
20059
20060 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
20061 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
20062 this.
20063 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20064 @end deftypevr
20065
20066 @end deftypevr
20067
20068 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
20069 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
20070 constructor.
20071
20072 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
20073
20074 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
20075 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
20076 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20077 @end deftypevr
20078
20079 @end deftypevr
20080
20081 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
20082 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
20083 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
20084
20085 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
20086
20087 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20088 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
20089 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
20090 @samp{static}.
20091 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
20092 @end deftypevr
20093
20094 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20095 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
20096 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20097 @end deftypevr
20098
20099 @end deftypevr
20100
20101 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
20102 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
20103 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
20104
20105 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
20106
20107 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20108 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
20109 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
20110 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
20111 @end deftypevr
20112
20113 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20114 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
20115 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20116 @end deftypevr
20117
20118 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
20119 Override fields from passwd.
20120 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20121 @end deftypevr
20122
20123 @end deftypevr
20124
20125 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
20126 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
20127 constructor.
20128 @end deftypevr
20129
20130 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
20131 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
20132 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
20133
20134 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
20135
20136 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
20137 Name for this namespace.
20138 @end deftypevr
20139
20140 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
20141 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
20142 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
20143 @end deftypevr
20144
20145 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
20146 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
20147 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
20148 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
20149 format.
20150 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20151 @end deftypevr
20152
20153 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
20154 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
20155 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
20156 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20157 @end deftypevr
20158
20159 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
20160 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
20161 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
20162 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20163 @end deftypevr
20164
20165 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
20166 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
20167 namespace has it.
20168 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20169 @end deftypevr
20170
20171 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
20172 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
20173 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
20174 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
20175 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
20176 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
20177 and @samp{mail/}.
20178 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20179 @end deftypevr
20180
20181 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
20182 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
20183 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
20184 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
20185 hides the namespace prefix.
20186 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20187 @end deftypevr
20188
20189 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
20190 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
20191 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
20192 as @code{#t}).
20193 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20194 @end deftypevr
20195
20196 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
20197 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
20198 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20199
20200 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
20201
20202 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
20203 Name for this mailbox.
20204 @end deftypevr
20205
20206 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
20207 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
20208 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
20209 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20210 @end deftypevr
20211
20212 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
20213 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
20214 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
20215 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
20216 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20217 @end deftypevr
20218
20219 @end deftypevr
20220
20221 @end deftypevr
20222
20223 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
20224 Base directory where to store runtime data.
20225 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
20226 @end deftypevr
20227
20228 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
20229 Greeting message for clients.
20230 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
20231 @end deftypevr
20232
20233 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
20234 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
20235 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
20236 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
20237 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
20238 here.
20239 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20240 @end deftypevr
20241
20242 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
20243 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
20244 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20245 @end deftypevr
20246
20247 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
20248 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
20249 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
20250 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
20251 accounts).
20252 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20253 @end deftypevr
20254
20255 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
20256 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
20257 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
20258 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
20259 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
20260 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20261 @end deftypevr
20262
20263 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
20264 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
20265 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
20266 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20267 @end deftypevr
20268
20269 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
20270 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
20271 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
20272 @end deftypevr
20273
20274 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
20275 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
20276 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
20277 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
20278 @end deftypevr
20279
20280 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
20281 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
20282 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
20283 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
20284 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
20285 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
20286 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20287 @end deftypevr
20288
20289 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
20290 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
20291 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
20292 for caching to be used.
20293 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20294 @end deftypevr
20295
20296 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
20297 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
20298 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
20299 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
20300 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
20301 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
20302 authentication.
20303 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20304 @end deftypevr
20305
20306 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
20307 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
20308 0 disables caching them completely.
20309 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20310 @end deftypevr
20311
20312 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
20313 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
20314 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
20315 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
20316 realm first.
20317 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20318 @end deftypevr
20319
20320 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
20321 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
20322 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
20323 logins.
20324 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20325 @end deftypevr
20326
20327 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
20328 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
20329 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
20330 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
20331 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
20332 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
20333 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
20334 @end deftypevr
20335
20336 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
20337 Username character translations before it's looked up from
20338 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
20339 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
20340 translated to @samp{@@}.
20341 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20342 @end deftypevr
20343
20344 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
20345 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
20346 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
20347 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
20348 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
20349 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
20350 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20351 @end deftypevr
20352
20353 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
20354 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
20355 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
20356 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
20357 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
20358 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
20359 choice.
20360 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20361 @end deftypevr
20362
20363 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
20364 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
20365 mechanism.
20366 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
20367 @end deftypevr
20368
20369 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
20370 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
20371 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
20372 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
20373 Defaults to @samp{30}.
20374 @end deftypevr
20375
20376 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
20377 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
20378 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
20379 allow all keytab entries.
20380 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20381 @end deftypevr
20382
20383 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
20384 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
20385 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
20386 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
20387 file.
20388 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20389 @end deftypevr
20390
20391 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
20392 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
20393 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
20394 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
20395 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20396 @end deftypevr
20397
20398 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
20399 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
20400 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
20401 @end deftypevr
20402
20403 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
20404 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
20405 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
20406 @end deftypevr
20407
20408 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
20409 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
20410 fails.
20411 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20412 @end deftypevr
20413
20414 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
20415 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
20416 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
20417 CommonName.
20418 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20419 @end deftypevr
20420
20421 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
20422 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
20423 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
20424 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
20425 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
20426 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
20427 @end deftypevr
20428
20429 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
20430 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
20431 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
20432 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
20433 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20434 @end deftypevr
20435
20436 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
20437 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
20438 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
20439 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20440 @end deftypevr
20441
20442 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
20443 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
20444 has any connections.
20445 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
20446 @end deftypevr
20447
20448 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
20449 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
20450 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
20451 are shared within domain.
20452 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20453 @end deftypevr
20454
20455 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
20456 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
20457 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
20458 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
20459 @end deftypevr
20460
20461 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
20462 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
20463 @samp{log-path}.
20464 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20465 @end deftypevr
20466
20467 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
20468 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
20469 @samp{info-log-path}.
20470 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20471 @end deftypevr
20472
20473 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
20474 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
20475 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
20476 standard facilities are supported.
20477 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
20478 @end deftypevr
20479
20480 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
20481 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
20482 failed.
20483 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20484 @end deftypevr
20485
20486 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
20487 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
20488 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
20489 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
20490 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
20491 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
20492 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20493 @end deftypevr
20494
20495 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
20496 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
20497 SQL queries.
20498 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20499 @end deftypevr
20500
20501 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
20502 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
20503 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
20504 @samp{auth-debug}.
20505 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20506 @end deftypevr
20507
20508 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
20509 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
20510 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
20511 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20512 @end deftypevr
20513
20514 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
20515 Show protocol level SSL errors.
20516 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20517 @end deftypevr
20518
20519 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
20520 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
20521 strftime(3) format.
20522 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
20523 @end deftypevr
20524
20525 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
20526 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
20527 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
20528 string.
20529 @end deftypevr
20530
20531 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
20532 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
20533 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
20534 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
20535 @end deftypevr
20536
20537 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
20538 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
20539 of possible variables you can use.
20540 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
20541 @end deftypevr
20542
20543 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
20544 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
20545 @table @code
20546 @item %$
20547 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
20548 @item %m
20549 Message-ID
20550 @item %s
20551 Subject
20552 @item %f
20553 From address
20554 @item %p
20555 Physical size
20556 @item %w
20557 Virtual size.
20558 @end table
20559 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
20560 @end deftypevr
20561
20562 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
20563 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
20564 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
20565 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
20566 Dovecot the full location.
20567
20568 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
20569 file (e.g.@: @file{/var/mail/%u}) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
20570 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the @emph{root mail
20571 directory}, and it must be the first path given in the
20572 @samp{mail-location} setting.
20573
20574 There are a few special variables you can use, e.g.:
20575
20576 @table @samp
20577 @item %u
20578 username
20579 @item %n
20580 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
20581 @item %d
20582 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
20583 @item %h
20584 home director
20585 @end table
20586
20587 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
20588 @table @samp
20589 @item maildir:~/Maildir
20590 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
20591 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
20592 @end table
20593 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20594 @end deftypevr
20595
20596 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
20597 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
20598 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
20599 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
20600 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20601 @end deftypevr
20602
20603 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
20604
20605 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20606 @end deftypevr
20607
20608 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
20609 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
20610 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
20611 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to @samp{"mail"} to give access to
20612 @file{/var/mail}.
20613 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20614 @end deftypevr
20615
20616 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
20617 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
20618 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
20619 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create symlinks
20620 (e.g.@: if @samp{mail} group is set here, @code{ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var}
20621 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or @code{ln -s
20622 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox} would allow reading it). Defaults to
20623 @samp{""}.
20624 @end deftypevr
20625
20626 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
20627 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
20628 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID@. It
20629 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
20630 names with e.g.@: @file{/path/} or @file{~user/}.
20631 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20632 @end deftypevr
20633
20634 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
20635 Don't use @code{mmap()} at all. This is required if you store indexes to
20636 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
20637 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20638 @end deftypevr
20639
20640 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
20641 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
20642 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
20643 nowadays by default.
20644 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20645 @end deftypevr
20646
20647 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
20648 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
20649 @table @code
20650 @item optimized
20651 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
20652 @item always
20653 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when @code{write()}s are delayed
20654 @item never
20655 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
20656 @end table
20657 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
20658 @end deftypevr
20659
20660 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
20661 Mail storage exists in NFS@. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
20662 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
20663 this isn't needed.
20664 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20665 @end deftypevr
20666
20667 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
20668 Mail index files also exist in NFS@. Setting this to yes requires
20669 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
20670 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20671 @end deftypevr
20672
20673 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
20674 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
20675 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
20676 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
20677 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
20678 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
20679 @end deftypevr
20680
20681 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
20682 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
20683 kB.
20684 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
20685 @end deftypevr
20686
20687 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
20688 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
20689 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
20690 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
20691 is set to 0.
20692 Defaults to @samp{500}.
20693 @end deftypevr
20694
20695 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
20696
20697 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20698 @end deftypevr
20699
20700 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
20701 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
20702 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
20703 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
20704 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20705 @end deftypevr
20706
20707 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
20708
20709 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20710 @end deftypevr
20711
20712 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
20713 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
20714 trying to create new keywords.
20715 Defaults to @samp{50}.
20716 @end deftypevr
20717
20718 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
20719 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
20720 processes (i.e.@: @file{/var/mail} will allow chrooting to @file{/var/mail/foo/bar}
20721 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
20722 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
20723 @samp{/./} in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
20724 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
20725 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
20726 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20727 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20728 @end deftypevr
20729
20730 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
20731 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
20732 for specific users in user database by giving @samp{/./} in user's home
20733 directory (e.g.@: @samp{/home/./user} chroots into @file{/home}). Note that usually
20734 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
20735 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
20736 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append @samp{/.} to
20737 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20738 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20739 @end deftypevr
20740
20741 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
20742 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
20743 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
20744 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
20745 @end deftypevr
20746
20747 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
20748 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
20749 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
20750 @end deftypevr
20751
20752 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
20753 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
20754 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
20755 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20756 @end deftypevr
20757
20758 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
20759 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
20760 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
20761 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
20762 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20763 @end deftypevr
20764
20765 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
20766 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
20767 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
20768 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
20769 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
20770 occur.
20771 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
20772 @end deftypevr
20773
20774 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
20775 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF@. This makes sending those
20776 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
20777 FreeBSD@. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
20778 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
20779 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
20780 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20781 @end deftypevr
20782
20783 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
20784 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
20785 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
20786 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
20787 causes more disk I/O.
20788 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
20789 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
20790 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20791 @end deftypevr
20792
20793 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
20794 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
20795 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
20796 side effects.
20797 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20798 @end deftypevr
20799
20800 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
20801 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
20802 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
20803 the mail otherwise.
20804 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20805 @end deftypevr
20806
20807 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
20808 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
20809 available:
20810
20811 @table @code
20812 @item dotlock
20813 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
20814 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
20815 need write access to that directory.
20816 @item dotlock-try
20817 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
20818 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
20819 @item fcntl
20820 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
20821 @item flock
20822 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20823 @item lockf
20824 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20825 @end table
20826
20827 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
20828 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
20829 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
20830 them simultaneously.
20831 @end deftypevr
20832
20833 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
20834
20835 @end deftypevr
20836
20837 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
20838 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
20839 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
20840 @end deftypevr
20841
20842 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
20843 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
20844 override the lock file after this much time.
20845 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
20846 @end deftypevr
20847
20848 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
20849 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
20850 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
20851 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
20852 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
20853 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
20854 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
20855 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
20856 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
20857 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
20858 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20859 @end deftypevr
20860
20861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
20862 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
20863 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
20864 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
20865 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20866 @end deftypevr
20867
20868 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
20869 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
20870 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
20871 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
20872 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
20873 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20874 @end deftypevr
20875
20876 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
20877 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
20878 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
20879 updated.
20880 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20881 @end deftypevr
20882
20883 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
20884 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
20885 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
20886 @end deftypevr
20887
20888 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
20889 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
20890 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
20891 disabled.
20892 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
20893 @end deftypevr
20894
20895 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
20896 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
20897 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
20898 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
20899 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20900 @end deftypevr
20901
20902 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
20903 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
20904 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
20905 don't support this for now.
20906
20907 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
20908
20909 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
20910 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20911 @end deftypevr
20912
20913 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
20914 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
20915 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
20916 externally.
20917 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
20918 @end deftypevr
20919
20920 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
20921 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
20922 @table @code
20923 @item posix
20924 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
20925 @item sis posix
20926 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
20927 @item sis-queue posix
20928 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
20929 @end table
20930 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
20931 @end deftypevr
20932
20933 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
20934 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
20935 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
20936 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
20937 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
20938 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
20939 @end deftypevr
20940
20941 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
20942
20943 Defaults to @samp{100}.
20944 @end deftypevr
20945
20946 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
20947
20948 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
20949 @end deftypevr
20950
20951 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
20952 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
20953 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
20954 before they eat up everything.
20955 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20956 @end deftypevr
20957
20958 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
20959 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
20960 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
20961 at all.
20962 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
20963 @end deftypevr
20964
20965 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
20966 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
20967 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
20968 processes.
20969 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
20970 @end deftypevr
20971
20972 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
20973 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
20974 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
20975 @end deftypevr
20976
20977 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
20978 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
20979 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
20980 @end deftypevr
20981
20982 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
20983 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
20984 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
20985 root.
20986 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
20987 @end deftypevr
20988
20989 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
20990 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
20991 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
20992 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
20993 instead to a different.
20994 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20995 @end deftypevr
20996
20997 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
20998 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
20999 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
21000 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
21001 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
21002 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21003 @end deftypevr
21004
21005 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
21006 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
21007 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21008 @end deftypevr
21009
21010 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
21011 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
21012 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
21013 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21014 @end deftypevr
21015
21016 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
21017 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
21018 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
21019 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
21020 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
21021 @end deftypevr
21022
21023 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
21024 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
21025 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
21026 @end deftypevr
21027
21028 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
21029 SSL ciphers to use.
21030 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
21031 @end deftypevr
21032
21033 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
21034 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
21035 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21036 @end deftypevr
21037
21038 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
21039 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
21040 %d expands to recipient domain.
21041 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
21042 @end deftypevr
21043
21044 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21045 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
21046 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
21047 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21048 @end deftypevr
21049
21050 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
21051 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
21052 bouncing the mail.
21053 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21054 @end deftypevr
21055
21056 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
21057 Binary to use for sending mails.
21058 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
21059 @end deftypevr
21060
21061 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
21062 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
21063 sendmail.
21064 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21065 @end deftypevr
21066
21067 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
21068 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
21069 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
21070 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
21071 @end deftypevr
21072
21073 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
21074 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
21075 variables:
21076
21077 @table @code
21078 @item %n
21079 CRLF
21080 @item %r
21081 reason
21082 @item %s
21083 original subject
21084 @item %t
21085 recipient
21086 @end table
21087 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
21088 @end deftypevr
21089
21090 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
21091 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
21092 address.
21093 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
21094 @end deftypevr
21095
21096 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
21097 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
21098 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
21099 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
21100 X-Original-To.
21101 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21102 @end deftypevr
21103
21104 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
21105 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
21106 it?.
21107 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21108 @end deftypevr
21109
21110 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
21111 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
21112 subscribed?.
21113 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21114 @end deftypevr
21115
21116 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
21117 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
21118 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
21119 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
21120 often.
21121 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
21122 @end deftypevr
21123
21124 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
21125 IMAP logout format string:
21126 @table @code
21127 @item %i
21128 total number of bytes read from client
21129 @item %o
21130 total number of bytes sent to client.
21131 @end table
21132 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
21133 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
21134 @end deftypevr
21135
21136 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
21137 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
21138 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
21139 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21140 @end deftypevr
21141
21142 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
21143 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
21144 is IDLEing.
21145 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
21146 @end deftypevr
21147
21148 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
21149 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
21150 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
21151 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
21152 support-email.
21153 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21154 @end deftypevr
21155
21156 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
21157 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
21158 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21159 @end deftypevr
21160
21161 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
21162 Workarounds for various client bugs:
21163
21164 @table @code
21165 @item delay-newmail
21166 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
21167 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
21168 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
21169 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
21170 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
21171 "Headers Only".
21172
21173 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
21174 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
21175 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
21176 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
21177
21178 @item tb-lsub-flags
21179 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
21180 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
21181 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
21182 @end table
21183 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21184 @end deftypevr
21185
21186 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
21187 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
21188 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21189 @end deftypevr
21190
21191
21192 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
21193 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
21194 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
21195 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
21196 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
21197
21198 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
21199 and running. In that case, you can pass an
21200 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
21201 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
21202 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
21203
21204 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
21205
21206 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
21207 The dovecot package.
21208 @end deftypevr
21209
21210 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
21211 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
21212 @end deftypevr
21213
21214 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
21215 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
21216
21217 @lisp
21218 (dovecot-service #:config
21219 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
21220 (string "")))
21221 @end lisp
21222
21223 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
21224
21225 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
21226 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
21227 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
21228 as in this example:
21229
21230 @lisp
21231 (service opensmtpd-service-type
21232 (opensmtpd-configuration
21233 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
21234 @end lisp
21235 @end deffn
21236
21237 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
21238 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
21239
21240 @table @asis
21241 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
21242 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
21243
21244 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
21245 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
21246 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
21247 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
21248 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
21249
21250 @end table
21251 @end deftp
21252
21253 @subsubheading Exim Service
21254
21255 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
21256 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
21257 @cindex SMTP
21258
21259 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
21260 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
21261 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
21262 as in this example:
21263
21264 @lisp
21265 (service exim-service-type
21266 (exim-configuration
21267 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
21268 @end lisp
21269 @end deffn
21270
21271 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
21272 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
21273 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
21274
21275 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
21276 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
21277
21278 @table @asis
21279 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
21280 Package object of the Exim server.
21281
21282 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
21283 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
21284 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
21285 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
21286 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
21287 variables.
21288
21289 @end table
21290 @end deftp
21291
21292 @subsubheading Getmail service
21293
21294 @cindex IMAP
21295 @cindex POP
21296
21297 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
21298 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
21299 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
21300 @end deffn
21301
21302 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
21303
21304 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
21305 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
21306
21307 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
21308
21309 @end deftypevr
21310
21311 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
21312 The getmail package to use.
21313
21314 @end deftypevr
21315
21316 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
21317 The user to run getmail as.
21318
21319 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21320
21321 @end deftypevr
21322
21323 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
21324 The group to run getmail as.
21325
21326 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21327
21328 @end deftypevr
21329
21330 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
21331 The getmail directory to use.
21332
21333 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
21334
21335 @end deftypevr
21336
21337 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
21338 The getmail configuration file to use.
21339
21340 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
21341
21342 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
21343 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
21344
21345 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
21346
21347 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
21348 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
21349 and @samp{static}.
21350
21351 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
21352
21353 @end deftypevr
21354
21355 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
21356 Username to login to the mail server with.
21357
21358 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21359
21360 @end deftypevr
21361
21362 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
21363 Username to login to the mail server with.
21364
21365 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21366
21367 @end deftypevr
21368
21369 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
21370 Port number to connect to.
21371
21372 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21373
21374 @end deftypevr
21375
21376 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
21377 Override fields from passwd.
21378
21379 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21380
21381 @end deftypevr
21382
21383 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
21384 Override fields from passwd.
21385
21386 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21387
21388 @end deftypevr
21389
21390 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
21391 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21392
21393 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21394
21395 @end deftypevr
21396
21397 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
21398 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21399
21400 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21401
21402 @end deftypevr
21403
21404 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
21405 CA certificates to use.
21406
21407 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21408
21409 @end deftypevr
21410
21411 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21412 Extra retriever parameters.
21413
21414 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21415
21416 @end deftypevr
21417
21418 @end deftypevr
21419
21420 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
21421 What to do with retrieved messages.
21422
21423 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
21424
21425 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
21426 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
21427 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
21428
21429 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21430
21431 @end deftypevr
21432
21433 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
21434 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
21435 chosen type.
21436
21437 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21438
21439 @end deftypevr
21440
21441 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21442 Extra destination parameters
21443
21444 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21445
21446 @end deftypevr
21447
21448 @end deftypevr
21449
21450 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
21451 Configure getmail.
21452
21453 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
21454
21455 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
21456 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
21457 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
21458 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
21459 about each of it's actions.
21460
21461 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21462
21463 @end deftypevr
21464
21465 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
21466 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
21467 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
21468
21469 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21470
21471 @end deftypevr
21472
21473 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
21474 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
21475 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
21476 be left on the server.
21477
21478 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21479
21480 @end deftypevr
21481
21482 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
21483 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
21484 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
21485 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
21486 disabled this feature.
21487
21488 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21489
21490 @end deftypevr
21491
21492 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
21493 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
21494 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
21495 disables this feature.
21496
21497 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21498
21499 @end deftypevr
21500
21501 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
21502 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
21503 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
21504
21505 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21506
21507 @end deftypevr
21508
21509 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
21510 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
21511 @samp{0} disables this feature.
21512
21513 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21514
21515 @end deftypevr
21516
21517 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
21518 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
21519
21520 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21521
21522 @end deftypevr
21523
21524 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
21525 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
21526
21527 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21528
21529 @end deftypevr
21530
21531 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
21532 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
21533 @samp{""} disables this feature.
21534
21535 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21536
21537 @end deftypevr
21538
21539 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
21540 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
21541 logger.
21542
21543 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21544
21545 @end deftypevr
21546
21547 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
21548 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
21549 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
21550 information lines.
21551
21552 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21553
21554 @end deftypevr
21555
21556 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21557 Extra options to include.
21558
21559 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21560
21561 @end deftypevr
21562
21563 @end deftypevr
21564
21565 @end deftypevr
21566
21567 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
21568 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
21569 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
21570 extension.
21571
21572 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21573
21574 @end deftypevr
21575
21576 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
21577 Environment variables to set for getmail.
21578
21579 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21580
21581 @end deftypevr
21582
21583 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
21584
21585 @cindex email aliases
21586 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
21587
21588 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
21589 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
21590 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
21591
21592 @lisp
21593 (service mail-aliases-service-type
21594 '(("postmaster" "bob")
21595 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
21596 @end lisp
21597 @end deffn
21598
21599 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
21600 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
21601 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
21602 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
21603 where to deliver this user's mail.
21604
21605 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
21606 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
21607 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
21608 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
21609 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
21610
21611 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21612 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21613
21614 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
21615 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
21616 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
21617 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
21618
21619 @lisp
21620 (service imap4d-service-type
21621 (imap4d-configuration
21622 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
21623 @end lisp
21624 @end deffn
21625
21626 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
21627 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
21628
21629 @table @asis
21630 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
21631 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
21632
21633 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
21634 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21635 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
21636 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
21637
21638 @end table
21639 @end deftp
21640
21641 @subsubheading Radicale Service
21642 @cindex CalDAV
21643 @cindex CardDAV
21644
21645 @deffn {Scheme Variable} radicale-service-type
21646 This is the type of the @uref{https://radicale.org, Radicale} CalDAV/CardDAV
21647 server whose value should be a @code{radicale-configuration}.
21648 @end deffn
21649
21650 @deftp {Data Type} radicale-configuration
21651 Data type representing the configuration of @command{radicale}.
21652
21653 @table @asis
21654 @item @code{package} (default: @code{radicale})
21655 The package that provides @command{radicale}.
21656
21657 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-radicale-config-file})
21658 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21659 on TCP port 5232 of @code{localhost} and use the @code{htpasswd} file at
21660 @file{/var/lib/radicale/users} with no (@code{plain}) encryption.
21661
21662 @end table
21663 @end deftp
21664
21665 @node Messaging Services
21666 @subsection Messaging Services
21667
21668 @cindex messaging
21669 @cindex jabber
21670 @cindex XMPP
21671 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
21672 definitions for messaging services. Currently it provides the following
21673 services:
21674
21675 @subsubheading Prosody Service
21676
21677 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
21678 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
21679 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
21680 record as in this example:
21681
21682 @lisp
21683 (service prosody-service-type
21684 (prosody-configuration
21685 (modules-enabled (cons* "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
21686 (int-components
21687 (list
21688 (int-component-configuration
21689 (hostname "conference.example.net")
21690 (plugin "muc")
21691 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
21692 (virtualhosts
21693 (list
21694 (virtualhost-configuration
21695 (domain "example.net"))))))
21696 @end lisp
21697
21698 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
21699
21700 @end deffn
21701
21702 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
21703 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
21704 Prosody to serve.
21705
21706 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
21707 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
21708
21709 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
21710 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
21711 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
21712
21713 @example
21714 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
21715 @end example
21716
21717 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
21718 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
21719 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
21720 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
21721 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21722
21723 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
21724 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
21725 some other system; see the end for more details.
21726
21727 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
21728 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
21729
21730 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21731 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
21732 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21733 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21734 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21735 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21736 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
21737
21738 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
21739
21740 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
21741 The Prosody package.
21742 @end deftypevr
21743
21744 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
21745 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
21746 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
21747 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
21748 @end deftypevr
21749
21750 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
21751 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
21752 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
21753 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21754 @end deftypevr
21755
21756 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
21757 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
21758 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
21759 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
21760 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
21761 @end deftypevr
21762
21763 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
21764 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
21765 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
21766 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21767 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
21768 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21769 @end deftypevr
21770
21771 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
21772 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
21773 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
21774 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21775 @end deftypevr
21776
21777 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
21778 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
21779 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
21780 Documentation on modules can be found at:
21781 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
21782 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
21783 @end deftypevr
21784
21785 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
21786 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
21787 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
21788 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21789 @end deftypevr
21790
21791 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
21792 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
21793 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
21794 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
21795 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
21796 @end deftypevr
21797
21798 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
21799 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
21800 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21801 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21802 @end deftypevr
21803
21804 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
21805 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
21806 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
21807 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
21808 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
21809
21810 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
21811
21812 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
21813 This determines what handshake to use.
21814 @end deftypevr
21815
21816 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
21817 Path to your private key file.
21818 @end deftypevr
21819
21820 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
21821 Path to your certificate file.
21822 @end deftypevr
21823
21824 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
21825 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
21826 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
21827 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
21828 @end deftypevr
21829
21830 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
21831 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
21832 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
21833 @end deftypevr
21834
21835 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
21836 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
21837 @code{set_verify()} flags).
21838 @end deftypevr
21839
21840 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
21841 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS@. These map to OpenSSL's
21842 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
21843 LuaSec source.
21844 @end deftypevr
21845
21846 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
21847 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
21848 trusted root certificate.
21849 @end deftypevr
21850
21851 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
21852 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
21853 clients, and in what order.
21854 @end deftypevr
21855
21856 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
21857 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
21858 can create such a file with:
21859 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
21860 @end deftypevr
21861
21862 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
21863 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
21864 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
21865 @end deftypevr
21866
21867 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
21868 A list of ``extra'' verification options.
21869 @end deftypevr
21870
21871 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
21872 Password for encrypted private keys.
21873 @end deftypevr
21874
21875 @end deftypevr
21876
21877 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
21878 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21879 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21880 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21881 @end deftypevr
21882
21883 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
21884 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
21885 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
21886 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
21887 @end deftypevr
21888
21889 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
21890 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21891 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21892 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21893 @end deftypevr
21894
21895 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
21896 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
21897 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
21898 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
21899 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21900 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21901 @end deftypevr
21902
21903 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
21904 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
21905 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
21906 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS@. See
21907 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21908 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21909 @end deftypevr
21910
21911 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
21912 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
21913 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
21914 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21915 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21916 @end deftypevr
21917
21918 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
21919 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
21920 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
21921 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
21922 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
21923 about using the hashed backend. See also
21924 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
21925 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
21926 @end deftypevr
21927
21928 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
21929 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
21930 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
21931 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
21932 @end deftypevr
21933
21934 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
21935 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
21936 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
21937 @end deftypevr
21938
21939 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
21940 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
21941 @end deftypevr
21942
21943 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
21944 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
21945 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
21946 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
21947 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
21948 @end deftypevr
21949
21950 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
21951 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
21952 example if you want your users to have addresses like
21953 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
21954 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
21955
21956 Note: the name @emph{virtual} host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
21957 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
21958 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
21959 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
21960 have just one VirtualHost entry.
21961
21962 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
21963
21964 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
21965
21966 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21967 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
21968 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
21969 @end deftypevr
21970
21971 @end deftypevr
21972
21973 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
21974 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
21975 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
21976 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
21977 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
21978
21979 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
21980 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
21981 to use for the component.
21982
21983 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
21984 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21985
21986 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
21987
21988 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21989 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21990 Hostname of the component.
21991 @end deftypevr
21992
21993 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
21994 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
21995 @end deftypevr
21996
21997 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
21998 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
21999 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
22000
22001 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
22002 in the ``Chatrooms'' documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
22003 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
22004
22005 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
22006
22007 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
22008
22009 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
22010 The name to return in service discovery responses.
22011 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
22012 @end deftypevr
22013
22014 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
22015 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
22016 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
22017 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
22018 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
22019 restricts to service administrators only.
22020 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22021 @end deftypevr
22022
22023 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
22024 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
22025 just joined the room.
22026 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22027 @end deftypevr
22028
22029 @end deftypevr
22030
22031 @end deftypevr
22032
22033 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
22034 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
22035 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
22036 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
22037 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22038
22039 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
22040
22041 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
22042 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
22043 Password which the component will use to log in.
22044 @end deftypevr
22045
22046 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22047 Hostname of the component.
22048 @end deftypevr
22049
22050 @end deftypevr
22051
22052 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
22053 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
22054 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
22055 @end deftypevr
22056
22057 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
22058 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
22059 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
22060 @end deftypevr
22061
22062 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
22063 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
22064 @end deftypevr
22065
22066 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
22067 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
22068 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
22069 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
22070 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
22071 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
22072
22073 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
22074 The prosody package.
22075 @end deftypevr
22076
22077 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
22078 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
22079 @end deftypevr
22080
22081 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
22082 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
22083
22084 @lisp
22085 (service prosody-service-type
22086 (opaque-prosody-configuration
22087 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
22088 @end lisp
22089
22090 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
22091
22092 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
22093
22094 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22095 @cindex IRC gateway
22096 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
22097 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
22098
22099 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
22100 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
22101 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
22102 below).
22103
22104 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
22105 services:
22106
22107 @lisp
22108 (service bitlbee-service-type)
22109 @end lisp
22110 @end defvr
22111
22112 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
22113 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
22114
22115 @table @asis
22116 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
22117 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
22118 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
22119 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
22120
22121 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
22122 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
22123 networking interface.
22124
22125 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
22126 The BitlBee package to use.
22127
22128 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
22129 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
22130
22131 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
22132 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
22133 @end table
22134 @end deftp
22135
22136 @subsubheading Quassel Service
22137
22138 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22139 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
22140 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
22141 central core.
22142
22143 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
22144 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
22145 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
22146 (see below).
22147 @end defvr
22148
22149 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
22150 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
22151
22152 @table @asis
22153 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
22154 The Quassel package to use.
22155
22156 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
22157 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
22158 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
22159 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
22160 @var{port}.
22161
22162 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
22163 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
22164 and Error.
22165 @end table
22166 @end deftp
22167
22168 @node Telephony Services
22169 @subsection Telephony Services
22170
22171 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
22172 @cindex VoIP server
22173 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
22174 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
22175 (VoIP) suite.
22176
22177 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
22178 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
22179 look like this:
22180
22181 @lisp
22182 (service murmur-service-type
22183 (murmur-configuration
22184 (welcome-text
22185 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
22186 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
22187 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
22188 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
22189 @end lisp
22190
22191 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
22192 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
22193
22194 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
22195 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
22196 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
22197 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
22198 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
22199 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
22200 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
22201 rights and create some channels.
22202
22203 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
22204
22205 @table @asis
22206 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
22207 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
22208
22209 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22210 User who will run the Murmur server.
22211
22212 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22213 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
22214
22215 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
22216 Port on which the server will listen.
22217
22218 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
22219 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
22220
22221 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
22222 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
22223
22224 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
22225 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
22226
22227 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
22228 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
22229
22230 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
22231 File name of the sqlite database.
22232 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22233
22234 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
22235 File name of the log file.
22236 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22237
22238 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
22239 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
22240 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
22241
22242 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
22243 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
22244
22245 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
22246 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
22247 when violating the autoban limits.
22248
22249 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
22250 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
22251 before switching over to opus audio codec.
22252
22253 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
22254 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
22255
22256 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22257 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
22258
22259 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22260 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
22261
22262 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
22263 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
22264
22265 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
22266 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
22267
22268 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
22269 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
22270 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
22271
22272 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
22273 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
22274 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
22275
22276 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
22277 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
22278
22279 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
22280 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
22281 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
22282 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
22283
22284 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
22285
22286 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
22287 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
22288
22289 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
22290 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
22291
22292 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
22293 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
22294 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
22295 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
22296
22297 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
22298 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
22299
22300 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
22301 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
22302
22303 @lisp
22304 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
22305 @end lisp
22306 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
22307 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
22308 @lisp
22309 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
22310 @end lisp
22311
22312 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
22313 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
22314 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
22315 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
22316 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
22317
22318 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
22319 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
22320 in SSL/TLS.
22321
22322 This option is specified using
22323 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
22324 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
22325
22326 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
22327 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
22328 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
22329 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
22330
22331 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
22332 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
22333 to connect to it.
22334
22335 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
22336 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
22337
22338 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
22339 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
22340 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
22341 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
22342
22343 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
22344
22345 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
22346 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
22347 @end table
22348 @end deftp
22349
22350 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
22351 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
22352
22353 @table @asis
22354 @item @code{name}
22355 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
22356
22357 @item @code{password}
22358 A password to identify your registration.
22359 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
22360
22361 @item @code{url}
22362 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
22363 site.
22364
22365 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
22366 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
22367 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
22368 @end table
22369 @end deftp
22370
22371
22372
22373 @node File-Sharing Services
22374 @subsection File-Sharing Services
22375
22376 The @code{(gnu services file-sharing)} module provides services that
22377 assist with transferring files over peer-to-peer file-sharing networks.
22378
22379 @subsubheading Transmission Daemon Service
22380
22381 @uref{https://transmissionbt.com/, Transmission} is a flexible
22382 BitTorrent client that offers a variety of graphical and command-line
22383 interfaces. A @code{transmission-daemon-service-type} service provides
22384 Transmission's headless variant, @command{transmission-daemon}, as a
22385 system service, allowing users to share files via BitTorrent even when
22386 they are not logged in.
22387
22388 @deffn {Scheme Variable} transmission-daemon-service-type
22389 The service type for the Transmission Daemon BitTorrent client. Its
22390 value must be a @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} object as in
22391 this example:
22392
22393 @lisp
22394 (service transmission-daemon-service-type
22395 (transmission-daemon-configuration
22396 ;; Restrict access to the RPC ("control") interface
22397 (rpc-authentication-required? #t)
22398 (rpc-username "transmission")
22399 (rpc-password
22400 (transmission-password-hash
22401 "transmission" ; desired password
22402 "uKd1uMs9")) ; arbitrary salt value
22403
22404 ;; Accept requests from this and other hosts on the
22405 ;; local network
22406 (rpc-whitelist-enabled? #t)
22407 (rpc-whitelist '("::1" "127.0.0.1" "192.168.0.*"))
22408
22409 ;; Limit bandwidth use during work hours
22410 (alt-speed-down (* 1024 2)) ; 2 MB/s
22411 (alt-speed-up 512) ; 512 kB/s
22412
22413 (alt-speed-time-enabled? #t)
22414 (alt-speed-time-day 'weekdays)
22415 (alt-speed-time-begin
22416 (+ (* 60 8) 30)) ; 8:30 am
22417 (alt-speed-time-end
22418 (+ (* 60 (+ 12 5)) 30)))) ; 5:30 pm
22419 @end lisp
22420 @end deffn
22421
22422 Once the service is started, users can interact with the daemon through
22423 its Web interface (at @code{http://localhost:9091/}) or by using the
22424 @command{transmission-remote} command-line tool, available in the
22425 @code{transmission} package. (Emacs users may want to also consider the
22426 @code{emacs-transmission} package.) Both communicate with the daemon
22427 through its remote procedure call (RPC) interface, which by default is
22428 available to all users on the system; you may wish to change this by
22429 assigning values to the @code{rpc-authentication-required?},
22430 @code{rpc-username} and @code{rpc-password} settings, as shown in the
22431 example above and documented further below.
22432
22433 The value for @code{rpc-password} must be a password hash of the type
22434 generated and used by Transmission clients. This can be copied verbatim
22435 from an existing @file{settings.json} file, if another Transmission
22436 client is already being used. Otherwise, the
22437 @code{transmission-password-hash} and @code{transmission-random-salt}
22438 procedures provided by this module can be used to obtain a suitable hash
22439 value.
22440
22441 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-password-hash @var{password} @var{salt}
22442 Returns a string containing the result of hashing @var{password}
22443 together with @var{salt}, in the format recognized by Transmission
22444 clients for their @code{rpc-password} configuration setting.
22445
22446 @var{salt} must be an eight-character string. The
22447 @code{transmission-random-salt} procedure can be used to generate a
22448 suitable salt value at random.
22449 @end deffn
22450
22451 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-random-salt
22452 Returns a string containing a random, eight-character salt value of the
22453 type generated and used by Transmission clients, suitable for passing to
22454 the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
22455 @end deffn
22456
22457 These procedures are accessible from within a Guile REPL started with
22458 the @command{guix repl} command (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). This is
22459 useful for obtaining a random salt value to provide as the second
22460 parameter to `transmission-password-hash`, as in this example session:
22461
22462 @example
22463 $ guix repl
22464 scheme@@(guix-user)> ,use (gnu services file-sharing)
22465 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-random-salt)
22466 $1 = "uKd1uMs9"
22467 @end example
22468
22469 Alternatively, a complete password hash can generated in a single step:
22470
22471 @example
22472 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-password-hash "transmission"
22473 (transmission-random-salt))
22474 $2 = "@{c8bbc6d1740cd8dc819a6e25563b67812c1c19c9VtFPfdsX"
22475 @end example
22476
22477 The resulting string can be used as-is for the value of
22478 @code{rpc-password}, allowing the password to be kept hidden even in the
22479 operating-system configuration.
22480
22481 Torrent files downloaded by the daemon are directly accessible only to
22482 users in the ``transmission'' user group, who receive read-only access
22483 to the directory specified by the @code{download-dir} configuration
22484 setting (and also the directory specified by @code{incomplete-dir}, if
22485 @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}). Downloaded files can be
22486 moved to another directory or deleted altogether using
22487 @command{transmission-remote} with its @code{--move} and
22488 @code{--remove-and-delete} options.
22489
22490 If the @code{watch-dir-enabled?} setting is set to @code{#t}, users in
22491 the ``transmission'' group are able also to place @file{.torrent} files
22492 in the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} to have the corresponding
22493 torrents added by the daemon. (The @code{trash-original-torrent-files?}
22494 setting controls whether the daemon deletes these files after processing
22495 them.)
22496
22497 Some of the daemon's configuration settings can be changed temporarily
22498 by @command{transmission-remote} and similar tools. To undo these
22499 changes, use the service's @code{reload} action to have the daemon
22500 reload its settings from disk:
22501
22502 @example
22503 # herd reload transmission-daemon
22504 @end example
22505
22506 The full set of available configuration settings is defined by the
22507 @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} data type.
22508
22509 @deftp {Data Type} transmission-daemon-configuration
22510 The data type representing configuration settings for Transmission
22511 Daemon. These correspond directly to the settings recognized by
22512 Transmission clients in their @file{settings.json} file.
22513 @end deftp
22514
22515 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
22516 @c (generate-transmission-daemon-documentation) in (gnu services
22517 @c file-sharing). Manually maintained documentation is better, so we
22518 @c shouldn't hesitate to edit below as needed. However if the change
22519 @c you want to make to this documentation can be done in an automated
22520 @c way, it's probably easier to change (generate-documentation) than to
22521 @c make it below and have to deal with the churn as Transmission Daemon
22522 @c updates.
22523
22524 @c %start of fragment
22525
22526 Available @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} fields are:
22527
22528 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} package transmission
22529 The Transmission package to use.
22530
22531 @end deftypevr
22532
22533 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer stop-wait-period
22534 The period, in seconds, to wait when stopping the service for
22535 @command{transmission-daemon} to exit before killing its process. This
22536 allows the daemon time to complete its housekeeping and send a final
22537 update to trackers as it shuts down. On slow hosts, or hosts with a
22538 slow network connection, this value may need to be increased.
22539
22540 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22541
22542 @end deftypevr
22543
22544 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string download-dir
22545 The directory to which torrent files are downloaded.
22546
22547 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/transmission-daemon/downloads"}.
22548
22549 @end deftypevr
22550
22551 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean incomplete-dir-enabled?
22552 If @code{#t}, files will be held in @code{incomplete-dir} while their
22553 torrent is being downloaded, then moved to @code{download-dir} once the
22554 torrent is complete. Otherwise, files for all torrents (including those
22555 still being downloaded) will be placed in @code{download-dir}.
22556
22557 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22558
22559 @end deftypevr
22560
22561 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string incomplete-dir
22562 The directory in which files from incompletely downloaded torrents will
22563 be held when @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22564
22565 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22566
22567 @end deftypevr
22568
22569 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} umask umask
22570 The file mode creation mask used for downloaded files. (See the
22571 @command{umask} man page for more information.)
22572
22573 Defaults to @samp{18}.
22574
22575 @end deftypevr
22576
22577 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rename-partial-files?
22578 When @code{#t}, ``.part'' is appended to the name of partially
22579 downloaded files.
22580
22581 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22582
22583 @end deftypevr
22584
22585 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} preallocation-mode preallocation
22586 The mode by which space should be preallocated for downloaded files, one
22587 of @code{none}, @code{fast} (or @code{sparse}) and @code{full}.
22588 Specifying @code{full} will minimize disk fragmentation at a cost to
22589 file-creation speed.
22590
22591 Defaults to @samp{fast}.
22592
22593 @end deftypevr
22594
22595 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean watch-dir-enabled?
22596 If @code{#t}, the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} will be
22597 watched for new @file{.torrent} files and the torrents they describe
22598 added automatically (and the original files removed, if
22599 @code{trash-original-torrent-files?} is @code{#t}).
22600
22601 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22602
22603 @end deftypevr
22604
22605 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string watch-dir
22606 The directory to be watched for @file{.torrent} files indicating new
22607 torrents to be added, when @code{watch-dir-enabled} is @code{#t}.
22608
22609 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22610
22611 @end deftypevr
22612
22613 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean trash-original-torrent-files?
22614 When @code{#t}, @file{.torrent} files will be deleted from the watch
22615 directory once their torrent has been added (see
22616 @code{watch-directory-enabled?}).
22617
22618 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22619
22620 @end deftypevr
22621
22622 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-down-enabled?
22623 When @code{#t}, the daemon's download speed will be limited to the rate
22624 specified by @code{speed-limit-down}.
22625
22626 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22627
22628 @end deftypevr
22629
22630 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-down
22631 The default global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
22632
22633 Defaults to @samp{100}.
22634
22635 @end deftypevr
22636
22637 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-up-enabled?
22638 When @code{#t}, the daemon's upload speed will be limited to the rate
22639 specified by @code{speed-limit-up}.
22640
22641 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22642
22643 @end deftypevr
22644
22645 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-up
22646 The default global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
22647
22648 Defaults to @samp{100}.
22649
22650 @end deftypevr
22651
22652 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-enabled?
22653 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
22654 @code{alt-speed-up} are used (in place of @code{speed-limit-down} and
22655 @code{speed-limit-up}, if they are enabled) to constrain the daemon's
22656 bandwidth usage. This can be scheduled to occur automatically at
22657 certain times during the week; see @code{alt-speed-time-enabled?}.
22658
22659 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22660
22661 @end deftypevr
22662
22663 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-down
22664 The alternate global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
22665
22666 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22667
22668 @end deftypevr
22669
22670 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-up
22671 The alternate global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
22672
22673 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22674
22675 @end deftypevr
22676
22677 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-time-enabled?
22678 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
22679 @code{alt-speed-up} will be enabled automatically during the periods
22680 specified by @code{alt-speed-time-day}, @code{alt-speed-time-begin} and
22681 @code{alt-time-speed-end}.
22682
22683 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22684
22685 @end deftypevr
22686
22687 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} day-list alt-speed-time-day
22688 The days of the week on which the alternate-speed schedule should be
22689 used, specified either as a list of days (@code{sunday}, @code{monday},
22690 and so on) or using one of the symbols @code{weekdays}, @code{weekends}
22691 or @code{all}.
22692
22693 Defaults to @samp{all}.
22694
22695 @end deftypevr
22696
22697 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-begin
22698 The time of day at which to enable the alternate speed limits, expressed
22699 as a number of minutes since midnight.
22700
22701 Defaults to @samp{540}.
22702
22703 @end deftypevr
22704
22705 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-end
22706 The time of day at which to disable the alternate speed limits,
22707 expressed as a number of minutes since midnight.
22708
22709 Defaults to @samp{1020}.
22710
22711 @end deftypevr
22712
22713 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv4
22714 The IP address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``0.0.0.0''
22715 to listen at all available IP addresses.
22716
22717 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
22718
22719 @end deftypevr
22720
22721 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv6
22722 The IPv6 address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``::'' to
22723 listen at all available IPv6 addresses.
22724
22725 Defaults to @samp{"::"}.
22726
22727 @end deftypevr
22728
22729 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean peer-port-random-on-start?
22730 If @code{#t}, when the daemon starts it will select a port at random on
22731 which to listen for peer connections, from the range specified
22732 (inclusively) by @code{peer-port-random-low} and
22733 @code{peer-port-random-high}. Otherwise, it listens on the port
22734 specified by @code{peer-port}.
22735
22736 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22737
22738 @end deftypevr
22739
22740 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-low
22741 The lowest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start?}
22742 is @code{#t}.
22743
22744 Defaults to @samp{49152}.
22745
22746 @end deftypevr
22747
22748 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-high
22749 The highest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start}
22750 is @code{#t}.
22751
22752 Defaults to @samp{65535}.
22753
22754 @end deftypevr
22755
22756 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port
22757 The port on which to listen for peer connections when
22758 @code{peer-port-random-on-start?} is @code{#f}.
22759
22760 Defaults to @samp{51413}.
22761
22762 @end deftypevr
22763
22764 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean port-forwarding-enabled?
22765 If @code{#t}, the daemon will attempt to configure port-forwarding on an
22766 upstream gateway automatically using @acronym{UPnP} and
22767 @acronym{NAT-PMP}.
22768
22769 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22770
22771 @end deftypevr
22772
22773 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} encryption-mode encryption
22774 The encryption preference for peer connections, one of
22775 @code{prefer-unencrypted-connections},
22776 @code{prefer-encrypted-connections} or
22777 @code{require-encrypted-connections}.
22778
22779 Defaults to @samp{prefer-encrypted-connections}.
22780
22781 @end deftypevr
22782
22783 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string peer-congestion-algorithm
22784 The TCP congestion-control algorithm to use for peer connections,
22785 specified using a string recognized by the operating system in calls to
22786 @code{setsockopt} (or set to @code{disabled}, in which case the
22787 operating-system default is used).
22788
22789 Note that on GNU/Linux systems, the kernel must be configured to allow
22790 processes to use a congestion-control algorithm not in the default set;
22791 otherwise, it will deny these requests with ``Operation not permitted''.
22792 To see which algorithms are available on your system and which are
22793 currently permitted for use, look at the contents of the files
22794 @file{tcp_available_congestion_control} and
22795 @file{tcp_allowed_congestion_control} in the @file{/proc/sys/net/ipv4}
22796 directory.
22797
22798 As an example, to have Transmission Daemon use
22799 @uref{http://www-ece.rice.edu/networks/TCP-LP/,the TCP Low Priority
22800 congestion-control algorithm}, you'll need to modify your kernel
22801 configuration to build in support for the algorithm, then update your
22802 operating-system configuration to allow its use by adding a
22803 @code{sysctl-service-type} service (or updating the existing one's
22804 configuration) with lines like the following:
22805
22806 @lisp
22807 (service sysctl-service-type
22808 (sysctl-configuration
22809 (settings
22810 ("net.ipv4.tcp_allowed_congestion_control" .
22811 "reno cubic lp"))))
22812 @end lisp
22813
22814 The Transmission Daemon configuration can then be updated with
22815
22816 @lisp
22817 (peer-congestion-algorithm "lp")
22818 @end lisp
22819
22820 and the system reconfigured to have the changes take effect.
22821
22822 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22823
22824 @end deftypevr
22825
22826 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} tcp-type-of-service peer-socket-tos
22827 The type of service to request in outgoing @acronym{TCP} packets, one of
22828 @code{default}, @code{low-cost}, @code{throughput}, @code{low-delay} and
22829 @code{reliability}.
22830
22831 Defaults to @samp{default}.
22832
22833 @end deftypevr
22834
22835 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-global
22836 The global limit on the number of connected peers.
22837
22838 Defaults to @samp{200}.
22839
22840 @end deftypevr
22841
22842 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-per-torrent
22843 The per-torrent limit on the number of connected peers.
22844
22845 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22846
22847 @end deftypevr
22848
22849 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer upload-slots-per-torrent
22850 The maximum number of peers to which the daemon will upload data
22851 simultaneously for each torrent.
22852
22853 Defaults to @samp{14}.
22854
22855 @end deftypevr
22856
22857 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-id-ttl-hours
22858 The maximum lifespan, in hours, of the peer ID associated with each
22859 public torrent before it is regenerated.
22860
22861 Defaults to @samp{6}.
22862
22863 @end deftypevr
22864
22865 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean blocklist-enabled?
22866 When @code{#t}, the daemon will ignore peers mentioned in the blocklist
22867 it has most recently downloaded from @code{blocklist-url}.
22868
22869 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22870
22871 @end deftypevr
22872
22873 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string blocklist-url
22874 The URL of a peer blocklist (in @acronym{P2P}-plaintext or eMule
22875 @file{.dat} format) to be periodically downloaded and applied when
22876 @code{blocklist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22877
22878 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22879
22880 @end deftypevr
22881
22882 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean download-queue-enabled?
22883 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to downloading at most
22884 @code{download-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
22885
22886 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22887
22888 @end deftypevr
22889
22890 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer download-queue-size
22891 The size of the daemon's download queue, which limits the number of
22892 non-stalled torrents it will download at any one time when
22893 @code{download-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22894
22895 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22896
22897 @end deftypevr
22898
22899 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean seed-queue-enabled?
22900 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to seeding at most
22901 @code{seed-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
22902
22903 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22904
22905 @end deftypevr
22906
22907 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer seed-queue-size
22908 The size of the daemon's seed queue, which limits the number of
22909 non-stalled torrents it will seed at any one time when
22910 @code{seed-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22911
22912 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22913
22914 @end deftypevr
22915
22916 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean queue-stalled-enabled?
22917 When @code{#t}, the daemon will consider torrents for which it has not
22918 shared data in the past @code{queue-stalled-minutes} minutes to be
22919 stalled and not count them against its @code{download-queue-size} and
22920 @code{seed-queue-size} limits.
22921
22922 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22923
22924 @end deftypevr
22925
22926 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer queue-stalled-minutes
22927 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent may be idle before it is
22928 considered to be stalled, when @code{queue-stalled-enabled?} is
22929 @code{#t}.
22930
22931 Defaults to @samp{30}.
22932
22933 @end deftypevr
22934
22935 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean ratio-limit-enabled?
22936 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
22937 it reaches the ratio specified by @code{ratio-limit}.
22938
22939 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22940
22941 @end deftypevr
22942
22943 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-rational ratio-limit
22944 The ratio at which a torrent being seeded will be paused, when
22945 @code{ratio-limit-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22946
22947 Defaults to @samp{2.0}.
22948
22949 @end deftypevr
22950
22951 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean idle-seeding-limit-enabled?
22952 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
22953 it has been idle for @code{idle-seeding-limit} minutes.
22954
22955 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22956
22957 @end deftypevr
22958
22959 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer idle-seeding-limit
22960 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent being seeded may be idle
22961 before it is paused, when @code{idle-seeding-limit-enabled?} is
22962 @code{#t}.
22963
22964 Defaults to @samp{30}.
22965
22966 @end deftypevr
22967
22968 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean dht-enabled?
22969 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0005.html,the distributed
22970 hash table (@acronym{DHT}) protocol}, which supports the use of
22971 trackerless torrents.
22972
22973 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22974
22975 @end deftypevr
22976
22977 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean lpd-enabled?
22978 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Local_Peer_Discovery,local
22979 peer discovery} (@acronym{LPD}), which allows the discovery of peers on
22980 the local network and may reduce the amount of data sent over the public
22981 Internet.
22982
22983 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22984
22985 @end deftypevr
22986
22987 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean pex-enabled?
22988 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Peer_exchange,peer exchange}
22989 (@acronym{PEX}), which reduces the daemon's reliance on external
22990 trackers and may improve its performance.
22991
22992 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22993
22994 @end deftypevr
22995
22996 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean utp-enabled?
22997 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0029.html,the micro
22998 transport protocol} (@acronym{uTP}), which aims to reduce the impact of
22999 BitTorrent traffic on other users of the local network while maintaining
23000 full utilization of the available bandwidth.
23001
23002 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23003
23004 @end deftypevr
23005
23006 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-enabled?
23007 If @code{#t}, enable the remote procedure call (@acronym{RPC})
23008 interface, which allows remote control of the daemon via its Web
23009 interface, the @command{transmission-remote} command-line client, and
23010 similar tools.
23011
23012 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23013
23014 @end deftypevr
23015
23016 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-bind-address
23017 The IP address at which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections, or
23018 ``0.0.0.0'' to listen at all available IP addresses.
23019
23020 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
23021
23022 @end deftypevr
23023
23024 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number rpc-port
23025 The port on which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections.
23026
23027 Defaults to @samp{9091}.
23028
23029 @end deftypevr
23030
23031 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-url
23032 The path prefix to use in the @acronym{RPC}-endpoint @acronym{URL}.
23033
23034 Defaults to @samp{"/transmission/"}.
23035
23036 @end deftypevr
23037
23038 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-authentication-required?
23039 When @code{#t}, clients must authenticate (see @code{rpc-username} and
23040 @code{rpc-password}) when using the @acronym{RPC} interface. Note this
23041 has the side effect of disabling host-name whitelisting (see
23042 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?}.
23043
23044 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23045
23046 @end deftypevr
23047
23048 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rpc-username
23049 The username required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23050 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23051
23052 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23053
23054 @end deftypevr
23055
23056 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-transmission-password-hash rpc-password
23057 The password required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23058 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}. This must be
23059 specified using a password hash in the format recognized by Transmission
23060 clients, either copied from an existing @file{settings.json} file or
23061 generated using the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
23062
23063 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23064
23065 @end deftypevr
23066
23067 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-whitelist-enabled?
23068 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23069 originate from an address specified in @code{rpc-whitelist}.
23070
23071 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23072
23073 @end deftypevr
23074
23075 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-whitelist
23076 The list of IP and IPv6 addresses from which @acronym{RPC} requests will
23077 be accepted when @code{rpc-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}. Wildcards
23078 may be specified using @samp{*}.
23079
23080 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1" "::1")}.
23081
23082 @end deftypevr
23083
23084 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?
23085 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23086 are addressed to a host named in @code{rpc-host-whitelist}. Note that
23087 requests to ``localhost'' or ``localhost.'', or to a numeric address,
23088 are always accepted regardless of these settings.
23089
23090 Note also this functionality is disabled when
23091 @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23092
23093 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23094
23095 @end deftypevr
23096
23097 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-host-whitelist
23098 The list of host names recognized by the @acronym{RPC} server when
23099 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23100
23101 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23102
23103 @end deftypevr
23104
23105 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} message-level message-level
23106 The minimum severity level of messages to be logged (to
23107 @file{/var/log/transmission.log}) by the daemon, one of @code{none} (no
23108 logging), @code{error}, @code{info} and @code{debug}.
23109
23110 Defaults to @samp{info}.
23111
23112 @end deftypevr
23113
23114 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean start-added-torrents?
23115 When @code{#t}, torrents are started as soon as they are added;
23116 otherwise, they are added in ``paused'' state.
23117
23118 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23119
23120 @end deftypevr
23121
23122 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean script-torrent-done-enabled?
23123 When @code{#t}, the script specified by
23124 @code{script-torrent-done-filename} will be invoked each time a torrent
23125 completes.
23126
23127 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23128
23129 @end deftypevr
23130
23131 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object script-torrent-done-filename
23132 A file name or file-like object specifying a script to run each time a
23133 torrent completes, when @code{script-torrent-done-enabled?} is
23134 @code{#t}.
23135
23136 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23137
23138 @end deftypevr
23139
23140 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean scrape-paused-torrents-enabled?
23141 When @code{#t}, the daemon will scrape trackers for a torrent even when
23142 the torrent is paused.
23143
23144 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23145
23146 @end deftypevr
23147
23148 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer cache-size-mb
23149 The amount of memory, in megabytes, to allocate for the daemon's
23150 in-memory cache. A larger value may increase performance by reducing
23151 the frequency of disk I/O.
23152
23153 Defaults to @samp{4}.
23154
23155 @end deftypevr
23156
23157 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean prefetch-enabled?
23158 When @code{#t}, the daemon will try to improve I/O performance by
23159 hinting to the operating system which data is likely to be read next
23160 from disk to satisfy requests from peers.
23161
23162 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23163
23164 @end deftypevr
23165
23166
23167 @c %end of fragment
23168
23169
23170
23171 @node Monitoring Services
23172 @subsection Monitoring Services
23173
23174 @subsubheading Tailon Service
23175
23176 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
23177 viewing and searching log files.
23178
23179 The following example will configure the service with default values.
23180 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
23181
23182 @lisp
23183 (service tailon-service-type)
23184 @end lisp
23185
23186 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
23187 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
23188
23189 @lisp
23190 (service tailon-service-type
23191 (tailon-configuration
23192 (config-file
23193 (tailon-configuration-file
23194 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
23195 @end lisp
23196
23197
23198 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
23199 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
23200 This type has the following parameters:
23201
23202 @table @asis
23203 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
23204 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
23205 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
23206 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
23207
23208 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
23209 can be used:
23210
23211 @lisp
23212 (service tailon-service-type
23213 (tailon-configuration
23214 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
23215 @end lisp
23216
23217 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
23218 The tailon package to use.
23219
23220 @end table
23221 @end deftp
23222
23223 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
23224 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
23225 This type has the following parameters:
23226
23227 @table @asis
23228 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
23229 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
23230 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
23231 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
23232 subsection.
23233
23234 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
23235 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
23236
23237 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
23238 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
23239
23240 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
23241 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
23242
23243 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
23244 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
23245
23246 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
23247 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
23248
23249 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
23250 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
23251
23252 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
23253 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
23254
23255 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
23256 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
23257 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
23258 wrap lines.
23259
23260 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
23261 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
23262 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
23263 @code{"basic"}.
23264
23265 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
23266 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
23267 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
23268 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
23269 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
23270
23271 @lisp
23272 (tailon-configuration-file
23273 (http-auth "basic")
23274 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
23275 ("user2" . "password2"))))
23276 @end lisp
23277
23278 @end table
23279 @end deftp
23280
23281
23282 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
23283 @cindex darkstat
23284 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
23285 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
23286
23287 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
23288 This is the service type for the
23289 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
23290 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
23291 this example:
23292
23293 @lisp
23294 (service darkstat-service-type
23295 (darkstat-configuration
23296 (interface "eno1")))
23297 @end lisp
23298 @end defvar
23299
23300 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
23301 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
23302
23303 @table @asis
23304 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
23305 The darkstat package to use.
23306
23307 @item @code{interface}
23308 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
23309
23310 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
23311 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
23312
23313 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
23314 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
23315
23316 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
23317 Specify the path of the base URL@. This can be useful if
23318 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
23319
23320 @end table
23321 @end deftp
23322
23323 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
23324
23325 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
23326 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
23327 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
23328 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
23329 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
23330
23331 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
23332 This is the service type for the
23333 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
23334 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}.
23335
23336 @lisp
23337 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type)
23338 @end lisp
23339 @end defvar
23340
23341 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
23342 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
23343
23344 @table @asis
23345 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
23346 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
23347
23348 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
23349 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
23350
23351 @item @code{textfile-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/prometheus/node-exporter"})
23352 This directory can be used to export metrics specific to this machine.
23353 Files containing metrics in the text format, with the filename ending in
23354 @code{.prom} should be placed in this directory.
23355
23356 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
23357 Extra options to pass to the Prometheus node exporter.
23358
23359 @end table
23360 @end deftp
23361
23362 @subsubheading Zabbix server
23363 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
23364 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
23365 and disk space consumption:
23366
23367 @itemize
23368 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
23369 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
23370 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
23371 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
23372 @item Native high performance agents.
23373 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
23374 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
23375 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
23376 @end itemize
23377
23378 @c %start of fragment
23379
23380 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
23381
23382 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
23383 The zabbix-server package.
23384
23385 @end deftypevr
23386
23387 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
23388 User who will run the Zabbix server.
23389
23390 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23391
23392 @end deftypevr
23393
23394 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
23395 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
23396
23397 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23398
23399 @end deftypevr
23400
23401 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
23402 Database host name.
23403
23404 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
23405
23406 @end deftypevr
23407
23408 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
23409 Database name.
23410
23411 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23412
23413 @end deftypevr
23414
23415 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
23416 Database user.
23417
23418 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23419
23420 @end deftypevr
23421
23422 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
23423 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
23424 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
23425
23426 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23427
23428 @end deftypevr
23429
23430 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
23431 Database port.
23432
23433 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
23434
23435 @end deftypevr
23436
23437 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
23438 Specifies where log messages are written to:
23439
23440 @itemize @bullet
23441 @item
23442 @code{system} - syslog.
23443
23444 @item
23445 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
23446
23447 @item
23448 @code{console} - standard output.
23449
23450 @end itemize
23451
23452 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23453
23454 @end deftypevr
23455
23456 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
23457 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
23458
23459 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
23460
23461 @end deftypevr
23462
23463 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
23464 Name of PID file.
23465
23466 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
23467
23468 @end deftypevr
23469
23470 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
23471 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
23472 certificate verification.
23473
23474 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
23475
23476 @end deftypevr
23477
23478 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
23479 Location of SSL client certificates.
23480
23481 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
23482
23483 @end deftypevr
23484
23485 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
23486 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
23487
23488 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23489
23490 @end deftypevr
23491
23492 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
23493 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
23494 configuration file.
23495
23496 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23497
23498 @end deftypevr
23499
23500 @c %end of fragment
23501
23502 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
23503 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
23504
23505 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
23506
23507 @c %start of fragment
23508
23509 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
23510
23511 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
23512 The zabbix-agent package.
23513
23514 @end deftypevr
23515
23516 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
23517 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
23518
23519 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23520
23521 @end deftypevr
23522
23523 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
23524 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
23525
23526 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23527
23528 @end deftypevr
23529
23530 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
23531 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
23532 must match hostname as configured on the server.
23533
23534 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23535
23536 @end deftypevr
23537
23538 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
23539 Specifies where log messages are written to:
23540
23541 @itemize @bullet
23542 @item
23543 @code{system} - syslog.
23544
23545 @item
23546 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
23547
23548 @item
23549 @code{console} - standard output.
23550
23551 @end itemize
23552
23553 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23554
23555 @end deftypevr
23556
23557 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
23558 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
23559
23560 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
23561
23562 @end deftypevr
23563
23564 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
23565 Name of PID file.
23566
23567 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
23568
23569 @end deftypevr
23570
23571 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
23572 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
23573 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
23574 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
23575
23576 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
23577
23578 @end deftypevr
23579
23580 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
23581 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
23582 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
23583 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
23584
23585 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
23586
23587 @end deftypevr
23588
23589 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
23590 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
23591
23592 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23593
23594 @end deftypevr
23595
23596 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
23597 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
23598 configuration file.
23599
23600 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23601
23602 @end deftypevr
23603
23604 @c %end of fragment
23605
23606 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
23607 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
23608
23609 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
23610
23611 @c %start of fragment
23612
23613 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
23614
23615 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
23616 NGINX configuration.
23617
23618 @end deftypevr
23619
23620 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
23621 Database host name.
23622
23623 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
23624
23625 @end deftypevr
23626
23627 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
23628 Database port.
23629
23630 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
23631
23632 @end deftypevr
23633
23634 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
23635 Database name.
23636
23637 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23638
23639 @end deftypevr
23640
23641 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
23642 Database user.
23643
23644 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23645
23646 @end deftypevr
23647
23648 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
23649 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
23650
23651 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23652
23653 @end deftypevr
23654
23655 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
23656 Secret file containing the credentials for the Zabbix front-end. The value
23657 must be a local file name, not a G-expression. You are expected to create
23658 this file manually. Its contents will be copied into @file{zabbix.conf.php}
23659 as the value of @code{$DB['PASSWORD']}.
23660
23661 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23662
23663 @end deftypevr
23664
23665 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
23666 Zabbix server hostname.
23667
23668 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
23669
23670 @end deftypevr
23671
23672 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
23673 Zabbix server port.
23674
23675 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
23676
23677 @end deftypevr
23678
23679
23680 @c %end of fragment
23681
23682 @node Kerberos Services
23683 @subsection Kerberos Services
23684 @cindex Kerberos
23685
23686 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
23687 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
23688
23689 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
23690
23691 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
23692 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
23693 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
23694 operating system declaration.
23695 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
23696
23697 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
23698 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
23699 Other implementations have not been tested.
23700
23701 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
23702 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
23703 @end defvr
23704
23705 @noindent
23706 Here is an example of its use:
23707 @lisp
23708 (service krb5-service-type
23709 (krb5-configuration
23710 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
23711 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
23712 (realms (list
23713 (krb5-realm
23714 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
23715 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
23716 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
23717 (krb5-realm
23718 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
23719 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
23720 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
23721 @end lisp
23722
23723 @noindent
23724 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
23725 @itemize
23726 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
23727 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
23728 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
23729 specified by clients;
23730 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
23731 @end itemize
23732
23733 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
23734 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
23735 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
23736 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
23737 documentation.
23738
23739
23740 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
23741 @cindex realm, kerberos
23742 @table @asis
23743 @item @code{name}
23744 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
23745 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
23746 converted to upper case.
23747
23748 @item @code{admin-server}
23749 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
23750 running.
23751
23752 @item @code{kdc}
23753 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
23754 for the realm.
23755 @end table
23756 @end deftp
23757
23758 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
23759
23760 @table @asis
23761 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
23762 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
23763 known to be weak will be accepted.
23764
23765 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
23766 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
23767 realm for the client.
23768 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
23769 If this value is @code{#f}
23770 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
23771 such as @command{kinit}.
23772
23773 @item @code{realms}
23774 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
23775 access.
23776 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
23777 field.
23778 @end table
23779 @end deftp
23780
23781
23782 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
23783 @cindex pam-krb5
23784
23785 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
23786 management via Kerberos.
23787 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
23788 users using Kerberos.
23789
23790 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
23791 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
23792 @end defvr
23793
23794 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
23795 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
23796 This type has the following parameters:
23797 @table @asis
23798 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
23799 The pam-krb5 package to use.
23800
23801 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
23802 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
23803 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
23804 @end table
23805 @end deftp
23806
23807
23808 @node LDAP Services
23809 @subsection LDAP Services
23810 @cindex LDAP
23811 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
23812
23813 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
23814 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
23815 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
23816 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
23817 Switch} for detailed information.
23818
23819 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
23820 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
23821 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
23822
23823 @lisp
23824 (use-service-modules authentication)
23825 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
23826 ...
23827 (operating-system
23828 ...
23829 (services
23830 (cons*
23831 (service nslcd-service-type)
23832 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
23833 %base-services))
23834 (name-service-switch
23835 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
23836 (name-service (name "files"))
23837 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
23838 (name-service-switch
23839 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
23840 (password services)
23841 (shadow services)
23842 (group services)
23843 (netgroup services)
23844 (gshadow services)))))
23845 @end lisp
23846
23847 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
23848
23849 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
23850
23851 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
23852 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
23853
23854 @end deftypevr
23855
23856 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
23857 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
23858 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
23859 The default is to start 5 threads.
23860
23861 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23862
23863 @end deftypevr
23864
23865 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
23866 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
23867
23868 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
23869
23870 @end deftypevr
23871
23872 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
23873 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
23874
23875 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
23876
23877 @end deftypevr
23878
23879 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
23880 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
23881 SCHEME and LEVEL@. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols
23882 @samp{none} or @samp{syslog}, or an absolute file name. The LEVEL
23883 argument is optional and specifies the log level. The log level may be
23884 one of the following symbols: @samp{crit}, @samp{error}, @samp{warning},
23885 @samp{notice}, @samp{info} or @samp{debug}. All messages with the
23886 specified log level or higher are logged.
23887
23888 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
23889
23890 @end deftypevr
23891
23892 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
23893 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
23894 used with the following servers as fall-back.
23895
23896 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
23897
23898 @end deftypevr
23899
23900 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
23901 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
23902 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
23903
23904 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23905
23906 @end deftypevr
23907
23908 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
23909 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
23910 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
23911
23912 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23913
23914 @end deftypevr
23915
23916 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
23917 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
23918 applicable when used with binddn.
23919
23920 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23921
23922 @end deftypevr
23923
23924 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
23925 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
23926 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
23927
23928 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23929
23930 @end deftypevr
23931
23932 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
23933 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
23934 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
23935 rootpwmoddn
23936
23937 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23938
23939 @end deftypevr
23940
23941 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
23942 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
23943 authentication.
23944
23945 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23946
23947 @end deftypevr
23948
23949 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
23950 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
23951
23952 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23953
23954 @end deftypevr
23955
23956 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
23957 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
23958 authentication.
23959
23960 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23961
23962 @end deftypevr
23963
23964 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
23965 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
23966 authentication.
23967
23968 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23969
23970 @end deftypevr
23971
23972 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
23973 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
23974 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
23975 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
23976 performed or not.
23977
23978 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23979
23980 @end deftypevr
23981
23982 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
23983 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
23984
23985 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23986
23987 @end deftypevr
23988
23989 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
23990 The directory search base.
23991
23992 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
23993
23994 @end deftypevr
23995
23996 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
23997 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
23998 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
23999 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
24000
24001 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
24002
24003 @end deftypevr
24004
24005 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
24006 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
24007 to never dereference aliases.
24008
24009 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24010
24011 @end deftypevr
24012
24013 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
24014 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
24015 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
24016
24017 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24018
24019 @end deftypevr
24020
24021 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
24022 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
24023 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
24024 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
24025 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
24026
24027 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24028
24029 @end deftypevr
24030
24031 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
24032 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
24033 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
24034
24035 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24036
24037 @end deftypevr
24038
24039 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
24040 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
24041 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
24042
24043 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24044
24045 @end deftypevr
24046
24047 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
24048 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
24049 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
24050 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
24051
24052 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24053
24054 @end deftypevr
24055
24056 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
24057 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
24058 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
24059 out connections.
24060
24061 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24062
24063 @end deftypevr
24064
24065 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
24066 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
24067 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
24068 failure and the first retry.
24069
24070 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24071
24072 @end deftypevr
24073
24074 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
24075 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
24076 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
24077 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
24078
24079 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24080
24081 @end deftypevr
24082
24083 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
24084 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
24085 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
24086 SSL.
24087
24088 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24089
24090 @end deftypevr
24091
24092 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
24093 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
24094 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
24095
24096 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24097
24098 @end deftypevr
24099
24100 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
24101 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
24102 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
24103
24104 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24105
24106 @end deftypevr
24107
24108 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
24109 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
24110
24111 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24112
24113 @end deftypevr
24114
24115 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
24116 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
24117 using GnuTLS.
24118
24119 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24120
24121 @end deftypevr
24122
24123 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
24124 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
24125
24126 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24127
24128 @end deftypevr
24129
24130 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
24131 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
24132 client TLS authentication.
24133
24134 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24135
24136 @end deftypevr
24137
24138 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
24139 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
24140 authentication.
24141
24142 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24143
24144 @end deftypevr
24145
24146 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
24147 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
24148 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
24149 request paged results.
24150
24151 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24152
24153 @end deftypevr
24154
24155 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
24156 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
24157 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
24158 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
24159
24160 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24161
24162 @end deftypevr
24163
24164 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
24165 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
24166 the specified value are ignored.
24167
24168 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24169
24170 @end deftypevr
24171
24172 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
24173 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
24174 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
24175
24176 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24177
24178 @end deftypevr
24179
24180 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
24181 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
24182 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
24183
24184 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24185
24186 @end deftypevr
24187
24188 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
24189 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
24190 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
24191 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
24192 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
24193 groups.
24194
24195 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24196
24197 @end deftypevr
24198
24199 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
24200 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
24201 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
24202 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
24203 groups assigned on login.
24204
24205 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24206
24207 @end deftypevr
24208
24209 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
24210 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
24211 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
24212 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
24213 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
24214 most configurations.
24215
24216 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24217
24218 @end deftypevr
24219
24220 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
24221 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
24222 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
24223 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
24224
24225 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24226
24227 @end deftypevr
24228
24229 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
24230 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
24231 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
24232 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
24233 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
24234
24235 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24236
24237 @end deftypevr
24238
24239 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
24240 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
24241 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
24242
24243 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24244
24245 @end deftypevr
24246
24247 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
24248 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
24249 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
24250 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
24251 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
24252 It should return at least one entry.
24253
24254 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24255
24256 @end deftypevr
24257
24258 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
24259 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
24260 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
24261 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
24262
24263 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24264
24265 @end deftypevr
24266
24267 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
24268 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
24269 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
24270 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
24271 changing their password.
24272
24273 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24274
24275 @end deftypevr
24276
24277 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
24278 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
24279
24280 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24281
24282 @end deftypevr
24283
24284 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
24285
24286
24287 @node Web Services
24288 @subsection Web Services
24289
24290 @cindex web
24291 @cindex www
24292 @cindex HTTP
24293 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
24294 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
24295
24296 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
24297
24298 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
24299 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
24300 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
24301 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
24302
24303 A simple example configuration is given below.
24304
24305 @lisp
24306 (service httpd-service-type
24307 (httpd-configuration
24308 (config
24309 (httpd-config-file
24310 (server-name "www.example.com")
24311 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
24312 @end lisp
24313
24314 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
24315 the configuration.
24316
24317 @lisp
24318 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
24319 (list
24320 (httpd-virtualhost
24321 "*:80"
24322 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
24323 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
24324 "\n")))))
24325 @end lisp
24326 @end deffn
24327
24328 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
24329 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
24330 given below.
24331
24332 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
24333 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
24334
24335 @table @asis
24336 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
24337 The httpd package to use.
24338
24339 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
24340 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
24341
24342 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
24343 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
24344 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
24345 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
24346 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
24347
24348 @end table
24349 @end deffn
24350
24351 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
24352 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
24353
24354 @table @asis
24355 @item @code{name}
24356 The name of the module.
24357
24358 @item @code{file}
24359 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
24360 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
24361 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
24362 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
24363
24364 @end table
24365 @end deffn
24366
24367 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
24368 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
24369 @end defvr
24370
24371 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
24372 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
24373
24374 @table @asis
24375 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
24376 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
24377 additional configuration.
24378
24379 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
24380 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
24381
24382 @lisp
24383 (service httpd-service-type
24384 (httpd-configuration
24385 (config
24386 (httpd-config-file
24387 (modules (cons*
24388 (httpd-module
24389 (name "proxy_module")
24390 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
24391 (httpd-module
24392 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
24393 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
24394 %default-httpd-modules))
24395 (extra-config (list "\
24396 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
24397 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
24398 </FilesMatch>"))))))
24399 (service php-fpm-service-type
24400 (php-fpm-configuration
24401 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
24402 (socket-group "httpd")))
24403 @end lisp
24404
24405 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
24406 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
24407 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
24408 taken as relative to the server root.
24409
24410 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
24411 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
24412 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
24413 itself.
24414
24415 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
24416 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
24417 @code{ServerName}.
24418
24419 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
24420 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
24421
24422 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
24423 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
24424 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
24425 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
24426 protocol to use.
24427
24428 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
24429 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
24430 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
24431 configured correctly.
24432
24433 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
24434 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
24435
24436 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24437 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
24438
24439 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24440 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
24441
24442 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
24443 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
24444 of the configuration file.
24445
24446 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
24447 list.
24448
24449 @end table
24450 @end deffn
24451
24452 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
24453 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
24454
24455 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
24456
24457 @lisp
24458 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
24459 (list
24460 (httpd-virtualhost
24461 "*:80"
24462 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
24463 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
24464 "\n")))))
24465 @end lisp
24466
24467 @table @asis
24468 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
24469 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
24470
24471 @item @code{contents}
24472 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
24473 of strings and G-expressions.
24474
24475 @end table
24476 @end deffn
24477
24478 @subsubheading NGINX
24479
24480 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
24481 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
24482 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
24483
24484 A simple example configuration is given below.
24485
24486 @lisp
24487 (service nginx-service-type
24488 (nginx-configuration
24489 (server-blocks
24490 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24491 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24492 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
24493 @end lisp
24494
24495 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
24496 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
24497 blocks, as in this example:
24498
24499 @lisp
24500 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
24501 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24502 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
24503 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
24504 @end lisp
24505 @end deffn
24506
24507 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
24508 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
24509 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
24510 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
24511 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
24512 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
24513 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
24514 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
24515
24516 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
24517 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
24518 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
24519 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
24520
24521 @table @asis
24522 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
24523 The nginx package to use.
24524
24525 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
24526 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
24527
24528 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
24529 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
24530 files.
24531
24532 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
24533 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
24534 file, the elements should be of type
24535 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
24536
24537 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
24538 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
24539 HTTPS.
24540 @lisp
24541 (service nginx-service-type
24542 (nginx-configuration
24543 (server-blocks
24544 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24545 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24546 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
24547 @end lisp
24548
24549 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
24550 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
24551 file, the elements should be of type
24552 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
24553
24554 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
24555 when combined with @code{locations} in the
24556 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
24557 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
24558 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
24559 requests with two servers.
24560
24561 @lisp
24562 (service
24563 nginx-service-type
24564 (nginx-configuration
24565 (server-blocks
24566 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24567 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24568 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
24569 (locations
24570 (list
24571 (nginx-location-configuration
24572 (uri "/path1")
24573 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
24574 (upstream-blocks
24575 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
24576 (name "server-proxy")
24577 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
24578 "server2.example.com")))))))
24579 @end lisp
24580
24581 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
24582 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
24583 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
24584 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
24585 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
24586 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
24587
24588 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
24589 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
24590 nginx-configuration record.
24591
24592 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
24593 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
24594 use the size of the processors cache line.
24595
24596 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
24597 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
24598
24599 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
24600 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
24601 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
24602
24603 @lisp
24604 (modules
24605 (list
24606 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
24607 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")
24608 (file-append nginx-lua-module "\
24609 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_lua_module.so")))
24610 @end lisp
24611
24612 @item @code{lua-package-path} (default: @code{'()})
24613 List of nginx lua packages to load. This should be a list of package
24614 names of loadable lua modules, as in this example:
24615
24616 @lisp
24617 (lua-package-path (list lua-resty-core
24618 lua-resty-lrucache
24619 lua-resty-signal
24620 lua-tablepool
24621 lua-resty-shell))
24622 @end lisp
24623
24624 @item @code{lua-package-cpath} (default: @code{'()})
24625 List of nginx lua C packages to load. This should be a list of package
24626 names of loadable lua C modules, as in this example:
24627
24628 @lisp
24629 (lua-package-cpath (list lua-resty-signal))
24630 @end lisp
24631
24632 @item @code{global-directives} (default: @code{'((events . ()))})
24633 Association list of global directives for the top level of the nginx
24634 configuration. Values may themselves be association lists.
24635
24636 @lisp
24637 (global-directives
24638 `((worker_processes . 16)
24639 (pcre_jit . on)
24640 (events . ((worker_connections . 1024)))))
24641 @end lisp
24642
24643 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
24644 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
24645 valued G-expression.
24646
24647 @end table
24648 @end deffn
24649
24650 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
24651 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
24652 This type has the following parameters:
24653
24654 @table @asis
24655 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
24656 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
24657 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
24658 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
24659 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
24660
24661 @lisp
24662 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
24663 @end lisp
24664
24665 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
24666 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
24667 default server for connections matching no other server.
24668
24669 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
24670 Root of the website nginx will serve.
24671
24672 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
24673 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
24674 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
24675 server block.
24676
24677 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
24678 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
24679 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
24680
24681 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
24682 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
24683 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
24684
24685 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
24686 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
24687 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
24688
24689 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
24690 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
24691 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
24692
24693 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
24694 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
24695
24696 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
24697 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
24698
24699 @end table
24700 @end deftp
24701
24702 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
24703 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
24704 block. This type has the following parameters:
24705
24706 @table @asis
24707 @item @code{name}
24708 Name for this group of servers.
24709
24710 @item @code{servers}
24711 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
24712 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
24713 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
24714 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
24715 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
24716 explicitly.
24717
24718 @end table
24719 @end deftp
24720
24721 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
24722 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
24723 block. This type has the following parameters:
24724
24725 @table @asis
24726 @item @code{uri}
24727 URI which this location block matches.
24728
24729 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
24730 @item @code{body}
24731 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
24732 many
24733 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
24734 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
24735 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
24736 http://upstream-name;")}.
24737
24738 @end table
24739 @end deftp
24740
24741 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
24742 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
24743 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
24744 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
24745 parameters:
24746
24747 @table @asis
24748 @item @code{name}
24749 Name to identify this location block.
24750
24751 @item @code{body}
24752 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
24753 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
24754 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
24755 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
24756
24757 @end table
24758 @end deftp
24759
24760 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
24761 @cindex Varnish
24762 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
24763 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
24764 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
24765 creates one request to the back-end.
24766
24767 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
24768 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
24769 @end defvr
24770
24771 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
24772 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
24773 This type has the following parameters:
24774
24775 @table @asis
24776 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
24777 The Varnish package to use.
24778
24779 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
24780 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
24781 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
24782 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
24783 directory name.
24784
24785 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
24786 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
24787
24788 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
24789 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
24790
24791 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
24792 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
24793 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
24794 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
24795 VCL syntax.
24796
24797 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
24798 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
24799 can do something along these lines:
24800
24801 @lisp
24802 (define %gnu-mirror
24803 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
24804 "vcl 4.1;
24805 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
24806
24807 (operating-system
24808 ;; @dots{}
24809 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
24810 (varnish-configuration
24811 (listen '(":80"))
24812 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
24813 %base-services)))
24814 @end lisp
24815
24816 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
24817 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
24818
24819 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
24820 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
24821 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
24822
24823 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
24824 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
24825
24826 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
24827 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
24828
24829 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
24830 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
24831
24832 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
24833 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
24834
24835 @end table
24836 @end deftp
24837
24838 @subsubheading Patchwork
24839 @cindex Patchwork
24840 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
24841 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
24842
24843 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
24844 Service type for Patchwork.
24845 @end defvr
24846
24847 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
24848 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
24849
24850 @lisp
24851 (service patchwork-service-type
24852 (patchwork-configuration
24853 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
24854 (settings-module
24855 (patchwork-settings-module
24856 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
24857 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
24858 (getmail-retriever-config
24859 (getmail-retriever-configuration
24860 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
24861 (server "imap.example.com")
24862 (port 993)
24863 (username "patchwork")
24864 (password-command
24865 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
24866 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
24867 (extra-parameters
24868 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
24869
24870 @end lisp
24871
24872 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
24873 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
24874 within the HTTPD service.
24875
24876 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
24877 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
24878 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
24879
24880 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
24881 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
24882 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
24883
24884 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
24885 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
24886 following parameters:
24887
24888 @table @asis
24889 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
24890 The Patchwork package to use.
24891
24892 @item @code{domain}
24893 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
24894 host.
24895
24896 @item @code{settings-module}
24897 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
24898 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
24899 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
24900 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
24901 store.
24902
24903 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
24904 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
24905
24906 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
24907 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
24908 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
24909 delivered to Patchwork.
24910
24911 @end table
24912 @end deftp
24913
24914 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
24915 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
24916 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
24917 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
24918 has the following parameters:
24919
24920 @table @asis
24921 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
24922 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
24923 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
24924
24925 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
24926 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
24927 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
24928
24929 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
24930 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
24931
24932 This setting relates to Django.
24933
24934 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
24935 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
24936 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
24937
24938 This is a Django setting.
24939
24940 @item @code{default-from-email}
24941 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
24942
24943 This is a Patchwork setting.
24944
24945 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
24946 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
24947 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
24948
24949 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
24950 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
24951
24952 This is a Django setting.
24953
24954 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
24955 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
24956 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
24957
24958 This is a Django setting.
24959
24960 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
24961 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
24962 messages will be shown.
24963
24964 This is a Django setting.
24965
24966 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
24967 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
24968
24969 This is a Patchwork setting.
24970
24971 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
24972 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
24973
24974 This is a Patchwork setting.
24975
24976 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
24977 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
24978
24979 This is a Patchwork setting.
24980
24981 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
24982 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
24983
24984 @end table
24985 @end deftp
24986
24987 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
24988 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
24989
24990 @table @asis
24991 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
24992 The database engine to use.
24993
24994 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
24995 The name of the database to use.
24996
24997 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24998 The user to connect to the database as.
24999
25000 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
25001 The password to use when connecting to the database.
25002
25003 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
25004 The host to make the database connection to.
25005
25006 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
25007 The port on which to connect to the database.
25008
25009 @end table
25010 @end deftp
25011
25012 @subsubheading Mumi
25013
25014 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
25015 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
25016 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
25017 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
25018 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
25019 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
25020
25021 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
25022 This is the service type for Mumi.
25023 @end defvr
25024
25025 @deftp {Data Type} mumi-configuration
25026 Data type representing the Mumi service configuration. This type has the
25027 following fields:
25028
25029 @table @asis
25030 @item @code{mumi} (default: @code{mumi})
25031 The Mumi package to use.
25032
25033 @item @code{mailer?} (default: @code{#true})
25034 Whether to enable or disable the mailer component.
25035
25036 @item @code{mumi-configuration-sender}
25037 The email address used as the sender for comments.
25038
25039 @item @code{mumi-configuration-smtp}
25040 A URI to configure the SMTP settings for Mailutils. This could be
25041 something like @code{sendmail:///path/to/bin/msmtp} or any other URI
25042 supported by Mailutils. @xref{SMTP Mailboxes, SMTP Mailboxes,,
25043 mailutils, GNU@tie{}Mailutils}.
25044
25045 @end table
25046 @end deftp
25047
25048
25049 @subsubheading FastCGI
25050 @cindex fastcgi
25051 @cindex fcgiwrap
25052 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
25053 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
25054 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
25055 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
25056 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
25057 support for it in Guix.
25058
25059 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
25060 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
25061 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
25062 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
25063 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
25064 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
25065
25066 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
25067 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
25068 @end defvr
25069
25070 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
25071 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
25072 This type has the following parameters:
25073 @table @asis
25074 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25075 The fcgiwrap package to use.
25076
25077 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
25078 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
25079 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
25080 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
25081 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
25082 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
25083
25084 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25085 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25086 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
25087 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
25088 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
25089 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
25090
25091 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
25092 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
25093 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
25094 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
25095 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
25096 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
25097 @end table
25098 @end deftp
25099
25100 @cindex php-fpm
25101 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
25102 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
25103
25104 These features include:
25105 @itemize @bullet
25106 @item Adaptive process spawning
25107 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
25108 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
25109 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
25110 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
25111 @item Stdout & stderr logging
25112 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
25113 @item Accelerated upload support
25114 @item Support for a "slowlog"
25115 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
25116 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
25117 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
25118 @end itemize
25119 ...@: and much more.
25120
25121 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
25122 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
25123 @end defvr
25124
25125 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
25126 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
25127 @table @asis
25128 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
25129 The php package to use.
25130 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
25131 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
25132 @table @asis
25133 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
25134 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
25135 @item @code{"port"}
25136 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
25137 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
25138 Listen on a unix socket.
25139 @end table
25140
25141 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25142 User who will own the php worker processes.
25143 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25144 Group of the worker processes.
25145 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25146 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25147 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
25148 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25149 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
25150 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
25151 once the service has started.
25152 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
25153 Log for the php-fpm master process.
25154 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
25155 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
25156 Must be one of:
25157 @table @asis
25158 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
25159 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
25160 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
25161 @end table
25162 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
25163 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
25164 and displayed in their browsers.
25165 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
25166 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
25167 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
25168 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
25169 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
25170 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
25171 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
25172 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
25173 An optional override of the whole configuration.
25174 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25175 @item @code{php-ini-file} (default @code{#f})
25176 An optional override of the default php settings.
25177 It may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
25178 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25179
25180 For local development it is useful to set a higher timeout and memory
25181 limit for spawned php processes. This be accomplished with the
25182 following operating system configuration snippet:
25183 @lisp
25184 (define %local-php-ini
25185 (plain-file "php.ini"
25186 "memory_limit = 2G
25187 max_execution_time = 1800"))
25188
25189 (operating-system
25190 ;; @dots{}
25191 (services (cons (service php-fpm-service-type
25192 (php-fpm-configuration
25193 (php-ini-file %local-php-ini)))
25194 %base-services)))
25195 @end lisp
25196
25197 Consult the @url{https://www.php.net/manual/en/ini.core.php,core php.ini
25198 directives} for comprehensive documentation on the acceptable
25199 @file{php.ini} directives.
25200 @end table
25201 @end deftp
25202
25203 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
25204 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
25205 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
25206 based on it's configured limits.
25207 @table @asis
25208 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25209 Maximum of worker processes.
25210 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
25211 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
25212 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
25213 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
25214 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
25215 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
25216 @end table
25217 @end deftp
25218
25219 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
25220 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
25221 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
25222 are created.
25223 @table @asis
25224 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25225 Maximum of worker processes.
25226 @end table
25227 @end deftp
25228
25229 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
25230 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
25231 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
25232 requests arrive.
25233 @table @asis
25234 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25235 Maximum of worker processes.
25236 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
25237 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
25238 @end table
25239 @end deftp
25240
25241
25242 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-location @
25243 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
25244 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
25245 (version-major (package-version php)) @
25246 "-fpm.sock")]
25247 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
25248 @end deffn
25249
25250 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
25251 @lisp
25252 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
25253 (service php-fpm-service-type)
25254 (service nginx-service-type
25255 (nginx-server-configuration
25256 (server-name '("example.com"))
25257 (root "/srv/http/")
25258 (locations
25259 (list (nginx-php-location)))
25260 (listen '("80"))
25261 (ssl-certificate #f)
25262 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
25263 %base-services))
25264 @end lisp
25265
25266 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
25267 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
25268 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
25269 the hash of a user's email address.
25270
25271 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
25272 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
25273 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
25274 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
25275 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
25276 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
25277 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
25278 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
25279 @end deffn
25280
25281 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
25282 @lisp
25283 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
25284 #:configuration
25285 (nginx-server-configuration
25286 (server-name '("example.com"))))
25287 ...
25288 %base-services))
25289 @end lisp
25290
25291 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
25292
25293 @cindex hpcguix-web
25294 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
25295 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
25296 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
25297 clusters.
25298
25299 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
25300 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
25301 @end defvr
25302
25303 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
25304 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
25305
25306 @table @asis
25307 @item @code{specs}
25308 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
25309 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
25310
25311 @table @asis
25312 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
25313 The page title prefix.
25314
25315 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
25316 The @command{guix} command.
25317
25318 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
25319 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
25320
25321 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
25322 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
25323
25324 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
25325 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
25326
25327 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
25328 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
25329
25330 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
25331 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
25332 the latest instances of the given channels.
25333 @end table
25334
25335 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
25336 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
25337 complete example}.
25338
25339 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
25340 The hpcguix-web package to use.
25341 @end table
25342 @end deftp
25343
25344 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
25345
25346 @lisp
25347 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
25348 (hpcguix-web-configuration
25349 (specs
25350 #~(define site-config
25351 (hpcweb-configuration
25352 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
25353 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
25354 @end lisp
25355
25356 @quotation Note
25357 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
25358 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
25359 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
25360 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
25361
25362 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
25363 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
25364 more information on X.509 certificates.
25365 @end quotation
25366
25367 @subsubheading gmnisrv
25368
25369 @cindex gmnisrv
25370 The @uref{https://git.sr.ht/~sircmpwn/gmnisrv, gmnisrv} program is a
25371 simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini} protocol server.
25372
25373 @deffn {Scheme Variable} gmnisrv-service-type
25374 This is the type of the gmnisrv service, whose value should be a
25375 @code{gmnisrv-configuration} object, as in this example:
25376
25377 @lisp
25378 (service gmnisrv-service-type
25379 (gmnisrv-configuration
25380 (config-file (local-file "./my-gmnisrv.ini"))))
25381 @end lisp
25382 @end deffn
25383
25384 @deftp {Data Type} gmnisrv-configuration
25385 Data type representing the configuration of gmnisrv.
25386
25387 @table @asis
25388 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gmnisrv})
25389 Package object of the gmnisrv server.
25390
25391 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-gmnisrv-config-file})
25392 File-like object of the gmnisrv configuration file to use. The default
25393 configuration listens on port 1965 and serves files from
25394 @file{/srv/gemini}. Certificates are stored in
25395 @file{/var/lib/gemini/certs}. For more information, run @command{man
25396 gmnisrv} and @command{man gmnisrv.ini}.
25397
25398 @end table
25399 @end deftp
25400
25401 @subsubheading Agate
25402
25403 @cindex agate
25404 The @uref{gemini://qwertqwefsday.eu/agate.gmi, Agate}
25405 (@uref{https://github.com/mbrubeck/agate, GitHub page over HTTPS})
25406 program is a simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini}
25407 protocol server written in Rust.
25408
25409 @deffn {Scheme Variable} agate-service-type
25410 This is the type of the agate service, whose value should be an
25411 @code{agate-service-type} object, as in this example:
25412
25413 @lisp
25414 (service agate-service-type
25415 (agate-configuration
25416 (content "/srv/gemini")
25417 (cert "/srv/cert.pem")
25418 (key "/srv/key.rsa")))
25419 @end lisp
25420
25421 The example above represents the minimal tweaking necessary to get Agate
25422 up and running. Specifying the path to the certificate and key is
25423 always necessary, as the Gemini protocol requires TLS by default.
25424
25425 To obtain a certificate and a key, you could, for example, use OpenSSL,
25426 running a command similar to the following example:
25427
25428 @example
25429 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:4096 -keyout key.rsa -out cert.pem \
25430 -days 3650 -nodes -subj "/CN=example.com"
25431 @end example
25432
25433 Of course, you'll have to replace @i{example.com} with your own domain
25434 name, and then point the Agate configuration towards the path of the
25435 generated key and certificate.
25436
25437 @end deffn
25438
25439 @deftp {Data Type} agate-configuration
25440 Data type representing the configuration of Agate.
25441
25442 @table @asis
25443 @item @code{package} (default: @code{agate})
25444 The package object of the Agate server.
25445
25446 @item @code{content} (default: @file{"/srv/gemini"})
25447 The directory from which Agate will serve files.
25448
25449 @item @code{cert} (default: @code{#f})
25450 The path to the TLS certificate PEM file to be used for encrypted
25451 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
25452
25453 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
25454 The path to the PKCS8 private key file to be used for encrypted
25455 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
25456
25457 @item @code{addr} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0:1965" "[::]:1965")})
25458 A list of the addresses to listen on.
25459
25460 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
25461 The domain name of this Gemini server. Optional.
25462
25463 @item @code{lang} (default: @code{#f})
25464 RFC 4646 language code(s) for text/gemini documents. Optional.
25465
25466 @item @code{silent?} (default: @code{#f})
25467 Set to @code{#t} to disable logging output.
25468
25469 @item @code{serve-secret?} (default: @code{#f})
25470 Set to @code{#t} to serve secret files (files/directories starting with
25471 a dot).
25472
25473 @item @code{log-ip?} (default: @code{#t})
25474 Whether or not to output IP addresses when logging.
25475
25476 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"agate"})
25477 Owner of the @code{agate} process.
25478
25479 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"agate"})
25480 Owner's group of the @code{agate} process.
25481
25482 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/agate.log"})
25483 The file which should store the logging output of Agate.
25484
25485 @end table
25486 @end deftp
25487
25488 @node Certificate Services
25489 @subsection Certificate Services
25490
25491 @cindex Web
25492 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
25493 @cindex Let's Encrypt
25494 @cindex TLS certificates
25495 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
25496 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
25497 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
25498 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
25499 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
25500 authenticity.
25501
25502 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
25503 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
25504 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
25505 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
25506 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
25507 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
25508 response over HTTP@. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
25509 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
25510 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
25511 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
25512 signature.
25513
25514 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
25515 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
25516 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
25517 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
25518 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
25519 with different permissions).
25520
25521 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
25522 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
25523 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
25524 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
25525 some reason.
25526
25527 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
25528 can be found there:
25529 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
25530
25531 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
25532 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
25533 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
25534
25535 @lisp
25536 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
25537 (program-file
25538 "nginx-deploy-hook"
25539 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
25540 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
25541
25542 (service certbot-service-type
25543 (certbot-configuration
25544 (email "foo@@example.net")
25545 (certificates
25546 (list
25547 (certificate-configuration
25548 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
25549 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
25550 (certificate-configuration
25551 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
25552 @end lisp
25553
25554 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
25555 @end defvr
25556
25557 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
25558 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
25559 This type has the following parameters:
25560
25561 @table @asis
25562 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
25563 The certbot package to use.
25564
25565 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
25566 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
25567 files.
25568
25569 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
25570 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
25571 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
25572 and several @code{domains}.
25573
25574 @item @code{email} (default: @code{#f})
25575 Optional email address used for registration and recovery contact.
25576 Setting this is encouraged as it allows you to receive important
25577 notifications about the account and issued certificates.
25578
25579 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
25580 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
25581 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
25582
25583 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
25584 Size of the RSA key.
25585
25586 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
25587 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
25588 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
25589 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
25590 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
25591 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
25592 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
25593 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
25594 these nginx configuration data types.
25595
25596 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
25597 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
25598 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
25599
25600 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
25601 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
25602 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
25603
25604 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
25605 @end table
25606 @end deftp
25607
25608 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
25609 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
25610 This type has the following parameters:
25611
25612 @table @asis
25613 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
25614 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
25615 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
25616 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
25617
25618 Its default is the first provided domain.
25619
25620 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
25621 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
25622 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
25623
25624 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
25625 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
25626 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
25627 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
25628 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
25629 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
25630 requesting machine.
25631
25632 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25633 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
25634 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
25635 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
25636 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
25637 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
25638
25639 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25640 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
25641 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
25642 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
25643 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
25644 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
25645
25646 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25647 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
25648 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
25649 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
25650 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
25651 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
25652 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
25653 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
25654
25655 @end table
25656 @end deftp
25657
25658 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
25659 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
25660 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
25661 @node DNS Services
25662 @subsection DNS Services
25663 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
25664 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
25665
25666 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
25667 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
25668 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
25669 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
25670 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
25671 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
25672
25673 @subsubheading Knot Service
25674
25675 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
25676 and one slave, is:
25677
25678 @lisp
25679 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
25680 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
25681 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
25682 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
25683 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
25684
25685 (define master-zone
25686 (knot-zone-configuration
25687 (domain "example.org")
25688 (zone (zone-file
25689 (origin "example.org")
25690 (entries example.org.zone)))))
25691
25692 (define slave-zone
25693 (knot-zone-configuration
25694 (domain "plop.org")
25695 (dnssec-policy "default")
25696 (master (list "plop-master"))))
25697
25698 (define plop-master
25699 (knot-remote-configuration
25700 (id "plop-master")
25701 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
25702
25703 (operating-system
25704 ;; ...
25705 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
25706 (knot-configuration
25707 (remotes (list plop-master))
25708 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
25709 ;; ...
25710 %base-services)))
25711 @end lisp
25712
25713 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
25714 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
25715
25716 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
25717 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
25718 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
25719 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
25720 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
25721 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
25722 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
25723
25724 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
25725 @end deffn
25726
25727 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
25728 Data type representing a key.
25729 This type has the following parameters:
25730
25731 @table @asis
25732 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25733 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
25734 be unique and must not be empty.
25735
25736 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
25737 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
25738 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
25739 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
25740
25741 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
25742 The secret key itself.
25743
25744 @end table
25745 @end deftp
25746
25747 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
25748 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
25749 This type has the following parameters:
25750
25751 @table @asis
25752 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25753 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
25754 unique and must not be empty.
25755
25756 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
25757 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
25758 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
25759 address match is not required.
25760
25761 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
25762 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
25763 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
25764 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
25765
25766 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
25767 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL@. Possible
25768 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
25769 and @code{'update}.
25770
25771 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
25772 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
25773 false, listed actions are allowed.
25774
25775 @end table
25776 @end deftp
25777
25778 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
25779 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
25780 This type has the following parameters:
25781
25782 @table @asis
25783 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
25784 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
25785 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
25786 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
25787 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
25788 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
25789
25790 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
25791 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
25792
25793 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
25794 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
25795 partially @code{"CH"}.
25796
25797 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
25798 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
25799 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
25800 defined.
25801
25802 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
25803 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
25804 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
25805 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
25806
25807 @end table
25808 @end deftp
25809
25810 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
25811 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
25812 This type has the following parameters:
25813
25814 @table @asis
25815 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
25816 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
25817 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
25818 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
25819 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
25820 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
25821 field of the @code{zone-file}.
25822
25823 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
25824 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
25825
25826 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
25827 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
25828 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
25829 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
25830 to an IP address in the list of entries.
25831
25832 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
25833 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
25834 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
25835
25836 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
25837 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
25838 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
25839 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
25840
25841 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
25842 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
25843 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
25844 @code{(string->duration)}.
25845
25846 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
25847 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
25848 to do so a first time.
25849
25850 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
25851 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
25852 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
25853 and check again that it still exists.
25854
25855 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
25856 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
25857 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
25858
25859 @end table
25860 @end deftp
25861
25862 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
25863 Data type representing a remote configuration.
25864 This type has the following parameters:
25865
25866 @table @asis
25867 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25868 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
25869 be unique and must not be empty.
25870
25871 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
25872 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
25873 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
25874 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
25875
25876 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
25877 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
25878 an appropriate source IP@. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
25879 The default is to choose at random.
25880
25881 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
25882 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
25883 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
25884
25885 @end table
25886 @end deftp
25887
25888 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
25889 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
25890 This type has the following parameters:
25891
25892 @table @asis
25893 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25894 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
25895
25896 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
25897 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
25898
25899 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
25900 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
25901 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
25902 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
25903
25904 @end table
25905 @end deftp
25906
25907 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
25908 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
25909 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
25910 use keys that you generate.
25911
25912 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
25913 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
25914 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
25915 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
25916 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
25917 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
25918
25919 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
25920 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
25921 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
25922 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
25923 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
25924
25925 This type has the following parameters:
25926
25927 @table @asis
25928 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25929 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
25930
25931 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
25932 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
25933 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
25934 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
25935 was setup by this service).
25936
25937 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
25938 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
25939
25940 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
25941 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
25942
25943 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
25944 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
25945
25946 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
25947 The length of the KSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
25948 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
25949
25950 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
25951 The length of the ZSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
25952 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
25953
25954 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
25955 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
25956 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
25957
25958 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
25959 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
25960
25961 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
25962 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
25963 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
25964
25965 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
25966 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
25967
25968 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
25969 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
25970
25971 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
25972 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
25973
25974 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
25975 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
25976
25977 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
25978 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
25979 name before hashing.
25980
25981 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
25982 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
25983
25984 @end table
25985 @end deftp
25986
25987 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
25988 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
25989 This type has the following parameters:
25990
25991 @table @asis
25992 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
25993 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
25994
25995 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
25996 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
25997 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
25998
25999 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
26000 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
26001 must contain a zone-file record.
26002
26003 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
26004 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
26005 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
26006
26007 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
26008 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
26009 masters.
26010
26011 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
26012 A list of slave remote identifiers.
26013
26014 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
26015 A list of acl identifiers.
26016
26017 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
26018 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
26019
26020 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
26021 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
26022
26023 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
26024 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
26025 synchronization.
26026
26027 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
26028 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
26029 are:
26030
26031 @itemize
26032 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
26033 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
26034 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
26035 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
26036 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
26037 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
26038 automatically.
26039 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
26040 @end itemize
26041
26042 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
26043 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
26044 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
26045 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26046 default value from Knot is used.
26047
26048 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
26049 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
26050 so the default value from Knot is used.
26051
26052 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
26053 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26054 default value from Knot is used.
26055
26056 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
26057 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
26058 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
26059 value from Knot is used.
26060
26061 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
26062 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
26063 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
26064 on this zone.
26065
26066 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
26067 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
26068
26069 @end table
26070 @end deftp
26071
26072 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
26073 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
26074 This type has the following parameters:
26075
26076 @table @asis
26077 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
26078 The Knot package.
26079
26080 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
26081 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
26082
26083 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
26084 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
26085 included at the top of the configuration file.
26086
26087 @cindex secrets, Knot service
26088 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
26089 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
26090 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
26091 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
26092 to the @code{includes} list.
26093
26094 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
26095 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
26096 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
26097 tsig key:
26098
26099 @example
26100 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26101 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26102 @end example
26103
26104 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
26105 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
26106 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
26107 to that key.
26108
26109 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
26110
26111 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
26112 An ip address on which to listen.
26113
26114 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
26115 An ip address on which to listen.
26116
26117 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
26118 A port on which to listen.
26119
26120 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
26121 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
26122
26123 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
26124 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
26125
26126 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
26127 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
26128
26129 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
26130 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
26131
26132 @end table
26133 @end deftp
26134
26135 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
26136
26137 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
26138 This is the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
26139 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
26140
26141 @lisp
26142 (service knot-resolver-service-type
26143 (knot-resolver-configuration
26144 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
26145 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
26146 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
26147 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
26148 cache.size = 100 * MB
26149 "))))
26150 @end lisp
26151
26152 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
26153 @end deffn
26154
26155 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
26156 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
26157
26158 @table @asis
26159 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
26160 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
26161
26162 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
26163 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
26164 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
26165
26166 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
26167 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
26168
26169 @end table
26170 @end deftp
26171
26172
26173 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
26174
26175 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
26176 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
26177 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
26178
26179 @lisp
26180 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26181 (dnsmasq-configuration
26182 (no-resolv? #t)
26183 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
26184 @end lisp
26185 @end deffn
26186
26187 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
26188 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
26189
26190 @table @asis
26191 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
26192 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
26193
26194 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
26195 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
26196
26197 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
26198 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
26199 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
26200
26201 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
26202 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
26203 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
26204
26205 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26206 Listen on the given IP addresses.
26207
26208 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
26209 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
26210
26211 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
26212 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
26213
26214 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
26215 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
26216
26217 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26218 For each entry, specify an IP address to return for any host in the
26219 given domains. Queries in the domains are never forwarded and always
26220 replied to with the specified IP address.
26221
26222 This is useful for redirecting hosts locally, for example:
26223
26224 @lisp
26225 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26226 (dnsmasq-configuration
26227 (addresses
26228 '(; Redirect to a local web-server.
26229 "/example.org/127.0.0.1"
26230 ; Redirect subdomain to a specific IP.
26231 "/subdomain.example.org/192.168.1.42"))))
26232 @end lisp
26233
26234 Note that rules in @file{/etc/hosts} take precedence over this.
26235
26236 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
26237 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
26238 disables caching.
26239
26240 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
26241 When false, disable negative caching.
26242
26243 @item @code{tftp-enable?} (default: @code{#f})
26244 Whether to enable the built-in TFTP server.
26245
26246 @item @code{tftp-no-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
26247 If true, does not fail dnsmasq if the TFTP server could not start up.
26248
26249 @item @code{tftp-single-port?} (default: @code{#f})
26250 Whether to use only one single port for TFTP.
26251
26252 @item @code{tftp-secure?} (default: @code{#f})
26253 If true, only files owned by the user running the dnsmasq process are accessible.
26254
26255 If dnsmasq is being run as root, different rules apply:
26256 @code{tftp-secure?} has no effect, but only files which have the
26257 world-readable bit set are accessible.
26258
26259 @item @code{tftp-max} (default: @code{#f})
26260 If set, sets the maximal number of concurrent connections allowed.
26261
26262 @item @code{tftp-mtu} (default: @code{#f})
26263 If set, sets the MTU for TFTP packets to that value.
26264
26265 @item @code{tftp-no-blocksize?} (default: @code{#f})
26266 If true, stops the TFTP server from negotiating the blocksize with a client.
26267
26268 @item @code{tftp-lowercase?} (default: @code{#f})
26269 Whether to convert all filenames in TFTP requests to lowercase.
26270
26271 @item @code{tftp-port-range} (default: @code{#f})
26272 If set, fixes the dynamical ports (one per client) to the given range
26273 (@code{"<start>,<end>"}).
26274
26275 @item @code{tftp-root} (default: @code{/var/empty,lo})
26276 Look for files to transfer using TFTP relative to the given directory.
26277 When this is set, TFTP paths which include @samp{..} are rejected, to stop clients
26278 getting outside the specified root. Absolute paths (starting with @samp{/}) are
26279 allowed, but they must be within the TFTP-root. If the optional interface
26280 argument is given, the directory is only used for TFTP requests via that
26281 interface.
26282
26283 @item @code{tftp-unique-root} (default: @code{#f})
26284 If set, add the IP or hardware address of the TFTP client as a path component
26285 on the end of the TFTP-root. Only valid if a TFTP root is set and the
26286 directory exists. Defaults to adding IP address (in standard dotted-quad
26287 format).
26288
26289 For instance, if @option{--tftp-root} is @samp{/tftp} and client
26290 @samp{1.2.3.4} requests file @file{myfile} then the effective path will
26291 be @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4/myfile} if @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4} exists or
26292 @file{/tftp/myfile} otherwise. When @samp{=mac} is specified it will
26293 append the MAC address instead, using lowercase zero padded digits
26294 separated by dashes, e.g.: @samp{01-02-03-04-aa-bb}. Note that
26295 resolving MAC addresses is only possible if the client is in the local
26296 network or obtained a DHCP lease from dnsmasq.
26297
26298 @end table
26299 @end deftp
26300
26301 @subsubheading ddclient Service
26302
26303 @cindex ddclient
26304 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
26305 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
26306 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
26307
26308 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
26309 configuration:
26310
26311 @lisp
26312 (service ddclient-service-type)
26313 @end lisp
26314
26315 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
26316 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
26317 @code{secret-file} below). You are expected to create this file manually, in
26318 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
26319 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
26320 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}). See the examples in the
26321 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
26322
26323 @c %start of fragment
26324
26325 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
26326
26327 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
26328 The ddclient package.
26329
26330 @end deftypevr
26331
26332 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
26333 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
26334
26335 Defaults to @samp{300}.
26336
26337 @end deftypevr
26338
26339 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
26340 Use syslog for the output.
26341
26342 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26343
26344 @end deftypevr
26345
26346 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
26347 Mail to user.
26348
26349 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26350
26351 @end deftypevr
26352
26353 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
26354 Mail failed update to user.
26355
26356 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26357
26358 @end deftypevr
26359
26360 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
26361 The ddclient PID file.
26362
26363 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
26364
26365 @end deftypevr
26366
26367 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
26368 Enable SSL support.
26369
26370 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26371
26372 @end deftypevr
26373
26374 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
26375 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
26376 program.
26377
26378 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
26379
26380 @end deftypevr
26381
26382 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
26383 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
26384
26385 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
26386
26387 @end deftypevr
26388
26389 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
26390 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
26391 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
26392 create it manually.
26393
26394 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
26395
26396 @end deftypevr
26397
26398 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
26399 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
26400
26401 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26402
26403 @end deftypevr
26404
26405
26406 @c %end of fragment
26407
26408
26409 @node VPN Services
26410 @subsection VPN Services
26411 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
26412 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
26413
26414 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
26415 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs).
26416
26417 @subsubheading OpenVPN
26418
26419 It provides a @emph{client} service for your machine to connect to a
26420 VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine to host a VPN@.
26421
26422 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
26423 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
26424
26425 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
26426 @end deffn
26427
26428 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
26429 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
26430
26431 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
26432
26433 Both can be run simultaneously.
26434 @end deffn
26435
26436 @c %automatically generated documentation
26437
26438 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
26439
26440 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
26441 The OpenVPN package.
26442
26443 @end deftypevr
26444
26445 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
26446 The OpenVPN pid file.
26447
26448 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
26449
26450 @end deftypevr
26451
26452 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
26453 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
26454 servers.
26455
26456 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
26457
26458 @end deftypevr
26459
26460 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
26461 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
26462
26463 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
26464
26465 @end deftypevr
26466
26467 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
26468 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
26469 it to @code{'disabled}.
26470
26471 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
26472 The certificate authority to check connections against.
26473
26474 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
26475
26476 @end deftypevr
26477
26478 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
26479 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
26480 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
26481
26482 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
26483
26484 @end deftypevr
26485
26486 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
26487 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
26488 certificate is @code{cert}.
26489
26490 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
26491
26492 @end deftypevr
26493
26494 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
26495 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
26496
26497 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26498
26499 @end deftypevr
26500
26501 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
26502 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
26503
26504 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26505
26506 @end deftypevr
26507
26508 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
26509 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
26510 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
26511
26512 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26513
26514 @end deftypevr
26515
26516 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
26517 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
26518 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
26519
26520 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26521 @end deftypevr
26522
26523 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
26524 Verbosity level.
26525
26526 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26527
26528 @end deftypevr
26529
26530 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
26531 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
26532 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
26533
26534 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26535
26536 @end deftypevr
26537
26538 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
26539 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
26540 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
26541 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
26542
26543 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
26544 @end deftypevr
26545
26546 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
26547 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
26548
26549 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26550
26551 @end deftypevr
26552
26553 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
26554 Bind to a specific local port number.
26555
26556 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26557
26558 @end deftypevr
26559
26560 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
26561 Retry resolving server address.
26562
26563 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26564
26565 @end deftypevr
26566
26567 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
26568 A list of remote servers to connect to.
26569
26570 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26571
26572 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
26573
26574 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
26575 Server name.
26576
26577 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
26578
26579 @end deftypevr
26580
26581 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
26582 Port number the server listens to.
26583
26584 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
26585
26586 @end deftypevr
26587
26588 @end deftypevr
26589 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
26590
26591 @c %automatically generated documentation
26592
26593 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
26594
26595 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
26596 The OpenVPN package.
26597
26598 @end deftypevr
26599
26600 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
26601 The OpenVPN pid file.
26602
26603 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
26604
26605 @end deftypevr
26606
26607 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
26608 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
26609 servers.
26610
26611 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
26612
26613 @end deftypevr
26614
26615 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
26616 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
26617
26618 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
26619
26620 @end deftypevr
26621
26622 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
26623 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
26624 it to @code{'disabled}.
26625
26626 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
26627 The certificate authority to check connections against.
26628
26629 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
26630
26631 @end deftypevr
26632
26633 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
26634 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
26635 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
26636
26637 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
26638
26639 @end deftypevr
26640
26641 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
26642 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
26643 certificate is @code{cert}.
26644
26645 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
26646
26647 @end deftypevr
26648
26649 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
26650 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
26651
26652 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26653
26654 @end deftypevr
26655
26656 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
26657 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
26658
26659 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26660
26661 @end deftypevr
26662
26663 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
26664 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
26665 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
26666
26667 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26668
26669 @end deftypevr
26670
26671 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
26672 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
26673 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
26674
26675 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26676 @end deftypevr
26677
26678 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
26679 Verbosity level.
26680
26681 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26682
26683 @end deftypevr
26684
26685 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
26686 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
26687 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
26688
26689 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26690
26691 @end deftypevr
26692
26693 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
26694 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
26695
26696 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
26697
26698 @end deftypevr
26699
26700 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
26701 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
26702
26703 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
26704
26705 @end deftypevr
26706
26707 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
26708 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
26709
26710 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26711
26712 @end deftypevr
26713
26714 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
26715 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
26716
26717 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
26718
26719 @end deftypevr
26720
26721 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
26722 The file that records client IPs.
26723
26724 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
26725
26726 @end deftypevr
26727
26728 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
26729 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
26730
26731 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26732
26733 @end deftypevr
26734
26735 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
26736 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
26737
26738 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26739
26740 @end deftypevr
26741
26742 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
26743 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
26744 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
26745 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
26746 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
26747 down.
26748
26749 @end deftypevr
26750
26751 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
26752 The maximum number of clients.
26753
26754 Defaults to @samp{100}.
26755
26756 @end deftypevr
26757
26758 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
26759 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
26760 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
26761
26762 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
26763
26764 @end deftypevr
26765
26766 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
26767 The list of configuration for some clients.
26768
26769 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26770
26771 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
26772
26773 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
26774 Client name.
26775
26776 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
26777
26778 @end deftypevr
26779
26780 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
26781 Client own network
26782
26783 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26784
26785 @end deftypevr
26786
26787 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
26788 Client VPN IP.
26789
26790 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26791
26792 @end deftypevr
26793
26794 @end deftypevr
26795
26796
26797 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
26798
26799 @subsubheading Wireguard
26800
26801 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wireguard-service-type
26802 A service type for a Wireguard tunnel interface. Its value must be a
26803 @code{wireguard-configuration} record as in this example:
26804
26805 @lisp
26806 (service wireguard-service-type
26807 (wireguard-configuration
26808 (peers
26809 (list
26810 (wireguard-peer
26811 (name "my-peer")
26812 (endpoint "my.wireguard.com:51820")
26813 (public-key "hzpKg9X1yqu1axN6iJp0mWf6BZGo8m1wteKwtTmDGF4=")
26814 (allowed-ips '("10.0.0.2/32")))))))
26815 @end lisp
26816
26817 @end defvr
26818
26819 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-configuration
26820 Data type representing the configuration of the Wireguard service.
26821
26822 @table @asis
26823 @item @code{wireguard}
26824 The wireguard package to use for this service.
26825
26826 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wg0"})
26827 The interface name for the VPN.
26828
26829 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'("10.0.0.1/32")})
26830 The IP addresses to be assigned to the above interface.
26831
26832 @item @code{private-key} (default: @code{"/etc/wireguard/private.key"})
26833 The private key file for the interface. It is automatically generated if
26834 the file does not exist.
26835
26836 @item @code{peers} (default: @code{'()})
26837 The authorized peers on this interface. This is a list of
26838 @var{wireguard-peer} records.
26839
26840 @end table
26841 @end deftp
26842
26843 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-peer
26844 Data type representing a Wireguard peer attached to a given interface.
26845
26846 @table @asis
26847 @item @code{name}
26848 The peer name.
26849
26850 @item @code{endpoint} (default: @code{#f})
26851 The optional endpoint for the peer, such as
26852 @code{"demo.wireguard.com:51820"}.
26853
26854 @item @code{public-key}
26855 The peer public-key represented as a base64 string.
26856
26857 @item @code{allowed-ips}
26858 A list of IP addresses from which incoming traffic for this peer is
26859 allowed and to which incoming traffic for this peer is directed.
26860
26861 @end table
26862 @end deftp
26863
26864 @node Network File System
26865 @subsection Network File System
26866 @cindex NFS
26867
26868 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
26869 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
26870 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
26871
26872 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
26873 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
26874 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
26875
26876 @subsubheading NFS Service
26877 @cindex NFS, server
26878
26879 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
26880 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
26881 the locations that NFS expects.
26882
26883 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
26884 A service type for a complete NFS server.
26885 @end defvr
26886
26887 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
26888 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
26889 of its subsystems.
26890
26891 It has the following parameters:
26892 @table @asis
26893 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
26894 The nfs-utils package to use.
26895
26896 @item @code{nfs-versions} (default: @code{'("4.2" "4.1" "4.0")})
26897 If a list of string values is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon
26898 will be limited to supporting the given versions of the NFS protocol.
26899
26900 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
26901 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
26902 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
26903 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
26904 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
26905
26906 @lisp
26907 (nfs-configuration
26908 (exports
26909 '(("/export"
26910 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
26911 @end lisp
26912
26913 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
26914 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
26915
26916 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
26917 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
26918
26919 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
26920 The rpcbind package to use.
26921
26922 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
26923 The local NFSv4 domain name.
26924
26925 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
26926 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
26927
26928 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
26929 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
26930
26931 @item @code{nfsd-tcp?} (default: @code{#t})
26932 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a TCP socket.
26933
26934 @item @code{nfsd-udp?} (default: @code{#f})
26935 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a UDP socket.
26936
26937 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
26938 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
26939
26940 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
26941 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
26942 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
26943 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
26944 @end table
26945 @end deftp
26946
26947 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
26948 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
26949
26950 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
26951 @cindex rpcbind
26952
26953 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
26954 universal addresses.
26955 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
26956 started when a dependent service starts.
26957
26958 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
26959 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
26960 @end defvr
26961
26962
26963 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
26964 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
26965 This type has the following parameters:
26966 @table @asis
26967 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
26968 The rpcbind package to use.
26969
26970 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
26971 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
26972 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
26973 instance.
26974 @end table
26975 @end deftp
26976
26977
26978 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
26979 @cindex pipefs
26980 @cindex rpc_pipefs
26981
26982 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
26983 between the kernel and user space programs.
26984
26985 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
26986 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
26987 @end defvr
26988
26989 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
26990 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
26991 This type has the following parameters:
26992 @table @asis
26993 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
26994 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
26995 @end table
26996 @end deftp
26997
26998
26999 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
27000 @cindex GSSD
27001 @cindex GSS
27002 @cindex global security system
27003
27004 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
27005 based protocols.
27006 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
27007 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
27008 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
27009
27010 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
27011 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
27012 @end defvr
27013
27014 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
27015 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
27016 This type has the following parameters:
27017 @table @asis
27018 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27019 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
27020
27021 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27022 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27023
27024 @end table
27025 @end deftp
27026
27027
27028 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
27029 @cindex idmapd
27030 @cindex name mapper
27031
27032 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
27033 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
27034
27035 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
27036 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
27037 @end defvr
27038
27039 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
27040 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
27041 This type has the following parameters:
27042 @table @asis
27043 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27044 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
27045
27046 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27047 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27048
27049 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
27050 The local NFSv4 domain name.
27051 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
27052 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
27053
27054 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
27055 The verbosity level of the daemon.
27056
27057 @end table
27058 @end deftp
27059
27060 @node Continuous Integration
27061 @subsection Continuous Integration
27062
27063 @cindex continuous integration
27064 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
27065 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
27066 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
27067
27068 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
27069
27070 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
27071 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
27072 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
27073 @end defvr
27074
27075 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
27076 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
27077 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
27078 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
27079 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
27080
27081 @lisp
27082 (define %cuirass-specs
27083 #~(list
27084 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
27085 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
27086 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
27087 (#:proc-input . "guix")
27088 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
27089 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
27090 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
27091 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
27092 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
27093 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
27094 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
27095 (#:load-path . ".")
27096 (#:branch . "master")
27097 (#:no-compile? . #t))
27098 ((#:name . "config")
27099 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
27100 (#:load-path . ".")
27101 (#:branch . "master")
27102 (#:no-compile? . #t))
27103 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
27104 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
27105 (#:load-path . ".")
27106 (#:branch . "master")
27107 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
27108
27109 (service cuirass-service-type
27110 (cuirass-configuration
27111 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
27112 @end lisp
27113
27114 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
27115 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
27116 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
27117
27118 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
27119 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
27120
27121 @table @asis
27122 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
27123 Location of the log file.
27124
27125 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
27126 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
27127
27128 @item @code{queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
27129 Location of the SQL queries log file. By default, SQL queries logging is
27130 disabled.
27131
27132 @item @code{web-queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
27133 Location of the web SQL queries log file. By default, web SQL queries
27134 logging is disabled.
27135
27136 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
27137 Location of the repository cache.
27138
27139 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27140 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
27141
27142 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27143 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
27144
27145 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
27146 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
27147 Cuirass jobs.
27148
27149 @item @code{queue-size} (default: @code{1})
27150 Size of the database writer queue.
27151
27152 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
27153 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
27154 added specifications.
27155
27156 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
27157 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
27158 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
27159 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
27160
27161 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
27162 Port number used by the HTTP server.
27163
27164 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
27165 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
27166 accept connections from localhost.
27167
27168 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
27169 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
27170 where a specification is an association list
27171 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
27172 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
27173 above.
27174
27175 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
27176 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
27177 from source.
27178
27179 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
27180 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
27181
27182 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
27183 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
27184 packages locally.
27185
27186 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
27187 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
27188
27189 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
27190 The Cuirass package to use.
27191 @end table
27192 @end deftp
27193
27194 @cindex simple cuirass
27195 @subsubheading Simple Cuirass
27196
27197 The Cuirass service configuration described above can be a little
27198 intimidating. In particular, getting the right @code{specifications}
27199 can prove difficult. The @code{simple-cuirass-configuration->specs}
27200 procedure offers a way to generate those @code{specifications} and thus
27201 setup a continuous integration server more readily.
27202
27203 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-cuirass-configuration->specs @var{configuration}
27204 This procedure takes a @code{simple-cuirass-configuration} record as
27205 argument and returns the corresponding Cuirass specifications gexp.
27206 @end deffn
27207
27208 @deftp {Data Type} simple-cuirass-configuration
27209 Data type representing the configuration of a simple Cuirass instance.
27210
27211 @table @asis
27212 @item @code{build} (default: @code{all})
27213 The packages to be built by Cuirass. It defaults to @code{all}, which
27214 means that all the discovered packages in the subsequent @code{channels}
27215 field are to be selected.
27216
27217 It is also possible to set this field to a list of @code{build-manifest}
27218 records, so that only the packages that are part of the declared
27219 manifests are built. This record is described below.
27220
27221 @deftp {Data Type} build-manifest
27222 @table @asis
27223 @item @code{channel-name}
27224 The name of the channel where the manifest is located.
27225
27226 @item @code{manifest}
27227 The manifest path inside the channel.
27228
27229 @end table
27230 @end deftp
27231
27232 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
27233 The channels to be fetched by Cuirass (@pxref{Channels}).
27234
27235 @item @code{non-package-channels} (default: @code{'()})
27236 List the channel names that must not be searched for packages. That is
27237 often the case for the channel containing the manifest.
27238
27239 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{(list (%current-system))})
27240 Build every discovered package for each system in this list. By default
27241 only the current system is selected.
27242
27243 @end table
27244 @end deftp
27245
27246 Here is an example of how to setup a Cuirass instance that builds all
27247 the packages declared by Guix and a user repository. The package list
27248 is re-evaluated each time a commit is pushed in one of the declared
27249 channels.
27250
27251 @lisp
27252 (service cuirass-service-type
27253 (cuirass-configuration
27254 (specifications
27255 (simple-cuirass-configuration->specs
27256 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27257 (build 'all)
27258 (channels (cons (channel
27259 (name 'my-guix)
27260 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27261 %default-channels)))))))
27262 @end lisp
27263
27264 In the same spirit, this builds all the packages that are part of the
27265 @code{guix} or @code{my-guix} channels and declared in the manifest
27266 located in the @code{conf} channel.
27267
27268 @lisp
27269 (service cuirass-service-type
27270 (cuirass-configuration
27271 (specifications
27272 (simple-cuirass-configuration->specs
27273 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27274 (build (list
27275 (build-manifest
27276 (channel-name 'conf)
27277 (manifest "guix/manifest.scm"))))
27278 (channels (cons* (channel
27279 (name 'my-guix)
27280 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27281 (channel
27282 (name 'conf)
27283 (url "https://my-git-repo/conf.git"))
27284 %default-channels))
27285 (non-package-channels '(conf)))))))
27286 @end lisp
27287
27288 Finally, @code{simple-cuirass-services} takes as a second optional
27289 argument a @code{cuirass-configuration} record. It can be used to
27290 customize the configuration of the Cuirass instance.
27291
27292 @lisp
27293 (simple-cuirass-services
27294 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27295 (build 'all)
27296 (channels (cons (channel
27297 (name 'my-guix)
27298 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27299 %default-channels))
27300 (non-package-channels '(conf)))
27301 (cuirass-configuration
27302 (inherit %default-cuirass-config)
27303 (host "0.0.0.0"))) ;listen on all interfaces.
27304 @end lisp
27305
27306 @node Power Management Services
27307 @subsection Power Management Services
27308
27309 @cindex tlp
27310 @cindex power management with TLP
27311 @subsubheading TLP daemon
27312
27313 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
27314 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
27315
27316 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
27317 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
27318 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
27319 source is detected. More information can be found at
27320 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
27321
27322 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
27323 The service type for the TLP tool. The default settings are optimised
27324 for battery life on most systems, but you can tweak them to your heart's
27325 content by adding a valid @code{tlp-configuration}:
27326 @lisp
27327 (service tlp-service-type
27328 (tlp-configuration
27329 (cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac (list "performance"))
27330 (sched-powersave-on-bat? #t)))
27331 @end lisp
27332 @end deffn
27333
27334 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
27335 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
27336 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
27337 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
27338 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
27339
27340 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
27341 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
27342 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
27343 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
27344 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
27345 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
27346 @c the churn as TLP updates.
27347
27348 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
27349
27350 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
27351 The TLP package.
27352
27353 @end deftypevr
27354
27355 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
27356 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
27357
27358 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27359
27360 @end deftypevr
27361
27362 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
27363 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
27364 and BAT.
27365
27366 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
27367
27368 @end deftypevr
27369
27370 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
27371 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
27372 before syncing on AC.
27373
27374 Defaults to @samp{0}.
27375
27376 @end deftypevr
27377
27378 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
27379 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
27380
27381 Defaults to @samp{2}.
27382
27383 @end deftypevr
27384
27385 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
27386 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
27387
27388 Defaults to @samp{15}.
27389
27390 @end deftypevr
27391
27392 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
27393 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27394
27395 Defaults to @samp{60}.
27396
27397 @end deftypevr
27398
27399 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
27400 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
27401 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
27402 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
27403
27404 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27405
27406 @end deftypevr
27407
27408 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
27409 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27410
27411 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27412
27413 @end deftypevr
27414
27415 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
27416 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
27417
27418 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27419
27420 @end deftypevr
27421
27422 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
27423 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
27424
27425 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27426
27427 @end deftypevr
27428
27429 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
27430 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
27431
27432 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27433
27434 @end deftypevr
27435
27436 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
27437 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
27438
27439 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27440
27441 @end deftypevr
27442
27443 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
27444 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
27445 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
27446
27447 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27448
27449 @end deftypevr
27450
27451 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
27452 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
27453 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
27454
27455 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27456
27457 @end deftypevr
27458
27459 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
27460 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27461
27462 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27463
27464 @end deftypevr
27465
27466 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
27467 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27468
27469 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27470
27471 @end deftypevr
27472
27473 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
27474 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
27475
27476 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27477
27478 @end deftypevr
27479
27480 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
27481 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
27482
27483 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27484
27485 @end deftypevr
27486
27487 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
27488 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
27489 used under light load conditions.
27490
27491 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27492
27493 @end deftypevr
27494
27495 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
27496 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
27497
27498 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27499
27500 @end deftypevr
27501
27502 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
27503 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
27504
27505 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27506
27507 @end deftypevr
27508
27509 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
27510 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
27511 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
27512
27513 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27514
27515 @end deftypevr
27516
27517 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
27518 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC@. Alternatives are
27519 performance, normal, powersave.
27520
27521 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27522
27523 @end deftypevr
27524
27525 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
27526 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
27527
27528 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
27529
27530 @end deftypevr
27531
27532 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
27533 Hard disk devices.
27534
27535 @end deftypevr
27536
27537 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
27538 Hard disk advanced power management level.
27539
27540 @end deftypevr
27541
27542 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
27543 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
27544
27545 @end deftypevr
27546
27547 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
27548 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
27549 declared hard disk.
27550
27551 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27552
27553 @end deftypevr
27554
27555 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
27556 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27557
27558 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27559
27560 @end deftypevr
27561
27562 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
27563 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
27564 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
27565 noop.
27566
27567 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27568
27569 @end deftypevr
27570
27571 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
27572 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
27573 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
27574
27575 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
27576
27577 @end deftypevr
27578
27579 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
27580 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
27581
27582 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
27583
27584 @end deftypevr
27585
27586 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
27587 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
27588
27589 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27590
27591 @end deftypevr
27592
27593 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
27594 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
27595 mode.
27596
27597 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27598
27599 @end deftypevr
27600
27601 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
27602 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27603
27604 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27605
27606 @end deftypevr
27607
27608 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
27609 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
27610
27611 Defaults to @samp{15}.
27612
27613 @end deftypevr
27614
27615 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
27616 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
27617 default, performance, powersave.
27618
27619 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27620
27621 @end deftypevr
27622
27623 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
27624 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
27625
27626 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
27627
27628 @end deftypevr
27629
27630 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
27631 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
27632 auto, default.
27633
27634 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
27635
27636 @end deftypevr
27637
27638 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
27639 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
27640
27641 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
27642
27643 @end deftypevr
27644
27645 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
27646 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
27647 performance.
27648
27649 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27650
27651 @end deftypevr
27652
27653 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
27654 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
27655
27656 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
27657
27658 @end deftypevr
27659
27660 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
27661 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
27662
27663 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27664
27665 @end deftypevr
27666
27667 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
27668 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
27669
27670 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27671
27672 @end deftypevr
27673
27674 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
27675 Wifi power saving mode.
27676
27677 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27678
27679 @end deftypevr
27680
27681 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
27682 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
27683
27684 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27685
27686 @end deftypevr
27687
27688 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
27689 Disable wake on LAN.
27690
27691 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27692
27693 @end deftypevr
27694
27695 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
27696 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
27697 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
27698
27699 Defaults to @samp{0}.
27700
27701 @end deftypevr
27702
27703 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
27704 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
27705
27706 Defaults to @samp{1}.
27707
27708 @end deftypevr
27709
27710 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
27711 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
27712
27713 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27714
27715 @end deftypevr
27716
27717 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
27718 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
27719 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
27720 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
27721
27722 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27723
27724 @end deftypevr
27725
27726 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
27727 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
27728
27729 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
27730
27731 @end deftypevr
27732
27733 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
27734 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
27735 and auto.
27736
27737 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
27738
27739 @end deftypevr
27740
27741 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
27742 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
27743
27744 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27745
27746 @end deftypevr
27747
27748 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
27749 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
27750 ones.
27751
27752 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27753
27754 @end deftypevr
27755
27756 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
27757 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
27758
27759 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27760
27761 @end deftypevr
27762
27763 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
27764 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
27765 Power Management.
27766
27767 @end deftypevr
27768
27769 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
27770 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
27771
27772 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27773
27774 @end deftypevr
27775
27776 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
27777 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
27778
27779 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27780
27781 @end deftypevr
27782
27783 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
27784 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
27785
27786 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27787
27788 @end deftypevr
27789
27790 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
27791 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
27792 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
27793
27794 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27795
27796 @end deftypevr
27797
27798 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
27799 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
27800
27801 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27802
27803 @end deftypevr
27804
27805 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
27806 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
27807 shutdown on system startup.
27808
27809 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27810
27811 @end deftypevr
27812
27813 @cindex thermald
27814 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
27815 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
27816
27817 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
27818 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
27819
27820 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
27821 This is the service type for
27822 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
27823 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
27824 of processors and preventing overheating.
27825 @end defvr
27826
27827 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
27828 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
27829
27830 @table @asis
27831 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
27832 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
27833
27834 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
27835 Package object of thermald.
27836
27837 @end table
27838 @end deftp
27839
27840 @node Audio Services
27841 @subsection Audio Services
27842
27843 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
27844 (the Music Player Daemon).
27845
27846 @cindex mpd
27847 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
27848
27849 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
27850 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
27851 of clients.
27852
27853 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
27854 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
27855
27856 @lisp
27857 (service mpd-service-type
27858 (mpd-configuration
27859 (user "bob")
27860 (port "6666")))
27861 @end lisp
27862
27863 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
27864 The service type for @command{mpd}
27865 @end defvr
27866
27867 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
27868 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
27869
27870 @table @asis
27871 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
27872 The user to run mpd as.
27873
27874 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
27875 The directory to scan for music files.
27876
27877 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
27878 The directory to store playlists.
27879
27880 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
27881 The location of the music database.
27882
27883 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
27884 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
27885
27886 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
27887 The location of the sticker database.
27888
27889 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
27890 The port to run mpd on.
27891
27892 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
27893 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
27894 an absolute path can be specified here.
27895
27896 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
27897 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
27898
27899 @end table
27900 @end deftp
27901
27902 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
27903 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
27904
27905 @table @asis
27906 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
27907 The name of the audio output.
27908
27909 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
27910 The type of audio output.
27911
27912 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
27913 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
27914 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
27915 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
27916 state is restored.
27917
27918 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
27919 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
27920 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
27921 @code{httpd} output plugin.
27922
27923 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
27924 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
27925 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
27926 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
27927
27928 @item @code{mixer-type}
27929 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
27930 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
27931 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
27932 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
27933 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
27934
27935 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
27936 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
27937 the audio output configuration.
27938
27939 @end table
27940 @end deftp
27941
27942 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
27943 an HTTP audio streaming output.
27944
27945 @lisp
27946 (service mpd-service-type
27947 (mpd-configuration
27948 (outputs
27949 (list (mpd-output
27950 (name "streaming")
27951 (type "httpd")
27952 (mixer-type 'null)
27953 (extra-options
27954 `((encoder . "vorbis")
27955 (port . "8080"))))))))
27956 @end lisp
27957
27958
27959 @node Virtualization Services
27960 @subsection Virtualization Services
27961
27962 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
27963 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
27964 services.
27965
27966 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
27967
27968 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
27969 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
27970 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
27971
27972 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
27973 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
27974 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
27975
27976 @lisp
27977 (service libvirt-service-type
27978 (libvirt-configuration
27979 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
27980 (tls-port "16555")))
27981 @end lisp
27982 @end deffn
27983
27984 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
27985 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
27986
27987 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
27988 Libvirt package.
27989
27990 @end deftypevr
27991
27992 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
27993 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
27994 You must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
27995
27996 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
27997 this capability.
27998
27999 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28000
28001 @end deftypevr
28002
28003 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
28004 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. You must
28005 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
28006
28007 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
28008 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
28009 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5).
28010
28011 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28012
28013 @end deftypevr
28014
28015 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
28016 Port for accepting secure TLS connections. This can be a port number,
28017 or service name.
28018
28019 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
28020
28021 @end deftypevr
28022
28023 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
28024 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections. This can be a port number,
28025 or service name.
28026
28027 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
28028
28029 @end deftypevr
28030
28031 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
28032 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
28033
28034 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
28035
28036 @end deftypevr
28037
28038 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
28039 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
28040
28041 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
28042 Avahi daemon.
28043
28044 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28045
28046 @end deftypevr
28047
28048 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
28049 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
28050 broadcast network.
28051
28052 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
28053
28054 @end deftypevr
28055
28056 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
28057 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
28058 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
28059 becoming root.
28060
28061 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
28062
28063 @end deftypevr
28064
28065 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
28066 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
28067 VM status only.
28068
28069 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28070
28071 @end deftypevr
28072
28073 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
28074 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
28075 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
28076 everyone (eg, 0777)
28077
28078 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
28079
28080 @end deftypevr
28081
28082 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
28083 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
28084 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
28085 the access to.
28086
28087 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28088
28089 @end deftypevr
28090
28091 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
28092 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
28093
28094 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
28095
28096 @end deftypevr
28097
28098 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
28099 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
28100 permissions allow anyone to connect
28101
28102 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28103
28104 @end deftypevr
28105
28106 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
28107 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
28108 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
28109 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
28110
28111 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28112
28113 @end deftypevr
28114
28115 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
28116 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
28117 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
28118 scenario.
28119
28120 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
28121
28122 @end deftypevr
28123
28124 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
28125 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
28126 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
28127 by certificates.
28128
28129 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
28130 by using 'sasl' for this option
28131
28132 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
28133
28134 @end deftypevr
28135
28136 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
28137 API access control scheme.
28138
28139 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
28140 drivers can place restrictions on this.
28141
28142 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28143
28144 @end deftypevr
28145
28146 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
28147 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
28148 loaded.
28149
28150 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28151
28152 @end deftypevr
28153
28154 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
28155 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
28156 loaded.
28157
28158 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28159
28160 @end deftypevr
28161
28162 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
28163 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
28164 is loaded.
28165
28166 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28167
28168 @end deftypevr
28169
28170 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
28171 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
28172 CRL is loaded.
28173
28174 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28175
28176 @end deftypevr
28177
28178 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
28179 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
28180
28181 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
28182 certificates.
28183
28184 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28185
28186 @end deftypevr
28187
28188 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
28189 Disable verification of client certificates.
28190
28191 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
28192 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
28193 rejected.
28194
28195 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28196
28197 @end deftypevr
28198
28199 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
28200 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
28201
28202 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28203
28204 @end deftypevr
28205
28206 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
28207 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
28208 the SASL authentication mechanism.
28209
28210 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28211
28212 @end deftypevr
28213
28214 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
28215 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
28216 usually @samp{"NORMAL"} unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
28217 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
28218
28219 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
28220
28221 @end deftypevr
28222
28223 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
28224 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
28225 sockets combined.
28226
28227 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
28228
28229 @end deftypevr
28230
28231 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
28232 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
28233 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
28234 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
28235
28236 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
28237
28238 @end deftypevr
28239
28240 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
28241 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
28242 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
28243
28244 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28245
28246 @end deftypevr
28247
28248 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
28249 Number of workers to start up initially.
28250
28251 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28252
28253 @end deftypevr
28254
28255 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
28256 Maximum number of worker threads.
28257
28258 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
28259 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
28260 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
28261
28262 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28263
28264 @end deftypevr
28265
28266 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
28267 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
28268 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
28269 executed in this pool.
28270
28271 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28272
28273 @end deftypevr
28274
28275 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
28276 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
28277
28278 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28279
28280 @end deftypevr
28281
28282 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
28283 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
28284 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
28285 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
28286
28287 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28288
28289 @end deftypevr
28290
28291 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
28292 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
28293
28294 Defaults to @samp{1}.
28295
28296 @end deftypevr
28297
28298 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
28299 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
28300
28301 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28302
28303 @end deftypevr
28304
28305 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
28306 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
28307
28308 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28309
28310 @end deftypevr
28311
28312 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
28313 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
28314
28315 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28316
28317 @end deftypevr
28318
28319 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
28320 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
28321
28322 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28323
28324 @end deftypevr
28325
28326 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
28327 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
28328
28329 Defaults to @samp{3}.
28330
28331 @end deftypevr
28332
28333 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
28334 Logging filters.
28335
28336 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
28337 of logs. The format for a filter is one of:
28338
28339 @itemize @bullet
28340 @item
28341 x:name
28342
28343 @item
28344 x:+name
28345
28346 @end itemize
28347
28348 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
28349 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
28350 file, e.g., @samp{"remote"}, @samp{"qemu"}, or @samp{"util.json"} (the
28351 name in the filter can be a substring of the full category name, in
28352 order to match multiple similar categories), the optional @samp{"+"}
28353 prefix tells libvirt to log stack trace for each message matching name,
28354 and @code{x} is the minimal level where matching messages should be
28355 logged:
28356
28357 @itemize @bullet
28358 @item
28359 1: DEBUG
28360
28361 @item
28362 2: INFO
28363
28364 @item
28365 3: WARNING
28366
28367 @item
28368 4: ERROR
28369
28370 @end itemize
28371
28372 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
28373 need to be separated by spaces.
28374
28375 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
28376
28377 @end deftypevr
28378
28379 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
28380 Logging outputs.
28381
28382 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
28383 for an output can be:
28384
28385 @table @code
28386 @item x:stderr
28387 output goes to stderr
28388
28389 @item x:syslog:name
28390 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
28391
28392 @item x:file:file_path
28393 output to a file, with the given filepath
28394
28395 @item x:journald
28396 output to journald logging system
28397
28398 @end table
28399
28400 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
28401
28402 @itemize @bullet
28403 @item
28404 1: DEBUG
28405
28406 @item
28407 2: INFO
28408
28409 @item
28410 3: WARNING
28411
28412 @item
28413 4: ERROR
28414
28415 @end itemize
28416
28417 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
28418 spaces.
28419
28420 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
28421
28422 @end deftypevr
28423
28424 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
28425 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
28426
28427 @itemize @bullet
28428 @item
28429 0: disable all auditing
28430
28431 @item
28432 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
28433
28434 @item
28435 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
28436
28437 @end itemize
28438
28439 Defaults to @samp{1}.
28440
28441 @end deftypevr
28442
28443 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
28444 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
28445
28446 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28447
28448 @end deftypevr
28449
28450 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
28451 Host UUID@. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
28452
28453 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28454
28455 @end deftypevr
28456
28457 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
28458 Source to read host UUID.
28459
28460 @itemize @bullet
28461 @item
28462 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
28463
28464 @item
28465 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
28466
28467 @end itemize
28468
28469 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
28470 be generated.
28471
28472 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
28473
28474 @end deftypevr
28475
28476 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
28477 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
28478 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
28479 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
28480 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
28481
28482 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28483
28484 @end deftypevr
28485
28486 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
28487 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
28488 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
28489 broken.
28490
28491 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
28492 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
28493 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
28494 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
28495 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
28496 keepalive messages.
28497
28498 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28499
28500 @end deftypevr
28501
28502 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
28503 Same as above but for admin interface.
28504
28505 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28506
28507 @end deftypevr
28508
28509 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
28510 Same as above but for admin interface.
28511
28512 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28513
28514 @end deftypevr
28515
28516 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
28517 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
28518
28519 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
28520 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
28521 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
28522
28523 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28524
28525 @end deftypevr
28526
28527 @c %end of autogenerated docs
28528
28529 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
28530 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
28531 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
28532
28533 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
28534 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
28535 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
28536 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
28537 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
28538
28539 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
28540 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
28541 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
28542
28543 @lisp
28544 (service virtlog-service-type
28545 (virtlog-configuration
28546 (max-clients 1000)))
28547 @end lisp
28548 @end deffn
28549
28550 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
28551 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
28552
28553 Defaults to @samp{3}.
28554
28555 @end deftypevr
28556
28557 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
28558 Logging filters.
28559
28560 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
28561 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
28562
28563 @itemize @bullet
28564 @item
28565 x:name
28566
28567 @item
28568 x:+name
28569
28570 @end itemize
28571
28572 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
28573 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
28574 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
28575 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
28576 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
28577 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
28578 where matching messages should be logged:
28579
28580 @itemize @bullet
28581 @item
28582 1: DEBUG
28583
28584 @item
28585 2: INFO
28586
28587 @item
28588 3: WARNING
28589
28590 @item
28591 4: ERROR
28592
28593 @end itemize
28594
28595 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
28596 need to be separated by spaces.
28597
28598 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
28599
28600 @end deftypevr
28601
28602 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
28603 Logging outputs.
28604
28605 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
28606 for an output can be:
28607
28608 @table @code
28609 @item x:stderr
28610 output goes to stderr
28611
28612 @item x:syslog:name
28613 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
28614
28615 @item x:file:file_path
28616 output to a file, with the given filepath
28617
28618 @item x:journald
28619 output to journald logging system
28620
28621 @end table
28622
28623 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
28624
28625 @itemize @bullet
28626 @item
28627 1: DEBUG
28628
28629 @item
28630 2: INFO
28631
28632 @item
28633 3: WARNING
28634
28635 @item
28636 4: ERROR
28637
28638 @end itemize
28639
28640 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
28641 spaces.
28642
28643 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
28644
28645 @end deftypevr
28646
28647 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
28648 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
28649 sockets combined.
28650
28651 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
28652
28653 @end deftypevr
28654
28655 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
28656 Maximum file size before rolling over.
28657
28658 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
28659
28660 @end deftypevr
28661
28662 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
28663 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
28664
28665 Defaults to @samp{3}
28666
28667 @end deftypevr
28668
28669 @anchor{transparent-emulation-qemu}
28670 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
28671
28672 @cindex emulation
28673 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
28674 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
28675 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
28676 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
28677 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
28678 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
28679 This feature only allows you to emulate GNU/Linux on a different
28680 architecture, but see below for GNU/Hurd support.
28681
28682 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
28683 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
28684 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
28685 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
28686 emulated:
28687
28688 @lisp
28689 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
28690 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
28691 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64"))))
28692 @end lisp
28693
28694 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
28695 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
28696 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
28697 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
28698 @end defvr
28699
28700 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
28701 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
28702
28703 @table @asis
28704 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
28705 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
28706 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
28707
28708 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
28709 service:
28710
28711 @lisp
28712 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
28713 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
28714 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
28715 @end lisp
28716
28717 You can run:
28718
28719 @example
28720 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
28721 @end example
28722
28723 @noindent
28724 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
28725 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU@. Pretty handy
28726 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
28727 access to!
28728
28729 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
28730 The QEMU package to use.
28731 @end table
28732 @end deftp
28733
28734 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
28735 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
28736 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
28737 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
28738 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
28739 @end deffn
28740
28741 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
28742 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
28743 @end deffn
28744
28745 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
28746 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
28747 @end deffn
28748
28749
28750 @subsubheading The Hurd in a Virtual Machine
28751
28752 @cindex @code{hurd}
28753 @cindex the Hurd
28754 @cindex childhurd
28755
28756 Service @code{hurd-vm} provides support for running GNU/Hurd in a
28757 virtual machine (VM), a so-called @dfn{childhurd}. This service is meant
28758 to be used on GNU/Linux and the given GNU/Hurd operating system
28759 configuration is cross-compiled. The virtual machine is a Shepherd
28760 service that can be referred to by the names @code{hurd-vm} and
28761 @code{childhurd} and be controlled with commands such as:
28762
28763 @example
28764 herd start hurd-vm
28765 herd stop childhurd
28766 @end example
28767
28768 When the service is running, you can view its console by connecting to
28769 it with a VNC client, for example with:
28770
28771 @example
28772 guix environment --ad-hoc tigervnc-client -- \
28773 vncviewer localhost:5900
28774 @end example
28775
28776 The default configuration (see @code{hurd-vm-configuration} below)
28777 spawns a secure shell (SSH) server in your GNU/Hurd system, which QEMU
28778 (the virtual machine emulator) redirects to port 10222 on the host.
28779 Thus, you can connect over SSH to the childhurd with:
28780
28781 @example
28782 ssh root@@localhost -p 10022
28783 @end example
28784
28785 The childhurd is volatile and stateless: it starts with a fresh root
28786 file system every time you restart it. By default though, all the files
28787 under @file{/etc/childhurd} on the host are copied as is to the root
28788 file system of the childhurd when it boots. This allows you to
28789 initialize ``secrets'' inside the VM: SSH host keys, authorized
28790 substitute keys, and so on---see the explanation of @code{secret-root}
28791 below.
28792
28793 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-vm-service-type
28794 This is the type of the Hurd in a Virtual Machine service. Its value
28795 must be a @code{hurd-vm-configuration} object, which specifies the
28796 operating system (@pxref{operating-system Reference}) and the disk size
28797 for the Hurd Virtual Machine, the QEMU package to use as well as the
28798 options for running it.
28799
28800 For example:
28801
28802 @lisp
28803 (service hurd-vm-service-type
28804 (hurd-vm-configuration
28805 (disk-size (* 5000 (expt 2 20))) ;5G
28806 (memory-size 1024))) ;1024MiB
28807 @end lisp
28808
28809 would create a disk image big enough to build GNU@tie{}Hello, with some
28810 extra memory.
28811 @end defvr
28812
28813 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-vm-configuration
28814 The data type representing the configuration for
28815 @code{hurd-vm-service-type}.
28816
28817 @table @asis
28818 @item @code{os} (default: @var{%hurd-vm-operating-system})
28819 The operating system to instantiate. This default is bare-bones with a
28820 permissive OpenSSH secure shell daemon listening on port 2222
28821 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}).
28822
28823 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu-minimal})
28824 The QEMU package to use.
28825
28826 @item @code{image} (default: @var{hurd-vm-disk-image})
28827 The procedure used to build the disk-image built from this
28828 configuration.
28829
28830 @item @code{disk-size} (default: @code{'guess})
28831 The size of the disk image.
28832
28833 @item @code{memory-size} (default: @code{512})
28834 The memory size of the Virtual Machine in mebibytes.
28835
28836 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'("--snapshot")})
28837 The extra options for running QEMU.
28838
28839 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
28840 If set, a non-zero positive integer used to parameterize Childhurd
28841 instances. It is appended to the service's name,
28842 e.g. @code{childhurd1}.
28843
28844 @item @code{net-options} (default: @var{hurd-vm-net-options})
28845 The procedure used to produce the list of QEMU networking options.
28846
28847 By default, it produces
28848
28849 @lisp
28850 '("--device" "rtl8139,netdev=net0"
28851 "--netdev" "user,id=net0\
28852 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{secrets-port}-:1004\
28853 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{ssh-port}-:2222\
28854 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{vnc-port}-:5900")
28855 @end lisp
28856
28857 with forwarded ports:
28858
28859 @example
28860 @var{secrets-port}: @code{(+ 11004 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28861 @var{ssh-port}: @code{(+ 10022 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28862 @var{vnc-port}: @code{(+ 15900 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28863 @end example
28864
28865 @item @code{secret-root} (default: @file{/etc/childhurd})
28866 The root directory with out-of-band secrets to be installed into the
28867 childhurd once it runs. Childhurds are volatile which means that on
28868 every startup, secrets such as the SSH host keys and Guix signing key
28869 are recreated.
28870
28871 If the @file{/etc/childhurd} directory does not exist, the
28872 @code{secret-service} running in the Childhurd will be sent an empty
28873 list of secrets.
28874
28875 By default, the service automatically populates @file{/etc/childhurd}
28876 with the following non-volatile secrets, unless they already exist:
28877
28878 @example
28879 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/acl
28880 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
28881 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.sec
28882 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key
28883 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key
28884 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub
28885 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key.pub
28886 @end example
28887
28888 These files are automatically sent to the guest Hurd VM when it boots,
28889 including permissions.
28890
28891 @cindex childhurd, offloading
28892 @cindex Hurd, offloading
28893 Having these files in place means that only a couple of things are
28894 missing to allow the host to offload @code{i586-gnu} builds to the
28895 childhurd:
28896
28897 @enumerate
28898 @item
28899 Authorizing the childhurd's key on the host so that the host accepts
28900 build results coming from the childhurd, which can be done like so:
28901
28902 @example
28903 guix archive --authorize < \
28904 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
28905 @end example
28906
28907 @item
28908 Adding the childhurd to @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} (@pxref{Daemon
28909 Offload Setup}).
28910 @end enumerate
28911
28912 We're working towards making that happen automatically---get in touch
28913 with us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to discuss it!
28914 @end table
28915 @end deftp
28916
28917 Note that by default the VM image is volatile, i.e., once stopped the
28918 contents are lost. If you want a stateful image instead, override the
28919 configuration's @code{image} and @code{options} without
28920 the @code{--snapshot} flag using something along these lines:
28921
28922 @lisp
28923 (service hurd-vm-service-type
28924 (hurd-vm-configuration
28925 (image (const "/out/of/store/writable/hurd.img"))
28926 (options '())))
28927 @end lisp
28928
28929 @subsubheading Ganeti
28930
28931 @cindex ganeti
28932
28933 @quotation Note
28934 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be changed
28935 in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have been thorougly
28936 tested. Users of this service are encouraged to share their experience at
28937 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
28938 @end quotation
28939
28940 Ganeti is a virtual machine management system. It is designed to keep virtual
28941 machines running on a cluster of servers even in the event of hardware failures,
28942 and to make maintenance and recovery tasks easy. It consists of multiple
28943 services which are described later in this section. In addition to the Ganeti
28944 service, you will need the OpenSSH service (@pxref{Networking Services,
28945 @code{openssh-service-type}}), and update the @file{/etc/hosts} file
28946 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{hosts-file}}) with the cluster name
28947 and address (or use a DNS server).
28948
28949 All nodes participating in a Ganeti cluster should have the same Ganeti and
28950 @file{/etc/hosts} configuration. Here is an example configuration for a Ganeti
28951 cluster node that supports multiple storage backends, and installs the
28952 @code{debootstrap} and @code{guix} @dfn{OS providers}:
28953
28954 @lisp
28955 (use-package-modules virtualization)
28956 (use-service-modules base ganeti networking ssh)
28957 (operating-system
28958 ;; @dots{}
28959 (host-name "node1")
28960 (hosts-file (plain-file "hosts" (format #f "
28961 127.0.0.1 localhost
28962 ::1 localhost
28963
28964 192.168.1.200 ganeti.example.com
28965 192.168.1.201 node1.example.com node1
28966 192.168.1.202 node2.example.com node2
28967 ")))
28968
28969 ;; Install QEMU so we can use KVM-based instances, and LVM, DRBD and Ceph
28970 ;; in order to use the "plain", "drbd" and "rbd" storage backends.
28971 (packages (append (map specification->package
28972 '("qemu" "lvm2" "drbd-utils" "ceph"
28973 ;; Add the debootstrap and guix OS providers.
28974 "ganeti-instance-guix" "ganeti-instance-debootstrap"))
28975 %base-packages))
28976 (services
28977 (append (list (static-networking-service "eth0" "192.168.1.201"
28978 #:netmask "255.255.255.0"
28979 #:gateway "192.168.1.254"
28980 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.252"
28981 "192.168.1.253"))
28982
28983 ;; Ganeti uses SSH to communicate between nodes.
28984 (service openssh-service-type
28985 (openssh-configuration
28986 (permit-root-login 'without-password)))
28987
28988 (service ganeti-service-type
28989 (ganeti-configuration
28990 ;; This list specifies allowed file system paths
28991 ;; for storing virtual machine images.
28992 (file-storage-paths '("/srv/ganeti/file-storage"))
28993 ;; This variable configures a single "variant" for
28994 ;; both Debootstrap and Guix that works with KVM.
28995 (os %default-ganeti-os))))
28996 %base-services)))
28997 @end lisp
28998
28999 Users are advised to read the
29000 @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/admin.html,Ganeti
29001 administrators guide} to learn about the various cluster options and
29002 day-to-day operations. There is also a
29003 @url{https://guix.gnu.org/blog/2020/running-a-ganeti-cluster-on-guix/,blog post}
29004 describing how to configure and initialize a small cluster.
29005
29006 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-service-type
29007 This is a service type that includes all the various services that Ganeti
29008 nodes should run.
29009
29010 Its value is a @code{ganeti-configuration} object that defines the package
29011 to use for CLI operations, as well as configuration for the various daemons.
29012 Allowed file storage paths and available guest operating systems are also
29013 configured through this data type.
29014 @end defvr
29015
29016 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-configuration
29017 The @code{ganeti} service takes the following configuration options:
29018
29019 @table @asis
29020 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29021 The @code{ganeti} package to use. It will be installed to the system profile
29022 and make @command{gnt-cluster}, @command{gnt-instance}, etc available. Note
29023 that the value specified here does not affect the other services as each refer
29024 to a specific @code{ganeti} package (see below).
29025
29026 @item @code{noded-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-noded-configuration)})
29027 @itemx @code{confd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-confd-configuration)})
29028 @itemx @code{wconfd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-wconfd-configuration)})
29029 @itemx @code{luxid-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-luxid-configuration)})
29030 @itemx @code{rapi-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-rapi-configuration)})
29031 @itemx @code{kvmd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-kvmd-configuration)})
29032 @itemx @code{mond-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-mond-configuration)})
29033 @itemx @code{metad-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-metad-configuration)})
29034 @itemx @code{watcher-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-watcher-configuration)})
29035 @itemx @code{cleaner-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-cleaner-configuration)})
29036
29037 These options control the various daemons and cron jobs that are distributed
29038 with Ganeti. The possible values for these are described in detail below.
29039 To override a setting, you must use the configuration type for that service:
29040
29041 @lisp
29042 (service ganeti-service-type
29043 (ganeti-configuration
29044 (rapi-configuration
29045 (ganeti-rapi-configuration
29046 (interface "eth1"))))
29047 (watcher-configuration
29048 (ganeti-watcher-configuration
29049 (rapi-ip "10.0.0.1"))))
29050 @end lisp
29051
29052 @item @code{file-storage-paths} (default: @code{'()})
29053 List of allowed directories for file storage backend.
29054
29055 @item @code{os} (default: @code{%default-ganeti-os})
29056 List of @code{<ganeti-os>} records.
29057 @end table
29058
29059 In essence @code{ganeti-service-type} is shorthand for declaring each service
29060 individually:
29061
29062 @lisp
29063 (service ganeti-noded-service-type)
29064 (service ganeti-confd-service-type)
29065 (service ganeti-wconfd-service-type)
29066 (service ganeti-luxid-service-type)
29067 (service ganeti-kvmd-service-type)
29068 (service ganeti-mond-service-type)
29069 (service ganeti-metad-service-type)
29070 (service ganeti-watcher-service-type)
29071 (service ganeti-cleaner-service-type)
29072 @end lisp
29073
29074 Plus a service extension for @code{etc-service-type} that configures the file
29075 storage backend and OS variants.
29076
29077 @end deftp
29078
29079 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os
29080 This data type is suitable for passing to the @code{os} parameter of
29081 @code{ganeti-configuration}. It takes the following parameters:
29082
29083 @table @asis
29084 @item @code{name}
29085 The name for this OS provider. It is only used to specify where the
29086 configuration ends up. Setting it to ``debootstrap'' will create
29087 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap}.
29088
29089 @item @code{extension}
29090 The file extension for variants of this OS type. For example
29091 @file{.conf} or @file{.scm}.
29092
29093 @item @code{variants} (default: @code{'()})
29094 List of @code{ganeti-os-variant} objects for this OS.
29095
29096 @end table
29097 @end deftp
29098
29099 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os-variant
29100 This is the data type for a Ganeti OS variant. It takes the following
29101 parameters:
29102
29103 @table @asis
29104 @item @code{name}
29105 The name of this variant.
29106
29107 @item @code{configuration}
29108 A configuration file for this variant.
29109 @end table
29110 @end deftp
29111
29112 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-hooks
29113 This variable contains hooks to configure networking and the GRUB bootloader.
29114 @end defvr
29115
29116 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs
29117 This variable contains a list of packages suitable for a fully-virtualized guest.
29118 @end defvr
29119
29120 @deftp {Data Type} debootstrap-configuration
29121
29122 This data type creates configuration files suitable for the debootstrap OS provider.
29123
29124 @table @asis
29125 @item @code{hooks} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-hooks})
29126 When not @code{#f}, this must be a G-expression that specifies a directory with
29127 scripts that will run when the OS is installed. It can also be a list of
29128 @code{(name . file-like)} pairs. For example:
29129
29130 @lisp
29131 `((99-hello-world . ,(plain-file "#!/bin/sh\necho Hello, World")))
29132 @end lisp
29133
29134 That will create a directory with one executable named @code{99-hello-world}
29135 and run it every time this variant is installed. If set to @code{#f}, hooks
29136 in @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap/hooks} will be used, if any.
29137 @item @code{proxy} (default: @code{#f})
29138 Optional HTTP proxy to use.
29139 @item @code{mirror} (default: @code{#f})
29140 The Debian mirror. Typically something like @code{http://ftp.no.debian.org/debian}.
29141 The default varies depending on the distribution.
29142 @item @code{arch} (default: @code{#f})
29143 The dpkg architecture. Set to @code{armhf} to debootstrap an ARMv7 instance
29144 on an AArch64 host. Default is to use the current system architecture.
29145 @item @code{suite} (default: @code{"stable"})
29146 When set, this must be a Debian distribution ``suite'' such as @code{buster}
29147 or @code{focal}. If set to @code{#f}, the default for the OS provider is used.
29148 @item @code{extra-pkgs} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs})
29149 List of extra packages that will get installed by dpkg in addition
29150 to the minimal system.
29151 @item @code{components} (default: @code{#f})
29152 When set, must be a list of Debian repository ``components''. For example
29153 @code{'("main" "contrib")}.
29154 @item @code{generate-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
29155 Whether to automatically cache the generated debootstrap archive.
29156 @item @code{clean-cache} (default: @code{14})
29157 Discard the cache after this amount of days. Use @code{#f} to never
29158 clear the cache.
29159 @item @code{partition-style} (default: @code{'msdos})
29160 The type of partition to create. When set, it must be one of
29161 @code{'msdos}, @code{'none} or a string.
29162 @item @code{partition-alignment} (default: @code{2048})
29163 Alignment of the partition in sectors.
29164 @end table
29165 @end deftp
29166
29167 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
29168 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record. It
29169 takes two parameters: a name and a @code{debootstrap-configuration} object.
29170 @end deffn
29171
29172 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-os @var{variants}@dots{}
29173 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It takes
29174 a list of variants created with @code{debootstrap-variant}.
29175 @end deffn
29176
29177 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
29178 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record for
29179 use with the Guix OS provider. It takes a name and a G-expression that returns
29180 a ``file-like'' (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) object containing a
29181 Guix System configuration.
29182 @end deffn
29183
29184 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-os @var{variants}@dots{}
29185 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It
29186 takes a list of variants produced by @code{guix-variant}.
29187 @end deffn
29188
29189 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-variants
29190 This is a convenience variable to make the debootstrap provider work
29191 ``out of the box'' without users having to declare variants manually. It
29192 contains a single debootstrap variant with the default configuration:
29193
29194 @lisp
29195 (list (debootstrap-variant
29196 "default"
29197 (debootstrap-configuration)))
29198 @end lisp
29199 @end defvr
29200
29201 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-guix-variants
29202 This is a convenience variable to make the Guix OS provider work without
29203 additional configuration. It creates a virtual machine that has an SSH
29204 server, a serial console, and authorizes the Ganeti hosts SSH keys.
29205
29206 @lisp
29207 (list (guix-variant
29208 "default"
29209 (file-append ganeti-instance-guix
29210 "/share/doc/ganeti-instance-guix/examples/dynamic.scm")))
29211 @end lisp
29212 @end defvr
29213
29214 Users can implement support for OS providers unbeknownst to Guix by extending
29215 the @code{ganeti-os} and @code{ganeti-os-variant} records appropriately.
29216 For example:
29217
29218 @lisp
29219 (ganeti-os
29220 (name "custom")
29221 (extension ".conf")
29222 (variants
29223 (list (ganeti-os-variant
29224 (name "foo")
29225 (configuration (plain-file "bar" "this is fine"))))))
29226 @end lisp
29227
29228 That creates @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/foo.conf} which points
29229 to a file in the store with contents @code{this is fine}. It also creates
29230 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/variants.list} with contents @code{foo}.
29231
29232 Obviously this may not work for all OS providers out there. If you find the
29233 interface limiting, please reach out to @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
29234
29235 The rest of this section documents the various services that are included by
29236 @code{ganeti-service-type}.
29237
29238 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-noded-service-type
29239 @command{ganeti-noded} is the daemon responsible for node-specific functions
29240 within the Ganeti system. The value of this service must be a
29241 @code{ganeti-noded-configuration} object.
29242 @end defvr
29243
29244 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-noded-configuration
29245 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-noded} service.
29246
29247 @table @asis
29248 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29249 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29250
29251 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1811})
29252 The TCP port on which the node daemon listens for network requests.
29253
29254 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29255 The network address that the daemon will bind to. The default address means
29256 bind to all available addresses.
29257
29258 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
29259 When this is set, it must be a specific network interface (e.g.@: @code{eth0})
29260 that the daemon will bind to.
29261
29262 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
29263 This sets a limit on the maximum number of simultaneous client connections
29264 that the daemon will handle. Connections above this count are accepted, but
29265 no responses will be sent until enough connections have closed.
29266
29267 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
29268 Whether to use SSL/TLS to encrypt network communications. The certificate
29269 is automatically provisioned by the cluster and can be rotated with
29270 @command{gnt-cluster renew-crypto}.
29271
29272 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29273 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
29274
29275 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29276 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
29277
29278 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29279 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29280 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
29281
29282 @end table
29283 @end deftp
29284
29285 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-confd-service-type
29286 @command{ganeti-confd} answers queries related to the configuration of a
29287 Ganeti cluster. The purpose of this daemon is to have a highly available
29288 and fast way to query cluster configuration values. It is automatically
29289 active on all @dfn{master candidates}. The value of this service must be a
29290 @code{ganeti-confd-configuration} object.
29291
29292 @end defvr
29293
29294 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-confd-configuration
29295 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-confd} service.
29296
29297 @table @asis
29298 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29299 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29300
29301 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1814})
29302 The UDP port on which to listen for network requests.
29303
29304 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29305 Network address that the daemon will bind to.
29306
29307 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29308 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29309
29310 @end table
29311 @end deftp
29312
29313 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-wconfd-service-type
29314 @command{ganeti-wconfd} is the daemon that has authoritative knowledge
29315 about the cluster configuration and is the only entity that can accept
29316 changes to it. All jobs that need to modify the configuration will do so
29317 by sending appropriate requests to this daemon. It only runs on the
29318 @dfn{master node} and will automatically disable itself on other nodes.
29319
29320 The value of this service must be a
29321 @code{ganeti-wconfd-configuration} object.
29322 @end defvr
29323
29324 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-wconfd-configuration
29325 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
29326
29327 @table @asis
29328 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29329 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29330
29331 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
29332 The daemon will refuse to start if the majority of cluster nodes does not
29333 agree that it is running on the master node. Set to @code{#t} to start
29334 even if a quorum can not be reached (dangerous, use with caution).
29335
29336 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29337 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29338
29339 @end table
29340 @end deftp
29341
29342 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-luxid-service-type
29343 @command{ganeti-luxid} is a daemon used to answer queries related to the
29344 configuration and the current live state of a Ganeti cluster. Additionally,
29345 it is the authoritative daemon for the Ganeti job queue. Jobs can be
29346 submitted via this daemon and it schedules and starts them.
29347
29348 It takes a @code{ganeti-luxid-configuration} object.
29349 @end defvr
29350
29351 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-luxid-configuration
29352 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
29353
29354 @table @asis
29355 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29356 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29357
29358 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
29359 The daemon will refuse to start if it cannot verify that the majority of
29360 cluster nodes believes that it is running on the master node. Set to
29361 @code{#t} to ignore such checks and start anyway (this can be dangerous).
29362
29363 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29364 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29365
29366 @end table
29367 @end deftp
29368
29369 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-rapi-service-type
29370 @command{ganeti-rapi} provides a remote API for Ganeti clusters. It runs on
29371 the master node and can be used to perform cluster actions programmatically
29372 via a JSON-based RPC protocol.
29373
29374 Most query operations are allowed without authentication (unless
29375 @var{require-authentication?} is set), whereas write operations require
29376 explicit authorization via the @file{/var/lib/ganeti/rapi/users} file. See
29377 the @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/rapi.html, Ganeti Remote
29378 API documentation} for more information.
29379
29380 The value of this service must be a @code{ganeti-rapi-configuration} object.
29381 @end defvr
29382
29383 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-rapi-configuration
29384 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-rapi} service.
29385
29386 @table @asis
29387 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29388 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29389
29390 @item @code{require-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
29391 Whether to require authentication even for read-only operations.
29392
29393 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5080})
29394 The TCP port on which to listen to API requests.
29395
29396 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29397 The network address that the service will bind to. By default it listens
29398 on all configured addresses.
29399
29400 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
29401 When set, it must specify a specific network interface such as @code{eth0}
29402 that the daemon will bind to.
29403
29404 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
29405 The maximum number of simultaneous client requests to handle. Further
29406 connections are allowed, but no responses are sent until enough connections
29407 have closed.
29408
29409 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
29410 Whether to use SSL/TLS encryption on the RAPI port.
29411
29412 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29413 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
29414
29415 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29416 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
29417
29418 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29419 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29420 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
29421
29422 @end table
29423 @end deftp
29424
29425 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-kvmd-service-type
29426 @command{ganeti-kvmd} is responsible for determining whether a given KVM
29427 instance was shut down by an administrator or a user. Normally Ganeti will
29428 restart an instance that was not stopped through Ganeti itself. If the
29429 cluster option @code{user_shutdown} is true, this daemon monitors the
29430 @code{QMP} socket provided by QEMU and listens for shutdown events, and
29431 marks the instance as @dfn{USER_down} instead of @dfn{ERROR_down} when
29432 it shuts down gracefully by itself.
29433
29434 It takes a @code{ganeti-kvmd-configuration} object.
29435 @end defvr
29436
29437 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-kvmd-configuration
29438
29439 @table @asis
29440 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29441 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29442
29443 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29444 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29445
29446 @end table
29447 @end deftp
29448
29449 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-mond-service-type
29450 @command{ganeti-mond} is an optional daemon that provides Ganeti monitoring
29451 functionality. It is responsible for running data collectors and publish the
29452 collected information through a HTTP interface.
29453
29454 It takes a @code{ganeti-mond-configuration} object.
29455 @end defvr
29456
29457 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-mond-configuration
29458
29459 @table @asis
29460 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29461 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29462
29463 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1815})
29464 The port on which the daemon will listen.
29465
29466 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29467 The network address that the daemon will bind to. By default it binds to all
29468 available interfaces.
29469
29470 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29471 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29472
29473 @end table
29474 @end deftp
29475
29476 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-metad-service-type
29477 @command{ganeti-metad} is an optional daemon that can be used to provide
29478 information about the cluster to instances or OS install scripts.
29479
29480 It takes a @code{ganeti-metad-configuration} object.
29481 @end defvr
29482
29483 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-metad-configuration
29484
29485 @table @asis
29486 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29487 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29488
29489 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
29490 The port on which the daemon will listen.
29491
29492 @item @code{address} (default: @code{#f})
29493 If set, the daemon will bind to this address only. If left unset, the behavior
29494 depends on the cluster configuration.
29495
29496 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29497 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29498
29499 @end table
29500 @end deftp
29501
29502 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-watcher-service-type
29503 @command{ganeti-watcher} is a script designed to run periodically and ensure
29504 the health of a cluster. It will automatically restart instances that have
29505 stopped without Ganeti's consent, and repairs DRBD links in case a node has
29506 rebooted. It also archives old cluster jobs and restarts Ganeti daemons
29507 that are not running. If the cluster parameter @code{ensure_node_health}
29508 is set, the watcher will also shutdown instances and DRBD devices if the
29509 node it is running on is declared offline by known master candidates.
29510
29511 It can be paused on all nodes with @command{gnt-cluster watcher pause}.
29512
29513 The service takes a @code{ganeti-watcher-configuration} object.
29514 @end defvr
29515
29516 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-watcher-configuration
29517
29518 @table @asis
29519 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29520 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29521
29522 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{'(next-second-from (next-minute (range 0 60 5)))})
29523 How often to run the script. The default is every five minutes.
29524
29525 @item @code{rapi-ip} (default: @code{#f})
29526 This option needs to be specified only if the RAPI daemon is configured to use
29527 a particular interface or address. By default the cluster address is used.
29528
29529 @item @code{job-age} (default: @code{(* 6 3600)})
29530 Archive cluster jobs older than this age, specified in seconds. The default
29531 is 6 hours. This keeps @command{gnt-job list} manageable.
29532
29533 @item @code{verify-disks?} (default: @code{#t})
29534 If this is @code{#f}, the watcher will not try to repair broken DRBD links
29535 automatically. Administrators will need to use @command{gnt-cluster verify-disks}
29536 manually instead.
29537
29538 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29539 When @code{#t}, the script performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29540
29541 @end table
29542 @end deftp
29543
29544 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-cleaner-service-type
29545 @command{ganeti-cleaner} is a script designed to run periodically and remove
29546 old files from the cluster. This service type controls two @dfn{cron jobs}:
29547 one intended for the master node that permanently purges old cluster jobs,
29548 and one intended for every node that removes expired X509 certificates, keys,
29549 and outdated @command{ganeti-watcher} information. Like all Ganeti services,
29550 it is safe to include even on non-master nodes as it will disable itself as
29551 necessary.
29552
29553 It takes a @code{ganeti-cleaner-configuration} object.
29554 @end defvr
29555
29556 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-cleaner-configuration
29557
29558 @table @asis
29559 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29560 The @code{ganeti} package to use for the @command{gnt-cleaner} command.
29561
29562 @item @code{master-schedule} (default: @code{"45 1 * * *"})
29563 How often to run the master cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
29564 01:45:00.
29565
29566 @item @code{node-schedule} (default: @code{"45 2 * * *"})
29567 How often to run the node cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
29568 02:45:00.
29569
29570 @end table
29571 @end deftp
29572
29573 @node Version Control Services
29574 @subsection Version Control Services
29575
29576 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
29577 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
29578 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
29579 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
29580 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
29581 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
29582 @code{cgit-service-type}.
29583
29584 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
29585
29586 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
29587 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
29588
29589 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
29590 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
29591 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
29592 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} in the repository directory.} repositories under
29593 @file{/srv/git}.
29594
29595 @end deffn
29596
29597 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
29598 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
29599
29600 @table @asis
29601 @item @code{package} (default: @code{git})
29602 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
29603
29604 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
29605 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
29606 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
29607
29608 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
29609 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
29610 If you run @command{git daemon} with @code{(base-path "/srv/git")} on
29611 @samp{example.com}, then if you later try to pull
29612 @indicateurl{git://example.com/hello.git}, git daemon will interpret the
29613 path as @file{/srv/git/hello.git}.
29614
29615 @item @code{user-path} (default: @code{#f})
29616 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
29617 specified with empty string, requests to
29618 @indicateurl{git://host/~alice/foo} is taken as a request to access
29619 @code{foo} repository in the home directory of user @code{alice}. If
29620 @code{(user-path "@var{path}")} is specified, the same request is taken
29621 as a request to access @file{@var{path}/foo} repository in the home
29622 directory of user @code{alice}.
29623
29624 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'()})
29625 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
29626 all.
29627
29628 @item @code{port} (default: @code{#f})
29629 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
29630
29631 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @code{'()})
29632 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
29633
29634 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
29635 Extra options will be passed to @command{git daemon}, please run
29636 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
29637
29638 @end table
29639 @end deftp
29640
29641 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
29642 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
29643 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
29644 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
29645 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
29646 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
29647 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
29648 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
29649 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
29650 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
29651
29652 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
29653 over HTTP.
29654
29655 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
29656 Data type representing the configuration for a future
29657 @code{git-http-service-type}; can currently be used to configure Nginx
29658 through @code{git-http-nginx-location-configuration}.
29659
29660 @table @asis
29661 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
29662 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
29663
29664 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
29665 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
29666
29667 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
29668 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
29669 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
29670
29671 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @samp{/git/})
29672 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @samp{/git/} prefix, this
29673 will map @indicateurl{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
29674 @file{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
29675 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
29676
29677 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
29678 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
29679 Services}.
29680 @end table
29681 @end deftp
29682
29683 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
29684 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
29685 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
29686 server.
29687
29688 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
29689 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
29690 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
29691 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
29692 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
29693
29694 @lisp
29695 (service nginx-service-type
29696 (nginx-configuration
29697 (server-blocks
29698 (list
29699 (nginx-server-configuration
29700 (listen '("443 ssl"))
29701 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
29702 (ssl-certificate
29703 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
29704 (ssl-certificate-key
29705 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
29706 (locations
29707 (list
29708 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
29709 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
29710 @end lisp
29711
29712 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
29713 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
29714 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
29715 HTTPS@. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
29716 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
29717 @end deffn
29718
29719 @subsubheading Cgit Service
29720
29721 @cindex Cgit service
29722 @cindex Git, web interface
29723 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
29724 repositories written in C.
29725
29726 The following example will configure the service with default values.
29727 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
29728
29729 @lisp
29730 (service cgit-service-type)
29731 @end lisp
29732
29733 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
29734 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
29735
29736 @c %start of fragment
29737
29738 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
29739
29740 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
29741 The CGIT package.
29742
29743 @end deftypevr
29744
29745 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
29746 NGINX configuration.
29747
29748 @end deftypevr
29749
29750 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
29751 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
29752 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
29753
29754 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29755
29756 @end deftypevr
29757
29758 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
29759 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
29760 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
29761
29762 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29763
29764 @end deftypevr
29765
29766 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
29767 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
29768 access.
29769
29770 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29771
29772 @end deftypevr
29773
29774 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
29775 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
29776 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
29777
29778 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
29779
29780 @end deftypevr
29781
29782 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
29783 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
29784
29785 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
29786
29787 @end deftypevr
29788
29789 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
29790 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29791 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
29792
29793 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
29794
29795 @end deftypevr
29796
29797 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
29798 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29799 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
29800
29801 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29802
29803 @end deftypevr
29804
29805 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
29806 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29807 version of the repository summary page.
29808
29809 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29810
29811 @end deftypevr
29812
29813 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
29814 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29815 version of the repository index page.
29816
29817 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29818
29819 @end deftypevr
29820
29821 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
29822 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
29823 scanning a path for Git repositories.
29824
29825 Defaults to @samp{15}.
29826
29827 @end deftypevr
29828
29829 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
29830 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29831 version of the repository about page.
29832
29833 Defaults to @samp{15}.
29834
29835 @end deftypevr
29836
29837 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
29838 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29839 version of snapshots.
29840
29841 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29842
29843 @end deftypevr
29844
29845 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
29846 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
29847 caching is disabled.
29848
29849 Defaults to @samp{0}.
29850
29851 @end deftypevr
29852
29853 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
29854 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
29855
29856 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29857
29858 @end deftypevr
29859
29860 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
29861 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
29862 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
29863
29864 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29865
29866 @end deftypevr
29867
29868 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
29869 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
29870
29871 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29872
29873 @end deftypevr
29874
29875 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
29876 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
29877
29878 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29879
29880 @end deftypevr
29881
29882 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
29883 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
29884 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
29885 ordering.
29886
29887 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
29888
29889 @end deftypevr
29890
29891 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
29892 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
29893
29894 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
29895
29896 @end deftypevr
29897
29898 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
29899 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
29900 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
29901 places throughout the cgit interface.
29902
29903 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29904
29905 @end deftypevr
29906
29907 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
29908 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
29909 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
29910
29911 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29912
29913 @end deftypevr
29914
29915 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
29916 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
29917 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
29918 repository log page.
29919
29920 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29921
29922 @end deftypevr
29923
29924 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
29925 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
29926 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
29927
29928 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29929
29930 @end deftypevr
29931
29932 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
29933 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
29934 log view.
29935
29936 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29937
29938 @end deftypevr
29939
29940 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
29941 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
29942 clones.
29943
29944 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29945
29946 @end deftypevr
29947
29948 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
29949 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
29950 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
29951
29952 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29953
29954 @end deftypevr
29955
29956 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
29957 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
29958 each repo in the repository index.
29959
29960 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29961
29962 @end deftypevr
29963
29964 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
29965 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
29966 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
29967
29968 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29969
29970 @end deftypevr
29971
29972 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
29973 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
29974 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
29975
29976 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29977
29978 @end deftypevr
29979
29980 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
29981 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
29982 branches in the summary and refs views.
29983
29984 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29985
29986 @end deftypevr
29987
29988 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
29989 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
29990 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
29991 commit view.
29992
29993 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29994
29995 @end deftypevr
29996
29997 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
29998 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
29999 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
30000 commit view.
30001
30002 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30003
30004 @end deftypevr
30005
30006 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
30007 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
30008 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
30009
30010 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
30011
30012 @end deftypevr
30013
30014 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
30015 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
30016 set any repo specific settings.
30017
30018 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30019
30020 @end deftypevr
30021
30022 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
30023 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
30024
30025 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
30026
30027 @end deftypevr
30028
30029 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
30030 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30031 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
30032 "generated by..."@: message).
30033
30034 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30035
30036 @end deftypevr
30037
30038 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
30039 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30040 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
30041
30042 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30043
30044 @end deftypevr
30045
30046 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
30047 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30048 verbatim at the top of all pages.
30049
30050 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30051
30052 @end deftypevr
30053
30054 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
30055 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
30056 file is parsed.
30057
30058 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30059
30060 @end deftypevr
30061
30062 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
30063 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30064 verbatim above the repository index.
30065
30066 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30067
30068 @end deftypevr
30069
30070 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
30071 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30072 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
30073
30074 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30075
30076 @end deftypevr
30077
30078 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
30079 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
30080 in the servers timezone.
30081
30082 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30083
30084 @end deftypevr
30085
30086 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
30087 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
30088 on all cgit pages.
30089
30090 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
30091
30092 @end deftypevr
30093
30094 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
30095 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
30096
30097 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30098
30099 @end deftypevr
30100
30101 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
30102 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
30103 page.
30104
30105 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30106
30107 @end deftypevr
30108
30109 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
30110 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
30111
30112 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30113
30114 @end deftypevr
30115
30116 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
30117 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
30118
30119 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30120
30121 @end deftypevr
30122
30123 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
30124 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
30125
30126 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30127
30128 @end deftypevr
30129
30130 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
30131 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
30132 page.
30133
30134 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30135
30136 @end deftypevr
30137
30138 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
30139 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
30140 on the repository index page.
30141
30142 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30143
30144 @end deftypevr
30145
30146 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
30147 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
30148
30149 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30150
30151 @end deftypevr
30152
30153 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
30154 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
30155 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
30156
30157 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30158
30159 @end deftypevr
30160
30161 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
30162 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
30163
30164 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
30165 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
30166 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
30167
30168 @end deftypevr
30169
30170 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
30171 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
30172
30173 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30174
30175 @end deftypevr
30176
30177 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
30178 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30179 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
30180
30181 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30182
30183 @end deftypevr
30184
30185 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
30186 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
30187
30188 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30189
30190 @end deftypevr
30191
30192 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
30193 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
30194 disabled.
30195
30196 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30197
30198 @end deftypevr
30199
30200 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
30201 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
30202 header on all pages.
30203
30204 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30205
30206 @end deftypevr
30207
30208 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
30209 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
30210 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
30211 all subdirectories will be loaded.
30212
30213 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30214
30215 @end deftypevr
30216
30217 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
30218 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
30219
30220 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30221
30222 @end deftypevr
30223
30224 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
30225 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
30226 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
30227 removed for the URL and name.
30228
30229 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30230
30231 @end deftypevr
30232
30233 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
30234 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
30235
30236 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
30237
30238 @end deftypevr
30239
30240 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
30241 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
30242
30243 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30244
30245 @end deftypevr
30246
30247 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
30248 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
30249
30250 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
30251
30252 @end deftypevr
30253
30254 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
30255 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
30256
30257 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
30258
30259 @end deftypevr
30260
30261 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
30262 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30263 verbatim below the ``about'' link on the repository index page.
30264
30265 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30266
30267 @end deftypevr
30268
30269 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
30270 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
30271
30272 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30273
30274 @end deftypevr
30275
30276 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
30277 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
30278 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
30279 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
30280 directories, considered as ``hidden''. Note that this does not apply to
30281 the @file{.git} directory in non-bare repos.
30282
30283 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30284
30285 @end deftypevr
30286
30287 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
30288 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
30289 generates links for.
30290
30291 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30292
30293 @end deftypevr
30294
30295 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
30296 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
30297 @code{scan-path}).
30298
30299 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
30300
30301 @end deftypevr
30302
30303 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
30304 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
30305 after this option will inherit the current section name.
30306
30307 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30308
30309 @end deftypevr
30310
30311 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
30312 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
30313 repository listing by name.
30314
30315 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30316
30317 @end deftypevr
30318
30319 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
30320 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
30321 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
30322
30323 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30324
30325 @end deftypevr
30326
30327 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
30328 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
30329 default.
30330
30331 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30332
30333 @end deftypevr
30334
30335 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
30336 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
30337 the tree view.
30338
30339 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30340
30341 @end deftypevr
30342
30343 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
30344 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository ``summary''
30345 view.
30346
30347 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30348
30349 @end deftypevr
30350
30351 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
30352 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
30353 ``summary'' view.
30354
30355 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30356
30357 @end deftypevr
30358
30359 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
30360 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository ``summary''
30361 view.
30362
30363 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30364
30365 @end deftypevr
30366
30367 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
30368 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
30369 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
30370
30371 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30372
30373 @end deftypevr
30374
30375 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
30376 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
30377
30378 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
30379
30380 @end deftypevr
30381
30382 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
30383 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
30384
30385 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30386
30387 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
30388
30389 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
30390 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
30391 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
30392
30393 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30394
30395 @end deftypevr
30396
30397 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
30398 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
30399
30400 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30401
30402 @end deftypevr
30403
30404 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
30405 The relative URL used to access the repository.
30406
30407 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30408
30409 @end deftypevr
30410
30411 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
30412 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
30413
30414 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30415
30416 @end deftypevr
30417
30418 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
30419 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
30420 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
30421
30422 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30423
30424 @end deftypevr
30425
30426 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
30427 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
30428
30429 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30430
30431 @end deftypevr
30432
30433 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
30434 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
30435
30436 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30437
30438 @end deftypevr
30439
30440 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
30441 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
30442 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
30443 ordering.
30444
30445 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30446
30447 @end deftypevr
30448
30449 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
30450 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
30451 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
30452 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or ``master'' if
30453 there is no suitable HEAD.
30454
30455 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30456
30457 @end deftypevr
30458
30459 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
30460 The value to show as repository description.
30461
30462 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30463
30464 @end deftypevr
30465
30466 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
30467 The value to show as repository homepage.
30468
30469 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30470
30471 @end deftypevr
30472
30473 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
30474 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
30475
30476 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30477
30478 @end deftypevr
30479
30480 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
30481 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30482 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
30483
30484 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30485
30486 @end deftypevr
30487
30488 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
30489 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30490 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
30491
30492 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30493
30494 @end deftypevr
30495
30496 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
30497 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30498 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
30499
30500 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30501
30502 @end deftypevr
30503
30504 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
30505 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
30506 branches in the summary and refs views.
30507
30508 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30509
30510 @end deftypevr
30511
30512 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
30513 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
30514 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
30515
30516 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30517
30518 @end deftypevr
30519
30520 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
30521 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
30522 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
30523
30524 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30525
30526 @end deftypevr
30527
30528 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
30529 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
30530 repository index.
30531
30532 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30533
30534 @end deftypevr
30535
30536 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
30537 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
30538
30539 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30540
30541 @end deftypevr
30542
30543 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
30544 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
30545 on this repo’s pages.
30546
30547 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30548
30549 @end deftypevr
30550
30551 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
30552 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
30553
30554 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30555
30556 @end deftypevr
30557
30558 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
30559 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
30560
30561 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30562
30563 @end deftypevr
30564
30565 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
30566 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30567 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
30568 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
30569
30570 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30571
30572 @end deftypevr
30573
30574 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
30575 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30576 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
30577 listing.
30578
30579 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30580
30581 @end deftypevr
30582
30583 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
30584 Override the default maximum statistics period.
30585
30586 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30587
30588 @end deftypevr
30589
30590 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
30591 The value to show as repository name.
30592
30593 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30594
30595 @end deftypevr
30596
30597 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
30598 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
30599
30600 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30601
30602 @end deftypevr
30603
30604 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
30605 An absolute path to the repository directory.
30606
30607 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30608
30609 @end deftypevr
30610
30611 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
30612 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
30613 the ``About'' page for this repo.
30614
30615 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30616
30617 @end deftypevr
30618
30619 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
30620 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
30621 after this option will inherit the current section name.
30622
30623 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30624
30625 @end deftypevr
30626
30627 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
30628 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
30629
30630 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30631
30632 @end deftypevr
30633
30634 @end deftypevr
30635
30636 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
30637 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
30638
30639 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30640
30641 @end deftypevr
30642
30643
30644 @c %end of fragment
30645
30646 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
30647 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
30648 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
30649 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
30650
30651 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
30652
30653 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
30654 The cgit package.
30655 @end deftypevr
30656
30657 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
30658 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
30659 @end deftypevr
30660
30661 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
30662 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
30663
30664 @lisp
30665 (service cgit-service-type
30666 (opaque-cgit-configuration
30667 (cgitrc "")))
30668 @end lisp
30669
30670 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
30671
30672 @cindex Gitolite service
30673 @cindex Git, hosting
30674 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
30675 repositories on a central server.
30676
30677 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
30678 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
30679
30680 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
30681 user, and the provided SSH public key.
30682
30683 @lisp
30684 (service gitolite-service-type
30685 (gitolite-configuration
30686 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
30687 "yourname.pub"
30688 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
30689 @end lisp
30690
30691 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
30692 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
30693 following command to clone the admin repository.
30694
30695 @example
30696 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
30697 @end example
30698
30699 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
30700 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
30701 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
30702 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
30703
30704 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
30705 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
30706
30707 @table @asis
30708 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
30709 Gitolite package to use.
30710
30711 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
30712 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
30713 Gitolite over SSH.
30714
30715 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
30716 Group to use for Gitolite.
30717
30718 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
30719 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
30720
30721 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
30722 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
30723 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
30724
30725 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
30726 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
30727 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
30728 within the gitolite-admin repository.
30729
30730 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
30731
30732 @lisp
30733 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
30734 @end lisp
30735
30736 @end table
30737 @end deftp
30738
30739 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
30740 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
30741
30742 @table @asis
30743 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
30744 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
30745 contents.
30746
30747 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
30748 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
30749 like cgit or gitweb.
30750
30751 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
30752 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the @samp{config}
30753 keyword. This setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
30754
30755 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
30756 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
30757
30758 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
30759 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
30760
30761 @end table
30762 @end deftp
30763
30764
30765 @node Game Services
30766 @subsection Game Services
30767
30768 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
30769 @cindex wesnothd
30770 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
30771 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
30772 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
30773
30774 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
30775 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
30776 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
30777 configuration, instantiate it as:
30778
30779 @lisp
30780 (service wesnothd-service-type)
30781 @end lisp
30782 @end defvar
30783
30784 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
30785 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
30786
30787 @table @asis
30788 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
30789 The wesnoth server package to use.
30790
30791 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
30792 The port to bind the server to.
30793 @end table
30794 @end deftp
30795
30796
30797 @node PAM Mount Service
30798 @subsection PAM Mount Service
30799 @cindex pam-mount
30800
30801 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
30802 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
30803 volume format supported by the system.
30804
30805 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
30806 Service type for PAM Mount support.
30807 @end defvar
30808
30809 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
30810 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
30811
30812 It takes the following parameters:
30813
30814 @table @asis
30815 @item @code{rules}
30816 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
30817 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
30818
30819 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
30820 Guile Reference Manual}), and the default ones don't mount anything for
30821 anyone at login:
30822
30823 @lisp
30824 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
30825 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
30826 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
30827 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
30828 "allow_root" "allow_other")
30829 ","))))
30830 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
30831 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
30832 (hup "0")
30833 (term "no")
30834 (kill "no")))
30835 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
30836 (remove "true"))))
30837 @end lisp
30838
30839 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
30840 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
30841 encrypted @env{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
30842 the partition where he stores his data:
30843
30844 @lisp
30845 (define pam-mount-rules
30846 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
30847 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
30848 (fstype "crypt")
30849 (path "/dev/sda2")
30850 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
30851 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
30852 (fstype "auto")
30853 (path "/dev/sdb3")
30854 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
30855 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
30856 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
30857 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
30858 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
30859 "allow_root" "allow_other")
30860 ","))))
30861 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
30862 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
30863 (hup "0")
30864 (term "no")
30865 (kill "no")))
30866 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
30867 (remove "true")))))
30868
30869 (service pam-mount-service-type
30870 (pam-mount-configuration
30871 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
30872 @end lisp
30873
30874 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
30875 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
30876 @end table
30877 @end deftp
30878
30879
30880 @node Guix Services
30881 @subsection Guix Services
30882
30883 @subsubheading Guix Build Coordinator
30884 The @uref{https://git.cbaines.net/guix/build-coordinator/,Guix Build
30885 Coordinator} aids in distributing derivation builds among machines
30886 running an @dfn{agent}. The build daemon is still used to build the
30887 derivations, but the Guix Build Coordinator manages allocating builds
30888 and working with the results.
30889
30890 @quotation Note
30891 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be
30892 changed in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have
30893 been thorougly tested.
30894 @end quotation
30895
30896 The Guix Build Coordinator consists of one @dfn{coordinator}, and one or
30897 more connected @dfn{agent} processes. The coordinator process handles
30898 clients submitting builds, and allocating builds to agents. The agent
30899 processes talk to a build daemon to actually perform the builds, then
30900 send the results back to the coordinator.
30901
30902 There is a script to run the coordinator component of the Guix Build
30903 Coordinator, but the Guix service uses a custom Guile script instead, to
30904 provide better integration with G-expressions used in the configuration.
30905
30906 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-service-type
30907 Service type for the Guix Build Coordinator. Its value must be a
30908 @code{guix-build-coordinator-configuration} object.
30909 @end defvar
30910
30911 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-configuration
30912 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Build Coordinator.
30913
30914 @table @asis
30915 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
30916 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
30917
30918 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
30919 The system user to run the service as.
30920
30921 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
30922 The system group to run the service as.
30923
30924 @item @code{database-uri-string} (default: @code{"sqlite:///var/lib/guix-build-coordinator/guix_build_coordinator.db"})
30925 The URI to use for the database.
30926
30927 @item @code{agent-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://0.0.0.0:8745"})
30928 The URI describing how to listen to requests from agent processes.
30929
30930 @item @code{client-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://127.0.0.1:8746"})
30931 The URI describing how to listen to requests from clients. The client
30932 API allows submitting builds and currently isn't authenticated, so take
30933 care when configuring this value.
30934
30935 @item @code{allocation-strategy} (default: @code{#~basic-build-allocation-strategy})
30936 A G-expression for the allocation strategy to be used. This is a
30937 procedure that takes the datastore as an argument and populates the
30938 allocation plan in the database.
30939
30940 @item @code{hooks} (default: @var{'()})
30941 An association list of hooks. These provide a way to execute arbitrary
30942 code upon certain events, like a build result being processed.
30943
30944 @item @code{guile} (default: @code{guile-3.0-latest})
30945 The Guile package with which to run the Guix Build Coordinator.
30946
30947 @end table
30948 @end deftp
30949
30950 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-agent-service-type
30951 Service type for a Guix Build Coordinator agent. Its value must be a
30952 @code{guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration} object.
30953 @end defvar
30954
30955 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration
30956 Data type representing the configuration a Guix Build Coordinator agent.
30957
30958 @table @asis
30959 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
30960 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
30961
30962 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-agent"})
30963 The system user to run the service as.
30964
30965 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
30966 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
30967
30968 @item @code{authentication}
30969 Record describing how this agent should authenticate with the
30970 coordinator. Possible record types are described below.
30971
30972 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
30973 The systems for which this agent should fetch builds. The agent process
30974 will use the current system it's running on as the default.
30975
30976 @item @code{max-parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
30977 The number of builds to perform in parallel.
30978
30979 @item @code{derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
30980 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for derivations, if the
30981 derivations aren't already available.
30982
30983 @item @code{non-derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
30984 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for build inputs, if the
30985 input store items aren't already available.
30986
30987 @end table
30988 @end deftp
30989
30990 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-password-auth
30991 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
30992 UUID and password.
30993
30994 @table @asis
30995 @item @code{uuid}
30996 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
30997 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
30998 agent.
30999
31000 @item @code{password}
31001 The password to use when connecting to the coordinator.
31002
31003 @end table
31004 @end deftp
31005
31006 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-password-file-auth
31007 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31008 UUID and password read from a file.
31009
31010 @table @asis
31011 @item @code{uuid}
31012 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
31013 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
31014 agent.
31015
31016 @item @code{password-file}
31017 A file containing the password to use when connecting to the
31018 coordinator.
31019
31020 @end table
31021 @end deftp
31022
31023 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-dynamic-auth
31024 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31025 dyanmic auth token and agent name.
31026
31027 @table @asis
31028 @item @code{agent-name}
31029 Name of an agent, this is used to match up to an existing entry in the
31030 database if there is one. When no existing entry is found, a new entry
31031 is automatically added.
31032
31033 @item @code{token}
31034 Dynamic auth token, this is created and stored in the coordinator
31035 database, and is used by the agent to authenticate.
31036
31037 @end table
31038 @end deftp
31039
31040 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-dynamic-auth-with-file
31041 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31042 dyanmic auth token read from a file and agent name.
31043
31044 @table @asis
31045 @item @code{agent-name}
31046 Name of an agent, this is used to match up to an existing entry in the
31047 database if there is one. When no existing entry is found, a new entry
31048 is automatically added.
31049
31050 @item @code{token-file}
31051 File containing the dynamic auth token, this is created and stored in
31052 the coordinator database, and is used by the agent to authenticate.
31053
31054 @end table
31055 @end deftp
31056
31057 The Guix Build Coordinator package contains a script to query an
31058 instance of the Guix Data Service for derivations to build, and then
31059 submit builds for those derivations to the coordinator. The service
31060 type below assists in running this script. This is an additional tool
31061 that may be useful when building derivations contained within an
31062 instance of the Guix Data Service.
31063
31064 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-service-type
31065 Service type for the
31066 guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-from-guix-data-service script. Its
31067 value must be a @code{guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration}
31068 object.
31069 @end defvar
31070
31071 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration
31072 Data type representing the options to the queue builds from guix data
31073 service script.
31074
31075 @table @asis
31076 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
31077 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
31078
31079 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds"})
31080 The system user to run the service as.
31081
31082 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
31083 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
31084
31085 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
31086 The systems for which to fetch derivations to build.
31087
31088 @item @code{systems-and-targets} (default: @code{#f})
31089 An association list of system and target pairs for which to fetch
31090 derivations to build.
31091
31092 @item @code{guix-data-service} (default: @code{"https://data.guix.gnu.org"})
31093 The Guix Data Service instance from which to query to find out about
31094 derivations to build.
31095
31096 @item @code{processed-commits-file} (default: @code{"/var/cache/guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds/processed-commits"})
31097 A file to record which commits have been processed, to avoid needlessly
31098 processing them again if the service is restarted.
31099
31100 @end table
31101 @end deftp
31102
31103 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
31104 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
31105 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
31106 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
31107
31108 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
31109 interface.
31110
31111 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
31112 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
31113 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
31114 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
31115 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
31116 @end defvar
31117
31118 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
31119 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
31120
31121 @table @asis
31122 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
31123 The Guix Data Service package to use.
31124
31125 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
31126 The system user to run the service as.
31127
31128 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
31129 The system group to run the service as.
31130
31131 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
31132 The port to bind the web service to.
31133
31134 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
31135 The host to bind the web service to.
31136
31137 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
31138 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
31139 configured to listen to.
31140
31141 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
31142 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
31143 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
31144 list.
31145
31146 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
31147 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
31148
31149 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
31150 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
31151
31152 @end table
31153 @end deftp
31154
31155 @node Linux Services
31156 @subsection Linux Services
31157
31158 @cindex oom
31159 @cindex out of memory killer
31160 @cindex earlyoom
31161 @cindex early out of memory daemon
31162 @subsubheading Early OOM Service
31163
31164 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
31165 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
31166 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
31167 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
31168 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
31169
31170 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
31171 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
31172 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
31173 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
31174 with:
31175
31176 @lisp
31177 (service earlyoom-service-type)
31178 @end lisp
31179 @end deffn
31180
31181 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
31182 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
31183
31184 @table @asis
31185 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
31186 The Earlyoom package to use.
31187
31188 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
31189 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
31190
31191 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
31192 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
31193
31194 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
31195 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
31196 that should be preferably killed.
31197
31198 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
31199 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
31200 that should @emph{not} be killed.
31201
31202 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
31203 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
31204 disabled by default.
31205
31206 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
31207 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
31208 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj} should be ignored.
31209
31210 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
31211 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
31212 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
31213
31214 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
31215 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
31216 notifications.
31217 @end table
31218 @end deftp
31219
31220 @cindex modprobe
31221 @cindex kernel module loader
31222 @subsubheading Kernel Module Loader Service
31223
31224 The kernel module loader service allows one to load loadable kernel
31225 modules at boot. This is especially useful for modules that don't
31226 autoload and need to be manually loaded, as it's the case with
31227 @code{ddcci}.
31228
31229 @deffn {Scheme Variable} kernel-module-loader-service-type
31230 The service type for loading loadable kernel modules at boot with
31231 @command{modprobe}. Its value must be a list of strings representing
31232 module names. For example loading the drivers provided by
31233 @code{ddcci-driver-linux}, in debugging mode by passing some module
31234 parameters, can be done as follow:
31235
31236 @lisp
31237 (use-modules (gnu) (gnu services))
31238 (use-package-modules linux)
31239 (use-service-modules linux)
31240
31241 (define ddcci-config
31242 (plain-file "ddcci.conf"
31243 "options ddcci dyndbg delay=120"))
31244
31245 (operating-system
31246 ...
31247 (services (cons* (service kernel-module-loader-service-type
31248 '("ddcci" "ddcci_backlight"))
31249 (simple-service 'ddcci-config etc-service-type
31250 (list `("modprobe.d/ddcci.conf"
31251 ,ddcci-config)))
31252 %base-services))
31253 (kernel-loadable-modules (list ddcci-driver-linux)))
31254 @end lisp
31255 @end deffn
31256
31257 @cindex zram
31258 @cindex compressed swap
31259 @cindex Compressed RAM-based block devices
31260 @subsubheading Zram Device Service
31261
31262 The Zram device service provides a compressed swap device in system
31263 memory. The Linux Kernel documentation has more information about
31264 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/admin-guide/blockdev/zram.html,zram}
31265 devices.
31266
31267 @deffn {Scheme Variable} zram-device-service-type
31268 This service creates the zram block device, formats it as swap and
31269 enables it as a swap device. The service's value is a
31270 @code{zram-device-configuration} record.
31271
31272 @deftp {Data Type} zram-device-configuration
31273 This is the data type representing the configuration for the zram-device
31274 service.
31275
31276 @table @asis
31277 @item @code{size} (default @code{"1G"})
31278 This is the amount of space you wish to provide for the zram device. It
31279 accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a suffix, eg.:
31280 @code{"512M"} or @code{1024000}.
31281 @item @code{compression-algorithm} (default @code{'lzo})
31282 This is the compression algorithm you wish to use. It is difficult to
31283 list all the possible compression options, but common ones supported by
31284 Guix's Linux Libre Kernel include @code{'lzo}, @code{'lz4} and @code{'zstd}.
31285 @item @code{memory-limit} (default @code{0})
31286 This is the maximum amount of memory which the zram device can use.
31287 Setting it to '0' disables the limit. While it is generally expected
31288 that compression will be 2:1, it is possible that uncompressable data
31289 can be written to swap and this is a method to limit how much memory can
31290 be used. It accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a
31291 suffix, eg.: @code{"2G"}.
31292 @item @code{priority} (default @code{-1})
31293 This is the priority of the swap device created from the zram device.
31294 @code{swapon} accepts values between -1 and 32767, with higher values
31295 indicating higher priority. Higher priority swap will generally be used
31296 first.
31297 @end table
31298
31299 @end deftp
31300 @end deffn
31301
31302 @node Hurd Services
31303 @subsection Hurd Services
31304
31305 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-console-service-type
31306 This service starts the fancy @code{VGA} console client on the Hurd.
31307
31308 The service's value is a @code{hurd-console-configuration} record.
31309 @end defvr
31310
31311 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-console-configuration
31312 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
31313 hurd-console-service.
31314
31315 @table @asis
31316 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
31317 The Hurd package to use.
31318 @end table
31319 @end deftp
31320
31321 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-getty-service-type
31322 This service starts a tty using the Hurd @code{getty} program.
31323
31324 The service's value is a @code{hurd-getty-configuration} record.
31325 @end defvr
31326
31327 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-getty-configuration
31328 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
31329 hurd-getty-service.
31330
31331 @table @asis
31332 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
31333 The Hurd package to use.
31334
31335 @item @code{tty}
31336 The name of the console this Getty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
31337
31338 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{38400})
31339 An integer specifying the baud rate of the tty.
31340
31341 @end table
31342 @end deftp
31343
31344 @node Miscellaneous Services
31345 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
31346
31347 @cindex fingerprint
31348 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
31349
31350 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
31351 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
31352
31353 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
31354 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
31355 reading capability.
31356
31357 @lisp
31358 (service fprintd-service-type)
31359 @end lisp
31360 @end defvr
31361
31362 @cindex sysctl
31363 @subsubheading System Control Service
31364
31365 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
31366 parameters at boot.
31367
31368 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
31369 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
31370 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
31371 instantiated as:
31372
31373 @lisp
31374 (service sysctl-service-type
31375 (sysctl-configuration
31376 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
31377 @end lisp
31378 @end defvr
31379
31380 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
31381 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
31382
31383 @table @asis
31384 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
31385 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
31386
31387 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
31388 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
31389 @end table
31390 @end deftp
31391
31392 @cindex pcscd
31393 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
31394
31395 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
31396 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
31397 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
31398 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
31399 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
31400
31401 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
31402 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
31403 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
31404 configuration, instantiate it as:
31405
31406 @lisp
31407 (service pcscd-service-type)
31408 @end lisp
31409 @end defvr
31410
31411 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
31412 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
31413
31414 @table @asis
31415 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
31416 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
31417 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
31418 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
31419 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
31420 @end table
31421 @end deftp
31422
31423 @cindex lirc
31424 @subsubheading Lirc Service
31425
31426 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
31427
31428 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
31429 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
31430 [#:extra-options '()]
31431 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
31432 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
31433
31434 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
31435 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
31436 for details.
31437
31438 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
31439 passed to @command{lircd}.
31440 @end deffn
31441
31442 @cindex spice
31443 @subsubheading Spice Service
31444
31445 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
31446
31447 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
31448 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
31449 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
31450 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
31451 @end deffn
31452
31453 @cindex inputattach
31454 @subsubheading inputattach Service
31455
31456 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
31457 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
31458 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
31459 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
31460 Xorg display server.
31461
31462 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
31463 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
31464 dispatches events from it.
31465 @end deffn
31466
31467 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
31468 @table @asis
31469 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
31470 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
31471 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
31472
31473 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
31474 The device file to connect to the device.
31475
31476 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
31477 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
31478 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
31479
31480 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
31481 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
31482 @end table
31483 @end deftp
31484
31485 @subsubheading Dictionary Service
31486 @cindex dictionary
31487 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
31488
31489 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dicod-service-type
31490 This is the type of the service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an
31491 implementation of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31492 @end defvr
31493
31494 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
31495 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
31496 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31497
31498 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
31499 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
31500 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
31501
31502 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
31503 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
31504 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31505 @end deffn
31506
31507 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
31508 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
31509
31510 @table @asis
31511 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
31512 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
31513
31514 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
31515 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
31516 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
31517 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31518
31519 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
31520 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
31521
31522 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
31523 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
31524 @end table
31525 @end deftp
31526
31527 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
31528 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
31529
31530 @table @asis
31531 @item @code{name}
31532 Name of the handler (module instance).
31533
31534 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
31535 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
31536 the module has the same name as the handler.
31537 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31538
31539 @item @code{options}
31540 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
31541 @end table
31542 @end deftp
31543
31544 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
31545 Data type representing a dictionary database.
31546
31547 @table @asis
31548 @item @code{name}
31549 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
31550
31551 @item @code{handler}
31552 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
31553 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31554
31555 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
31556 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
31557 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
31558
31559 @item @code{options}
31560 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
31561 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31562 @end table
31563 @end deftp
31564
31565 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
31566 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
31567 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
31568 @end defvr
31569
31570 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
31571
31572 @lisp
31573 (dicod-service #:config
31574 (dicod-configuration
31575 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
31576 (name "wordnet")
31577 (module "dictorg")
31578 (options
31579 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
31580 (databases (list (dicod-database
31581 (name "wordnet")
31582 (complex? #t)
31583 (handler "wordnet")
31584 (options '("database=wn")))
31585 %dicod-database:gcide))))
31586 @end lisp
31587
31588 @cindex Docker
31589 @subsubheading Docker Service
31590
31591 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
31592
31593 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
31594
31595 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
31596 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
31597 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
31598
31599 @end defvr
31600
31601 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
31602 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
31603
31604 @table @asis
31605
31606 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
31607 The Docker daemon package to use.
31608
31609 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker-cli})
31610 The Docker client package to use.
31611
31612 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
31613 The Containerd package to use.
31614
31615 @item @code{proxy} (default @var{docker-libnetwork-cmd-proxy})
31616 The Docker user-land networking proxy package to use.
31617
31618 @item @code{enable-proxy?} (default @code{#t})
31619 Enable or disable the use of the Docker user-land networking proxy.
31620
31621 @item @code{debug?} (default @code{#f})
31622 Enable or disable debug output.
31623
31624 @item @code{enable-iptables?} (default @code{#t})
31625 Enable or disable the addition of iptables rules.
31626
31627 @end table
31628 @end deftp
31629
31630 @cindex Singularity, container service
31631 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
31632 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
31633 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
31634 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
31635 service is the Singularity package to use.
31636
31637 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
31638 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
31639 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
31640 @end defvr
31641
31642 @cindex Audit
31643 @subsubheading Auditd Service
31644
31645 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
31646
31647 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
31648
31649 This is the type of the service that runs
31650 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
31651 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
31652
31653 Examples of things that can be tracked:
31654
31655 @enumerate
31656 @item
31657 File accesses
31658 @item
31659 System calls
31660 @item
31661 Invoked commands
31662 @item
31663 Failed login attempts
31664 @item
31665 Firewall filtering
31666 @item
31667 Network access
31668 @end enumerate
31669
31670 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
31671 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
31672 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
31673 of auditctl into a file called @code{audit.rules} in the configuration
31674 directory (see below).
31675 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
31676 to view a report of all recorded events.
31677 The audit daemon by default logs into the file
31678 @file{/var/log/audit.log}.
31679
31680 @end defvr
31681
31682 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
31683 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
31684
31685 @table @asis
31686
31687 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
31688 The audit package to use.
31689
31690 @item @code{configuration-directory} (default: @code{%default-auditd-configuration-directory})
31691 The directory containing the configuration file for the audit package, which
31692 must be named @code{auditd.conf}, and optionally some audit rules to
31693 instantiate on startup.
31694
31695 @end table
31696 @end deftp
31697
31698 @cindex rshiny
31699 @subsubheading R-Shiny service
31700
31701 The @code{(gnu services science)} module provides the following service.
31702
31703 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rshiny-service-type
31704
31705 This is a type of service which is used to run a webapp created with
31706 @code{r-shiny}. This service sets the @env{R_LIBS_USER} environment
31707 variable and runs the provided script to call @code{runApp}.
31708
31709 @deftp {Data Type} rshiny-configuration
31710 This is the data type representing the configuration of rshiny.
31711
31712 @table @asis
31713
31714 @item @code{package} (default: @code{r-shiny})
31715 The package to use.
31716
31717 @item @code{binary} (defaunlt @code{"rshiny"})
31718 The name of the binary or shell script located at @code{package/bin/} to
31719 run when the service is run.
31720
31721 The common way to create this file is as follows:
31722
31723 @lisp
31724 @dots{}
31725 (let* ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out"))
31726 (targetdir (string-append out "/share/" ,name))
31727 (app (string-append out "/bin/" ,name))
31728 (Rbin (string-append (assoc-ref %build-inputs "r-min")
31729 "/bin/Rscript")))
31730 ;; @dots{}
31731 (mkdir-p (string-append out "/bin"))
31732 (call-with-output-file app
31733 (lambda (port)
31734 (format port
31735 "#!~a
31736 library(shiny)
31737 setwd(\"~a\")
31738 runApp(launch.browser=0, port=4202)~%\n"
31739 Rbin targetdir))))
31740 @end lisp
31741
31742 @end table
31743 @end deftp
31744 @end defvr
31745
31746 @cindex Nix
31747 @subsubheading Nix service
31748
31749 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
31750
31751 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
31752
31753 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
31754 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
31755 how to use it:
31756
31757 @lisp
31758 (use-modules (gnu))
31759 (use-service-modules nix)
31760 (use-package-modules package-management)
31761
31762 (operating-system
31763 ;; @dots{}
31764 (packages (append (list nix)
31765 %base-packages))
31766
31767 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
31768 %base-services)))
31769 @end lisp
31770
31771 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
31772
31773 @itemize
31774 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
31775 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
31776
31777 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
31778 @end itemize
31779
31780 @example
31781 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
31782 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
31783 @end example
31784
31785 @end defvr
31786
31787 @deftp {Data Type} nix-configuration
31788 This data type represents the configuration of the Nix daemon.
31789
31790 @table @asis
31791 @item @code{nix} (default: @code{nix})
31792 The Nix package to use.
31793
31794 @item @code{sandbox} (default: @code{#t})
31795 Specifies whether builds are sandboxed by default.
31796
31797 @item @code{build-sandbox-items} (default: @code{'()})
31798 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the
31799 @code{build-sandbox-items} field of the configuration file.
31800
31801 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
31802 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file.
31803 It is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration
31804 file.
31805
31806 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
31807 Extra command line options for @code{nix-service-type}.
31808 @end table
31809 @end deftp
31810
31811 @node Setuid Programs
31812 @section Setuid Programs
31813
31814 @cindex setuid programs
31815 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
31816 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
31817 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
31818 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
31819 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
31820 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
31821 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
31822 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
31823 for more info about the setuid mechanism).
31824
31825 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
31826 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
31827 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
31828 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
31829 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
31830 should be setuid root.
31831
31832 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
31833 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
31834 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
31835 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
31836 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
31837
31838 @example
31839 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
31840 @end example
31841
31842 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
31843 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
31844
31845 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
31846 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
31847
31848 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
31849 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
31850 @end defvr
31851
31852 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
31853 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
31854 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
31855 store.
31856
31857 @node X.509 Certificates
31858 @section X.509 Certificates
31859
31860 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
31861 @cindex X.509 certificates
31862 @cindex TLS
31863 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
31864 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
31865 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
31866 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
31867 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
31868 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
31869
31870 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
31871 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
31872 out-of-the-box.
31873
31874 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
31875 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
31876 certificates can be found.
31877
31878 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
31879 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
31880 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
31881 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
31882 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
31883 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
31884
31885 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
31886 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
31887 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
31888 to the certificates installed globally.
31889
31890 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
31891 can also install their own certificate package in
31892 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
31893 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
31894 OpenSSL library honors the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @env{SSL_CERT_FILE}
31895 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
31896 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
31897 pointed to by the @env{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
31898 would typically run something like:
31899
31900 @example
31901 guix install nss-certs
31902 export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
31903 export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
31904 export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
31905 @end example
31906
31907 As another example, R requires the @env{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
31908 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
31909 something like this:
31910
31911 @example
31912 guix install nss-certs
31913 export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
31914 @end example
31915
31916 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
31917 variable in the relevant documentation.
31918
31919
31920 @node Name Service Switch
31921 @section Name Service Switch
31922
31923 @cindex name service switch
31924 @cindex NSS
31925 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
31926 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
31927 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
31928 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
31929 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
31930 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
31931 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
31932 C Library Reference Manual}).
31933
31934 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
31935 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
31936 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
31937 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
31938 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
31939 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
31940
31941 @cindex nss-mdns
31942 @cindex .local, host name lookup
31943 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
31944 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
31945 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
31946 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
31947
31948 @lisp
31949 (name-service-switch
31950 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
31951
31952 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
31953 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
31954 (name-service
31955 (name "mdns_minimal")
31956
31957 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
31958 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
31959 ;; no need to try the next methods.
31960 (reaction (lookup-specification
31961 (not-found => return))))
31962
31963 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
31964 (name-service
31965 (name "dns"))
31966
31967 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
31968 (name-service
31969 (name "mdns")))))
31970 @end lisp
31971
31972 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
31973 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
31974 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
31975
31976 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
31977 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
31978 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
31979 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
31980 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
31981 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
31982 @code{nscd-service}}).
31983
31984 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
31985 configurations.
31986
31987 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
31988 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
31989 @code{name-service-switch} object.
31990 @end defvr
31991
31992 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
31993 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
31994 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
31995 @end defvr
31996
31997 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
31998 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
31999 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
32000 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
32001 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
32002 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
32003 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
32004 run @command{guix system}.
32005
32006 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
32007
32008 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
32009 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
32010 system databases.
32011
32012 @table @code
32013 @item aliases
32014 @itemx ethers
32015 @itemx group
32016 @itemx gshadow
32017 @itemx hosts
32018 @itemx initgroups
32019 @itemx netgroup
32020 @itemx networks
32021 @itemx password
32022 @itemx public-key
32023 @itemx rpc
32024 @itemx services
32025 @itemx shadow
32026 The system databases handled by the NSS@. Each of these fields must be a
32027 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
32028 @end table
32029 @end deftp
32030
32031 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
32032
32033 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
32034 associated lookup action.
32035
32036 @table @code
32037 @item name
32038 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
32039 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
32040
32041 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
32042 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
32043 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
32044 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
32045
32046 @item reaction
32047 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
32048 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
32049 Reference Manual}). For example:
32050
32051 @lisp
32052 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
32053 (success => return))
32054 @end lisp
32055 @end table
32056 @end deftp
32057
32058 @node Initial RAM Disk
32059 @section Initial RAM Disk
32060
32061 @cindex initrd
32062 @cindex initial RAM disk
32063 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
32064 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
32065 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
32066 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
32067 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
32068
32069 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
32070 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
32071 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
32072 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
32073 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
32074 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
32075 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
32076 file system, you would write:
32077
32078 @lisp
32079 (operating-system
32080 ;; @dots{}
32081 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
32082 @end lisp
32083
32084 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
32085 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
32086 @end defvr
32087
32088 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
32089 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
32090 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
32091 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
32092 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
32093 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
32094
32095 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
32096 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
32097 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
32098 system declaration like this:
32099
32100 @lisp
32101 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
32102 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
32103 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
32104 (apply base-initrd file-systems
32105 #:qemu-networking? #t
32106 rest)))
32107 @end lisp
32108
32109 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
32110 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
32111 volatile root file system.
32112
32113 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
32114 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
32115 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
32116 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
32117 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
32118 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
32119
32120 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
32121 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
32122 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
32123 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
32124
32125 @table @code
32126 @item --load=@var{boot}
32127 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
32128 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
32129
32130 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
32131 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
32132 initialization system.
32133
32134 @item --root=@var{root}
32135 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
32136 name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system UUID.
32137 When unspecified, the device name from the root file system of the
32138 operating system declaration is used.
32139
32140 @item --system=@var{system}
32141 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
32142 @var{system}.
32143
32144 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
32145 @cindex module, black-listing
32146 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
32147 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
32148 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
32149 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
32150 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
32151
32152 @item --repl
32153 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
32154 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
32155 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
32156 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
32157 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
32158
32159 @end table
32160
32161 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
32162 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
32163 here is how to use it and customize it further.
32164
32165 @cindex initrd
32166 @cindex initial RAM disk
32167 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
32168 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
32169 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
32170 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
32171 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
32172 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
32173 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @option{--root}.
32174 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
32175 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
32176 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
32177 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd.
32178 It may
32179 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
32180 the root file system.
32181
32182 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
32183 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
32184 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
32185 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
32186 intended keyboard layout.
32187
32188 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
32189 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
32190 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
32191
32192 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
32193 to it are lost.
32194 @end deffn
32195
32196 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
32197 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
32198 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
32199 [#:linux-modules '()]
32200 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
32201 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
32202 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
32203 on the kernel command line via @option{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
32204 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
32205
32206 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
32207 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
32208 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
32209 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
32210 intended keyboard layout.
32211
32212 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
32213
32214 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
32215 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
32216 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
32217 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
32218 @end deffn
32219
32220 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
32221 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
32222 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
32223 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
32224 program to run in that initrd.
32225
32226 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
32227 [#:guile %guile-3.0-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
32228 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
32229 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
32230 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
32231 automatically copied to the initrd.
32232 @end deffn
32233
32234 @node Bootloader Configuration
32235 @section Bootloader Configuration
32236
32237 @cindex bootloader
32238 @cindex boot loader
32239
32240 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
32241 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
32242 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
32243 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
32244 installed.
32245
32246 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
32247 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
32248 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
32249 field.
32250
32251 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
32252 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
32253
32254 @table @asis
32255
32256 @item @code{bootloader}
32257 @cindex EFI, bootloader
32258 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
32259 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
32260 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
32261 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
32262 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, @code{extlinux-bootloader} and
32263 @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
32264
32265 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
32266 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
32267 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
32268 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
32269 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
32270 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
32271
32272 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
32273 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
32274 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
32275 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
32276 when you boot it on your system.
32277
32278 @vindex grub-bootloader
32279 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
32280 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
32281
32282 @vindex grub-efi-netboot-bootloader
32283 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} allows you to boot your system over network
32284 through TFTP@. In combination with an NFS root file system this allows you to
32285 build a diskless Guix system.
32286
32287 The installation of the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} generates the content
32288 of the TFTP root directory at @code{target}
32289 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{target}}), to be served by a TFTP server.
32290 You may want to mount your TFTP server directory onto @code{target} to move the
32291 required files to the TFTP server automatically.
32292
32293 If you plan to use an NFS root file system as well (actually if you mount the
32294 store from an NFS share), then the TFTP server needs to serve the file
32295 @file{/boot/grub/grub.cfg} and other files from the store (like GRUBs background
32296 image, the kernel (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{kernel}}) and the
32297 initrd (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{initrd}})), too. All these
32298 files from the store will be accessed by GRUB through TFTP with their normal
32299 store path, for example as
32300 @file{tftp://tftp-server/gnu/store/…-initrd/initrd.cpio.gz}.
32301
32302 Two symlinks are created to make this possible. The first symlink is
32303 @code{target}@file{/efi/Guix/boot/grub/grub.cfg} pointing to
32304 @file{../../../boot/grub/grub.cfg},
32305 where @code{target} may be @file{/boot}. In this case the link is not leaving
32306 the served TFTP root directory, but otherwise it does. The second link is
32307 @code{target}@file{/gnu/store} and points to @file{../gnu/store}. This link
32308 is leaving the served TFTP root directory.
32309
32310 The assumption behind all this is that you have an NFS server exporting the root
32311 file system for your Guix system, and additionally a TFTP server exporting your
32312 @code{target} directory—usually @file{/boot}—from that same root file system for
32313 your Guix system. In this constellation the symlinks will work.
32314
32315 For other constellations you will have to program your own bootloader installer,
32316 which then takes care to make necessary files from the store accessible through
32317 TFTP, for example by copying them into the TFTP root directory at @code{target}.
32318
32319 It is important to note that symlinks pointing outside the TFTP root directory
32320 may need to be allowed in the configuration of your TFTP server. Further the
32321 store link exposes the whole store through TFTP@. Both points need to be
32322 considered carefully for security aspects.
32323
32324 Beside the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, the already mentioned TFTP and
32325 NFS servers, you also need a properly configured DHCP server to make the booting
32326 over netboot possible. For all this we can currently only recommend you to look
32327 for instructions about @acronym{PXE, Preboot eXecution Environment}.
32328
32329 @item @code{target}
32330 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
32331 bootloader.
32332
32333 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
32334 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
32335 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
32336 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
32337 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
32338 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}. For @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader},
32339 @code{target} should be the mount point corresponding to the TFTP root
32340 directory of your TFTP server.
32341
32342 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
32343 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
32344 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
32345 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
32346
32347 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
32348 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
32349 current system.
32350
32351 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
32352 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
32353 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
32354
32355 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
32356 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
32357 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
32358 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
32359
32360 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
32361 Layout}).
32362
32363 @quotation Note
32364 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
32365 @code{grub-efi}.
32366 @end quotation
32367
32368 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
32369 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
32370 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
32371 for GRUB.
32372
32373 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
32374 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
32375 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
32376 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
32377 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
32378 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
32379 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32380
32381 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
32382 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
32383 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
32384 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
32385 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
32386 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
32387 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
32388 manual}).
32389
32390 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
32391 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
32392 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
32393 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32394
32395 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
32396 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
32397 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
32398 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32399 @end table
32400
32401 @end deftp
32402
32403 @cindex dual boot
32404 @cindex boot menu
32405 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
32406 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
32407 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
32408 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
32409 along these lines:
32410
32411 @lisp
32412 (menu-entry
32413 (label "The Other Distro")
32414 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
32415 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
32416 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
32417 @end lisp
32418
32419 Details below.
32420
32421 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
32422 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
32423
32424 @table @asis
32425
32426 @item @code{label}
32427 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
32428
32429 @item @code{linux} (default: @code{#f})
32430 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
32431
32432 @lisp
32433 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
32434 @end lisp
32435
32436 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
32437 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
32438 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
32439
32440 @example
32441 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
32442 @end example
32443
32444 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
32445 field is ignored entirely.
32446
32447 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
32448 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
32449 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
32450
32451 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{#f})
32452 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
32453 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
32454
32455 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
32456 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
32457 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
32458
32459 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
32460 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
32461 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
32462 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
32463 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
32464
32465 @item @code{multiboot-kernel} (default: @code{#f})
32466 The kernel to boot in Multiboot-mode (@pxref{multiboot,,, grub, GNU GRUB
32467 manual}). When this field is set, a Multiboot menu-entry is generated.
32468 For example:
32469
32470 @lisp
32471 (file-append mach "/boot/gnumach")
32472 @end lisp
32473
32474 @item @code{multiboot-arguments} (default: @code{()})
32475 The list of extra command-line arguments for the multiboot-kernel.
32476
32477 @item @code{multiboot-modules} (default: @code{()})
32478 The list of commands for loading Multiboot modules. For example:
32479
32480 @lisp
32481 (list (list (file-append hurd "/hurd/ext2fs.static") "ext2fs"
32482 @dots{})
32483 (list (file-append libc "/lib/ld.so.1") "exec"
32484 @dots{}))
32485 @end lisp
32486
32487 @end table
32488 @end deftp
32489
32490 @cindex HDPI
32491 @cindex HiDPI
32492 @cindex resolution
32493 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
32494 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
32495 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
32496
32497 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
32498 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
32499
32500 @table @asis
32501 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
32502 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings,
32503 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
32504 @end table
32505 @end deftp
32506
32507 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} grub-theme
32508 Return the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
32509 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
32510 record.
32511
32512 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
32513 logos.
32514 @end deffn
32515
32516 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
32517 like
32518
32519 @lisp
32520 (bootloader
32521 (bootloader-configuration
32522 ;; @dots{}
32523 (theme (grub-theme
32524 (inherit (grub-theme))
32525 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
32526 @end lisp
32527
32528 @node Invoking guix system
32529 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
32530
32531 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
32532 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
32533 system} command. The synopsis is:
32534
32535 @example
32536 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
32537 @end example
32538
32539 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
32540 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
32541 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
32542 supported:
32543
32544 @table @code
32545 @item search
32546 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
32547 expressions, sorted by relevance:
32548
32549 @cindex HDPI
32550 @cindex HiDPI
32551 @cindex resolution
32552 @example
32553 $ guix system search console
32554 name: console-fonts
32555 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
32556 extends: shepherd-root
32557 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
32558 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
32559 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
32560 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
32561 +
32562 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
32563 + ("tty2" . (file-append
32564 + font-tamzen
32565 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
32566 + ("tty3" . (file-append
32567 + font-terminus
32568 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
32569 relevance: 9
32570
32571 name: mingetty
32572 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
32573 extends: shepherd-root
32574 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
32575 relevance: 2
32576
32577 name: login
32578 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
32579 extends: pam
32580 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
32581 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
32582 relevance: 2
32583
32584 @dots{}
32585 @end example
32586
32587 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
32588 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
32589 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
32590
32591 @item reconfigure
32592 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
32593 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
32594 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
32595 systems already running Guix System.}.
32596
32597 @quotation Note
32598 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
32599 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
32600 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
32601 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
32602 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
32603 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
32604 @end quotation
32605
32606 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
32607 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
32608 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
32609 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
32610 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
32611 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
32612
32613 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
32614 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
32615 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
32616 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
32617 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
32618
32619 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
32620 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
32621 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
32622 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
32623
32624 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32625 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
32626 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
32627 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
32628 @var{file} itself, when available. You can view it by running:
32629
32630 @example
32631 guix system describe
32632 @end example
32633
32634 This information is useful should you later want to inspect how this
32635 particular generation was built. In fact, assuming @var{file} is
32636 self-contained, you can later rebuild generation @var{n} of your
32637 operating system with:
32638
32639 @example
32640 guix time-machine \
32641 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
32642 system reconfigure \
32643 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
32644 @end example
32645
32646 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
32647 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
32648 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
32649 information on provenance tracking.
32650
32651 By default, @command{reconfigure} @emph{prevents you from downgrading
32652 your system}, which could (re)introduce security vulnerabilities and
32653 also cause problems with ``stateful'' services such as database
32654 management systems. You can override that behavior by passing
32655 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
32656
32657 @item switch-generation
32658 @cindex generations
32659 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
32660 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
32661 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
32662 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
32663 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
32664 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
32665 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
32666
32667 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
32668 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
32669 configuration file.
32670
32671 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
32672 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
32673 generation 7:
32674
32675 @example
32676 guix system switch-generation 7
32677 @end example
32678
32679 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
32680 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
32681 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
32682 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
32683 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
32684 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
32685
32686 @example
32687 guix system switch-generation -- -1
32688 @end example
32689
32690 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
32691 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
32692 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
32693 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
32694 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
32695 like activating and deactivating services.
32696
32697 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
32698
32699 @item roll-back
32700 @cindex rolling back
32701 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
32702 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
32703 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
32704 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
32705
32706 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
32707 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
32708 generation.
32709
32710 @item delete-generations
32711 @cindex deleting system generations
32712 @cindex saving space
32713 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
32714 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
32715 collector'').
32716
32717 This works in the same way as @samp{guix package --delete-generations}
32718 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @option{--delete-generations}}). With no
32719 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
32720
32721 @example
32722 guix system delete-generations
32723 @end example
32724
32725 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
32726 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
32727
32728 @example
32729 guix system delete-generations 2m
32730 @end example
32731
32732 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
32733 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
32734 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
32735
32736 @item build
32737 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
32738 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
32739 This action does not actually install anything.
32740
32741 @item init
32742 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
32743 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
32744 installations of Guix System. For instance:
32745
32746 @example
32747 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
32748 @end example
32749
32750 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
32751 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
32752 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
32753 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
32754 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
32755
32756 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
32757 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
32758 passed.
32759
32760 @item vm
32761 @cindex virtual machine
32762 @cindex VM
32763 @anchor{guix system vm}
32764 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
32765 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
32766
32767 @quotation Note
32768 The @code{vm} action and others below
32769 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
32770 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
32771 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
32772 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
32773 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
32774 @end quotation
32775
32776 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
32777 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
32778 emulated machine:
32779
32780 @example
32781 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
32782 @end example
32783
32784 The VM shares its store with the host system.
32785
32786 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
32787 the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} command-line options: the former
32788 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
32789 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
32790
32791 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
32792 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
32793 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
32794
32795 @example
32796 guix system vm my-config.scm \
32797 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
32798 @end example
32799
32800 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
32801 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
32802 store of the host can then be mounted.
32803
32804 The @option{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
32805 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
32806 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
32807 be created. The @option{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
32808 size of the image.
32809
32810 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
32811 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
32812 @item image
32813 @itemx docker-image
32814 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
32815 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
32816 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
32817 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
32818 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
32819 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
32820 @code{docker-image}.
32821
32822 @cindex image, creating disk images
32823 The @code{image} command can produce various image types. The
32824 image type can be selected using the @option{--image-type} option. It
32825 defaults to @code{efi-raw}. When its value is @code{iso9660}, the
32826 @option{--label} option can be used to specify a volume ID with
32827 @code{image}. By default, the root file system of a disk image is
32828 mounted non-volatile; the @option{--volatile} option can be provided to
32829 make it volatile instead. When using @code{image}, the bootloader
32830 installed on the generated image is taken from the provided
32831 @code{operating-system} definition. The following example demonstrates
32832 how to generate an image that uses the @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
32833 bootloader and boot it with QEMU:
32834
32835 @example
32836 image=$(guix system image --image-type=qcow2 \
32837 gnu/system/examples/lightweight-desktop.tmpl)
32838 cp $image /tmp/my-image.qcow2
32839 chmod +w /tmp/my-image.qcow2
32840 qemu-system-x86_64 -enable-kvm -hda /tmp/my-image.qcow2 -m 1000 \
32841 -bios $(guix build ovmf)/share/firmware/ovmf_x64.bin
32842 @end example
32843
32844 When using the @code{efi-raw} image type, a raw disk image is produced;
32845 it can be copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming
32846 @code{/dev/sdc} is the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy
32847 the image to it using the following command:
32848
32849 @example
32850 # dd if=$(guix system image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc status=progress
32851 @end example
32852
32853 The @code{--list-image-types} command lists all the available image
32854 types.
32855
32856 @cindex creating virtual machine images
32857 When using the @code{qcow2} image type, the returned image is in qcow2
32858 format, which the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix
32859 in a VM}, for more information on how to run the image in a virtual
32860 machine. The @code{grub-bootloader} bootloader is always used
32861 independently of what is declared in the @code{operating-system} file
32862 passed as argument. This is to make it easier to work with QEMU, which
32863 uses the SeaBIOS BIOS by default, expecting a bootloader to be installed
32864 in the Master Boot Record (MBR).
32865
32866 @cindex docker-image, creating docker images
32867 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
32868 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
32869 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
32870 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
32871 Docker container using commands like the following:
32872
32873 @example
32874 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
32875 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
32876 docker start $container_id
32877 @end example
32878
32879 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
32880 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
32881 start any services you have defined in the operating system
32882 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
32883 using @command{docker exec}:
32884
32885 @example
32886 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
32887 @end example
32888
32889 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
32890 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
32891 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
32892 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
32893 @code{docker create}.
32894
32895 Last, the @option{--network} option applies to @command{guix system
32896 docker-image}: it produces an image where network is supposedly shared
32897 with the host, and thus without services like nscd or NetworkManager.
32898
32899 @item container
32900 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
32901 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
32902 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
32903 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
32904 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
32905 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
32906
32907 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
32908 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
32909 system.
32910
32911 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
32912 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
32913 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
32914
32915 @example
32916 guix system container my-config.scm \
32917 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
32918 @end example
32919
32920 @quotation Note
32921 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
32922 @end quotation
32923
32924 @end table
32925
32926 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
32927 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
32928 following:
32929
32930 @table @option
32931 @item --expression=@var{expr}
32932 @itemx -e @var{expr}
32933 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
32934 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
32935 operating system.
32936 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
32937 Installation Image}).
32938
32939 @item --system=@var{system}
32940 @itemx -s @var{system}
32941 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
32942 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
32943
32944 @item --derivation
32945 @itemx -d
32946 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
32947 building anything.
32948
32949 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32950 @item --save-provenance
32951 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
32952 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
32953 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
32954 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
32955 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
32956 can run:
32957
32958 @example
32959 guix system image -t qcow2 --save-provenance config.scm
32960 @end example
32961
32962 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
32963 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
32964 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
32965 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
32966 of the image.
32967
32968 @item --image-type=@var{type}
32969 @itemx -t @var{type}
32970 For the @code{image} action, create an image with given @var{type}.
32971
32972 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses the
32973 @code{efi-raw} image type.
32974
32975 @cindex ISO-9660 format
32976 @cindex CD image format
32977 @cindex DVD image format
32978 @option{--image-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
32979 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
32980
32981 @item --image-size=@var{size}
32982 For the @code{image} action, create an image of the given @var{size}.
32983 @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
32984 suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU
32985 Coreutils}).
32986
32987 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
32988 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
32989 @var{file}.
32990
32991 @item --network
32992 @itemx -N
32993 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
32994 that is, do not create a network namespace.
32995
32996 @item --root=@var{file}
32997 @itemx -r @var{file}
32998 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
32999 collector root.
33000
33001 @item --skip-checks
33002 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
33003
33004 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
33005 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
33006 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
33007 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
33008 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
33009 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
33010
33011 @item --allow-downgrades
33012 Instruct @command{guix system reconfigure} to allow system downgrades.
33013
33014 By default, @command{reconfigure} prevents you from downgrading your
33015 system. It achieves that by comparing the provenance info of your
33016 system (shown by @command{guix system describe}) with that of your
33017 @command{guix} command (shown by @command{guix describe}). If the
33018 commits for @command{guix} are not descendants of those used for your
33019 system, @command{guix system reconfigure} errors out. Passing
33020 @option{--allow-downgrades} allows you to bypass these checks.
33021
33022 @quotation Note
33023 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
33024 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
33025 @end quotation
33026
33027 @cindex on-error
33028 @cindex on-error strategy
33029 @cindex error strategy
33030 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
33031 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
33032 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
33033
33034 @table @code
33035 @item nothing-special
33036 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
33037
33038 @item backtrace
33039 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
33040
33041 @item debug
33042 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
33043 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
33044 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
33045 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
33046 a list of available debugging commands.
33047 @end table
33048 @end table
33049
33050 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
33051 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
33052 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
33053 bootloader boot menu:
33054
33055 @table @code
33056
33057 @item describe
33058 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
33059 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
33060
33061 @item list-generations
33062 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
33063 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
33064 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
33065 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
33066
33067 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
33068 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
33069 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
33070 generations that are up to 10 days old:
33071
33072 @example
33073 $ guix system list-generations 10d
33074 @end example
33075
33076 @end table
33077
33078 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
33079 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
33080 each other:
33081
33082 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
33083 @table @code
33084
33085 @item extension-graph
33086 Emit to standard output the @dfn{service
33087 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
33088 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
33089 extensions). By default the output is in Dot/Graphviz format, but you
33090 can choose a different format with @option{--graph-backend}, as with
33091 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph, @option{--backend}}):
33092
33093 The command:
33094
33095 @example
33096 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | xdot -
33097 @end example
33098
33099 shows the extension relations among services.
33100
33101 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
33102 @item shepherd-graph
33103 Emit to standard output the @dfn{dependency
33104 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
33105 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
33106 example graph.
33107
33108 Again, the default output format is Dot/Graphviz, but you can pass
33109 @option{--graph-backend} to select a different one.
33110
33111 @end table
33112
33113 @node Invoking guix deploy
33114 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
33115
33116 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
33117 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
33118 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
33119 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
33120 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
33121 once as a logical ``deployment''.
33122
33123 @quotation Note
33124 The functionality described in this section is still under development
33125 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
33126 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
33127 @end quotation
33128
33129 @example
33130 guix deploy @var{file}
33131 @end example
33132
33133 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
33134 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
33135
33136 @lisp
33137 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
33138 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
33139 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
33140 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
33141 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
33142
33143 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
33144 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
33145
33146 (define %system
33147 (operating-system
33148 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
33149 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
33150 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
33151 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
33152 (target "/dev/vda")
33153 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
33154 (file-systems (cons (file-system
33155 (mount-point "/")
33156 (device "/dev/vda1")
33157 (type "ext4"))
33158 %base-file-systems))
33159 (services
33160 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
33161 (service openssh-service-type
33162 (openssh-configuration
33163 (permit-root-login #t)
33164 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
33165 %base-services))))
33166
33167 (list (machine
33168 (operating-system %system)
33169 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
33170 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
33171 (host-name "localhost")
33172 (system "x86_64-linux")
33173 (user "alice")
33174 (identity "./id_rsa")
33175 (port 2222)))))
33176 @end lisp
33177
33178 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
33179 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
33180 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @code{%system}.
33181 @code{environment} and @code{configuration} specify how the machine should be
33182 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
33183 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
33184 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
33185 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
33186 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
33187 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
33188 @var{environment} type would be used.
33189
33190 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
33191 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
33192 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), though this step is automatic on Guix
33193 System:
33194
33195 @example
33196 # guix archive --generate-key
33197 @end example
33198
33199 @noindent
33200 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
33201 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
33202
33203 @example
33204 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
33205 @end example
33206
33207 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
33208 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
33209 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
33210 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
33211 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
33212 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
33213 @code{user}. That is, the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
33214 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag. This can
33215 be accomplished with the following operating system configuration snippet:
33216
33217 @lisp
33218 (use-modules ...
33219 (gnu system)) ;for %sudoers-specification
33220
33221 (define %user "username")
33222
33223 (operating-system
33224 ...
33225 (sudoers-file
33226 (plain-file "sudoers"
33227 (string-append (plain-file-content %sudoers-specification)
33228 (format #f "~a ALL = NOPASSWD: ALL~%"
33229 %user)))))
33230
33231 @end lisp
33232
33233 For more information regarding the format of the @file{sudoers} file,
33234 consult @command{man sudoers}.
33235
33236 @deftp {Data Type} machine
33237 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
33238 deployment.
33239
33240 @table @asis
33241 @item @code{operating-system}
33242 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
33243
33244 @item @code{environment}
33245 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
33246
33247 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
33248 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
33249 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
33250 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
33251 however, an error will be thrown.
33252 @end table
33253 @end deftp
33254
33255 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
33256 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
33257 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
33258
33259 @table @asis
33260 @item @code{host-name}
33261 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
33262 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
33263 @item @code{system}
33264 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
33265 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
33266 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
33267 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
33268 keyring.
33269 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
33270 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
33271 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
33272 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
33273 remote host.
33274
33275 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
33276 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
33277
33278 @example
33279 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
33280 @end example
33281
33282 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
33283 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
33284 client does.
33285
33286 @item @code{allow-downgrades?} (default: @code{#f})
33287 Whether to allow potential downgrades.
33288
33289 Like @command{guix system reconfigure}, @command{guix deploy} compares
33290 the channel commits currently deployed on the remote host (as returned
33291 by @command{guix system describe}) to those currently in use (as
33292 returned by @command{guix describe}) to determine whether commits
33293 currently in use are descendants of those deployed. When this is not
33294 the case and @code{allow-downgrades?} is false, it raises an error.
33295 This ensures you do not accidentally downgrade remote machines.
33296 @end table
33297 @end deftp
33298
33299 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
33300 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
33301 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
33302
33303 @table @asis
33304 @item @code{ssh-key}
33305 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
33306 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
33307 @item @code{tags}
33308 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
33309 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
33310 @item @code{region}
33311 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
33312 @item @code{size}
33313 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
33314 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
33315 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
33316 @end table
33317 @end deftp
33318
33319 @node Running Guix in a VM
33320 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
33321
33322 @cindex virtual machine
33323 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
33324 distributed at
33325 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
33326 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
33327 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
33328 as QEMU (see below for details).
33329
33330 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
33331 commonly used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
33332 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
33333 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
33334 as @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} (@pxref{Using the
33335 Configuration System}).
33336
33337 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
33338 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
33339 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
33340 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
33341
33342 @cindex QEMU
33343 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
33344 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
33345 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
33346 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
33347 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
33348 image -t qcow2} on x86_64 hardware:
33349
33350 @example
33351 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
33352 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
33353 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
33354 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
33355 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
33356 @end example
33357
33358 Here is what each of these options means:
33359
33360 @table @code
33361 @item qemu-system-x86_64
33362 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
33363 host.
33364
33365 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
33366 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
33367 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
33368 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
33369 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
33370 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
33371 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
33372 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
33373
33374 @item -enable-kvm
33375 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
33376 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
33377 faster.
33378
33379 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
33380 @item -m 1024
33381 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
33382 which may be insufficient for some operations.
33383
33384 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
33385 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
33386 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
33387 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
33388 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
33389
33390 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
33391 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing
33392 store of the ``myhd'' drive.
33393 @end table
33394
33395 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
33396 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
33397 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
33398 to your system definition and start the VM using
33399 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
33400 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
33401 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
33402 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
33403
33404 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
33405
33406 @cindex SSH
33407 @cindex SSH server
33408 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
33409 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
33410 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
33411 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
33412
33413 @example
33414 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
33415 @end example
33416
33417 To connect to the VM you can run
33418
33419 @example
33420 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
33421 @end example
33422
33423 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
33424 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
33425 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
33426 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
33427 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
33428
33429 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
33430
33431 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
33432 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
33433 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
33434 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
33435
33436 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
33437 VM@. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
33438
33439 @example
33440 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
33441 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
33442 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
33443 name=com.redhat.spice.0
33444 @end example
33445
33446 You'll also need to add the @code{(spice-vdagent-service)} to your
33447 system definition (@pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}).
33448
33449 @node Defining Services
33450 @section Defining Services
33451
33452 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
33453 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
33454 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
33455
33456 @menu
33457 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
33458 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
33459 * Service Reference:: API reference.
33460 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
33461 @end menu
33462
33463 @node Service Composition
33464 @subsection Service Composition
33465
33466 @cindex services
33467 @cindex daemons
33468 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
33469 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
33470 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
33471 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
33472 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
33473 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
33474 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
33475 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
33476 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
33477 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
33478 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
33479 of the system.
33480
33481 @cindex service extensions
33482 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
33483 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
33484 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
33485 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
33486 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
33487 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
33488 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
33489 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
33490 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
33491 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
33492 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
33493
33494 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
33495 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
33496 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
33497
33498 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
33499
33500 @cindex system service
33501 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
33502 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
33503 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
33504 to learn about the other service types shown here.
33505 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
33506 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
33507 particular operating system definition.
33508
33509 @cindex service types
33510 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
33511 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
33512 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
33513 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
33514 different parameters.
33515
33516 The following section describes the programming interface for service
33517 types and services.
33518
33519 @node Service Types and Services
33520 @subsection Service Types and Services
33521
33522 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
33523 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
33524 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
33525
33526 @lisp
33527 (define guix-service-type
33528 (service-type
33529 (name 'guix)
33530 (extensions
33531 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
33532 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
33533 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
33534 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
33535 @end lisp
33536
33537 @noindent
33538 It defines three things:
33539
33540 @enumerate
33541 @item
33542 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
33543
33544 @item
33545 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
33546 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
33547 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
33548
33549 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
33550 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
33551
33552 @item
33553 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
33554 @end enumerate
33555
33556 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
33557
33558 @table @code
33559 @item shepherd-root-service-type
33560 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
33561 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
33562 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
33563 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
33564
33565 @item account-service-type
33566 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
33567 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
33568 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
33569 guix-daemon}).
33570
33571 @item activation-service-type
33572 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
33573 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
33574 booted.
33575 @end table
33576
33577 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
33578
33579 @lisp
33580 (service guix-service-type
33581 (guix-configuration
33582 (build-accounts 5)
33583 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
33584 @end lisp
33585
33586 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
33587 the parameters of this specific service instance.
33588 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
33589 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
33590 value is omitted, the default value specified by
33591 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
33592
33593 @lisp
33594 (service guix-service-type)
33595 @end lisp
33596
33597 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
33598 services but is not extensible itself.
33599
33600 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
33601
33602 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
33603
33604 @lisp
33605 (define udev-service-type
33606 (service-type (name 'udev)
33607 (extensions
33608 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
33609 udev-shepherd-service)))
33610
33611 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
33612 (extend (lambda (config rules)
33613 (match config
33614 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
33615 (udev-configuration
33616 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
33617 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
33618 @end lisp
33619
33620 This is the service type for the
33621 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
33622 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
33623 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
33624
33625 @table @code
33626 @item compose
33627 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
33628 services of this type.
33629
33630 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
33631 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
33632
33633 @item extend
33634 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
33635 the composition of the extensions.
33636
33637 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
33638 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
33639 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
33640 list of contributed rules.
33641
33642 @item description
33643 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
33644 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
33645 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
33646 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
33647 @end table
33648
33649 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
33650 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
33651 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
33652
33653 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
33654 interface for services.
33655
33656 @node Service Reference
33657 @subsection Service Reference
33658
33659 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
33660 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
33661 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
33662 @code{(gnu services)} module.
33663
33664 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
33665 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
33666 below). @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
33667 this particular service instance.
33668
33669 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
33670 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
33671 raised.
33672
33673 For instance, this:
33674
33675 @lisp
33676 (service openssh-service-type)
33677 @end lisp
33678
33679 @noindent
33680 is equivalent to this:
33681
33682 @lisp
33683 (service openssh-service-type
33684 (openssh-configuration))
33685 @end lisp
33686
33687 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
33688 with the default configuration.
33689 @end deffn
33690
33691 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
33692 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
33693 @end deffn
33694
33695 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
33696 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
33697 @end deffn
33698
33699 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
33700 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
33701 parameters.
33702 @end deffn
33703
33704 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
33705
33706 @lisp
33707 (define s
33708 (service nginx-service-type
33709 (nginx-configuration
33710 (nginx nginx)
33711 (log-directory log-directory)
33712 (run-directory run-directory)
33713 (file config-file))))
33714
33715 (service? s)
33716 @result{} #t
33717
33718 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
33719 @result{} #t
33720 @end lisp
33721
33722 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
33723 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
33724 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
33725 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
33726 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
33727 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
33728 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
33729 common pattern.
33730
33731 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
33732 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
33733
33734 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
33735 clauses. Each clause has the form:
33736
33737 @example
33738 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
33739 @end example
33740
33741 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
33742 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
33743 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
33744 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
33745 @var{type}.
33746
33747 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
33748 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
33749 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
33750 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
33751 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
33752 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
33753
33754 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
33755
33756 @end deffn
33757
33758 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
33759 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
33760 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
33761 @code{operating-system} declaration.
33762
33763 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
33764 @cindex service type
33765 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
33766 and Services}).
33767
33768 @table @asis
33769 @item @code{name}
33770 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
33771
33772 @item @code{extensions}
33773 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
33774
33775 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
33776 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
33777 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
33778 services.
33779
33780 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
33781 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
33782 extensions. It may return any single value.
33783
33784 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
33785 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
33786
33787 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
33788 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
33789 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
33790 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
33791 parameter value for the service instance.
33792
33793 @item @code{description}
33794 This is a string, possibly using Texinfo markup, describing in a couple
33795 of sentences what the service is about. This string allows users to
33796 find about the service through @command{guix system search}
33797 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
33798
33799 @item @code{default-value} (default: @code{&no-default-value})
33800 The default value associated for instances of this service type. This
33801 allows users to use the @code{service} form without its second argument:
33802
33803 @lisp
33804 (service @var{type})
33805 @end lisp
33806
33807 The returned service in this case has the default value specified by
33808 @var{type}.
33809 @end table
33810
33811 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
33812 @end deftp
33813
33814 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
33815 @var{compute}
33816 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
33817 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
33818 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
33819 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
33820 @end deffn
33821
33822 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
33823 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
33824 @end deffn
33825
33826 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
33827 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
33828 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
33829 provides a shorthand for this.
33830
33831 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
33832 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
33833 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
33834 service is an instance.
33835
33836 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
33837 an additional job:
33838
33839 @lisp
33840 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
33841 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
33842 @end lisp
33843 @end deffn
33844
33845 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
33846 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
33847 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
33848 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
33849 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
33850 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
33851 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
33852
33853 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
33854 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
33855 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
33856 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
33857 @end deffn
33858
33859 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
33860 service types, some of which are listed below.
33861
33862 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
33863 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
33864 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
33865 @end defvr
33866
33867 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
33868 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
33869 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
33870 @end defvr
33871
33872 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
33873 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
33874 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
33875 passing it name/file tuples such as:
33876
33877 @lisp
33878 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
33879 @end lisp
33880
33881 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
33882 pointing to the given file.
33883 @end defvr
33884
33885 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
33886 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
33887 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
33888 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
33889 @end defvr
33890
33891 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
33892 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
33893 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
33894 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
33895 @end defvr
33896
33897 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
33898 @anchor{provenance-service-type}
33899 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
33900 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
33901 in the system itself. It creates several files under
33902 @file{/run/current-system}:
33903
33904 @table @file
33905 @item channels.scm
33906 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
33907 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
33908 to build the system, if that information was available
33909 (@pxref{Channels}).
33910
33911 @item configuration.scm
33912 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
33913 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
33914 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
33915 received on the command line.
33916
33917 @item provenance
33918 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
33919 format that is more readily processable.
33920 @end table
33921
33922 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
33923 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
33924
33925 @quotation Caveats
33926 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
33927 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
33928 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
33929 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
33930 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
33931 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
33932
33933 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
33934 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
33935 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
33936 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
33937 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
33938 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
33939 comparison less trivial.
33940 @end quotation
33941
33942 This service is automatically added to your operating system
33943 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
33944 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
33945 @end defvr
33946
33947 @node Shepherd Services
33948 @subsection Shepherd Services
33949
33950 @cindex shepherd services
33951 @cindex PID 1
33952 @cindex init system
33953 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
33954 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
33955 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
33956 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
33957 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
33958
33959 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
33960 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
33961 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
33962 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
33963 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
33964
33965 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
33966
33967 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
33968 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
33969 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
33970
33971 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
33972 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
33973 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
33974
33975 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
33976 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
33977
33978 @table @asis
33979 @item @code{provision}
33980 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
33981
33982 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
33983 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
33984 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
33985 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
33986
33987 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
33988 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
33989
33990 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
33991 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
33992 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
33993 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
33994 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
33995
33996 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
33997 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
33998 underlying process dies.
33999
34000 @item @code{start}
34001 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
34002 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
34003 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
34004 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
34005 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
34006 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
34007
34008 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
34009 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
34010 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
34011 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
34012 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
34013 @command{herd} sub-commands:
34014
34015 @example
34016 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
34017 @end example
34018
34019 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
34020 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
34021 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
34022
34023 @item @code{documentation}
34024 A documentation string, as shown when running:
34025
34026 @example
34027 herd doc @var{service-name}
34028 @end example
34029
34030 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
34031 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
34032
34033 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
34034 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
34035 @code{stop} are evaluated.
34036
34037 @end table
34038 @end deftp
34039
34040 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
34041 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
34042 Shepherd service (see above).
34043
34044 @table @code
34045 @item name
34046 Symbol naming the action.
34047
34048 @item documentation
34049 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
34050
34051 @example
34052 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
34053 @end example
34054
34055 @item procedure
34056 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
34057 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
34058 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
34059 @end table
34060
34061 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
34062 greets the user:
34063
34064 @lisp
34065 (shepherd-action
34066 (name 'say-hello)
34067 (documentation "Say hi!")
34068 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
34069 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
34070 args)
34071 #t)))
34072 @end lisp
34073
34074 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
34075
34076 @example
34077 # herd say-hello example
34078 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
34079 # herd say-hello example a b c
34080 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
34081 @end example
34082
34083 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
34084 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
34085 info on actions.
34086 @end deftp
34087
34088 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
34089 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
34090
34091 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
34092 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
34093 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}. Its
34094 value must be a @code{shepherd-configuration}, as described below.
34095 @end defvr
34096
34097 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-configuration
34098 This data type represents the Shepherd's configuration.
34099
34100 @table @code
34101 @item shepherd (default: @code{shepherd})
34102 The Shepherd package to use.
34103
34104 @item services (default: @code{'()})
34105 A list of @code{<shepherd-service>} to start.
34106 You should probably use the service extension
34107 mechanism instead (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
34108 @end table
34109 @end deftp
34110
34111 The following example specifies the Shepherd package for the operating
34112 system:
34113
34114 @lisp
34115 (operating-system
34116 ;; ...
34117 (services (append (list openssh-service-type))
34118 ;; ...
34119 %desktop-services)
34120 ;; ...
34121 ;; Use own Shepherd package.
34122 (essential-services
34123 (modify-services (operating-system-default-essential-services
34124 this-operating-system)
34125 (shepherd-root-service-type config => (shepherd-configuration
34126 (inherit config)
34127 (shepherd my-shepherd))))))
34128 @end lisp
34129
34130 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
34131 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
34132 @end defvr
34133
34134
34135 @node Documentation
34136 @chapter Documentation
34137
34138 @cindex documentation, searching for
34139 @cindex searching for documentation
34140 @cindex Info, documentation format
34141 @cindex man pages
34142 @cindex manual pages
34143 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
34144 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
34145 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
34146 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
34147 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
34148 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
34149
34150 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
34151 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
34152 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
34153
34154 @example
34155 $ info -k TLS
34156 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
34157 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
34158 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
34159 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
34160 @dots{}
34161 @end example
34162
34163 @noindent
34164 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
34165
34166 @example
34167 $ man -k TLS
34168 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
34169 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
34170 @dots {}
34171 @end example
34172
34173 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
34174 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
34175 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
34176 respected.
34177
34178 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
34179 running, say:
34180
34181 @example
34182 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
34183 @end example
34184
34185 @noindent
34186 or:
34187
34188 @example
34189 $ man certtool
34190 @end example
34191
34192 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
34193 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
34194 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
34195 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
34196 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
34197 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
34198
34199 @node Installing Debugging Files
34200 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
34201
34202 @cindex debugging files
34203 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
34204 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
34205 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
34206 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
34207 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
34208
34209 This chapter explains how to use separate debug info when packages
34210 provide it, and how to rebuild packages with debug info when it's
34211 missing.
34212
34213 @menu
34214 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
34215 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
34216 @end menu
34217
34218 @node Separate Debug Info
34219 @section Separate Debug Info
34220
34221 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
34222 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
34223 weighs in at more than 60 MiB@. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
34224 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
34225 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
34226 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
34227 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
34228
34229 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
34230 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
34231 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
34232 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
34233 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
34234 with GDB}).
34235
34236 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
34237 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
34238 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
34239 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
34240 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
34241 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
34242 Guile:
34243
34244 @example
34245 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
34246 @end example
34247
34248 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
34249 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
34250 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
34251 GDB}):
34252
34253 @example
34254 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
34255 @end example
34256
34257 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
34258 @file{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
34259
34260 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
34261 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
34262 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
34263 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
34264 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
34265 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
34266
34267 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
34268 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
34269 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
34270 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages with
34271 definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. To check
34272 whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use @command{guix package
34273 --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
34274
34275 Read on for how to deal with packages lacking a @code{debug} output.
34276
34277 @node Rebuilding Debug Info
34278 @section Rebuilding Debug Info
34279
34280 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
34281 As we saw above, some packages, but not all, provide debugging info in a
34282 @code{debug} output. What can you do when debugging info is missing?
34283 The @option{--with-debug-info} option provides a solution to that: it
34284 allows you to rebuild the package(s) for which debugging info is
34285 missing---and only those---and to graft those onto the application
34286 you're debugging. Thus, while it's not as fast as installing a
34287 @code{debug} output, it is relatively inexpensive.
34288
34289 Let's illustrate that. Suppose you're experiencing a bug in Inkscape
34290 and would like to see what's going on in GLib, a library that's deep
34291 down in its dependency graph. As it turns out, GLib does not have a
34292 @code{debug} output and the backtrace GDB shows is all sadness:
34293
34294 @example
34295 (gdb) bt
34296 #0 0x00007ffff5f92190 in g_getenv ()
34297 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libglib-2.0.so.0
34298 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init_ctor ()
34299 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libgobject-2.0.so.0
34300 #2 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=1, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffcfd8,
34301 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffcfe8) at dl-init.c:72
34302 #3 0x00007ffff7fe2866 in call_init (env=0x7fffffffcfe8, argv=0x7fffffffcfd8, argc=1, l=<optimized out>)
34303 at dl-init.c:118
34304 @end example
34305
34306 To address that, you install Inkscape linked against a variant GLib that
34307 contains debug info:
34308
34309 @example
34310 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
34311 @end example
34312
34313 This time, debugging will be a whole lot nicer:
34314
34315 @example
34316 $ gdb --args sh -c 'exec inkscape'
34317 @dots{}
34318 (gdb) b g_getenv
34319 Function "g_getenv" not defined.
34320 Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? (y or [n]) y
34321 Breakpoint 1 (g_getenv) pending.
34322 (gdb) r
34323 Starting program: /gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/sh -c exec\ inkscape
34324 @dots{}
34325 (gdb) bt
34326 #0 g_getenv (variable=variable@@entry=0x7ffff60c7a2e "GOBJECT_DEBUG") at ../glib-2.62.6/glib/genviron.c:252
34327 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4380
34328 #2 gobject_init_ctor () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4493
34329 #3 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=3, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffd088,
34330 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffd0a8) at dl-init.c:72
34331 @dots{}
34332 @end example
34333
34334 Much better!
34335
34336 Note that there can be packages for which @option{--with-debug-info}
34337 will not have the desired effect. @xref{Package Transformation Options,
34338 @option{--with-debug-info}}, for more information.
34339
34340 @node Security Updates
34341 @chapter Security Updates
34342
34343 @cindex security updates
34344 @cindex security vulnerabilities
34345 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
34346 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
34347 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
34348 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
34349 containing only security updates). The @command{guix lint} tool helps
34350 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
34351 distribution:
34352
34353 @smallexample
34354 $ guix lint -c cve
34355 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
34356 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
34357 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
34358 @dots{}
34359 @end smallexample
34360
34361 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
34362
34363 Guix follows a functional
34364 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
34365 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
34366 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
34367 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
34368 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
34369 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
34370 desired.
34371
34372 @cindex grafts
34373 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
34374 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
34375 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
34376 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
34377 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
34378 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
34379 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
34380
34381 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
34382 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
34383 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
34384 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
34385 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
34386 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
34387
34388 @lisp
34389 (define bash
34390 (package
34391 (name "bash")
34392 ;; @dots{}
34393 (replacement bash-fixed)))
34394 @end lisp
34395
34396 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
34397 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
34398 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
34399 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
34400 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
34401 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
34402 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
34403 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
34404
34405 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
34406 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
34407 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
34408 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
34409 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
34410 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
34411 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
34412
34413 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
34414 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
34415 Thus, the command:
34416
34417 @example
34418 guix build bash --no-grafts
34419 @end example
34420
34421 @noindent
34422 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
34423
34424 @example
34425 guix build bash
34426 @end example
34427
34428 @noindent
34429 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
34430 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
34431
34432 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
34433 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
34434
34435 @example
34436 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
34437 @end example
34438
34439 @noindent
34440 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
34441 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
34442
34443 @example
34444 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
34445 @end example
34446
34447 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
34448 @command{lsof} command:
34449
34450 @example
34451 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
34452 @end example
34453
34454
34455 @node Bootstrapping
34456 @chapter Bootstrapping
34457
34458 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
34459
34460 @cindex bootstrapping
34461
34462 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
34463 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
34464 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
34465 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
34466 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled?
34467
34468 It is tempting to think of this question as one that only die-hard
34469 hackers may care about. However, while the answer to that question is
34470 technical in nature, its implications are wide-ranging. How the
34471 distribution is bootstrapped defines the extent to which we, as
34472 individuals and as a collective of users and hackers, can trust the
34473 software we run. It is a central concern from the standpoint of
34474 @emph{security} and from a @emph{user freedom} viewpoint.
34475
34476 @cindex bootstrap binaries
34477 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
34478 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
34479 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
34480 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
34481 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
34482 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
34483 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
34484 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
34485 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
34486
34487 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
34488 re-create them if needed (@pxref{Preparing to Use the Bootstrap
34489 Binaries}).
34490
34491 @menu
34492 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
34493 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
34494 @end menu
34495
34496 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
34497 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
34498
34499 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
34500 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
34501 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
34502 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
34503 ``taken for granted.''
34504
34505 Taking the bootstrap binaries for granted means that we consider them to
34506 be a correct and trustworthy ``seed'' for building the complete system.
34507 Therein lies a problem: the combined size of these bootstrap binaries is
34508 about 250MB (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing
34509 or even inspecting these is next to impossible.
34510
34511 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a
34512 ``Reduced Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full
34513 Source Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would
34514 be hyperbole to use that term for what we do now.}.
34515
34516 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
34517 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
34518 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
34519 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
34520 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC).
34521
34522 Using these new binary seeds the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU
34523 C Library are built from source. From here on the more traditional
34524 bootstrap process resumes. This approach has reduced the bootstrap
34525 binaries in size to about 145MB in Guix v1.1.
34526
34527 The next step that Guix has taken is to replace the shell and all its
34528 utilities with implementations in Guile Scheme, the @emph{Scheme-only
34529 bootstrap}. Gash (@pxref{Gash,,, gash, The Gash manual}) is a
34530 POSIX-compatible shell that replaces Bash, and it comes with Gash Utils
34531 which has minimalist replacements for Awk, the GNU Core Utilities, Grep,
34532 Gzip, Sed, and Tar. The rest of the bootstrap binary seeds that were
34533 removed are now built from source.
34534
34535 Building the GNU System from source is currently only possible by adding
34536 some historical GNU packages as intermediate steps@footnote{Packages
34537 such as @code{gcc-2.95.3}, @code{binutils-2.14}, @code{glibc-2.2.5},
34538 @code{gzip-1.2.4}, @code{tar-1.22}, and some others. For details, see
34539 @file{gnu/packages/commencement.scm}.}. As Gash and Gash Utils mature,
34540 and GNU packages become more bootstrappable again (e.g., new releases of
34541 GNU Sed will also ship as gzipped tarballs again, as alternative to the
34542 hard to bootstrap @code{xz}-compression), this set of added packages can
34543 hopefully be reduced again.
34544
34545 The graph below shows the resulting dependency graph for
34546 @code{gcc-core-mesboot0}, the bootstrap compiler used for the
34547 traditional bootstrap of the rest of the Guix System.
34548
34549 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph -e '(@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-core-mesboot0)' | sed -re 's,((bootstrap-mescc-tools|bootstrap-mes|guile-bootstrap).*shape =) box,\1 ellipse,' > doc/images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph.dot
34550 @image{images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of gcc-core-mesboot0}
34551
34552 The only significant binary bootstrap seeds that remain@footnote{
34553 Ignoring the 68KB @code{mescc-tools}; that will be removed later,
34554 together with @code{mes}.} are a Scheme intepreter and a Scheme
34555 compiler: GNU Mes and GNU Guile@footnote{Not shown in this graph are the
34556 static binaries for @file{bash}, @code{tar}, and @code{xz} that are used
34557 to get Guile running.}.
34558
34559 This further reduction has brought down the size of the binary seed to
34560 about 60MB for @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}.
34561
34562 Work is ongoing to remove all binary blobs from our free software
34563 bootstrap stack, working towards a Full Source Bootstrap. Also ongoing
34564 is work to bring these bootstraps to the @code{arm-linux} and
34565 @code{aarch64-linux} architectures and to the Hurd.
34566
34567 If you are interested, join us on @samp{#bootstrappable} on the Freenode
34568 IRC network or discuss on @email{bug-mes@@gnu.org} or
34569 @email{gash-devel@@nongnu.org}.
34570
34571 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
34572 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
34573
34574 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
34575 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
34576 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
34577
34578 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
34579 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
34580 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
34581 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
34582
34583 @example
34584 guix graph -t derivation \
34585 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
34586 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
34587 @end example
34588
34589 or, for the further Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
34590
34591 @example
34592 guix graph -t derivation \
34593 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
34594 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
34595 @end example
34596
34597 At this level of detail, things are
34598 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
34599 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
34600 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
34601 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
34602 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
34603 (@pxref{The Store}).
34604
34605 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
34606 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
34607 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
34608 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
34609 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
34610 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
34611 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
34612 tarball to be unpacked.
34613
34614 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
34615 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
34616 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
34617 is what the @file{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
34618 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
34619 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
34620 in the store, using the original layout. The
34621 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
34622 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
34623 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
34624 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
34625
34626 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
34627 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
34628 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
34629 point we have a working C tool chain.
34630
34631 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
34632
34633 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
34634 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
34635 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
34636 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
34637 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
34638 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
34639 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
34640
34641 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
34642 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
34643 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
34644 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
34645 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
34646 package from source. The command:
34647
34648 @example
34649 guix graph -t bag \
34650 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
34651 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | xdot -
34652 @end example
34653
34654 @noindent
34655 displays the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
34656 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
34657 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
34658 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
34659
34660 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
34661
34662 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
34663 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
34664 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
34665 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
34666 built.
34667
34668 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
34669 tools---i.e., with @option{--target} equal to @option{--host}. They are
34670 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
34671 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
34672
34673 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built. GCC
34674 uses @command{ld} from the final Binutils, and links programs against
34675 the just-built libc. This tool chain is used to build the other
34676 packages used by Guix and by the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash,
34677 Coreutils, etc.
34678
34679 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
34680 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
34681 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
34682 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
34683 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
34684
34685
34686 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
34687
34688 @cindex bootstrap binaries
34689 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
34690 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
34691 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
34692 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
34693
34694 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
34695 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
34696 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
34697 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
34698 command-line tools):
34699
34700 @example
34701 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
34702 @end example
34703
34704 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
34705 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
34706 this section.
34707
34708 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
34709 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
34710 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
34711 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
34712 know.
34713
34714 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
34715
34716 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
34717 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
34718 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
34719 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
34720 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
34721 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
34722
34723 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
34724 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
34725 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
34726 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
34727 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
34728
34729 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
34730 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
34731 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
34732 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
34733 a simple and auditable assembler.
34734
34735 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
34736 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
34737 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
34738 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
34739 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
34740 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
34741 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
34742 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
34743
34744 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
34745 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
34746
34747 @node Porting
34748 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
34749
34750 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
34751 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
34752 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
34753 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
34754 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
34755 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
34756 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
34757
34758 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
34759 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
34760 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
34761 one:
34762
34763 @example
34764 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
34765 @end example
34766
34767 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
34768 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
34769 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
34770 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
34771 taught about the new platform.
34772
34773 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
34774 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
34775 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
34776 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
34777 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
34778 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
34779 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
34780 as well.
34781
34782 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
34783 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
34784 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
34785 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @option{--with-abi}
34786 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
34787 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
34788 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
34789 reason.
34790
34791 @c *********************************************************************
34792 @include contributing.texi
34793
34794 @c *********************************************************************
34795 @node Acknowledgments
34796 @chapter Acknowledgments
34797
34798 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
34799 which was designed and
34800 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
34801 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix). Nix pioneered functional package
34802 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
34803 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
34804 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
34805
34806 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
34807 an inspiration for Guix.
34808
34809 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
34810 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
34811 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
34812 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
34813 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
34814
34815
34816 @c *********************************************************************
34817 @node GNU Free Documentation License
34818 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
34819 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
34820 @include fdl-1.3.texi
34821
34822 @c *********************************************************************
34823 @node Concept Index
34824 @unnumbered Concept Index
34825 @printindex cp
34826
34827 @node Programming Index
34828 @unnumbered Programming Index
34829 @syncodeindex tp fn
34830 @syncodeindex vr fn
34831 @printindex fn
34832
34833 @bye
34834
34835 @c Local Variables:
34836 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
34837 @c End: